Renesas HD6417014RF28 32-bit risc microcomputer Datasheet

REJ09B0398-0500
The revision list can be viewed directly by clicking the title page.
The revision list summarizes the locations of revisions and
additions. Details should always be checked by referring to the
relevant text.
32
TM
SH7014, SH7016, SH7017F-ZTAT
Hardware Manual
Renesas 32-Bit RISC Microcomputer
SuperH RISC engine family/SH7010 Series
TM
SH7014
SH7016
SH7017
Rev.5.00
Revision date: Sep. 27, 2007
HD6417014F28
HD6417014RF28
HD6437016F28
HD64F7017F28
www.renesas.com
Notes regarding these materials
1. This document is provided for reference purposes only so that Renesas customers may select the appropriate
Renesas products for their use. Renesas neither makes warranties or representations with respect to the
accuracy or completeness of the information contained in this document nor grants any license to any
intellectual property rights or any other rights of Renesas or any third party with respect to the information in
this document.
2. Renesas shall have no liability for damages or infringement of any intellectual property or other rights arising
out of the use of any information in this document, including, but not limited to, product data, diagrams, charts,
programs, algorithms, and application circuit examples.
3. You should not use the products or the technology described in this document for the purpose of military
applications such as the development of weapons of mass destruction or for the purpose of any other military
use. When exporting the products or technology described herein, you should follow the applicable export
control laws and regulations, and procedures required by such laws and regulations.
4. All information included in this document such as product data, diagrams, charts, programs, algorithms, and
application circuit examples, is current as of the date this document is issued. Such information, however, is
subject to change without any prior notice. Before purchasing or using any Renesas products listed in this
document, please confirm the latest product information with a Renesas sales office. Also, please pay regular
and careful attention to additional and different information to be disclosed by Renesas such as that disclosed
through our website. (http://www.renesas.com )
5. Renesas has used reasonable care in compiling the information included in this document, but Renesas
assumes no liability whatsoever for any damages incurred as a result of errors or omissions in the information
included in this document.
6. When using or otherwise relying on the information in this document, you should evaluate the information in
light of the total system before deciding about the applicability of such information to the intended application.
Renesas makes no representations, warranties or guaranties regarding the suitability of its products for any
particular application and specifically disclaims any liability arising out of the application and use of the
information in this document or Renesas products.
7. With the exception of products specified by Renesas as suitable for automobile applications, Renesas
products are not designed, manufactured or tested for applications or otherwise in systems the failure or
malfunction of which may cause a direct threat to human life or create a risk of human injury or which require
especially high quality and reliability such as safety systems, or equipment or systems for transportation and
traffic, healthcare, combustion control, aerospace and aeronautics, nuclear power, or undersea communication
transmission. If you are considering the use of our products for such purposes, please contact a Renesas
sales office beforehand. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth above.
8. Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, you should not use Renesas products for the purposes listed below:
(1) artificial life support devices or systems
(2) surgical implantations
(3) healthcare intervention (e.g., excision, administration of medication, etc.)
(4) any other purposes that pose a direct threat to human life
Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of the uses set forth in the above and purchasers who
elect to use Renesas products in any of the foregoing applications shall indemnify and hold harmless Renesas
Technology Corp., its affiliated companies and their officers, directors, and employees against any and all
damages arising out of such applications.
9. You should use the products described herein within the range specified by Renesas, especially with respect
to the maximum rating, operating supply voltage range, movement power voltage range, heat radiation
characteristics, installation and other product characteristics. Renesas shall have no liability for malfunctions or
damages arising out of the use of Renesas products beyond such specified ranges.
10. Although Renesas endeavors to improve the quality and reliability of its products, IC products have specific
characteristics such as the occurrence of failure at a certain rate and malfunctions under certain use
conditions. Please be sure to implement safety measures to guard against the possibility of physical injury, and
injury or damage caused by fire in the event of the failure of a Renesas product, such as safety design for
hardware and software including but not limited to redundancy, fire control and malfunction prevention,
appropriate treatment for aging degradation or any other applicable measures. Among others, since the
evaluation of microcomputer software alone is very difficult, please evaluate the safety of the final products or
system manufactured by you.
11. In case Renesas products listed in this document are detached from the products to which the Renesas
products are attached or affixed, the risk of accident such as swallowing by infants and small children is very
high. You should implement safety measures so that Renesas products may not be easily detached from your
products. Renesas shall have no liability for damages arising out of such detachment.
12. This document may not be reproduced or duplicated, in any form, in whole or in part, without prior written
approval from Renesas.
13. Please contact a Renesas sales office if you have any questions regarding the information contained in this
document, Renesas semiconductor products, or if you have any other inquiries.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page ii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products
The following usage notes are applicable to all MPU/MCU products from Renesas. For detailed usage notes
on the products covered by this manual, refer to the relevant sections of the manual. If the descriptions under
General Precautions in the Handling of MPU/MCU Products and in the body of the manual differ from each
other, the description in the body of the manual takes precedence.
1. Handling of Unused Pins
Handle unused pins in accord with the directions given under Handling of Unused Pins in
the manual.
⎯ The input pins of CMOS products are generally in the high-impedance state. In
operation with an unused pin in the open-circuit state, extra electromagnetic noise is
induced in the vicinity of LSI, an associated shoot-through current flows internally, and
malfunctions may occur due to the false recognition of the pin state as an input signal.
Unused pins should be handled as described under Handling of Unused Pins in the
manual.
2. Processing at Power-on
The state of the product is undefined at the moment when power is supplied.
⎯ The states of internal circuits in the LSI are indeterminate and the states of register
settings and pins are undefined at the moment when power is supplied.
In a finished product where the reset signal is applied to the external reset pin, the
states of pins are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the
reset process is completed.
In a similar way, the states of pins in a product that is reset by an on-chip power-on
reset function are not guaranteed from the moment when power is supplied until the
power reaches the level at which resetting has been specified.
3. Prohibition of Access to Reserved Addresses
Access to reserved addresses is prohibited.
⎯ The reserved addresses are provided for the possible future expansion of functions. Do
not access these addresses; the correct operation of LSI is not guaranteed if they are
accessed.
4. Clock Signals
After applying a reset, only release the reset line after the operating clock signal has
become stable. When switching the clock signal during program execution, wait until the
target clock signal has stabilized.
⎯ When the clock signal is generated with an external resonator (or from an external
oscillator) during a reset, ensure that the reset line is only released after full stabilization
of the clock signal. Moreover, when switching to a clock signal produced with an
external resonator (or by an external oscillator) while program execution is in progress,
wait until the target clock signal is stable.
5. Differences between Products
Before changing from one product to another, i.e. to one with a different type number,
confirm that the change will not lead to problems.
⎯ The characteristics of MPU/MCU in the same group but having different type numbers
may differ because of the differences in internal memory capacity and layout pattern.
When changing to products of different type numbers, implement a system-evaluation
test for each of the products.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page iii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page iv of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Preface
The SH7014/16/17 CMOS single-chip microprocessors integrate a Renesas Technology-original
architecture, high-speed CPU with peripheral functions required for system configuration.
The CPU has a RISC-type instruction set. Most instructions can be executed in one clock cycle,
which greatly improves instruction execution speed. In addition, the 32-bit internal-bus
architecture enhances data processing power. With this CPU, it has become possible to assemble
low cost, high performance/high-functioning systems, even for applications that were previously
impossible with microprocessors, such as real-time control, which demands high speeds. In
particular, this LSI has a 1-kbyte on-chip cache, which allows an improvement in CPU
performance during external memory access.
In addition, this LSI includes on-chip peripheral functions necessary for system configuration,
such as large-capacity ROM (except the SH7014, which is ROMless) and RAM, timers, a serial
communication interface (SCI), an A/D converter, an interrupt controller (INTC), and I/O ports.
Memory or peripheral LSIs can be connected efficiently with an external memory access support
function. This greatly reduces system cost.
This LSI has an F-ZTAT™ version with on-chip flash memory and a mask ROM version. These
versions enable users to respond quickly and flexibly to changing application specifications,
growing production volumes, and other conditions.
This hardware manual covers the SH7014/16/17/. For a detailed description of instructions, refer
to the programming manual.
Related Manuals
SH7014/16/17 instruction execution: SH-1/SH-2/SH-DSP Software Manual
For information on development systems, please contact a Renesas Technology sales
representative.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page v of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page vi of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Main Revisions for This Edition
Item
Page
All
—
Revision (See Manual for Details)
Company name and brand names amended
(Before) Hitachi, Ltd. → (After) Renesas Technology Corp.
Description of DTC deleted
Figure amended
Figure 1.1 Block
Diagram of the SH7014
RES
WDTOVF
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
NMI
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
RAM (3 kB)/
cache (1 kB)
PLL
PLLVCC
PB9/IRQ7/A21
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
PB7/A19
PB6/A18
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
A17
A16
6
PA15/CK
RD
WRH
WRL
CS1
CS0
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
PA4/TXD1
PA3/RXD1
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
PA1/TXD0
PA0/RXD0
1.2 Block Diagram
PLLVSS
VCC
CPU
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
AVCC
AVSS
Direct memory
access controller
Interrupt
controller
Serial communication interface
(×2 channels)
: Peripheral data bus
: Internal address bus
: Internal upper data bus
: Internal lower data bus
Multifunction timer/
pulse unit
A/D
converter
Watchdog
timer
PE15/DACK1
PE14/DACK0/AH
PE13
PE12
PE11
PE10
PE9
PE8
PE7/TIOC2B
PE6/TIOC2A
PE5/TIOC1B
PE4/TIOC1A
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
PF7/AN7
PF6/AN6
PF5/AN5
PF4/AN4
PF3/AN3
PF2/AN2
PF1/AN1
PF0/AN0
Compare match
timer (×2 channels)
: Peripheral address bus
Figure 1.2 Block
7
Diagram of the SH7016,
SH7017
Bus state controller
A15
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
D15
D14
D13
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
Note amended
Note:
*
VCC in the SH7016, FWP in the SH7017 (except
FWE pin in the programmer mode).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page vii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
1.3.1 Pin Arrangement 9
Note amended
Figure 1.4 SH7016,
SH7017 Pin
Arrangement (FP-112
Top View)
Note:
5.3.1 Address Error
Sources
64
VCC in the SH7016, FWP in the SH7017 (except
FWE pin in the programmer mode).
*
Title added and table amended
Bus Cycle
Table 5.5 Bus Cycles
and Address Errors
Bus
Master Bus Cycle Description
Type
Instruction CPU
fetch
5.4.1 Interrupt Sources 65
Address Errors
Instruction fetched from even address
None (normal)
Instruction fetched from odd address
Address error occurs
Instruction fetched from other than on-chip peripheral
module space*
None (normal)
Instruction fetched from on-chip peripheral module
space*
Address error occurs
Instruction fetched from external memory space when
in single chip mode
Address error occurs
Title added and description amended
Table 5.6 shows the sources that start up interrupt exception
processing. These are divided into NMI,
IRQ and on-chip
peripheral modules.
6.3.1 Interrupt Priority 82
Registers A to H (IPRA
to IPRH)
IPRA to IPRH are initialized to H'0000 by a power-on reset
They are not initialized in standby mode.
8.1.3 Pin Configuration 103
Table amended
Table 8.1 Pin
Configuration
8.1.5 Address Map
Description amended
Signal
105
I/O
Description
WRH
O
Strobe that indicates a write cycle to the higher byte (D15 to D8) for
ordinary space/multiplex I/O. Also output during DRAM access.
WRL
O
Strobe that indicates a write cycle to the lower byte (D7 to D0) for ordinary
space/multiplex I/O. Also output during DRAM access.
Table amdended
Table 8.3 Address Map
Addresss
•
H'00000000 to H'0001FFF*
In on-chip ROM
enabled mode
8.2.1 Bus Control
Register 1 (BCR1)
Bit 0⎯CS0 Space Size
Specification (A0SZ)
4
108
Note added
Note: A0SZ is effective only in on-chip ROM effective mode.
In on-chip ROM ineffective mode, the CS0 space bus
size is specified by the mode pin.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page viii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
.
Item
Page
8.2.5 DRAM Area
115
Control Register (DCR)
Revision (See Manual for Details)
Description amended
DCR is a 16-bit read/write register that selects the number of
waits, operation mode, number of address multiplex shifts and
the like for DRAM control.
After a power-on reset, write the initial values to the bits in DCR
and do not change the values afterward.
Do not perform any DRAM space accesses before DCR initial
settings are completed.
9.1.1 Features
147
Description amended
•
Transfer requests: There are three DMAC transfer activation
requests, as indicated below.
⎯ External request: From two DREQ pins. DREQ can be
detected either by falling edge or by low level. These
can be received by all channels.
9.2.3 DMA Transfer
153
Count Registers 0, 1
(DMATCR0, DMATCR1)
Description amended
… Specifying a H'000001 gives a transfer count of 1, while
H'000000 gives the maximum setting, 65,536 transfers. While
DMAC is in operation, the number of transfers to be performed
is indicated. The initial value after power-on resets or in
software standby mode is undefined.
Upper sixteen bits of this register are read as 0 and the write
value should always be 0.
9.3.5 Number of Bus 176
Cycle States and DREQ
Pin Sample Timing
Cycle Steal Mode
Operations:
Note added
Note: With cycle-steal and single address operation, sampling
timing is the same whether DREQ detection is by level
or by edge.
Figure 9.12 Cycle
Steal, Single Address
and Level Detection
(Normal Operation)
Burst Mode, Single
Address, and Edge
Detection:
185
Description amended
…During this period, data is undefined, and DACK is not
output. Nor is the number of DMAC transfers counted. The
actual DMAC transfer begins after one dummy bus cycle
output. Thereafter, DMAC transfer continues until the data
transfer count set in the DMATCR has ended. ...
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page ix of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
9.3.6 DMA Transfer
Ending Conditions
187
Description amended
When the processing of a one unit transfer is complete. In a
dual address mode direct address transfer, even if an address
error occurs or the NMI flag is set during read processing, the
transfer will not be halted until after completion of the following
write processing. In such a case, SAR, DAR, and DMATCR
values are updated.
Conditions for Ending All
Channels
Simultaneously:
9.4.2 Example of DMA 189
Transfer between
External RAM and
External Device with
DACK
In this example, an external request, single address mode
transfer with external memory as the transfer source and an
external device with DACK as the transfer destination is
executed using DMAC channel 1.
10.1.1 Features
Description amended
191
Description amended
⎯ PWM mode: PWM output can be provided with any duty
cycle. When combined with the counter synchronizing
function, up to seven-phase PWM output is enabled
(with channels 0 to 2 set to PWM mode 2 and channel 0
synchronized with the TGR0A register (channels 0 to 2
phase output: 3, 2, 2)).
10.1.4 Register
Configuration
198
Table 10.3 Register
Configuration
10.2.4 Timer Interrupt 215
Enable Register (TIER)
Bit 5—Underflow
Interrupt Enable
(TCIEU)
Bit 3—TGR Interrupt
Enable D (TGIED):
216
Description amended
This bit is reserved for channel 0. It always reads as 0. The
write value should always be 0.
Description amended
This bit is reserved for channels 1 and 2. It always reads as 0.
The write value should always be 0.
Bit 2—TGR Interrupt
Enable C (TGIEC):
10.2.5 Timer Status
Register (TSR)
Notes amended
Notes: Do not access empty addresses.
1. 16-bit registers (TCNT, TGR) cannot be read or
written in 8-bit units.
2. Write 0 to clear flags.
Description amended
This bit is reserved for channels 1 and 2. It always reads as 0.
The write value should always be 0.
217
Description amended
The timer status register (TSR) is an 8-bit register that indicates
the status of each channel. The MTU has three TSR registers,
one each for channel. TSR is initialized to H'C0 by a power-on
reset or by standby mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page x of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
10.4.4 Buffer Operation 237
Description amended
Buffer Operation
Examples⎯when TGR
Is an Input Capture
Register
Figure 10.20 shows an example of TGRA set as an input
capture register with the TGRA and TGRC registers set for
buffer operation.
238
Figure 10.20 Buffer
Operation Example
(Input Capture Register)
Figure amended
10.4.6 PWM Mode
240
TIOC0A
Description amended
A period can be set for a register by using the TGR comparematch as a counter clear source. All
channels can be
independently set to PWM mode. Synchronous operation is
also possible.
10.4.7 Phase Counting 250
Mode
Phase Counting Mode
Application Example:
10.6.1 Input/Output
Timing
254
Output Compare Output
Timing:
10.7.10 TCNT2 Write 269
and Overflow/Underflow
Contention in Cascade
Connection
Description amended
The channel 1 TGR1A and TGR1B registers are set for the
input capture function, the channel 0 TGR0A and TGR0C
register compare-match is used as an input capture source,
and all of the control period increment and decrement values
are stored. This procedure enables the accurate detection of
position and speed.
Description amended
The compare-match signal is generated at the final state of
TCNT and TGR matching. When a compare-match signal is
issued, the output value set in TIOR
is output to the output
compare output pin (the TIOC pin). After TCNT and TGR
matching, a compare-match signal is not issued until
immediately before the TCNT input clock.
Description amended
With timer counters TCNT1 and TCNT2 in a cascade
connection, when a contention occurs during TCNT1 count
(during a TCNT2 overflow/underflow) in the T2 state of the
TCNT2 write cycle, the write to TCNT2 is conducted, and the
TCNT1 count signal is prohibited. At this point, if there is match
with TGR1A
and the TCNT1 value, a compare signal is
issued. Furthermore, when the TCNT1 count clock is selected
as the input capture source of channel 0, TGRA0 to TGRD0
carry out the input capture operation. In addition, when the
compare match/input capture is selected as the input capture
source of TGRB1, TGRB1 carries out input capture operation.
The timing is shown in figure 10.57.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xi of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
10.8.1 Operating
Modes
273
Description amended
10.8.3 Operation in
273
Case of Re-Setting Due
to Error during
Operation, Etc.
10.8.4 Overview of
277
Initialization Procedures
and Mode Transitions in
Case of Error during
Operation, etc.
•
Normal mode (channels 0 to 2)
•
PWM mode 1 (channels 0 to 2)
•
PWM mode 2 (channels 0 to 2)
•
Phase counting modes 1 to 4 (channels 1 and 2)
Description amended
The MTU has four operating modes, as stated above. There
are thus 16 mode transition combinations
. Possible mode
transition combinations are shown in table 10.14.
Note deleted
(3) Operation when
Error Occurs during
Normal Mode Operation,
and Operation is
Restarted in PWM Mode
2:
(4) Operation when
278
Error Occurs during
Normal Mode Operation,
and Operation is
Note deleted
Restarted in Phase
Counting Mode:
(7) Operation when
Error Occurs during
PWM Mode 1
Operation, and
Operation is
281
Note deleted
282
Note deleted
Restarted in PWM Mode
2:
(8) Operation when
Error Occurs during
PWM Mode 1
Operation, and
Operation is
Restarted in Phase
Counting Mode:
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
12.2.7 Serial Status
Register (SSR)
318
Description amended and notes added
Bit 4—Framing Error
(FER):
Bit 4
FER
0
1
Description
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally*1
[Clearing conditions]
•
Power-on reset or standby mode
•
When 0 is written to FER after reading FER = 1
A receive framing error occurred*2
[Setting condition]
When at the end of an SCI receive operation the final stop bit
of the receive data is checked and its value*2 is 0
Notes:
Bit 3—Parity Error
(PER):
1. The FER flag is not affected and retains their previous
values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
2. When the stop bit length is two bits, only the first bit is
checked to see if it is a 1. The second stop bit is not
checked. When a framing error occurs, the SCI transfers
the receive data into the RDR but does not set RDRF.
Serial receiving cannot continue while FER is set to 1. In
the clock synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also
disabled. In addition, serial transmission cannot continue
in clock synchronous mode.
Description amended and notes added
Bit 3
PER
0
1
Description
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally*1
[Clearing conditions]
•
Power-on reset or standby mode
•
When 0 is written to PER after reading PER = 1
A receive parity error occurred*2
[Setting condition]
PER is set to 1 if the number of 1s in receive data, including
the parity bit, does not match the even or odd parity setting of
the parity mode bit (O/E) in the serial mode register (SMR)
Notes:
1. The PER flag is not affected and retains their previous
values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to 0.
2. When a parity error occurs, the SCI transfers the receive
data into the RDR but does not set RDRF. Serial receiving
cannot continue while PER is set to 1. In the clock
synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also disabled. In
addition, serial transmission cannot continue in clock
synchronous mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xiii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
12.5.7 Constraints on
DMAC Use
366
Description amended
13.1.1 Features
367
•
When using an external clock source for the synchronization
clock, update the TDR with the DMAC
, and then after
five system clocks or more elapse, input a transmit clock. If
a transmit clock is input in the first four system clocks after
the TDR is written, an error may occur (figure 12.22).
Description amended
•
High-speed conversion
⎯ Minimum conversion time:
2.9 µs per channel (for 28-MHz operation)
1.4 μs per channel during continuous conversion
13.4 Operation
13.4.7 Conversion
Start Modes
378
388
Description amended
•
In buffer operation, the previous conversion result is saved
in a buffer register at the end of a conversion for the
relevant channel.
•
In simultaneous sampling operation, the analog input
voltages of two channels are sampled simultaneously then
converted in order.
•
Software, a timer conversion start trigger (MTU) can be
selected as the conversion start condition.
Description amended
In the low-power conversion mode, power is applied to the
analog circuitry simultaneous to the conversion start (ADST
set). When 200 cycles of the reference clock have elapsed,
conversion becomes possible for the analog circuit and the first
A/D conversion begins. When performing consecutive
conversions, the second and later conversions are executed in
20 cycles. Select the basic clock with the CKS bit of the
ADCSR. When the A/D conversion ends, ADST is cleared to 0
and the analog circuit power supply is automatically cut off.
Because the analog circuit is only active during the A/D
conversion operation period in this mode, current consumption
can be reduced.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xiv of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
13.4.8 A/D Conversion
Time
392
Note 2 amended
2. Table entries are for when PWR = 1. If 200 states have not
elapsed since the ADST bit has been set, no conversions
are done until after those 200 states have occurred.
When PWR = 0, add 200 states to the first A/D conversion
start delay time. When two or more conversions are
performed in succession, tcp is 20 cycles when CKS = 0,
and 40 cycles when CKS = 1.
Table 13.7 A/D
Conversion Times
Table 13.8 Operating
Frequency and CKS Bit
Settings
Note added
13.6.5 A/D Conversion 394
Termination
(HD6417014R only)
Title amended
14.1.3 Pin
Configuration
Note: The indication "⎯" means the setting is not available.
399
Description amended
The eight analog input pins are divided into two groups, with
analog input pins 0 to 3 (AN0 to AN3) comprising group 0, and
analog input pins 4 to 7 (AN4 to AN7) comprising group 1.
The AVCC and AVSS pins are for the mid-speed speed A/D
converter internal analog section power supply.
14.2.1 A/D Data
401
Register A to D (ADDRA
to ADDRD)
14.4.2 Scan Mode
(SCAN = 1)
409
Description amended
A/D registers are special registers that read stored results of
A/D conversion in 16 bits. There are four registers: ADDRA to
ADDRD.
Description amended
An example of operation in scan mode when three channels of
group 0 (AN0 to AN2) are selected for A/D conversion is shown
in figure 14.4.
1. Set the operation mode to scan mode (SCAN = 1), set the
scan group to group 0 (CH2 = 0), set the analog channels to
AN0 to AN2 (CH1 = 1, CH0 = 0), and then start A/D
conversion (ADST = 1).
14.5 Interrupt
414
Description amended
The mid-speed A/D converter's interrupt source is summarized
in table 14.5.
When the DMAC are activated by an ADI interrupt, the ADF flag
of ADCSR is cleared to 0 by register access of A/D.
15.4.1 Interrupt
Sources
427
Title amended
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xv of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
15.4.3 Compare Match 428
Flag Clear Timing
16.3.2 Port A Control 446
Registers L1, L2
(PACRL1 and PACRL2)
Port A Control Register 447
L1 (PACRL1):
Bit 14—PA15 Mode
(PA15MD):
16.3.3 Port B I/O
Register (PBIOR)
452
17.2.2 Port A Data
Register L (PADRL)
477
17.3.2 Port B Data
Register (PBDR)
479
17.4.2 Port C Data
Register (PCDR)
481
17.5.2 Port D Data
Register L (PDDRL)
483
Revision (See Manual for Details)
Description amended
The CMF bit of the CMCSR register is cleared either by writing
a 0 to it after reading a 1
. Figure 15.5 shows the timing
when the CMF bit is cleared by the CPU.
Description amended
PACRL1 is initialized by external power-on reset to H'4000 in
extended mode, and to H'0000 in single chip mode. PACRL2 is
initialized by external power-on reset to H'0000. Neither register
is initialized by reset by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so
the previous data is maintained.
Description amended
Bit 14
PA15MD Description
0
General input/output (PA15)
1
Clock output (CK)
(single chip mode initial value)
(extended mode initial value)
Description amended
The port B I/O register L (PBIOR) is a 16-bit read/write register
that selects input or output for the ten pins of port B (eight pins
in the SH7014). Bits PB9IOR to PB0IOR correspond to the
PB9/IRQ7/A21 pin to PB0/A16 pin. PBIOR is enabled when the
port B pins function as input/outputs (PB9 to PB0). For other
functions, it is disabled.
Description amended
PADRL is initialized by an external power-on reset. However,
PADRL is not initialized for a
reset by WDT, standby mode,
or sleep mode.
Description amended
PBDR is initialized by an external power-on reset. However,
PBDR is not initialized for a
reset by WDT, standby mode,
or sleep mode.
Description amended
PCDR is initialized by an external power-on reset. However,
PCDR is not initialized for a
reset by WDT, standby mode,
or sleep mode.
Description amended
PDDRL is initialized by an external power-on reset. However,
PDDRL is not initialized for a
reset by WDT, standby mode,
or sleep mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xvi of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
17.6.2 Port E Data
Register (PEDR)
485
Description amended
17.7.2 Port F Data
Register (PFDR)
487
PEDR is initialized by a external power-on reset. However,
PEDR is not initialized for a
reset by WDT, standby mode,
or sleep mode, so the previous data is retained.
Description amended
PFDR is an 8-bit read-only register that stores data for port F.
The bits PF7DR to PF0DR correspond to the PF7/AN7 to
PF0/AN0 pins.
Any value written into these bits is ignored,
and there is no effect on the status of the pins. When any of the
bits are read, the pin status rather than the bit value is read
directly. However, when an A/D converter analog input is being
sampled, values of 1 are read out. Table 17.17 shows the
read/write operations of the port F data register.
PFDR is not initialized by power-on resets,
standby mode,
or sleep mode (the bits always reflect the pin status).
18.4 Register
Configuration
Table 18.3 Flash
Memory Registers
497
Notes amended
Notes: FLMCR1, FLMCR2, and EBR1 are 8-bit registers, and
RAMER is a 16-bit register.
Only byte accesses are valid for FLMCR1, FLMCR2,
and EBR1, the access requiring 3 cycles. Three cycles
are required for a byte or word access to RAMER, and 6
cycles for a longword access.
When a longword write is performed on RAMER, 0 must
always be written to the lower word (address
H'FFFF8630). Operation is not guaranteed if any other
value is written.
1. In modes in which the on-chip flash memory is
disabled, a read will return H'00, and writes are
invalid. Writes are also disabled when the FWE bit
is set to 1 in FLMCR1.
2. A read in a mode in which on-chip flash memory is
disabled will return H'00.
3. When a low level is input to the FWP pin, the initial
value is H'80.
4. When a high level is input to the FWP pin, or if a low
level is input and the SWE bit in FLMCR1 is not set,
these registers are initialized to H'00.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xvii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
18.5.4 RAM Emulation 503
Register (RAMER)
18.7.2 Program-Verify 512
Mode
Revision (See Manual for Details)
Description amended
RAMER specifies the area of flash memory to be overlapped
with part of RAM when emulating real-time flash memory
programming. RAMER is initialized to H'0000 by a reset and in
hardware standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby
mode. RAMER settings should be made in user mode or user
program mode.
Figure amended and note 5 added
Start
Figure 18.13 Program/
Program-Verify
Flowchart
Set SWE-bit of FLMCR1
Wait 10 μs
*5
Store 32 bytes write data in write
data area and rewrite data area
*4
n=1
m=0
Successively write 32-byte data in rewrite data
area in RAM to flash memory
*1
Enable WDT
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
Wait 50 μs
*5
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
Write start
Wait 200 μs
*5
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
Write end
Wait 10 μs
*5
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
n←n+1
Wait 10 μs
*5
Disable WDT
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
Wait 4 μs
*5
Perform dummy-write of H'FF to verify address
Wait 2 μs
*5
Read verify data
*2
Increment address
*3
Write data = Verify data?
NG
m=1
OK
NG
Operate rewrite data
*3
Transfer rewrite data to rewrite data area
*4
32 byte data
verify complete?
OK
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
Wait 4 μs
m = 0?
OK
Note:
*5
NG
*5
n ≥ 1000?
NG
OK
Clear SWE bit of FLMCR1
Clear SWE bit of FLMCR1
Write end
Write failure
5. Set the values of x, y, z, α, β, γ, ε, η, and N to match
the characteristics of the memory device.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xviii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
Revision (See Manual for Details)
18.7.3 Erase Mode
517
Description added
When erasing flash memory, the erase/erase-verify flowchart
shown in figure 18.14 should be followed.
To perform data or program erasure, set the 1 bit flash memory
area to be erased in erase block register 1 (EBR1) at least 10
µs after setting the SWE bit to 1 in flash memory control
register 1 (FLMCR1).
18.8.2 Software
Protection
525
Description amended
Software protection can be implemented by setting the SWE bit
in FLMCR1, erase block register 1 (EBR1) and the RAMS bit in
the RAM emulation register (RAMER).
18.11.4 Auto-Program 538
Mode
Description amended
3. The lower 8 bits of the transfer address must be H'00, H'80.
If a value other than an effective address is input,
processing will switch to a memory write operation but a
write error will be flagged.
4. Memory address transfer is performed in the second cycle
(figure 18.24). Do not perform transfer after the third cycle.
18.11.6 Status Read
Mode
543
Note amended
Note: I/O2 and I/O3 are undefined at present.
Table 18.19 Status
Read Mode Return
Commands
22.3.3 Bus Timing
567
Table 22.7 Bus Timing
22.3.4 Direct Memory
Access Controller
Timing
Table 22.8 Direct
Memory Access
Controller Timing
Description amended and notes added
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC
±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = – 20 to +75°C
Notes: TPC is the set value of the TPC bit in DCR.
* The delay time Min values are reference values
(typ).)
579
Description amended
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = VCC
±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = – 20 to +75°C
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xix of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Item
Page
22.3.5 Multifunction
581
Timer Pulse Unit Timing
Table 22.9
Multifunction Timer
Pulse Unit Timing
Revision (See Manual for Details)
Description amended
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = VCC
±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = – 20 to +75°C
22.3.6 I/O Port Timing 582
Description amended
Table 22.10 I/O Port
Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = VCC
±10%, VSS =AVSS = 0 V, Ta = – 20 to +75°C
22.3.7 Watchdog Timer 583
Timing
Table 22.11 Watchdog
Timer Timing
22.3.8 Serial
Communication
Interface Timing
583
Description amended
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = VCC
±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = – 20 to +75°C
Description amended
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ± 10%, AVCC= VCC
±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = – 20 to +75°C
Table 22.12 Serial
Communication
Interface Timing
A.2 Functions
600 to
681
Newly added
Appendix B. I/O Port
Block Diagrams
686
Title amended
706
Title and table amended
Figure B.5
PAn/TCLKm/
IRQx Block Diagram
(SH7014, Mask)
C.1 Pin States
Table C.1 Pin States in
Reset, and Power-Down
Modes
Pin Function
Class
Pin Name
Data bus
D0 to D15
SCI
SCK0, SCK1
TXD0, TXD1
RXD0, RXD1
All trademarks and registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xx of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Contents
Section 1 SH7014/16/17 Overview ................................................................................
1.1
1.2
1.3
1
SH7014/16/17 Overview................................................................................................... 1
1.1.1 SH7014/16/17 Series Features ............................................................................. 1
Block Diagram .................................................................................................................. 6
Pin Arrangement and Pin Functions.................................................................................. 8
1.3.1 Pin Arrangement .................................................................................................. 8
1.3.2 Pin Arrangement by Mode................................................................................... 10
1.3.3 Pin Functions ....................................................................................................... 14
Section 2 CPU ...................................................................................................................... 19
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
Register Configuration ......................................................................................................
2.1.1 General Registers (Rn).........................................................................................
2.1.2 Control Registers .................................................................................................
2.1.3 System Registers ..................................................................................................
2.1.4 Initial Values of Registers....................................................................................
Data Formats .....................................................................................................................
2.2.1 Data Format in Registers......................................................................................
2.2.2 Data Format in Memory.......................................................................................
2.2.3 Immediate Data Format .......................................................................................
Instruction Features...........................................................................................................
2.3.1 RISC-Type Instruction Set...................................................................................
2.3.2 Addressing Modes ...............................................................................................
2.3.3 Instruction Format................................................................................................
Instruction Set by Classification .......................................................................................
Processing States...............................................................................................................
2.5.1 State Transitions...................................................................................................
2.5.2 Power-Down State ...............................................................................................
19
19
20
21
21
22
22
22
22
23
23
26
30
33
46
46
48
Section 3 Operating Modes............................................................................................... 51
3.1
3.2
3.3
Operating Modes, Types, and Selection............................................................................ 51
Explanation of Operating Modes ...................................................................................... 52
Pin Configuration.............................................................................................................. 52
Section 4 Clock Pulse Generator (CPG) ....................................................................... 53
4.1
4.2
Overview...........................................................................................................................
4.1.1 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................
Oscillator...........................................................................................................................
4.2.1 Connecting a Crystal Oscillator ...........................................................................
53
53
54
54
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxi of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
4.3
4.2.2 External Clock Input Method............................................................................... 56
Prescaler............................................................................................................................ 57
Section 5 Exception Processing....................................................................................... 59
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
5.6
5.7
5.8
Overview...........................................................................................................................
5.1.1 Types of Exception Processing and Priority ........................................................
5.1.2 Exception Processing Operations.........................................................................
5.1.3 Exception Processing Vector Table .....................................................................
Resets ................................................................................................................................
5.2.1 Power-on Reset ....................................................................................................
Address Errors ..................................................................................................................
5.3.1 Address Error Sources .........................................................................................
5.3.2 Address Error Exception Processing....................................................................
Interrupts...........................................................................................................................
5.4.1 Interrupt Sources..................................................................................................
5.4.2 Interrupt Priority Level ........................................................................................
5.4.3 Interrupt Exception Processing ............................................................................
Exceptions Triggered by Instructions ...............................................................................
5.5.1 Types of Exceptions Triggered by Instructions ...................................................
5.5.2 Trap Instructions ..................................................................................................
5.5.3 Illegal Slot Instructions ........................................................................................
5.5.4 General Illegal Instructions..................................................................................
When Exception Sources Are Not Accepted ....................................................................
5.6.1 Immediately after a Delayed Branch Instruction .................................................
5.6.2 Immediately after an Interrupt-Disabled Instruction............................................
Stack Status after Exception Processing Ends ..................................................................
Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................
5.8.1 Value of Stack Pointer (SP) .................................................................................
5.8.2 Value of Vector Base Register (VBR) .................................................................
5.8.3 Address Errors Caused by Stacking of Address Error Exception Processing......
59
59
60
61
63
63
64
64
65
65
65
66
66
67
67
67
68
68
69
69
69
70
71
71
71
71
Section 6 Interrupt Controller (INTC) ........................................................................... 73
6.1
6.2
Overview...........................................................................................................................
6.1.1 Features................................................................................................................
6.1.2 Block Diagram.....................................................................................................
6.1.3 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................
6.1.4 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
Interrupt Sources...............................................................................................................
6.2.1 NMI Interrupts .....................................................................................................
6.2.2 IRQ Interrupts ......................................................................................................
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
73
73
73
75
75
76
76
76
6.3
6.4
6.5
6.6
6.2.3 On-Chip Peripheral Module Interrupts ................................................................
6.2.4 Interrupt Exception Vectors and Priority Rankings .............................................
Description of Registers....................................................................................................
6.3.1 Interrupt Priority Registers A to H (IPRA to IPRH) ............................................
6.3.2 Interrupt Control Register (ICR)..........................................................................
6.3.3 IRQ Status Register (ISR)....................................................................................
Interrupt Operation............................................................................................................
6.4.1 Interrupt Sequence ...............................................................................................
6.4.2 Stack after Interrupt Exception Processing ..........................................................
Interrupt Response Time ...................................................................................................
Data Transfer with Interrupt Request Signals ...................................................................
6.6.1 Handling DMAC Activating Sources but Not CPU Interrupt Sources ................
6.6.2 Treating CPU Interrupt Sources but Not DMAC Activating Sources..................
77
77
81
81
82
83
85
85
87
88
90
90
90
Section 7 Cache Memory (CAC) .................................................................................... 91
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
Overview...........................................................................................................................
7.1.1 Features................................................................................................................
7.1.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................
7.1.3 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
Register Explanation .........................................................................................................
7.2.1 Cache Control Register (CCR) ............................................................................
Address Array and Data Array..........................................................................................
7.3.1 Cache Address Array Read/Write Space .............................................................
7.3.2 Cache Data Array Read/Write Space...................................................................
Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................
7.4.1 Cache Initialization ..............................................................................................
7.4.2 Forced Access to Address Array and Data Array ................................................
7.4.3 Cache Miss Penalty and Cache Fill Timing .........................................................
7.4.4 Cache Hit after Cache Miss .................................................................................
91
91
92
93
94
94
96
96
97
98
98
98
98
100
Section 8 Bus State Controller (BSC) ........................................................................... 101
8.1
8.2
Overview...........................................................................................................................
8.1.1 Features................................................................................................................
8.1.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................
8.1.3 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................
8.1.4 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
8.1.5 Address Map ........................................................................................................
Description of Registers....................................................................................................
8.2.1 Bus Control Register 1 (BCR1) ...........................................................................
8.2.2 Bus Control Register 2 (BCR2) ...........................................................................
101
101
102
103
103
104
107
107
109
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxiii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
8.2.3 Wait Control Register 1 (WCR1).........................................................................
8.2.4 Wait Control Register 2 (WCR2).........................................................................
8.2.5 DRAM Area Control Register (DCR) .................................................................
8.2.6 Refresh Timer Control/Status Register (RTCSR) ................................................
8.2.7 Refresh Timer Counter (RTCNT)........................................................................
8.2.8 Refresh Time Constant Register (RTCOR) .........................................................
8.3 Accessing Ordinary Space ................................................................................................
8.3.1 Basic Timing........................................................................................................
8.3.2 Wait State Control ...............................................................................................
8.3.3 CS Assert Period Extension .................................................................................
8.4 DRAM Access ..................................................................................................................
8.4.1 DRAM Direct Connection ...................................................................................
8.4.2 Basic Timing........................................................................................................
8.4.3 Wait State Control ...............................................................................................
8.4.4 Burst Operation....................................................................................................
8.4.5 Refresh Timing ....................................................................................................
8.5 Address/Data Multiplex I/O Space Access .......................................................................
8.5.1 Basic Timing........................................................................................................
8.5.2 Wait State Control ...............................................................................................
8.5.3 CS Assertion Extension .......................................................................................
8.6 Waits between Access Cycles...........................................................................................
8.6.1 Prevention of Data Bus Conflicts.........................................................................
8.6.2 Simplification of Bus Cycle Start Detection ........................................................
8.7 Bus Arbitration..................................................................................................................
8.8 Memory Connection Examples.........................................................................................
8.9 On-chip Peripheral I/O Register Access ...........................................................................
8.10 CPU Operation when Program Is in External Memory ....................................................
112
114
115
118
121
122
123
123
124
126
127
127
128
129
133
135
136
136
138
139
140
140
142
143
143
145
146
Section 9 Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC) ............................................ 147
9.1
9.2
Overview...........................................................................................................................
9.1.1 Features................................................................................................................
9.1.2 Block Diagram.....................................................................................................
9.1.3 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................
9.1.4 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................
9.2.1 DMA Source Address Registers 0, 1 (SAR0, SAR1) ..........................................
9.2.2 DMA Destination Address Registers 0, 1 (DAR0, DAR1)..................................
9.2.3 DMA Transfer Count Registers 0, 1 (DMATCR0, DMATCR1).........................
9.2.4 DMA Channel Control Registers 0, 1 (CHCR0, CHCR1)...................................
9.2.5 DMAC Operation Register (DMAOR) ................................................................
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxiv of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
147
147
148
149
150
151
151
152
153
154
159
9.3
9.4
9.5
Operation...........................................................................................................................
9.3.1 DMA Transfer Flow ............................................................................................
9.3.2 DMA Transfer Requests ......................................................................................
9.3.3 Channel Priority ...................................................................................................
9.3.4 DMA Transfer Types...........................................................................................
9.3.5 Number of Bus Cycle States and DREQ Pin Sample Timing..............................
9.3.6 DMA Transfer Ending Conditions.......................................................................
9.3.7 DMAC Access from CPU....................................................................................
Examples of Use ...............................................................................................................
9.4.1 Example of DMA Transfer between On-Chip SCI and External Memory ..........
9.4.2 Example of DMA Transfer between External RAM and External Device with
DACK ..................................................................................................................
Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................
161
161
163
165
165
172
187
188
188
188
189
190
Section 10 Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU) .................................................. 191
10.1 Overview...........................................................................................................................
10.1.1 Features................................................................................................................
10.1.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................
10.1.3 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................
10.1.4 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
10.2 MTU Register Descriptions ..............................................................................................
10.2.1 Timer Control Register (TCR) .............................................................................
10.2.2 Timer Mode Register (TMDR) ............................................................................
10.2.3 Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR) .....................................................................
10.2.4 Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER) ..............................................................
10.2.5 Timer Status Register (TSR)................................................................................
10.2.6 Timer Counters (TCNT) ......................................................................................
10.2.7 Timer General Register (TGR) ............................................................................
10.2.8 Timer Start Register (TSTR)................................................................................
10.2.9 Timer Synchro Register (TSYR) .........................................................................
10.3 Bus Master Interface .........................................................................................................
10.3.1 16-Bit Registers ...................................................................................................
10.3.2 8-Bit Registers .....................................................................................................
10.4 Operation...........................................................................................................................
10.4.1 Overview..............................................................................................................
10.4.2 Basic Functions....................................................................................................
10.4.3 Synchronous Operation........................................................................................
10.4.4 Buffer Operation ..................................................................................................
10.4.5 Cascade Connection Mode...................................................................................
10.4.6 PWM Mode..........................................................................................................
191
191
195
196
197
199
199
203
205
214
217
220
221
221
222
224
224
224
226
226
226
232
235
238
240
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxv of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
10.4.7 Phase Counting Mode..........................................................................................
10.5 Interrupts...........................................................................................................................
10.5.1 Interrupt Sources and Priority Ranking................................................................
10.5.2 DMAC Activation................................................................................................
10.5.3 A/D Converter Activation....................................................................................
10.6 Operation Timing..............................................................................................................
10.6.1 Input/Output Timing ............................................................................................
10.6.2 Interrupt Signal Timing........................................................................................
10.7 Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................
10.7.1 Input Clock Limitations .......................................................................................
10.7.2 Note on Cycle Setting ..........................................................................................
10.7.3 Contention between TCNT Write and Clear........................................................
10.7.4 Contention between TCNT Write and Increment ................................................
10.7.5 Contention between Buffer Register Write and Compare Match ........................
10.7.6 Contention between TGR Read and Input Capture..............................................
10.7.7 Contention between TGR Write and Input Capture.............................................
10.7.8 Contention between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture ............................
10.7.9 Contention between TGR Write and Compare Match .........................................
10.7.10 TCNT2 Write and Overflow/Underflow Contention in Cascade Connection .....
10.7.11 Contention between Overflow/Underflow and Counter Clearing........................
10.7.12 Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow/Underflow...............................
10.7.13 Cautions on Carrying Out Buffer Operation of Channel 0 in PWM Mode 1.......
10.8 MTU Output Pin Initialization ..........................................................................................
10.8.1 Operating Modes..................................................................................................
10.8.2 Reset Start Operation ...........................................................................................
10.8.3 Operation in Case of Re-Setting Due to Error during Operation, Etc..................
10.8.4 Overview of Initialization Procedures and Mode Transitions in Case of Error
during Operation, etc. ..........................................................................................
244
251
251
252
252
253
253
258
262
262
262
263
264
265
266
267
268
269
269
271
272
272
273
273
273
273
274
Section 11 Watchdog Timer (WDT).............................................................................. 291
11.1 Overview...........................................................................................................................
11.1.1 Features................................................................................................................
11.1.2 Block Diagram.....................................................................................................
11.1.3 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................
11.1.4 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
11.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................
11.2.1 Timer Counter (TCNT)........................................................................................
11.2.2 Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR)................................................................
11.2.3 Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR) ............................................................
11.2.4 Register Access....................................................................................................
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxvi of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
291
291
292
292
293
293
293
294
296
297
11.3 Operation...........................................................................................................................
11.3.1 Watchdog Timer Mode ........................................................................................
11.3.2 Interval Timer Mode ............................................................................................
11.3.3 Clearing the Standby Mode..................................................................................
11.3.4 Timing of Setting the Overflow Flag (OVF) .......................................................
11.3.5 Timing of Setting the Watchdog Timer Overflow Flag (WOVF)........................
11.4 Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................
11.4.1 TCNT Write and Increment Contention...............................................................
11.4.2 Changing CKS2 to CKS0 Bit Values...................................................................
11.4.3 Changing between Watchdog Timer/Interval Timer Modes................................
11.4.4 System Reset with WDTOVF..............................................................................
11.4.5 Internal Reset with the Watchdog Timer .............................................................
298
298
300
300
301
301
302
302
302
302
303
303
Section 12 Serial Communication Interface (SCI) .................................................... 305
12.1 Overview...........................................................................................................................
12.1.1 Features................................................................................................................
12.1.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................
12.1.3 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................
12.1.4 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
12.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................
12.2.1 Receive Shift Register (RSR) ..............................................................................
12.2.2 Receive Data Register (RDR) ..............................................................................
12.2.3 Transmit Shift Register (TSR) .............................................................................
12.2.4 Transmit Data Register (TDR).............................................................................
12.2.5 Serial Mode Register (SMR)................................................................................
12.2.6 Serial Control Register (SCR)..............................................................................
12.2.7 Serial Status Register (SSR) ................................................................................
12.2.8 Bit Rate Register (BRR) ......................................................................................
12.3 Operation...........................................................................................................................
12.3.1 Overview..............................................................................................................
12.3.2 Operation in Asynchronous Mode .......................................................................
12.3.3 Multiprocessor Communication...........................................................................
12.3.4 Clock Synchronous Operation .............................................................................
12.4 SCI Interrupt Sources and the DMAC ..............................................................................
12.5 Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................
12.5.1 TDR Write and TDRE Flags................................................................................
12.5.2 Simultaneous Multiple Receive Errors ................................................................
12.5.3 Break Detection and Processing...........................................................................
12.5.4 Sending a Break Signal........................................................................................
305
305
306
307
307
308
308
308
308
309
309
312
316
320
331
331
333
343
351
362
363
363
363
364
364
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxvii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
12.5.5 Receive Error Flags and Transmitter Operation
(Clock Synchronous Mode Only) ........................................................................
12.5.6 Receive Data Sampling Timing and Receive Margin in the Asynchronous
Mode ....................................................................................................................
12.5.7 Constraints on DMAC Use ..................................................................................
12.5.8 Cautions for Clock Synchronous External Clock Mode ......................................
12.5.9 Caution for Clock Synchronous Internal Clock Mode.........................................
364
364
366
366
366
Section 13 High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯............................................. 367
13.1 Overview...........................................................................................................................
13.1.1 Features................................................................................................................
13.1.2 Block Diagram.....................................................................................................
13.1.3 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................
13.1.4 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
13.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................
13.2.1 A/D Data Registers A to H (ADDRA to ADDRH) .............................................
13.2.2 A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR) ...............................................................
13.2.3 A/D Control Register (ADCR) ............................................................................
13.3 Bus Master Interface .........................................................................................................
13.4 Operation ..........................................................................................................................
13.4.1 Select-Single Mode..............................................................................................
13.4.2 Select-Scan Mode ................................................................................................
13.4.3 Group-Single Mode .............................................................................................
13.4.4 Group-Scan Mode................................................................................................
13.4.5 Buffer Operation ..................................................................................................
13.4.6 Simultaneous Sampling Operation.......................................................................
13.4.7 Conversion Start Modes.......................................................................................
13.4.8 A/D Conversion Time..........................................................................................
13.5 Interrupts...........................................................................................................................
13.6 Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................
13.6.1 Analog Input Voltage Range ...............................................................................
13.6.2 AVCC, AVSS Input Voltages ..................................................................................
13.6.3 Input Ports............................................................................................................
13.6.4 Conversion Start Modes.......................................................................................
13.6.5 A/D Conversion Termination (HD6417014R only).............................................
13.6.6 Handling of Analog Input Pins ............................................................................
367
367
368
368
369
370
370
371
374
376
378
378
379
380
381
383
386
388
391
393
394
394
394
394
394
394
395
Section 14 Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯........................... 397
14.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 397
14.1.1 Features................................................................................................................ 397
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxviii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
14.2
14.3
14.4
14.5
14.6
14.7
14.1.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................
14.1.3 Pin Configuration.................................................................................................
14.1.4 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................
14.2.1 A/D Data Register A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD) ...............................................
14.2.2 A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR) ...............................................................
14.2.3 A/D Control Register (ADCR) ............................................................................
Interface with CPU............................................................................................................
Operation...........................................................................................................................
14.4.1 Single Mode (SCAN = 0).....................................................................................
14.4.2 Scan Mode (SCAN = 1) .......................................................................................
14.4.3 Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time..........................................................
14.4.4 MTU Trigger Input Timing..................................................................................
Interrupt.............................................................................................................................
A/D Conversion Precision Definitions..............................................................................
Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................
14.7.1 Analog Voltage Settings ......................................................................................
14.7.2 Handling of Analog Input Pins ............................................................................
398
399
400
401
401
402
404
405
407
407
409
411
413
414
415
417
417
417
Section 15 Compare Match Timer (CMT) ................................................................... 419
15.1 Overview...........................................................................................................................
15.1.1 Features................................................................................................................
15.1.2 Block Diagram .....................................................................................................
15.1.3 Register Configuration.........................................................................................
15.2 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................
15.2.1 Compare Match Timer Start Register (CMSTR) .................................................
15.2.2 Compare Match Timer Control/Status Register (CMCSR)..................................
15.2.3 Compare Match Timer Counter (CMCNT) .........................................................
15.2.4 Compare Match Timer Constant Register (CMCOR)..........................................
15.3 Operation...........................................................................................................................
15.3.1 Period Count Operation .......................................................................................
15.3.2 CMCNT Count Timing........................................................................................
15.4 Interrupts ...........................................................................................................................
15.4.1 Interrupt Sources..................................................................................................
15.4.2 Compare Match Flag Set Timing.........................................................................
15.4.3 Compare Match Flag Clear Timing .....................................................................
15.5 Usage Notes ......................................................................................................................
15.5.1 Contention between CMCNT Write and Compare Match ...................................
15.5.2 Contention between CMCNT Word Write and Incrementation...........................
15.5.3 Contention between CMCNT Byte Write and Incrementation ............................
419
419
419
421
422
422
423
424
425
426
426
426
427
427
427
428
429
429
430
431
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxix of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Section 16 Pin Function Controller (PFC) ................................................................... 433
16.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 433
16.2 Register Configuration...................................................................................................... 444
16.3 Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................ 445
16.3.1 Port A I/O Register L (PAIORL)......................................................................... 445
16.3.2 Port A Control Registers L1, L2 (PACRL1 and PACRL2) ................................. 446
16.3.3 Port B I/O Register (PBIOR) ............................................................................... 452
16.3.4 Port B Control Registers (PBCR1 and PBCR2)................................................... 453
16.3.5 Port C I/O Register (PCIOR) ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯ ........................................ 458
16.3.6 Port C Control Register (PCCR) ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯................................... 459
16.3.7 Port D I/O Register L (PDIORL) ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯ .................................. 464
16.3.8 Port D Control Register L (PDCRL) ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯............................. 465
16.3.9 Port E I/O Register (PEIOR)................................................................................ 470
16.3.10 Port E Control Registers 1, 2 (PECR1 and PECR2) ............................................ 471
Section 17 I/O Ports (I/O) ................................................................................................. 475
17.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 475
17.2 Port A................................................................................................................................ 475
17.2.1 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 476
17.2.2 Port A Data Register L (PADRL) ........................................................................ 477
17.3 Port B ................................................................................................................................ 478
17.3.1 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 478
17.3.2 Port B Data Register (PBDR) .............................................................................. 479
17.4 Port C ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯ ......................................................................................... 480
17.4.1 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 480
17.4.2 Port C Data Register (PCDR) .............................................................................. 481
17.5 Port D ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯ ......................................................................................... 482
17.5.1 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 482
17.5.2 Port D Data Register L (PDDRL) ........................................................................ 483
17.6 Port E ................................................................................................................................ 484
17.6.1 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 484
17.6.2 Port E Data Register (PEDR)............................................................................... 485
17.7 Port F................................................................................................................................. 486
17.7.1 Register Configuration......................................................................................... 486
17.7.2 Port F Data Register (PFDR) ............................................................................... 487
Section 18 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT).............................................................. 489
18.1 Features............................................................................................................................. 489
18.2 Overview........................................................................................................................... 490
18.2.1 Block Diagram..................................................................................................... 490
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxx of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
18.3
18.4
18.5
18.6
18.7
18.8
18.9
18.10
18.11
18.2.2 Mode Transitions .................................................................................................
18.2.3 On-Board Programming Modes...........................................................................
18.2.4 Flash Memory Emulation in RAM ......................................................................
18.2.5 Differences between Boot Mode and User Program Mode..................................
18.2.6 Block Configuration.............................................................................................
Pin Configuration..............................................................................................................
Register Configuration ......................................................................................................
Register Descriptions ........................................................................................................
18.5.1 Flash Memory Control Register 1 (FLMCR1).....................................................
18.5.2 Flash Memory Control Register 2 (FLMCR2).....................................................
18.5.3 Erase Block Register 1 (EBR1)............................................................................
18.5.4 RAM Emulation Register (RAMER)...................................................................
On-Board Programming Modes ........................................................................................
18.6.1 Boot Mode ...........................................................................................................
18.6.2 User Program Mode.............................................................................................
Programming/Erasing Flash Memory ...............................................................................
18.7.1 Program Mode .....................................................................................................
18.7.2 Program-Verify Mode..........................................................................................
18.7.3 Erase Mode ..........................................................................................................
18.7.4 Erase-Verify Mode...............................................................................................
Protection ..........................................................................................................................
18.8.1 Hardware Protection ............................................................................................
18.8.2 Software Protection..............................................................................................
18.8.3 Error Protection....................................................................................................
Flash Memory Emulation in RAM....................................................................................
Note on Flash Memory Programming/Erasing .................................................................
Flash Memory Programmer Mode ....................................................................................
18.11.1 Socket Adapter Pin Correspondence Diagram.....................................................
18.11.2 Programmer Mode Operation ..............................................................................
18.11.3 Memory Read Mode ............................................................................................
18.11.4 Auto-Program Mode ............................................................................................
18.11.5 Auto-Erase Mode .................................................................................................
18.11.6 Status Read Mode ................................................................................................
18.11.7 Status Polling .......................................................................................................
18.11.8 Programmer Mode Transition Time.....................................................................
18.11.9 Notes on Memory Programming..........................................................................
491
492
494
495
496
496
497
498
498
501
502
503
504
505
509
510
510
511
517
518
524
524
525
526
528
530
530
531
533
534
538
540
542
543
544
545
Section 19 Mask ROM ....................................................................................................... 547
19.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 547
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxxi of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Section 20 RAM .................................................................................................................. 549
20.1 Overview........................................................................................................................... 549
Section 21 Power-Down State ......................................................................................... 551
21.1 Overview...........................................................................................................................
21.1.1 Power-Down States..............................................................................................
21.1.2 Related Register ...................................................................................................
21.2 Standby Control Register (SBYCR) .................................................................................
21.3 Sleep Mode .......................................................................................................................
21.3.1 Transition to Sleep Mode.....................................................................................
21.3.2 Canceling Sleep Mode .........................................................................................
21.4 Standby Mode ...................................................................................................................
21.4.1 Transition to Standby Mode.................................................................................
21.4.2 Canceling the Standby Mode ...............................................................................
21.4.3 Standby Mode Application Example ...................................................................
551
551
552
553
554
554
554
554
554
556
557
Section 22 Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz).............................................. 559
22.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings .............................................................................................
22.2 DC Characteristics ............................................................................................................
22.3 AC Characteristics ............................................................................................................
22.3.1 Clock Timing .......................................................................................................
22.3.2 Control Signal Timing .........................................................................................
22.3.3 Bus Timing ..........................................................................................................
22.3.4 Direct Memory Access Controller Timing ..........................................................
22.3.5 Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit Timing ..............................................................
22.3.6 I/O Port Timing....................................................................................................
22.3.7 Watchdog Timer Timing......................................................................................
22.3.8 Serial Communication Interface Timing..............................................................
22.3.9 High Speed A/D Converter Timing ⎯ SH7014 ⎯ .............................................
22.3.10 Mid-speed Converter Timing ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯........................................
22.3.11 Measuring Conditions for AC Characteristics .....................................................
22.4 A/D Converter Characteristics ..........................................................................................
559
560
562
562
564
566
579
581
582
583
583
584
586
588
589
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers ................................................ 591
A.1
A.2
Addresses .......................................................................................................................... 591
Functions........................................................................................................................... 600
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams........................................................................... 682
Appendix C Pin States ....................................................................................................... 707
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxxii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
C.1
C.2
Pin States........................................................................................................................... 707
Pin States of Bus Related Signals ..................................................................................... 709
Appendix D Notes when Converting the F-ZTAT Application Software to the
Mask-ROM Versions ................................................................................. 713
Appendix E Product Code Lineup .................................................................................. 714
Appendix F Package Dimensions ................................................................................... 715
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxxiii of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page xxxiv of xxxiv
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Section 1 SH7014/16/17 Overview
1.1
SH7014/16/17 Overview
The SH7014/16/17 CMOS single-chip microprocessors integrate a Renesas Technology-original
architecture, high-speed CPU with peripheral functions required for system configuration.
The CPU has a RISC-type instruction set. Most instructions can be executed in one clock cycle,
which greatly improves instruction execution speed. In addition, the 32-bit internal-bus
architecture enhances data processing power. With this CPU, it has become possible to assemble
low cost, high performance/high-functioning systems, even for applications that were previously
impossible with microprocessors, such as real-time control, which demands high speeds. In
particular, the SH7040 series has a 1-kbyte on-chip cache, which allows an improvement in CPU
performance during external memory access.
In addition, this LSI includes on-chip peripheral functions necessary for system configuration,
such as large-capacity ROM (except the SH7014, which is ROMless) and RAM, timers, a serial
communication interface (SCI), an A/D converter, an interrupt controller, and I/O ports. Memory
or peripheral LSIs can be connected efficiently with an external memory access support function.
This greatly reduces system cost.
TM
This LSI has an F-ZTAT * version with on-chip flash memory and a mask ROM version. These
versions enable users to respond quickly and flexibly to changing application specifications,
growing production volumes, and other conditions.
Notes: F-ZTAT (Flexible ZTAT) is a trademark of Renesas Technology Corp.
1.1.1
SH7014/16/17 Series Features
CPU:
• Original Renesas Technology architecture
• 32-bit internal data bus
• General-register machine
⎯ Sixteen 32-bit general registers
⎯ Three 32-bit control registers
⎯ Four 32-bit system registers
• RISC-type instruction set
⎯ Instruction length: 16-bit fixed length for improved code efficiency
⎯ Load-store architecture (basic operations are executed between registers)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 1 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
⎯ Delayed branch instructions reduce pipeline disruption during branch
⎯ Instruction set based on C language
• Instruction execution time: one instruction/cycle (35 ns/instruction at 28.7-MHz operation)
• Address space: Architecture supports 4 Gbytes
• On-chip multiplier: multiplication operations (32 bits × 32 bits → 64 bits) and
multiplication/accumulation operations (32 bits × 32 bits + 64 bits → 64 bits) executed in two
to four cycles
• Five-stage pipeline
Cache Memory:
• 1-kbyte instruction cache
• Caching of instruction codes and PC relative read data
• 4-byte line length (1 longword: 2 instruction lengths)
• 256 entry cache tags
• Direct map method
• On-chip ROM/RAM, and on-chip I/O areas not objects of cache
• Used in common with on-chip RAM; 2 kbytes of on-chip RAM used as address array/data
array when cache is enabled
Interrupt Controller (INTC):
• Seven external interrupt pins (NMI, IRQ × 6)
• Twenty-eight internal interrupt sources
• Sixteen programmable priority levels
Bus State Controller (BSC):
• Supports external extended memory access
⎯ 8-bit, or 16-bit external data bus
• Memory address space divided into five areas (four areas of SRAM space, one area of DRAM
space) with the following settable features:
⎯ Number of wait cycles
⎯ Outputs chip-select signals for each area
⎯ During DRAM space access:
• Outputs RAS and CAS signals for DRAM
• Can generate a RAS precharge time assurance Tp cycle
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 2 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
• DRAM burst access function
⎯ Supports high-speed access mode for DRAM
• DRAM refresh function
⎯ Programmable refresh interval
⎯ Supports CAS-before-RAS refresh and self-refresh modes
• Wait cycles can be inserted using an external WAIT signal
• Address data multiplex I/O devices can be accessed
Note: No bus release
Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC) (2 Channels):
• Supports cycle-steal and burst transfers
• Supports single address mode and dual address mode transfers
• Priority order: fixed at channel 0 > channel 1
• Transfer counter: 16 bits
• Transfer request sources: external DREQ input, auto-request, and on-chip supporting modules
• Address space: 4 Gbytes
• Choice of 8-, 16-, or 32-bit transfer data size
Multifunction Timer/Pulse Unit (MTU) (3 Channels):
• Maximum 8 types of waveform output or maximum 16 types of pulse I/O processing possible
based on 16-bit timer, 3 channels
• 8 dual-use output compare/input capture registers
• 8 independent comparators
• 8 types of counter input clock
• Input capture function
• Pulse output mode
⎯ One shot, toggle, PWM
• Phase calculation mode
⎯ 2-phase encoder calculation processing
Compare Match Timer (CMT) (Two Channels):
• 16-bit free-running counter
• One compare register
• Generates an interrupt request upon compare match
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 3 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Watchdog Timer (WDT) (One Channel):
• Watchdog timer or interval timer
• Count overflow can generate an internal reset, external signal, or interrupt
Serial Communication Interface (SCI) (Two Channels):
(Per Channel):
• Asynchronous or clock-synchronous mode is selectable
• Can transmit and receive simultaneously (full duplex)
• On-chip dedicated baud rate generator
• Multiprocessor communication function
I/O Ports:
• SH7014
⎯ Input/output: 35
⎯ Input: 8
⎯ Total: 43
• SH7016/17
⎯ Input/output: 74
⎯ Input: 8
⎯ Total: 82
A/D Converter:
• 10 bits × 8 channels
• The SH7014 has a high-speed A/D converter, while the SH7016 and SH7017 have a midspeed A/D converter.
On-Chip Memory:
• ROM
⎯ SH7014: ROMless
⎯ SH7016: 64 kbytes (mask ROM)
⎯ SH7017: 128 kbytes (flash ROM)
• RAM: SH7014/16: 3 kbytes (1 kbyte when cache is used)
SH7017: 4 kbytes (2 kbytes when cache is used)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 4 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Operating Modes:
• Operating modes
⎯ Non-extended ROM mode (SH7014/16/17)
⎯ Extended ROM mode (SH7016/17)
⎯ Single-chip mode (SH7016/17)
• Processing states
⎯ Program execution state
⎯ Exception processing state
• Power-down modes
⎯ Sleep mode
⎯ Software standby mode
Clock Pulse Generator (CPG):
• On-chip clock pulse generator
⎯ On-chip clock-doubling PLL circuit
Product Lineup:
Product Code
On-Chip
ROM
On-Chip
RAM
A/D Precision
HD6417014F28
ROMless
3 kB
±15 LSB
28.7 MHz/5 V −20 to +75°C FP-112
(high-speed A/D)
HD6417014RF28 ROMless
3 kB
±8 LSB
28.7 MHz/5 V −20 to +75°C FP-112
(high-speed A/D)
HD6437016F28
64 kB
3 kB
mask ROM
±4 LSB
28.7 MHz/5 V −20 to +75°C FP-112
(mid-speed A/D)
HD64F7017F28
128 kB
flash
memory
±4LSB
28.7 MHz/5 V −20 to +75°C FP-112
(mid-speed A/D)
4 kB
Frequency/
Voltage
Temperature Package
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 5 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
1.2
Block Diagram
RES
WDTOVF
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
NMI
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
RAM (3 kB)/
cache (1 kB)
PLL
PLLVCC
PB9/IRQ7/A21
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
PB7/A19
PB6/A18
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
A17
A16
PA15/CK
RD
WRH
WRL
CS1
CS0
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
PA4/TXD1
PA3/RXD1
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
PA1/TXD0
PA0/RXD0
Figure 1.1 is a block diagram of the SH7014. Figure 1.2 is a block diagram of the SH7016/17.
PLLVSS
VCC
CPU
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
VSS
AVCC
AVSS
Direct memory
access controller
Interrupt
controller
Bus state controller
Serial communication interface
(×2 channels)
: Peripheral address bus
: Peripheral data bus
: Internal address bus
: Internal upper data bus
: Internal lower data bus
A/D
converter
Watchdog
timer
PE15/DACK1
PE14/DACK0/AH
PE13
PE12
PE11
PE10
PE9
PE8
PE7/TIOC2B
PE6/TIOC2A
PE5/TIOC1B
PE4/TIOC1A
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
PF7/AN7
PF6/AN6
PF5/AN5
PF4/AN4
PF3/AN3
PF2/AN2
PF1/AN1
PF0/AN0
Compare match
timer (×2 channels)
Multifunction timer/
pulse unit
Figure 1.1 Block Diagram of the SH7014
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 6 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
A15
A14
A13
A12
A11
A10
A9
A8
A7
A6
A5
A4
A3
A2
A1
A0
D15
D14
D13
D12
D11
D10
D9
D8
D7
D6
D5
D4
D3
D2
D1
D0
PB0/A16
PB1/A17
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
PB6/A18
PB7/A19
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
PB9/IRQ7/A21
PA0/RXD0
PA1/TXD0
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
PA3/RXD1
PA4/TXD1
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
PA10/CS0
PA11/CS1
PA12/WRL
PA13/WRH
PA14/RD
PA15/CK
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
RES
WDTOVF
MD3
MD2
PC15/A15
MD1
PC14/A14
PC13/A13
MD0
EXTAL
PC12/A12
RAM (4 kB/3 kB)/
cache (1 kB)
Flash ROM (128 kB)/
mask ROM (64 kB)
NMI
PC11/A11
PC10/A10
XTAL
PC9/A9
PLLVcc
PLLCAP
PLL
PC8/A8
PC7/A7
PLLVss
Vcc/FWP*
PC6/A6
PC5/A5
CPU
Vcc
PC4/A4
Direct memory
access controller
Vcc
Vcc
Vcc
PC2/A2
Interrupt
controller
Vss
PC3/A3
Bus state controller
PC1/A1
PC0/A0
Vss
Vss
PD15/D15
Serial communication interface
(×2 channels)
Vss
Vss
Multifunction timer/
pulse unit
PD14/D14
PD13/D13
Vss
PD12/D12
Vss
Vss
Watchdog
timer
A/D
converter
Compare match
timer (×2 channels)
Vss
PD11/D11
PD10/D10
PD9/D9
Vss
PD8/D8
Vss
AVcc
AVss
PD7/D7
PD6/D6
PD5/D5
PD4/D4
PD3/D3
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
Note: * VCC in the SH7016, FWP in the SH7017 (except FWE pin in the programmer mode).
PE4/TIOC1A
PE5/TIOC1B
PE6/TIOC2A
PE7/TIOC2B
PE8
PE9
PE10
PE11
PE12
PE13
PE15/DACK1
PE14/DACK0/AH
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
PD2/D2
PD1/D1
PD0/D0
: Peripheral address bus
: Peripheral data bus
: Internal address bus
: Internal upper data bus
: Internal lower data bus
Figure 1.2 Block Diagram of the SH7016, SH7017
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 7 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
1.3
Pin Arrangement and Pin Functions
1.3.1
Pin Arrangement
FP-112
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
85
86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96
97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105
106
107
108
109
110
111
112
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
32
31
30
29
D12
VSS
D13
D14
D15
PA0/RXD0
PA1/TXD0
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
PA3/RXD1
PA4/TXD1
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
CS0
CS1
VSS
WRL
VCC
WRH
WDTOVF
RD
VSS
PB9/IRQ7/A21
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
PB7/A19
PB6/A18
PE14/DACK0/AH
PE15/DACK1
VSS
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11
A12
A13
A14
A15
A16
VCC
A17
VSS
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
VSS
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
PE4/TIOC1A
VSS
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
AVSS
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
AVCC
VSS
PE5/TIOC1B
VCC
PE6/TIOC2A
PE7/TIOC2B
PE8
PE9
PE10
VSS
PE11
PE12
PB13
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
RES
PA15/CK
PLLVSS
PLLCAP
PLLVCC
MD0
MD1
VCC
NMI
MD2
EXTAL
MD3
XTAL
VSS
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
VCC
D5
D6
D7
VSS
D8
D9
D10
D11
Figure 1.3 shows the pin arrangement for the SH7014 (top view).
Figure 1.3 SH7014 Pin Arrangement (FP-112 Top View)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 8 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
85
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
86
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
87
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
88
PE4/TIOC1A
89
Vss
PF0/AN0
90
PF1/AN1
92
PF2/AN2
93
PF3/AN3
94
PF4/AN4
95
PF5/AN5
96
AVss
97
PF6/AN6
98
PF7/AN7
99
RES
PA15/CK
PLLVss
PLLCAP
PLLVcc
MD0
MD1
Vcc/FWP*
NMI
MD2
EXTAL
MD3
XTAL
Vss
PD0/D0
PD1/D1
PD2/D2
PD3/D3
PD4/D4
Vcc
PD5/D5
PD6/D6
PD7/D7
Vss
PD8/D8
PD9/D9
PD10/D10
PD11/D11
84
83
82
81
80
79
78
77
76
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
Figure 1.4 shows the pin arrangement for the 144-pin QFP pin arrangement.
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
PC6/A6
PC7/A7
PC8/A8
PC9/A9
PC10/A10
PC11/A11
PC12/A12
PC13/A13
PC14/A14
PC15A15
PB0/A16
Vcc
PB1/A17
Vss
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
Vss
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
112
PC5/A5
111
PE13
8
PE12
PC4/A4
110
7
109
PC3/A3
Vss
PE11
6
108
PC2/A2
107
PE10
5
106
PE9
PC1/A1
PE8
4
105
PC0/A0
104
PE7/TIOC2B
3
PE6/TIOC2A
2
103
Vss
102
Vcc
1
PE5/TIOC1B
PE15/DACK1
101
FP-112
PE14/DACK0/AH
100
Vss
PD12/D12
55
Vss
PD13/D13
54
91
AVcc
56
53
PD14/D14
52
PD15/D15
51
PA0/RXD0
50
PA1/TXD0
49
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
48
PA3/RXD1
47
PA4/TXD1
46
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
45
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
44
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
43
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
42
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
41
PA10/CS0
40
PA11/CS1
39
Vss
38
PA12/WRL
37
Vcc
36
PA13/WRH
35
WDTOVF
34
PA14/RD
33
Vss
32
PB9/IRQ7/A21
31
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
30
PB7/A19
29
PB6/A18
Note: * VCC in the SH7016, FWP in the SH7017 (except FWE pin in the programmer mode).
Figure 1.4 SH7016, SH7017 Pin Arrangement (QFP-112 Top View)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 9 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
1.3.2
Table 1.1
Pin Arrangement by Mode
Pin Arrangement by Mode for SH7017F (FP-112 Pin)
Pin No.
MCU Mode
Programmer Mode
1
PE14/DACK0/AH
NC
2
PE15/DACK1
NC
3
VSS
VSS
4
PC0/A0
A0
5
PC1/A1
A1
6
PC2/A2
A2
7
PC3/A3
A3
8
PC4/A4
A4
9
PC5/A5
A5
10
PC6/A6
A6
11
PC7/A7
A7
12
PC8/A8
A8
13
PC9/A9
A9
14
PC10/A10
A10
15
PC11/A11
A11
16
PC12/A12
A12
17
PC13/A13
A13
18
PC14/A14
A14
19
PC15/A15
A15
20
PB0/A16
A16
21
VCC
VCC
22
PB1/A17
NC
23
VSS
VSS
24
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
NC
25
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
NC
26
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
A17
27
VSS
VSS
28
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
NC
29
PB6/A18
NC
30
PB7/A19
NC
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 10 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Pin No.
MCU Mode
Programmer Mode
31
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
NC
32
PB9/IRQ7/A21
NC
33
VSS
VSS
34
PA14/RD
NC
35
WDTOVF
NC
36
PA13/WRH
NC
37
VCC
VCC
38
PA12/WRL
NC
39
VSS
VSS
40
PA11/CS1
NC
41
PA10/CS0
NC
42
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
CE
43
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
OE
44
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
WE
45
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
NC
46
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
VCC
47
PA4/TXD1
NC
48
PA3 /RXD1
NC
49
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
VCC
50
PA1/TXD0
VCC
51
PA0/RXD0
NC
52
PD15/D15
NC
53
PD14/D14
NC
54
PD13/D13
NC
55
VSS
VSS
56
PD12/D12
NC
57
PD11/D11
NC
58
PD10/D10
NC
59
PD9/D9
NC
60
PD8/D8
NC
61
VSS
VSS
62
PD7/D7
D7
63
PD6/D6
D6
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 11 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Pin No.
MCU Mode
Programmer Mode
64
PD5/D5
D5
65
VCC
VCC
66
PD4/D4
D4
67
PD3/D3
D3
68
PD2/D2
D2
69
PD1/D1
D1
70
PD0/D0
D0
71
VSS
VSS
72
XTAL
XTAL
73
MD3
MD3
74
EXTAL
EXTAL
75
MD2
MD2
76
NMI
VCC
77
VCC (FWP)
FWE
78
MD1
MD1
79
MD0
MD0
80
PLLVCC
PLLVCC
81
PLLCAP
PLLCAP
82
PLLVSS
PLLVSS
83
PA15/CK
NC
84
RES
RES
85
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
NC
86
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
NC
87
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
NC
88
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
NC
89
PE4/TIOC1A
NC
90
VSS
VSS
91
PF0/AN0
VSS
92
PF1/AN1
VSS
93
PF2/AN2
VSS
94
PF3/AN3
VSS
95
PF4/AN4
VSS
96
PF5/AN5
VSS
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 12 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Pin No.
MCU Mode
Programmer Mode
97
AVSS
VSS
98
PF6/AN6
VSS
99
PF7/AN7
VSS
100
AVCC
VCC
101
VSS
VSS
102
PE5/TIOC1B
NC
103
VCC
VCC
104
PE6/TIOC2A
NC
105
PE7/TIOC2B
NC
106
PE8
NC
107
PE9
NC
108
PE10
NC
109
VSS
VSS
110
PE11
NC
111
PE12
NC
112
PE13
NC
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 13 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
1.3.3
Pin Functions
Table 1.2 lists the pin functions.
Table 1.2
Pin Functions
Classification
Symbol
I/O
Name
Function
Power supply
VCC
I
Supply
Connects to power supply.
Connect all VCC pins to the system
supply. No operation will occur if
there are any open pins.
VSS
I
Ground
Connects to ground.
Connect all VSS pins to the system
ground. No operation will occur if
there are any open pins.
Clock
System control
PLLVCC
I
PLL supply
On-chip PLL oscillator supply.
PLLVSS
I
PLL ground
On-chip PLL oscillator ground.
PLLCAP
I
PLL capacitance
On-chip PLL oscillator external
capacitance connection pin.
EXTAL
I
External clock
Connect a crystal oscillator. Also, an
external clock can be input to the
EXTAL pin.
XTAL
I
Crystal
Connect a crystal oscillator.
CK
O
System clock
Supplies the system clock to
peripheral devices.
RES
I
Power-on reset
Power-on reset when low
WDTOVF
O
Watchdog timer
overflow
Overflow output signal from WDT
Mode set
Determines the operating mode. Do
not change input value during
operation.
Operating mode MD0 to MD3 I
control
Interrupts
Address bus
FWP
I
Flash memory
write protect
Protects flash memory from being
written or deleted.
NMI
I
Non-maskable
interrupt
Non-maskable interrupt request pin.
Enables selection of whether to
accept on the rising or falling edge.
IRQ0 to
IRQ3,
IRQ6, IRQ7
I
Interrupt requests Maskable interrupt request pins.
0 to 3, 6,7
Allows selection of level input and
edge input.
A0 to A21
O
Address bus
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 14 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Outputs addresses.
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Classification
Symbol
I/O
Name
Function
Data bus
D0 to D15
I/O
Data bus
16-bit bidirectional data bus
Bus control
CS0 to CS3
O
Chip selects 0 to
3
Chip select signals for external
memory or devices.
RD
O
Read
Indicates reading from an external
device.
WRH
O
Upper write
Indicates writing the upper 8 bits of
external data.
WRL
O
Lower write
Indicates writing the lower 8 bits of
external data.
WAIT
I
Wait
Input causes insertion of wait cycles
into the bus cycle during external
space access.
RAS
O
Row address
strobe
Timing signal for DRAM row address
strobe.
CASH
O
Upper column
address strobe
Timing signal for DRAM column
address strobe.
Output when the upper 8 bits of data
are accessed.
CASL
O
Lower column
address strobe
Timing signal for DRAM column
address strobe.
Output when the lower 8 bits of data
are accessed.
RDWR
O
DRAM read/write
DRAM write strobe signal.
AH
O
Address hold
Address hold timing signal for
devices using an address/data
multiplex bus.
I
MTU timer clock
input
Input pins for external clocks to the
MTU counter.
I/O
MTU input
capture/output
compare
(channel 0)
Channel 0 input capture input/output
compare output/PWM output pins.
TCLKA
Multifunction
Timer Pulse Unit TCLKB
(MTU)
TCLKC
TCLKD
TIOC0A
TIOC0B
TIOC0C
TIOC0D
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 15 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Classification
Symbol
I/O
Name
Function
TIOC1A
Multifunction
Timer Pulse Unit TIOC1B
(MTU)
I/O
MTU input
capture/output
compare
(channel 1)
Channel 1 input capture input/output
compare output/PWM output pins.
TIOC2A
I/O
MTU input
capture/output
compare
(channel 2)
Channel 2 input capture input/output
compare output/PWM output pins.
DREQ0 to
DREQ1
I
DMA transfer
request
(channels 0, 1)
Input pin for external requests for
DMA transfer.
DRAK0 to
DRAK1
O
DREQ request
acknowledgment
(channels 0, 1)
Output the input sampling
acknowledgment of external DMA
transfer requests.
DACK0 to
DACK1
O
DMA transfer
strobe
(channels 0, 1)
Output a strobe to the external I/O of
external DMA transfer requests.
TxD0 to
TxD1
O
Transmit data
(channels 0, 1)
SCI0, SCI1 transmit data output pins.
RxD0 to
RxD1
I
Receive data
(channels 0, 1)
SCI0, SCI1 receive data input pins.
SCK0 to
SCK1
I/O
Serial clock
(channels 0, 1)
SCI0, SCI1 clock input/output pins.
AVCC
I
Analog supply
Analog supply; connected to VCC.
AVSS
I
Analog ground
Analog supply; connected to VSS.
AN0 to AN7
I
Analog input
Analog signal input pins.
PA0 to PA9,
PA15
(SH7014)
I/O
General purpose
port
General purpose input/output port
pins.
TIOC2B
Direct memory
access
controller
(DMAC)
Serial
communication
interface (SCI)
A/D Converter
I/O ports
Each bit can be designated for
input/output.
PA0 to PA15
(SH7016/17)
PB2 to PB9
(SH7014)
I/O
General purpose
port
PB0 to PB9
(SH7016/17)
PC0 to PC15 I/O
(SH7016/17)
General purpose input/output port
pins.
Each bit can be designated for
input/output.
General purpose
port
General purpose input/output port
pins.
Each bit can be designated for
input/output.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 16 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Classification
Symbol
I/O
I/O ports
PD0 to PD15 I/O
(SH7016/17)
Name
Function
General purpose
port
General purpose input/output port
pins.
Each bit can be designated for
input/output.
PE0 to PE15 I/O
General purpose
port
General purpose input/output port
pins.
Each bit can be designated for
input/output.
PF0 to PF7
I
General purpose
port
General purpose input port pins.
Usage Notes
1. Unused input pins should be pulled up or pulled down.
2. The WDTOVF pin should not be pulled down in the SH7017 F-ZTAT version. However, if it
is necessary to pull this pin down, a resistance of 100 kΩ or higher should be used.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 17 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
1. SH7014/16/17 Overview
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 18 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Section 2 CPU
2.1
Register Configuration
The register set consists of sixteen 32-bit general registers, three 32-bit control registers and four
32-bit system registers.
2.1.1
General Registers (Rn)
The sixteen 32-bit general registers (Rn) are numbered R0 to R15. General registers are used for
data processing and address calculation. R0 is also used as an index register. Several instructions
have R0 fixed as their only usable register. R15 is used as the hardware stack pointer (SP). Saving
and recovering the status register (SR) and program counter (PC) in exception processing is
accomplished by referencing the stack using R15. Figure 2.1 shows the general registers.
31
0
R0*1
R1
R2
R3
R4
R5
R6
R7
R8
R9
R10
R11
R12
R13
R14
R15, SP (hardware stack pointer)*2
Notes: 1.
2.
R0 functions as an index register in the indirect indexed register addressing
mode and indirect indexed GBR addressing mode. In some instructions, R0
functions as a fixed source register or destination register.
R15 functions as a hardware stack pointer (SP) during exception processing.
Figure 2.1 General Registers
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 19 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
2.1.2
Control Registers
The 32-bit control registers consist of the 32-bit status register (SR), global base register (GBR),
and vector base register (VBR). The status register indicates processing states. The global base
register functions as a base address for the indirect GBR addressing mode to transfer data to the
registers of on-chip peripheral modules. The vector base register functions as the base address of
the exception processing vector area (including interrupts). Figure 2.2 shows a control register.
31
SR
9 8 7 6 5 4 32 1 0
M Q I3 I2 I1 I0
SR: Status register
ST
T bit: The MOVT, CMP/cond, TAS, TST,
BT (BT/S), BF (BF/S), SETT, and CLRT
instructions use the T bit to indicate true
(1) or false (0). The ADDV, ADDC,
SUBV, SUBC, DIV0U, DIV0S, DIV1,
NEGC, SHAR, SHAL, SHLR, SHLL,
ROTR, ROTL, ROTCR, and ROTCL
instructions also use the T bit to indicate
carry/borrow or overflow/underflow.
S bit: Used by the MAC instruction.
Reserved bits. This bit always read 0.
The write value should always be 0.
Bits I0 to I3: Interrupt mask bits.
M and Q bits: Used by the DIV0U, DIV0S,
and DIV1 instructions.
Reserved bits. This bit always read 0.
The write value should always be 0.
31
0 Global base register (GBR):
Indicates the base address of the indirect
GBR addressing mode. The indirect GBR
addressing mode is used in data transfer
for on-chip peripheral modules register
areas and in logic operations.
GBR
31
0
VBR
Vector base register (VBR):
Stores the base address of the exception
processing vector area.
Figure 2.2 Control Registers
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 20 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
2.1.3
System Registers
System registers consist of four 32-bit registers: high and low multiply and accumulate registers
(MACH and MACL), the procedure register (PR), and the program counter (PC). The multiply
and accumulate registers store the results of multiply and accumulate operations. The procedure
register stores the return address from the subroutine procedure. The program counter stores
program addresses to control the flow of the processing. Figure 2.3 shows a system register.
31
0
MACH
MACL
31
0
Procedure register (PR): Stores
a return address from a
subroutine procedure.
0
Program counter (PC): Indicates
the fourth byte (second instruction)
after the current instruction.
PR
31
Multiply and accumulate (MAC)
registers high and low (MACH,
MACL): Stores the results of
multiply and accumulate operations.
PC
Figure 2.3 System Registers
2.1.4
Initial Values of Registers
Table 2.1 lists the values of the registers after reset.
Table 2.1
Initial Values of Registers
Classification
Register
Initial Value
General registers
R0 to R14
Undefined
R15 (SP)
Value of the stack pointer in the vector address table
SR
Bits I3 to I0 are 1111 (H'F), reserved bits are 0, and
other bits are undefined
GBR
Undefined
Control registers
System registers
VBR
H'00000000
MACH, MACL, PR
Undefined
PC
Value of the program counter in the vector address table
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 21 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
2.2
Data Formats
2.2.1
Data Format in Registers
Register operands are always longwords (32 bits). When the memory operand is only a byte (8
bits) or a word (16 bits), it is sign-extended into a longword when loaded into a register (figure
2.4).
31
0
Longword
Figure 2.4 Longword Operand
2.2.2
Data Format in Memory
Memory data formats are classified into bytes, words, and longwords. Byte data can be accessed
from any address, but an address error will occur if you try to access word data starting from an
address other than 2n or longword data starting from an address other than 4n. In such cases, the
data accessed cannot be guaranteed. The hardware stack area, referred to by the hardware stack
pointer (SP, R15), uses only longword data starting from address 4n because this area holds the
program counter and status register (figure 2.5).
Address m + 1
Address m
23
31
Byte
Address 2n
Address 4n
Address m + 3
Address m + 2
7
15
Byte
Byte
Word
0
Byte
Word
Longword
Figure 2.5 Byte, Word, and Longword Alignment
2.2.3
Immediate Data Format
Byte (8-bit) immediate data resides in an instruction code. Immediate data accessed by the MOV,
ADD, and CMP/EQ instructions is sign-extended and handled in registers as longword data.
Immediate data accessed by the TST, AND, OR, and XOR instructions is zero-extended and
handled as longword data. Consequently, AND instructions with immediate data always clear the
upper 24 bits of the destination register.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 22 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Word or longword immediate data is not located in the instruction code, but instead is stored in a
memory table. An immediate data transfer instruction (MOV) accesses the memory table using the
PC relative addressing mode with displacement.
2.3
Instruction Features
2.3.1
RISC-Type Instruction Set
All instructions are RISC type. This section details their functions.
16-Bit Fixed Length: All instructions are 16 bits long, increasing program code efficiency.
One Instruction per Cycle: The microprocessor can execute basic instructions in one cycle using
the pipeline system. Instructions are executed in 35 ns at 28.7 MHz.
Data Length: Longword is the standard data length for all operations. Memory can be accessed in
bytes, words, or longwords. Byte or word data accessed from memory is sign-extended and
handled as longword data. Immediate data is sign-extended for arithmetic operations or zeroextended for logic operations. It also is handled as longword data (table 2.2).
Table 2.2
Sign Extension of Word Data
SH7014/16/17 CPU
Description
Example of Conventional CPU
MOV.W
@(disp,PC),R1
ADD.W
ADD
R1,R0
Data is sign-extended to 32
bits, and R1 becomes
H'00001234. It is next
operated upon by an ADD
instruction.
··········
.DATA.W H'1234
#H'1234,R0
Note: @(disp, PC) accesses the immediate data.
Load-Store Architecture: Basic operations are executed between registers. For operations that
involve memory access, data is loaded to the registers and executed (load-store architecture).
Instructions such as AND that manipulate bits, however, are executed directly in memory.
Delayed Branch Instructions: Unconditional branch instructions are delayed. Executing the
instruction that follows the branch instruction and then branching reduces pipeline disruption
during branching (table 2.3). There are two types of conditional branch instructions: delayed
branch instructions and ordinary branch instructions.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 23 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Table 2.3
Delayed Branch Instructions
SH7014/16/17 CPU
Description
Example of Conventional CPU
BRA
TRGET
ADD.W
R1,R0
ADD
R1,R0
Executes an ADD before
branching to TRGET
BRA
TRGET
Multiplication/Accumulation Operation: 16-bit × 16-bit → 32-bit multiplication operations are
executed in one to two cycles. 16-bit × 16-bit + 64-bit → 64-bit multiplication/accumulation
operations are executed in two to three cycles. 32-bit × 32-bit → 64-bit and 32-bit × 32-bit + 64bit
→ 64-bit multiplication/accumulation operations are executed in two to four cycles.
T Bit: The T bit in the status register changes according to the result of the comparison, and in
turn is the condition (true/false) that determines if the program will branch. The number of
instructions that change the T bit is kept to a minimum to improve the processing speed (table
2.4).
Table 2.4
T Bit
SH7014/16/17 CPU
Description
Example of Conventional CPU
CMP/GE
R1,R0
R1,R0
TRGET0
BGE
TRGET0
BF
TRGET1
T bit is set when R0 ≥ R1. The
program branches to TRGET0
when R0 ≥ R1 and to TRGET1
when R0 < R1.
CMP.W
BT
BLT
TRGET1
ADD
#1,R0
CMP/EQ
#0,R0
BT
TRGET
T bit is not changed by ADD. T bit is SUB.W
set when R0 = 0. The program
BEQ
branches if R0 = 0.
#1,R0
TRGET
Immediate Data: Byte (8-bit) immediate data resides in instruction code. Word or longword
immediate data is not input via instruction codes but is stored in a memory table. An immediate
data transfer instruction (MOV) accesses the memory table using the PC relative addressing mode
with displacement (table 2.5).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 24 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Table 2.5
Immediate Data Accessing
Classification
SH7014/16/17 CPU
Example of Conventional CPU
8-bit immediate
MOV
#H'12,R0
MOV.B
#H'12,R0
16-bit immediate
MOV.W
@(disp,PC),R0
MOV.W
#H'1234,R0
MOV.L
#H'12345678,R0
.................
32-bit immediate
.DATA.W
H'1234
MOV.L
@(disp,PC),R0
.................
.DATA.L
H'12345678
Note: @(disp, PC) accesses the immediate data.
Absolute Address: When data is accessed by absolute address, the value already in the absolute
address is placed in the memory table. Loading the immediate data when the instruction is
executed transfers that value to the register and the data is accessed in the indirect register
addressing mode (table 2.6).
Table 2.6
Absolute Address Accessing
Classification
SH7014/16/17 CPU
Example of Conventional CPU
Absolute address
MOV.L
@(disp,PC),R1
MOV.B
MOV.B
@R1,R0
@H'12345678,R0
..................
.DATA.L
H'12345678
Note: @(disp,PC) accesses the immediate data.
16-Bit/32-Bit Displacement: When data is accessed by 16-bit or 32-bit displacement, the preexisting displacement value is placed in the memory table. Loading the immediate data when the
instruction is executed transfers that value to the register and the data is accessed in the indirect
indexed register addressing mode (table 2.7).
Table 2.7
Displacement Accessing
Classification
SH7014/16/17 CPU
Example of Conventional CPU
16-bit displacement
MOV.W
@(disp,PC),R0
MOV.W
MOV.W
@(R0,R1),R2
@(H'1234,R1),R2
..................
.DATA.W
H'1234
Note: @(disp,PC) accesses the immediate data.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 25 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
2.3.2
Addressing Modes
Table 2.8 describes addressing modes and effective address calculation.
Table 2.8
Addressing Modes and Effective Addresses
Addressing
Mode
Instruction
Format
Effective Addresses Calculation
Direct register
addressing
Rn
The effective address is register Rn. (The operand
is the contents of register Rn.)
⎯
Indirect register
addressing
@Rn
The effective address is the content of register Rn.
Rn
Post-increment
indirect register
addressing
@Rn+
Rn
Equation
Rn
The effective address is the content of register Rn.
A constant is added to the content of Rn after the
instruction is executed. 1 is added for a byte
operation, 2 for a word operation, and 4 for a
longword operation.
Rn
Rn
Rn + 1/2/4
@–Rn
Rn
1/2/4
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 26 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Byte: Rn + 1
→ Rn
Longword:
Rn + 4 → Rn
The effective address is the value obtained by
subtracting a constant from Rn. 1 is subtracted for
a byte operation, 2 for a word operation, and 4 for
a longword operation.
Rn − 1/2/4
(After the
instruction
executes)
Word: Rn + 2
→ Rn
+
1/2/4
Pre-decrement
indirect register
addressing
Rn
−
Rn − 1/2/4
Byte: Rn − 1
→ Rn
Word: Rn − 2
→ Rn
Longword:
Rn − 4 → Rn
(Instruction
executed with
Rn after
calculation)
2. CPU
Addressing
Mode
Instruction
Format
Effective Addresses Calculation
Indirect register
addressing with
displacement
@(disp:4, The effective address is Rn plus a 4-bit
Rn)
displacement (disp). The value of disp is zeroextended, and remains the same for a byte
operation, is doubled for a word operation, and is
quadrupled for a longword operation.
Rn
disp
(zero-extended)
Equation
Byte: Rn +
disp
Word: Rn +
disp × 2
Longword:
Rn + disp × 4
Rn + disp × 1/2/4
+
×
1/2/4
Indirect indexed @(R0, Rn) The effective address is the Rn value plus R0.
register
Rn
addressing
+
Rn + R0
Rn + R0
R0
Indirect GBR
addressing with
displacement
@(disp:8, The effective address is the GBR value plus an
GBR)
8-bit displacement (disp). The value of disp is zeroextended, and remains the same for a byte operation, is doubled for a word operation, and is
quadrupled for a longword operation.
GBR
disp
(zero-extended)
+
GBR
+ disp × 1/2/4
Byte: GBR +
disp
Word: GBR +
disp × 2
Longword:
GBR + disp ×
4
×
1/2/4
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 27 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Addressing
Mode
Instruction
Format
Effective Addresses Calculation
Equation
Indirect indexed @(R0, GBR) The effective address is the GBR value plus the R0. GBR + R0
GBR addressing
GBR
+
GBR + R0
R0
PC relative
addressing with
displacement
@(disp:8, The effective address is the PC value plus an 8-bit
PC)
displacement (disp). The value of disp is zeroextended, and is doubled for a word operation, and
quadrupled for a longword operation. For a
longword operation, the lowest two bits of the PC
value are masked.
PC
&
H'FFFFFFFC
+
disp
(zero-extended)
×
2/4
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 28 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(for longword)
PC + disp × 2
or
PC & H'FFFFFFFC
+ disp × 4
Word: PC +
disp × 2
Longword:
PC &
H'FFFFFFFC
+ disp × 4
2. CPU
Addressing
Mode
Instruction
Format
Effective Addresses Calculation
PC relative
addressing
disp:8
Equation
The effective address is the PC value sign-extended PC + disp × 2
with an 8-bit displacement (disp), doubled, and
added to the PC value.
PC
disp
(sign-extended)
+
PC + disp × 2
×
2
disp:12
The effective address is the PC value sign-extended PC + disp × 2
with a 12-bit displacement (disp), doubled, and
added to the PC value.
PC
disp
(sign-extended)
+
PC + disp × 2
×
2
Rn
The effective address is the register PC value
plus Rn.
PC + Rn
PC
+
PC + Rn
Rn
Immediate
addressing
#imm:8
The 8-bit immediate data (imm) for the TST, AND,
OR, and XOR instructions are zero-extended.
⎯
#imm:8
The 8-bit immediate data (imm) for the MOV, ADD,
and CMP/EQ instructions are sign-extended.
⎯
#imm:8
The 8-bit immediate data (imm) for the TRAPA
instruction is zero-extended and is quadrupled.
⎯
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 29 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
2.3.3
Instruction Format
Table 2.9 lists the instruction formats for the source operand and the destination operand. The
meaning of the operand depends on the instruction code. The symbols are used as follows:
• xxxx: Instruction code
• mmmm: Source register
• nnnn: Destination register
• iiii: Immediate data
• dddd: Displacement
Table 2.9
Instruction Formats
Instruction Formats
0 format
15
Source
Operand
Destination
Operand
Example
⎯
⎯
NOP
⎯
nnnn: Direct
register
MOVT
Rn
Control register
or system
register
nnnn: Direct
register
STS
MACH,Rn
Control register
or system
register
nnnn: Indirect predecrement register
STC.L
SR,@-Rn
mmmm: Direct
register
Control register or
system register
LDC
Rm,SR
mmmm: Indirect
post-increment
register
Control register or
system register
LDC.L
@Rm+,SR
mmmm: Direct
register
⎯
JMP
@Rm
BRAF
Rm
0
xxxx
xxxx
xxxx
xxxx
n format
15
0
xxxx
nnnn
xxxx
m format
15
xxxx mmmm xxxx
xxxx
0
xxxx
mmmm: PC
⎯
relative using Rm
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 30 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Source
Operand
Destination
Operand
mmmm: Direct
register
nnnn: Direct
register
ADD
Rm,Rn
mmmm: Direct
register
nnnn: Indirect
register
MOV.L
Rm,@Rn
mmmm: Indirect
post-increment
register (multiply/
accumulate)
nnnn*: Indirect
post-increment
register (multiply/
accumulate)
MACH, MACL
MAC.W
@Rm+,@Rn+
mmmm: Indirect
post-increment
register
nnnn: Direct
register
MOV.L
@Rm+,Rn
mmmm: Direct
register
nnnn: Indirect predecrement
register
MOV.L
Rm,@-Rn
mmmm: Direct
register
nnnn: Indirect
indexed register
MOV.L
Rm,@(R0,Rn)
md format
15
0
xxxx xxxx mmmm dddd
mmmmdddd:
indirect register
with
displacement
R0 (Direct
register)
MOV.B
@(disp,Rm),R0
nd4 format
15
xxxx xxxx
R0 (Direct
register)
nnnndddd:
Indirect register
with displacement
MOV.B
R0,@(disp,Rn)
mmmm: Direct
register
nnnndddd: Indirect
register with
displacement
MOV.L
Rm,@(disp,Rn)
mmmmdddd:
Indirect register
with
displacement
nnnn: Direct
register
MOV.L
@(disp,Rm),Rn
Instruction Formats
nm format
15
0
xxxx nnnn mmmm xxxx
0
nnnn
dddd
nmd format
15
0
xxxx nnnn mmmm dddd
Example
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 31 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Instruction Formats
d format
15
xxxx
0
xxxx
d12 format
15
xxxx dddd
nd8 format
15
xxxx nnnn
i format
15
xxxx
*
dddd
0
dddd
dddddddd:
Indirect GBR
with
displacement
R0 (Direct register)
MOV.L
@(disp,GBR),R0
R0 (Direct
register)
dddddddd: Indirect
GBR with
displacement
MOV.L
R0,@(disp,GBR)
dddddddd: PC
relative with
displacement
R0 (Direct register)
MOVA
@(disp,PC),R0
dddddddd: PC
relative
⎯
BF
label
dddddddddddd:
PC relative
⎯
BRA
label
dddddddd: PC
relative with
displacement
nnnn: Direct
register
MOV.L
@(disp,PC),Rn
dddd
iiiiiiii: Immediate
Indirect indexed
GBR
AND.B
#imm,@(R0,GBR)
xxxx
iiii
iiii
iiiiiiii: Immediate
R0 (Direct register)
AND
#imm,R0
iiiiiiii: Immediate
⎯
TRAPA
#imm
iiiiiiii: Immediate
nnnn: Direct
register
ADD
#imm,Rn
0
iiii
iiii
In multiply/accumulate instructions, nnnn is the source register.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 32 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Example
(label = disp
+ PC)
dddd
0
dddd
Destination
Operand
0
ni format
15
xxxx nnnn
Note:
dddd
Source
Operand
2. CPU
2.4
Instruction Set by Classification
Table 2.10 Classification of Instructions
Operation
Classification Types Code
Function
No. of
Instructions
Data transfer
39
Arithmetic
operations
5
21
MOV
Data transfer, immediate data transfer,
peripheral module data transfer, structure data
transfer
MOVA
Effective address transfer
MOVT
T bit transfer
SWAP
Swap of upper and lower bytes
XTRCT
Extraction of the middle of registers connected
ADD
Binary addition
ADDC
Binary addition with carry
ADDV
Binary addition with overflow check
33
CMP/cond Comparison
DIV1
Division
DIV0S
Initialization of signed division
DIV0U
Initialization of unsigned division
DMULS
Signed double-length multiplication
DMULU
Unsigned double-length multiplication
DT
Decrement and test
EXTS
Sign extension
EXTU
Zero extension
MAC
Multiply/accumulate, double-length
multiply/accumulate operation
MUL
Double-length multiply operation
MULS
Signed multiplication
MULU
Unsigned multiplication
NEG
Negation
NEGC
Negation with borrow
SUB
Binary subtraction
SUBC
Binary subtraction with borrow
SUBV
Binary subtraction with underflow
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 33 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Operation
Classification Types Code
Function
Logic
operations
Shift
Branch
6
10
9
AND
Logical AND
NOT
Bit inversion
OR
Logical OR
TAS
Memory test and bit set
TST
Logical AND and T bit set
XOR
Exclusive OR
ROTL
One-bit left rotation
ROTR
One-bit right rotation
ROTCL
One-bit left rotation with T bit
ROTCR
One-bit right rotation with T bit
SHAL
One-bit arithmetic left shift
SHAR
One-bit arithmetic right shift
SHLL
One-bit logical left shift
SHLLn
n-bit logical left shift
SHLR
One-bit logical right shift
SHLRn
n-bit logical right shift
BF
Conditional branch, conditional branch with
delay (Branch when T = 0)
BT
Conditional branch, conditional branch with
delay (Branch when T = 1)
BRA
Unconditional branch
BRAF
Unconditional branch
BSR
Branch to subroutine procedure
BSRF
Branch to subroutine procedure
JMP
Unconditional branch
JSR
Branch to subroutine procedure
RTS
Return from subroutine procedure
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 34 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
No. of
Instructions
14
14
11
2. CPU
Operation
Classification Types Code
Function
No. of
Instructions
System control 11
31
Total:
62
CLRT
T bit clear
CLRMAC
MAC register clear
LDC
Load to control register
LDS
Load to system register
NOP
No operation
RTE
Return from exception processing
SETT
T bit set
SLEEP
Shift into power-down mode
STC
Storing control register data
STS
Storing system register data
TRAPA
Trap exception handling
142
Table 2.11 shows the format used in tables 2.12 to 2.17, which list instruction codes, operation,
and execution states in order by classification.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 35 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Table 2.11 Instruction Code Format
Item
Format
Explanation
Instruction
OP.Sz SRC,DEST
OP: Operation code
Sz: Size (B: byte, W: word, or L: longword)
SRC: Source
DEST: Destination
Rm: Source register
Rn: Destination register
imm: Immediate data
disp: Displacement*1
Instruction
code
MSB ↔ LSB
mmmm: Source register
nnnn: Destination register
0000: R0
0001: R1
.
.
.
1111: R15
iiii: Immediate data
dddd: Displacement
Operation
→, ←
Direction of transfer
(xx)
Memory operand
M/Q/T
Flag bits in the SR
&
Logical AND of each bit
|
Logical OR of each bit
^
Exclusive OR of each bit
~
Logical NOT of each bit
<<n
n-bit left shift
>>n
n-bit right shift
Execution
cycles
⎯
Value when no wait states are inserted*2
T bit
⎯
Value of T bit after instruction is executed. An em-dash (⎯)
in the column means no change.
Notes: 1. Depending on the operand size, displacement is scaled ×1, ×2, or ×4. For details, see
the SH-1/SH-2/SH-DSP Software Manual.
2. Instruction execution cycles: The execution cycles shown in the table are minimums.
The actual number of cycles may be increased when (1) contention occurs between
instruction fetches and data access, or (2) when the destination register of the load
instruction (memory → register) and the register used by the next instruction are the
same.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 36 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Table 2.12 Data Transfer Instructions
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
#imm → Sign extension
→ Rn
1
⎯
1001nnnndddddddd
(disp × 2 + PC) → Sign
extension → Rn
1
⎯
MOV.L @(disp,PC),Rn
1101nnnndddddddd
(disp × 4 + PC) → Rn
1
⎯
MOV
0110nnnnmmmm0011
Rm → Rn
1
⎯
MOV.B Rm,@Rn
0010nnnnmmmm0000
Rm → (Rn)
1
⎯
MOV.W Rm,@Rn
0010nnnnmmmm0001
Rm → (Rn)
1
⎯
MOV.L Rm,@Rn
0010nnnnmmmm0010
Rm → (Rn)
1
⎯
MOV.B @Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm0000
(Rm) → Sign extension
→ Rn
1
⎯
MOV.W @Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm0001
(Rm) → Sign extension
→ Rn
1
⎯
MOV.L @Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm0010
(Rm) → Rn
1
⎯
MOV.B Rm,@–Rn
0010nnnnmmmm0100
Rn − 1 → Rn, Rm → (Rn) 1
⎯
MOV.W Rm,@–Rn
0010nnnnmmmm0101
Rn − 2 → Rn, Rm → (Rn) 1
⎯
MOV.L Rm,@–Rn
0010nnnnmmmm0110
Rn − 4 → Rn, Rm → (Rn) 1
⎯
MOV.B @Rm+,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm0100
(Rm) → Sign extension
→ Rn,Rm + 1 → Rm
1
⎯
MOV.W @Rm+,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm0101
(Rm) → Sign extension
→ Rn,Rm + 2 → Rm
1
⎯
MOV.L @Rm+,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm0110
(Rm) → Rn,Rm + 4 →
Rm
1
⎯
MOV.B R0,@(disp,Rn)
10000000nnnndddd
R0 → (disp + Rn)
1
⎯
MOV.W R0,@(disp,Rn)
10000001nnnndddd
R0 → (disp × 2 + Rn)
1
⎯
MOV.L Rm,@(disp,Rn)
0001nnnnmmmmdddd
Rm → (disp × 4 + Rn)
1
⎯
MOV.B @(disp,Rm),R0
10000100mmmmdddd
(disp + Rm) → Sign
extension → R0
1
⎯
MOV.W @(disp,Rm),R0
10000101mmmmdddd
(disp × 2 + Rm) → Sign
extension → R0
1
⎯
MOV.L @(disp,Rm),Rn
0101nnnnmmmmdddd
(disp × 4 + Rm) → Rn
1
⎯
MOV.B Rm,@(R0,Rn)
0000nnnnmmmm0100
Rm → (R0 + Rn)
1
⎯
Instruction
Instruction Code
Operation
MOV
#imm,Rn
1110nnnniiiiiiii
MOV.W @(disp,PC),Rn
Rm,Rn
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 37 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Instruction
Instruction Code
Operation
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
MOV.W
Rm,@(R0,Rn)
0000nnnnmmmm0101
Rm → (R0 + Rn)
1
⎯
MOV.L
Rm,@(R0,Rn)
0000nnnnmmmm0110
Rm → (R0 + Rn)
1
⎯
MOV.B
@(R0,Rm),Rn
0000nnnnmmmm1100
(R0 + Rm) → Sign
extension → Rn
1
⎯
MOV.W
@(R0,Rm),Rn
0000nnnnmmmm1101
(R0 + Rm) → Sign
extension → Rn
1
⎯
MOV.L
@(R0,Rm),Rn
0000nnnnmmmm1110
(R0 + Rm) → Rn
1
⎯
MOV.B
R0,@(disp,GBR)
11000000dddddddd
R0 → (disp + GBR)
1
⎯
MOV.W
R0,@(disp,GBR)
11000001dddddddd
R0 → (disp × 2 + GBR)
1
⎯
MOV.L
R0,@(disp,GBR)
11000010dddddddd
R0 → (disp × 4 + GBR)
1
⎯
MOV.B
@(disp,GBR),R0
11000100dddddddd
(disp + GBR) → Sign
extension → R0
1
⎯
MOV.W
@(disp,GBR),R0
11000101dddddddd
(disp × 2 + GBR) →
Sign extension → R0
1
⎯
MOV.L
@(disp,GBR),R0
11000110dddddddd
(disp × 4 + GBR) → R0
1
⎯
MOVA
@(disp,PC),R0
11000111dddddddd
disp × 4 + PC → R0
1
⎯
MOVT
Rn
0000nnnn00101001
T → Rn
1
⎯
SWAP.B Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm1000
Rm → Swap the bottom
two bytes → Rn
1
⎯
SWAP.W Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm1001
Rm → Swap two
consecutive words →
Rn
1
⎯
XTRCT
0010nnnnmmmm1101
Rm: Middle 32 bits of
Rn → Rn
1
⎯
Rm,Rn
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 38 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Table 2.13 Arithmetic Operation Instructions
Instruction
Instruction Code
Operation
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
ADD
Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm1100
Rn + Rm → Rn
1
⎯
ADD
#imm,Rn
0111nnnniiiiiiii
Rn + imm → Rn
1
⎯
ADDC
Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm1110
Rn + Rm + T → Rn,
Carry → T
1
Carry
ADDV
Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm1111
Rn + Rm → Rn,
Overflow → T
1
Overflow
CMP/EQ #imm,R0
10001000iiiiiiii
If R0 = imm, 1 → T
1
Comparison
result
CMP/EQ Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm0000
If Rn = Rm, 1 → T
1
Comparison
result
CMP/HS Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm0010
If Rn ≥ Rm with
unsigned data, 1 → T
1
Comparison
result
CMP/GE Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm0011
If Rn ≥ Rm with signed 1
data, 1 → T
Comparison
result
CMP/HI Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm0110
If Rn > Rm with
unsigned data, 1 → T
1
Comparison
result
CMP/GT Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm0111
If Rn > Rm with
signed data, 1 → T
1
Comparison
result
CMP/PL Rn
0100nnnn00010101
If Rn > 0, 1 → T
1
Comparison
result
CMP/PZ Rn
0100nnnn00010001
If Rn ≥ 0, 1 → T
1
Comparison
result
CMP/STR Rm,Rn
0010nnnnmmmm1100
If Rn and Rm have
an equivalent byte,
1→T
1
Comparison
result
DIV1
Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm0100
Single-step division
(Rn/Rm)
1
Calculation
result
DIV0S
Rm,Rn
0010nnnnmmmm0111
MSB of Rn → Q, MSB 1
of Rm → M, M ^ Q → T
Calculation
result
0000000000011001
0 → M/Q/T
0
DIV0U
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 39 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
Signed operation of
Rn × Rm → MACH,
MACL 32 × 32 → 64 bit
2 to 4*
⎯
0011nnnnmmmm0101
Unsigned operation of
Rn × Rm → MACH,
MACL 32 × 32 → 64 bit
2 to 4*
⎯
0100nnnn00010000
Rn − 1 → Rn, when
Rn is 0, 1 → T. When
Rn is nonzero, 0 → T
1
Comparison
result
EXTS.B Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm1110
A byte in Rm is signextended → Rn
1
⎯
EXTS.W Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm1111
A word in Rm is signextended → Rn
1
⎯
EXTU.B Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm1100
A byte in Rm is zeroextended → Rn
1
⎯
EXTU.W Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm1101
A word in Rm is zeroextended → Rn
1
⎯
MAC.L
@Rm+,@Rn+
0000nnnnmmmm1111
Signed operation of
(Rn) × (Rm) + MAC →
MAC 32 × 32 → 64 bit
3/
⎯
(2 to 4)*
MAC.W
@Rm+,@Rn+
0100nnnnmmmm1111
Signed operation of
(Rn) × (Rm) + MAC →
MAC 16 × 16 + 64 →
64 bit
3/(2)*
⎯
MUL.L
Rm,Rn
0000nnnnmmmm0111
Rn × Rm → MACL,
32 × 32 → 32 bit
2 to 4*
⎯
MULS.W Rm,Rn
0010nnnnmmmm1111
Signed operation of
Rn × Rm → MAC
16 × 16 → 32 bit
1 to 3*
⎯
MULU.W Rm,Rn
0010nnnnmmmm1110
Unsigned operation of
Rn × Rm → MAC
16 × 16 → 32 bit
1 to 3*
⎯
NEG
Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm1011
0 − Rm → Rn
1
⎯
NEGC
Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm1010
0 − Rm − T → Rn,
Borrow → T
1
Borrow
Instruction
Instruction Code
Operation
DMULS.L Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm1101
DMULU.L Rm,Rn
DT
Rn
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 40 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Instruction
Instruction Code
Operation
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
SUB
Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm1000
Rn − Rm → Rn
1
⎯
SUBC
Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm1010
Rn − Rm − T → Rn,
Borrow → T
1
Borrow
SUBV
Rm,Rn
0011nnnnmmmm1011
Rn − Rm → Rn,
Underflow → T
1
Overflow
Note:
*
The normal minimum number of execution cycles. (The number in parentheses is the
number of cycles when there is contention with following instructions.)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 41 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Table 2.14 Logic Operation Instructions
Instruction
Instruction Code
Operation
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
AND
Rm,Rn
0010nnnnmmmm1001
Rn & Rm → Rn
1
⎯
AND
#imm,R0
11001001iiiiiiii
R0 & imm → R0
1
⎯
AND.B #imm,@(R0,GBR)
11001101iiiiiiii
(R0 + GBR) & imm →
(R0 + GBR)
3
⎯
NOT
Rm,Rn
0110nnnnmmmm0111
∼Rm → Rn
1
⎯
OR
Rm,Rn
0010nnnnmmmm1011
Rn | Rm → Rn
1
⎯
OR
#imm,R0
11001011iiiiiiii
R0 | imm → R0
1
⎯
OR.B
#imm,@(R0,GBR)
11001111iiiiiiii
(R0 + GBR) | imm →
(R0 + GBR)
3
⎯
TAS.B @Rn*
0100nnnn00011011
If (Rn) is 0, 1 → T; 1 →
MSB of (Rn)*
4
Test
result
TST
Rm,Rn
0010nnnnmmmm1000
Rn & Rm; if the result is
0, 1 → T
1
Test
result
TST
#imm,R0
11001000iiiiiiii
R0 & imm; if the result is
0, 1 → T
1
Test
result
TST.B #imm,@(R0,GBR)
11001100iiiiiiii
(R0 + GBR) & imm; if
the result is 0, 1 → T
3
Test
result
XOR
Rm,Rn
0010nnnnmmmm1010
Rn ^ Rm → Rn
1
⎯
XOR
#imm,R0
11001010iiiiiiii
R0 ^ imm → R0
1
⎯
11001110iiiiiiii
(R0 + GBR) ^ imm →
(R0 + GBR)
3
⎯
XOR.B #imm,@(R0,GBR)
Note:
*
The on-chip DMAC bus cycles are not inserted between the read and write cycles of
TAS instruction execution.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 42 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Table 2.15 Shift Instructions
Instruction
Instruction Code
Operation
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
ROTL
Rn
0100nnnn00000100
T ← Rn ← MSB
1
MSB
ROTR
Rn
0100nnnn00000101
LSB → Rn → T
1
LSB
ROTCL
Rn
0100nnnn00100100
T ← Rn ← T
1
MSB
ROTCR
Rn
0100nnnn00100101
T → Rn → T
1
LSB
SHAL
Rn
0100nnnn00100000
T ← Rn ← 0
1
MSB
SHAR
Rn
0100nnnn00100001
MSB → Rn → T
1
LSB
SHLL
Rn
0100nnnn00000000
T ← Rn ← 0
1
MSB
SHLR
Rn
0100nnnn00000001
0 → Rn → T
1
LSB
SHLL2
Rn
0100nnnn00001000
Rn<<2 → Rn
1
⎯
SHLR2
Rn
0100nnnn00001001
Rn>>2 → Rn
1
⎯
SHLL8
Rn
0100nnnn00011000
Rn<<8 → Rn
1
⎯
SHLR8
Rn
0100nnnn00011001
Rn>>8 → Rn
1
⎯
SHLL16 Rn
0100nnnn00101000
Rn<<16 → Rn
1
⎯
SHLR16 Rn
0100nnnn00101001
Rn>>16 → Rn
1
⎯
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 43 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Table 2.16 Branch Instructions
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
10001011dddddddd If T = 0, disp × 2 + PC → PC; if T =
1, NOP
3/1*
⎯
BF/S label
10001111dddddddd Delayed branch, if T = 0, disp × 2 +
PC → PC; if T = 1, NOP
3/1*
⎯
BT
label
10001001dddddddd If T = 1, disp × 2 + PC → PC; if T =
0, NOP
3/1*
⎯
BT/S label
10001101dddddddd Delayed branch, if T = 1, disp × 2 +
PC → PC; if T = 0, NOP
2/1*
⎯
BRA
1010dddddddddddd Delayed branch, disp × 2 + PC →
PC
2
⎯
BRAF Rm
0000mmmm00100011 Delayed branch, Rm + PC → PC
2
⎯
BSR
1011dddddddddddd Delayed branch, PC → PR, disp × 2
+ PC → PC
2
⎯
BSRF Rm
0000mmmm00000011 Delayed branch, PC → PR,
Rm + PC → PC
2
⎯
JMP
@Rm
0100mmmm00101011 Delayed branch, Rm → PC
2
⎯
JSR
@Rm
0100mmmm00001011 Delayed branch, PC → PR,
Rm → PC
2
⎯
0000000000001011 Delayed branch, PR → PC
2
⎯
Instruction
Instruction Code
BF
label
RTS
label
label
Operation
Note: One state when it does not branch.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 44 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Table 2.17 System Control Instructions
Instruction
Instruction Code
Operation
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
CLRT
0000000000001000
0→T
1
0
CLRMAC
0000000000101000
0 → MACH, MACL
1
⎯
LDC
Rm,SR
0100mmmm00001110
Rm → SR
1
LSB
LDC
Rm,GBR
0100mmmm00011110
Rm → GBR
1
⎯
LDC
Rm,VBR
0100mmmm00101110
Rm → VBR
1
⎯
LDC.L @Rm+,SR
0100mmmm00000111
(Rm) → SR, Rm + 4 → Rm
3
LSB
LDC.L @Rm+,GBR
0100mmmm00010111
(Rm) → GBR, Rm + 4 → Rm
3
⎯
LDC.L @Rm+,VBR
0100mmmm00100111
(Rm) → VBR, Rm + 4 → Rm
3
⎯
LDS
Rm,MACH
0100mmmm00001010
Rm → MACH
1
⎯
LDS
Rm,MACL
0100mmmm00011010
Rm → MACL
1
⎯
LDS
Rm,PR
0100mmmm00101010
Rm → PR
1
⎯
0100mmmm00000110
(Rm) → MACH, Rm + 4 → Rm 1
⎯
LDS.L @Rm+,MACL
0100mmmm00010110
(Rm) → MACL, Rm + 4 → Rm
1
⎯
LDS.L @Rm+,PR
0100mmmm00100110
(Rm) → PR, Rm + 4 → Rm
1
⎯
NOP
0000000000001001
No operation
1
⎯
RTE
0000000000101011
Delayed branch, stack area
→ PC/SR
4
⎯
SETT
0000000000011000
1→T
1
1
SLEEP
0000000000011011
Sleep
3*
⎯
LDS.L @Rm+,MACH
STC
SR,Rn
0000nnnn00000010
SR → Rn
1
⎯
STC
GBR,Rn
0000nnnn00010010
GBR → Rn
1
⎯
STC
VBR,Rn
0000nnnn00100010
VBR → Rn
1
⎯
STC.L
SR,@–Rn
0100nnnn00000011
Rn − 4 → Rn, SR → (Rn)
2
⎯
STC.L
GBR,@–Rn
0100nnnn00010011
Rn − 4 → Rn, GBR → (Rn)
2
⎯
STC.L
VBR,@–Rn
0100nnnn00100011
Rn − 4 → Rn, BR → (Rn)
2
⎯
STS
MACH,Rn
0000nnnn00001010
MACH → Rn
1
⎯
STS
MACL,Rn
0000nnnn00011010
MACL → Rn
1
⎯
STS
PR,Rn
0000nnnn00101010
PR → Rn
1
⎯
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 45 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Instruction
Instruction Code
Operation
Exec.
Cycles
T Bit
STS.L
MACH,@–Rn
0100nnnn00000010
Rn − 4 → Rn, MACH → (Rn)
1
⎯
STS.L
MACL,@–Rn
0100nnnn00010010
Rn − 4 → Rn, MACL → (Rn)
1
⎯
STS.L
PR,@–Rn
0100nnnn00100010
Rn − 4 → Rn, PR → (Rn)
1
⎯
TRAPA
#imm
11000011iiiiiiii
PC/SR → stack area, (imm)
→ PC
8
⎯
Note: The number of execution cycles before the chip enters sleep mode: The execution cycles
shown in the table are minimums. The actual number of cycles may be increased when (1)
contention occurs between instruction fetches and data access, or (2) when the destination
register of the load instruction (memory → register) and the register used by the next
instruction are the same.
2.5
Processing States
2.5.1
State Transitions
The CPU has four processing states: reset, exception processing, program execution and powerdown. Figure 2.6 shows the transitions between the states.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 46 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
From any state
when RES = 0
Power-on reset state
Reset states
RES = 1
Exception processing state
When an interrupt
source or DMA
address error
occurs
NMI interrupt
source occurs
Exception
processing
source occurs
Exception
processing
ends
Program execution state
SBY bit
cleared
for SLEEP
instruction
Sleep mode
SBY bit set
for SLEEP
instruction
Standby mode
Power-down state
Figure 2.6 Transitions between Processing States
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 47 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Reset State: The CPU resets in the reset state. When the RES pin level goes low, a power-on reset
results.
Exception Processing State: The exception processing state is a transient state that occurs when
exception processing sources such as resets or interrupts alter the CPU's processing state flow.
For a reset, the initial values of the program counter (PC) (execution start address) and stack
pointer (SP) are fetched from the exception processing vector table and stored; the CPU then
branches to the execution start address and execution of the program begins.
For an interrupt, the stack pointer (SP) is accessed and the program counter (PC) and status
register (SR) are saved to the stack area. The exception service routine start address is fetched
from the exception processing vector table; the CPU then branches to that address and the program
starts executing, thereby entering the program execution state.
Program Execution State: In the program execution state, the CPU sequentially executes the
program.
Power-Down State: In the power-down state, the CPU operation halts and power consumption
declines. The SLEEP instruction places the CPU in the power-down state. This state has two
modes: sleep mode and standby mode.
2.5.2
Power-Down State
Besides the ordinary program execution states, the CPU also has a power-down state in which
CPU operation halts, lowering power consumption. There are two power-down state modes: sleep
mode and standby mode.
Sleep Mode: When standby bit SBY (in the standby control register SBYCR) is cleared to 0 and a
SLEEP instruction executed, the CPU moves from program execution state to sleep mode. In the
sleep mode, the CPU halts and the contents of its internal registers and the data in on-chip cache
(or on-chip RAM) is maintained. The on-chip peripheral modules other than the CPU do not halt
in the sleep mode.
To return from sleep mode, use a power-on reset, any interrupt, or a DMA address error; the CPU
returns to the ordinary program execution state through the exception processing state.
Standby Mode: To enter the standby mode, set the standby bit SBY (in the standby control
register SBYCR) to 1 and execute a SLEEP instruction. In standby mode, all CPU, on-chip
peripheral module, and oscillator functions are halted. However, when entering standby mode, the
DMA master enable bit of the DMAC should be set to 0. If multiplication-related instructions are
being executed at the time of entry into standby mode, the values of MACH and MACL will
become undefined.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 48 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
To return from standby mode, use a power-on reset or an NMI interrupt. For resets, the CPU
returns to ordinary program execution state through the exception processing state when placed in
a reset state for the duration of the oscillator stabilization time. For NMI interrupts, the CPU
returns to ordinary program execution state through the exception processing state after the
oscillator stabilization time has elapsed. In this mode, power consumption drops markedly, since
the oscillator stops (table 2.18).
Table 2.18 Power-Down State
State
On-Chip
On-Chip
Cache or I/O
Transition
Peripheral CPU
On-Chip Port
Mode Conditions Clock CPU Modules Registers RAM
Pins
Sleep Execute
Run
SLEEP
instruction
with SBY bit
cleared to 0
in SBYCR
Halt Run
Stand- Execute
Halt
by
SLEEP
instruction
with SBY bit
set to 1 in
SBYCR
Halt Halt and
initialize*
Note:
*
Held
Held
Held
Held
Held
Canceling
•
Interrupt
•
DMA address
error
•
Power-on reset
Held or •
Hi-Z
•
(selectable)
NMI interrupt
Power-on reset
Differs depending on the peripheral module and pin.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 49 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2. CPU
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 50 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
3. Operating Modes
Section 3 Operating Modes
3.1
Operating Modes, Types, and Selection
This LSI has five operating modes and three clock modes, determined by the setting of the mode
pins (MD3 to MD0). Do not change the mode pin settings during LSI operation (while power is
on).
Table 3.1 indicates the setting method for the operating mode.
Table 3.1
Operating Mode Setting
Pin Setting
Mode
1
1
No.
FWP MD3* MD2* MD1 MD0 Mode Name
On-Chip
ROM
CS0 Area
0
1
1
x
x
0
0
MCU mode 0
Not Active
8-bit space
1
x
x
0
1
MCU mode 1
Not Active
16-bit space
2*
4
1
x
x
1
0
MCU mode 2
Active
8/16-bit space*
3*
4
1
x
x
1
1
Single chip mode
Active
⎯
Active
8/16-bit space*
0
x
x
0
0
0
x
x
0
1
0
x
x
1
0
0
x
x
1
1
1
1
1
0
1
Notes: 1.
2.
3.
4.
Boot mode*
3
2
2
⎯
User programming
3
mode*
Active
Flash programmer
3
mode*
Active
2
8/16-bit space*
⎯
⎯
MD2 and MD3 pins select the clock mode in modes 0 to 3 (table 3.2).
Set by BCR1 of BSC.
Only F-ZTAT.
Only SH7016, SH7017.
Table 3.2 indicates the setting method for the clock mode.
Table 3.2
Clock Mode Setting
MD3
MD2
Clock Mode
0
0
PLL ON × 1
0
1
PLL ON × 2
1
0
PLL ON × 4
1
1
Reserved
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 51 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
3. Operating Modes
3.2
Explanation of Operating Modes
Table 3.3 describes the operating modes.
Table 3.3
Operating Modes
Mode
Description
(MCU) Mode 0
CS0 area becomes an external memory space with 8-bit bus width.
(MCU) Mode 1
CS0 area becomes an external memory space with 16-bit bus width.
(MCU) Mode 2
The on-chip ROM becomes effective. The bus width for the on-chip
ROM space is 32 bit.
Mode 3 (single chip
mode)
Any port can be used, but external addresses can not be employed.
Clock mode
The input waveform frequency can be used as is, doubled or
quadrupled as an internal clock in modes 0 to 3.
3.3
Pin Configuration
Table 3.4 describes the function of each operating mode related pin.
Table 3.4
Operating Mode Pin Function
Pin Name
Input/Output
Function
XTAL
Input
Connects to a crystal oscillator
EXTAL
Input
Connects to a crystal oscillator, or used for external clock input pin
PLLCAP
Input
Connects to a capacitor for PLL circuit operation
MD0
Input
Designates operating mode through the level applied to this pin
MD1
Input
Designates operating mode through the level applied to this pin
MD2
Input
Designates clock mode through the level applied to this pin
MD3
Input
Designates clock mode through the level applied to this pin
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 52 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
4. Clock Pulse Generator (CPG)
Section 4 Clock Pulse Generator (CPG)
4.1
Overview
This LSI has an on-chip clock pulse generator (CPG) that generates the system clock (φ), as well
as the internal clock (φ/2 to φ/8192). The CPG consists of an oscillator, a PLL, and a prescaler.
4.1.1
Block Diagram
A block diagram of the clock pulse generator is shown in figure 4.1.
PLLCAP
CK
EXTAL
Oscillator
PLL circuit
XTAL
Prescaler
MD2
MD3
Clock mode
control circuitry
φ
φ/2 to
φ/8192
Within the LSI
Figure 4.1 Block Diagram of the Clock Pulse Generator
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 53 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
4. Clock Pulse Generator (CPG)
4.2
Oscillator
Clock pulses can be supplied from a connected crystal resonator or an external clock.
4.2.1
Connecting a Crystal Oscillator
Circuit Configuration: A crystal oscillator can be connected as shown in figure 4.2. Use the
damping resistance (Rd) listed in table 4.1. Use a 4 to 10 MHz crystal oscillator (consult your
dealer concerning the compatibility of the crystal oscillator and the LSI).
CL1
EXTAL
4 to 10 MHz
CL2
XTAL
Rd
CL1 = CL2 = 18 to 22 pF (Recommended value)
Figure 4.2 Connection of the Crystal Oscillator (Example)
Table 4.1
Damping Resistance Values (Recommended Values)
Frequency (MHz)
Parameter
4
8
10
Rd (Ω)
500
200
0
Crystal Oscillator: Figure 4.3 shows an equivalent circuit of the crystal oscillator. Use a crystal
oscillator with the characteristics listed in table 4.2.
L
CL
Rs
XTAL
EXTAL
Co
Figure 4.3 Crystal Oscillator Equivalent Circuit
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 54 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
4. Clock Pulse Generator (CPG)
Table 4.2
Crystal Oscillator Parameters
Frequency (MHz)
Parameter
4
8
10
Rs max (Ω)
120
80
60
Co max (pF)
7
7
7
Notes on Board Design: When connecting a crystal oscillator, observe the following precautions:
• To prevent induction from interfering with correct oscillation, do not route any signal lines
near the oscillator circuitry.
• When designing the board, place the crystal oscillator and its load capacitors as close as
possible to the XTAL and EXTAL pins.
Figures 4.4 and 4.5 show the precautions regarding oscillator block board settings.
Crossing of signal
lines prohibited
CL1
XTAL
CL2
EXTAL
Figure 4.4 Cautions for Oscillator Circuit System Board Design
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 55 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
4. Clock Pulse Generator (CPG)
External circuitry such as that shown in figure 4.5 is recommended around the PLL.
R1: 3 kΩ
C1: 470 pF
PLLCAP
Rp: 200 Ω
PLLVCC
CPB: 0.1 μF*
PLLVSS
VCC
CB: 0.1 μF*
VSS
Note: * CB and CPB are laminated ceramic capacitors
(Recommended values)
Figure 4.5 Cautions for Use of PLL Oscillator Circuit
Place oscillation stabilization capacitor C1 and resistor R1 near the PLL CAP pin, and ensure that
these lines do not cross any other signal lines. Supply the C1 ground from PLL VSS.
Also, separate PLL VCC and PLL VSS, and the other VCC and VSS pins, from the board power supply
source, and be sure to insert bypass capacitors CPB and CB close to the pins.
4.2.2
External Clock Input Method
Figure 4.6 shows an example of an external clock input connection. In this case, make the external
clock high level to stop it when in standby mode. During operation, make the external input clock
frequency 4 to 10 MHz.
When leaving the XTAL pin open, make sure the parasitic capacitance is less than 10 pF.
Even when inputting an external clock, be sure to delay until after the oscillation stabilization time
(upon power-on) or after release from standby, in order to ensure the PLL stabilization time.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 56 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
4. Clock Pulse Generator (CPG)
EXTAL
XTAL
External clock
input 4 to 10 MHz
Open
Figure 4.6 Example of External Clock Connection
4.3
Prescaler
The prescaler divides the system clock (φ) to generate an internal clock (φ/2 to φ/8192) for supply
to peripheral modules.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 57 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
4. Clock Pulse Generator (CPG)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 58 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
Section 5 Exception Processing
5.1
Overview
5.1.1
Types of Exception Processing and Priority
Exception processing is started by four sources: resets, address errors, interrupts and instructions
and have the priority shown in table 5.1. When several exception processing sources occur at once,
they are processed according to the priority shown.
Table 5.1
Types of Exception Processing and Priority Order
Exception
Source
Priority
Reset
Power-on reset
High
Address error CPU address error
DMAC address error
Interrupt
NMI
User break
IRQ
On-chip peripheral modules:
Instructions
•
Direct memory access controller (DMAC)
•
Multifunction timer/pulse unit (MTU)
•
Serial communication interface (SCI)
•
A/D converter (A/D)
•
Compare match timer (CMT)
•
Watchdog timer (WDT)
•
Bus state controller (BSC)
Trap instruction (TRAPA instruction)
General illegal instructions (undefined code)
Illegal slot instructions (undefined code placed directly after a delay branch Low
1
2
instruction* or instructions that rewrite the PC* )
Notes: 1. Delayed branch instructions: JMP, JSR, BRA, BSR, RTS, RTE, BF/S, BT/S, BSRF,
BRAF.
2. Instructions that rewrite the PC: JMP, JSR, BRA, BSR, RTS, RTE, BT, BF, TRAPA,
BF/S, BT/S, BSRF, BRAF.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 59 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.1.2
Exception Processing Operations
The exception processing sources are detected and begin processing according to the timing
shown in table 5.2.
Table 5.2
Timing of Exception Source Detection and the Start of Exception Processing
Exception
Source
Timing of Source Detection and Start of Processing
Power-on reset
Starts when the RES pin changes from low to high.
Address error
Detected when instruction is decoded and starts when the
previous executing instruction finishes executing.
Interrupts
Detected when instruction is decoded and starts when the
previous executing instruction finishes executing.
Instructions
Trap instruction
Starts from the execution of a TRAPA instruction.
General illegal
instructions
Starts from the decoding of undefined code anytime except after
a delayed branch instruction (delay slot).
Illegal slot
instructions
Starts from the decoding of undefined code placed in a delayed
branch instruction (delay slot) or of instructions that rewrite the
PC.
When exception processing starts, the CPU operates as follows:
1. Exception processing triggered by reset:
The initial values of the program counter (PC) and stack pointer (SP) are fetched from the
exception processing vector table (PC and SP are respectively the H'00000000 and
H'00000004 addresses). See section 5.1.3, Exception Processing Vector Table, for more
information. 0 is then written to the vector base register (VBR) and 1111 is written to the
interrupt mask bits (I3 to I0) of the status register (SR). The program begins running from the
PC address fetched from the exception processing vector table.
2. Exception processing triggered by address errors, interrupts and instructions:
SR and PC are saved to the stack indicated by R15. For interrupt exception processing, the
interrupt priority level is written to the SR's interrupt mask bits (I3 to I0). For address error and
instruction exception processing, the I3 to I0 bits are not affected. The start address is then
fetched from the exception processing vector table and the program begins running from that
address.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 60 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.1.3
Exception Processing Vector Table
Before exception processing begins running, the exception processing vector table must be set in
memory. The exception processing vector table stores the start addresses of exception service
routines. (The reset exception processing table holds the initial values of PC and SP.)
All exception sources are given different vector numbers and vector table address offsets, from
which the vector table addresses are calculated. During exception processing, the start addresses of
the exception service routines are fetched from the exception processing vector table, which
indicated by this vector table address.
Table 5.3 shows the vector numbers and vector table address offsets. Table 5.4 shows how vector
table addresses are calculated.
Table 5.3
Exception Processing Vector Table
Vector
Numbers
Vector Table Address Offset
PC
0
H'00000000 to H'00000003
SP
1
H'00000004 to H'00000007
(Reserved by system)
2
H'00000008 to H'0000000B
(Reserved by system)
3
H'0000000C to H'0000000F
Exception Sources
Power-on reset
General illegal instruction
4
H'00000010 to H'00000013
(Reserved by system)
5
H'00000014 to H'00000017
Slot illegal instruction
6
H'00000018 to H'0000001B
(Reserved by system)
7
H'0000001C to H'0000001F
(Reserved by system)
8
H'00000020 to H'00000023
CPU address error
9
H'00000024 to H'00000027
DMAC address error
10
H'00000028 to H'0000002B
11
H'0000002C to H'0000002F
Interrupts
NMI
User break
(Reserved by system)
12
H'00000030 to H'00000033
13
H'00000034 to H'00000037
:
Trap instruction (user vector)
:
31
H'0000007C to H'0000007F
32
H'00000080 to H'00000083
:
63
:
H'000000FC to H'000000FF
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 61 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
Vector
Numbers
Vector Table Address Offset
IRQ0
64
H'00000100 to H'00000103
IRQ1
65
H'00000104 to H'00000107
IRQ2
66
H'00000108 to H'0000010B
IRQ3
67
H'0000010C to H'0000010F
(Reserved by system)
68
H'00000110 to H'00000113
(Reserved by system)
69
H'00000114 to H'00000117
IRQ6
70
H'00000118 to H'0000011B
IRQ7
71
H'0000011C to H'0000011F
72
H'00000120 to H'00000124
Exception Sources
Interrupts
Interrupt
On-chip peripheral module*
:
255
Note:
*
Table 5.4
:
H'000003FC to H'000003FF
The vector numbers and vector table address offsets for each on-chip peripheral
module interrupt are given in section 6, Interrupt Controller, and table 6.3, Interrupt
Exception Processing Vectors and Priorities.
Calculating Exception Processing Vector Table Addresses
Exception Source
Vector Table Address Calculation
Resets
Vector table address = (vector table address offset)
= (vector number) × 4
Address errors, interrupts,
instructions
Vector table address = VBR + (vector table address offset)
= VBR + (vector number) × 4
Notes: 1. VBR: Vector base register
2. Vector table address offset: See table 5.3.
3. Vector number: See table 5.3.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 62 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.2
Resets
5.2.1
Power-on Reset
When the RES pin is driven low, the LSI does a power-on reset. To reliably reset the LSI, the RES
pin should be kept at low for at least the duration of the oscillation settling time when applying
power or when in standby mode (when the clock circuit is halted) or at least 20 tcyc (when the
clock circuit is running). During power-on reset, CPU internal status and all registers of on-chip
peripheral modules are initialized. See Appendix B, Pin Status, for the status of individual pins
during the power-on reset status.
In the power-on reset status, power-on reset exception processing starts when the RES pin is first
driven low for a set period of time and then returned to high. The CPU will then operate as
follows:
1. The initial value (execution start address) of the program counter (PC) is fetched from the
exception processing vector table.
2. The initial value of the stack pointer (SP) is fetched from the exception processing vector table.
3. The vector base register (VBR) is cleared to H'00000000 and the interrupt mask bits (I3 to I0)
of the status register (SR) are set to H'F (1111).
4. The values fetched from the exception processing vector table are set in the program counter
(PC) and SP and the program begins executing.
Be certain to always perform power-on reset processing when turning the system power on.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 63 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.3
Address Errors
5.3.1
Address Error Sources
Address errors occur when instructions are fetched or data read or written, as shown in table 5.5.
Table 5.5
Bus Cycles and Address Errors
Bus Cycle
Bus
Master Bus Cycle Description
Type
Instruction CPU
fetch
Data
read/write
Note:
*
Address Errors
Instruction fetched from even address
None (normal)
Instruction fetched from odd address
Address error occurs
Instruction fetched from other than on-chip peripheral
module space*
None (normal)
Instruction fetched from on-chip peripheral module
space*
Address error occurs
Instruction fetched from external memory space when
in single chip mode
Address error occurs
CPU or Word data accessed from even address
DMAC
Word data accessed from odd address
None (normal)
Address error occurs
Longword data accessed from a longword boundary
None (normal)
Longword data accessed from other than a long-word
boundary
Address error occurs
Byte or word data accessed in on-chip peripheral
module space*
None (normal)
Longword data accessed in 16-bit on-chip peripheral
module space*
None (normal)
Longword data accessed in 8-bit on-chip peripheral
module space*
Address error occurs
External memory space accessed in single-chip mode
Address error occurs
See section 8, Bus State Controller.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 64 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.3.2
Address Error Exception Processing
When an address error occurs, the bus cycle in which the address error occurred ends. When the
executing instruction then finishes, address error exception processing starts up. The CPU operates
as follows:
1. The status register (SR) is saved to the stack.
2. The program counter (PC) is saved to the stack. The PC value saved is the start address of the
instruction to be executed after the last executed instruction.
3. The exception service routine start address is fetched from the exception processing vector
table that corresponds to the address error that occurred and the program starts executing from
that address. The jump that occurs is not a delayed branch.
5.4
Interrupts
5.4.1
Interrupt Sources
Table 5.6 shows the sources that start up interrupt exception processing. These are divided into
NMI, IRQ and on-chip peripheral modules.
Table 5.6
Interrupt Sources
Type
Request Source
Number of Sources
NMI
NMI pin (external input)
1
IRQ
IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7 (external input)
6
On-chip peripheral module
Direct memory access controller (DMAC)
2
Multifunction timer pulse unit (MTU)
13
Serial communication interface (SCI)
8
A/D converter
1
Compare match timer (CMT)
2
Watchdog timer (WDT)
1
Bus state controller (BSC)
1
Each interrupt source is allocated a different vector number and vector table offset. See section 6,
Interrupt Controller, and table 6.3, Interrupt Exception Processing Vectors and Priorities, for more
information on vector numbers and vector table address offsets.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 65 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.4.2
Interrupt Priority Level
The interrupt priority order is predetermined. When multiple interrupts occur simultaneously
(overlap), the interrupt controller (INTC) determines their relative priorities and starts up
processing according to the results.
The priority order of interrupts is expressed as priority levels 0 to 16, with priority 0 the lowest
and priority 16 the highest. The NMI interrupt has priority 16 and cannot be masked, so it is
always accepted. IRQ interrupts and on-chip peripheral module interrupt priority levels can be set
freely using the INTC's interrupt priority level setting registers A through H (IPRA to IPRH) as
shown in table 5.7. The priority levels that can be set are 0 to 15. Level 16 cannot be set. See
section 6.3.1, Interrupt Priority Registers A to H (IPRA to IPRH), for more information on IPRA
to IPRH.
Table 5.7
Interrupt Priority Order
Type
Priority Level
Comment
NMI
16
Fixed priority level. Cannot be masked.
IRQ
0 to 15
Set with interrupt priority level setting registers A
through H (IPRA to IPRH).
On-chip peripheral module
0 to 15
Set with interrupt priority level setting registers A
through H (IPRA to IPRH).
5.4.3
Interrupt Exception Processing
When an interrupt occurs, its priority level is ascertained by the interrupt controller (INTC). NMI
is always accepted, but other interrupts are only accepted if they have a priority level higher than
the priority level set in the interrupt mask bits (I3 to I0) of the status register (SR).
When an interrupt is accepted, exception processing begins. In interrupt exception processing, the
CPU saves SR and the program counter (PC) to the stack. The priority level value of the accepted
interrupt is written to SR bits I3 to I0. For NMI, however, the priority level is 16, but the value set
in I3 to I0 is H'F (level 15). Next, the start address of the exception service routine is fetched from
the exception processing vector table for the accepted interrupt, that address is jumped to and
execution begins. See section 6.4, Interrupt Operation, for more information on the interrupt
exception processing.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 66 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.5
Exceptions Triggered by Instructions
5.5.1
Types of Exceptions Triggered by Instructions
Exception processing can be triggered by trap instructions, general illegal instructions, and illegal
slot instructions, as shown in table 5.8.
Table 5.8
Types of Exceptions Triggered by Instructions
Type
Source Instruction
Comment
Trap instructions
TRAPA
⎯
Illegal slot
instructions
Undefined code placed
immediately after a delayed
branch instruction (delay slot)
and instructions that rewrite the
PC
Delayed branch instructions: JMP, JSR,
BRA, BSR, RTS, RTE, BF/S, BT/S, BSRF,
BRAF
Undefined code anywhere
besides in a delay slot
⎯
General illegal
instructions
5.5.2
Instructions that rewrite the PC: JMP, JSR,
BRA, BSR, RTS, RTE, BT, BF, TRAPA,
BF/S, BT/S, BSRF, BRAF
Trap Instructions
When a TRAPA instruction is executed, trap instruction exception processing starts up. The CPU
operates as follows:
1. The status register (SR) is saved to the stack.
2. The program counter (PC) is saved to the stack. The PC value saved is the start address of the
instruction to be executed after the TRAPA instruction.
3. The exception service routine start address is fetched from the exception processing vector
table that corresponds to the vector number specified in the TRAPA instruction. That address
is jumped to and the program starts executing. The jump that occurs is not a delayed branch.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 67 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.5.3
Illegal Slot Instructions
An instruction placed immediately after a delayed branch instruction is said to be placed in a delay
slot. When the instruction placed in the delay slot is undefined code, illegal slot exception
processing starts up when that undefined code is decoded. Illegal slot exception processing also
starts up when an instruction that rewrites the program counter (PC) is placed in a delay slot. The
processing starts when the instruction is decoded. The CPU handles an illegal slot instruction as
follows:
1. The status register (SR) is saved to the stack.
2. The program counter (PC) is saved to the stack. The PC value saved is the jump address of the
delayed branch instruction immediately before the undefined code or the instruction that
rewrites the PC.
3. The exception service routine start address is fetched from the exception processing vector
table that corresponds to the exception that occurred. That address is jumped to and the
program starts executing. The jump that occurs is not a delayed branch.
5.5.4
General Illegal Instructions
When undefined code placed anywhere other than immediately after a delayed branch instruction
(i.e., in a delay slot) is decoded, general illegal instruction exception processing starts up. The
CPU handles general illegal instructions the same as illegal slot instructions. Unlike processing of
illegal slot instructions, however, the program counter value stored is the start address of the
undefined code.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 68 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.6
When Exception Sources Are Not Accepted
When an address error or interrupt is generated after a delayed branch instruction or interruptdisabled instruction, it is sometimes not accepted immediately but stored instead, as shown in
table 5.9. When this happens, it will be accepted when an instruction that can accept the exception
is decoded.
Table 5.9
Generation of Exception Sources Immediately after a Delayed Branch
Instruction or Interrupt-Disabled Instruction
Exception Source
Point of Occurrence
Immediately after a delayed branch instruction*1
Immediately after an interrupt-disabled
instruction*2
Address Error
Interrupt
Not accepted
Not accepted
Accepted
Not accepted
Notes: 1. Delayed branch instructions: JMP, JSR, BRA, BSR, RTS, RTE, BF/S, BT/S, BSRF,
BRAF
2. Interrupt-disabled instructions: LDC, LDC.L, STC, STC.L, LDS, LDS.L, STS, STS.L
5.6.1
Immediately after a Delayed Branch Instruction
When an instruction placed immediately after a delayed branch instruction (delay slot) is decoded,
neither address errors nor interrupts are accepted. The delayed branch instruction and the
instruction located immediately after it (delay slot) are always executed consecutively, so no
exception processing occurs during this period.
5.6.2
Immediately after an Interrupt-Disabled Instruction
When an instruction immediately following an interrupt-disabled instruction is decoded, interrupts
are not accepted. Address errors are accepted.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 69 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
5.7
Stack Status after Exception Processing Ends
The status of the stack after exception processing ends is as shown in table 5.10.
Table 5.10 Types of Stack Status After Exception Processing Ends
Types
Stack Status
Address error
SP
Address of instruction
32 bits
after executed instruction
SR
32 bits
Address of instruction
after TRAPA instruction
32 bits
SR
32 bits
Start address of illegal
instruction
32 bits
SR
32 bits
Trap instruction
SP
General illegal instruction
SP
Interrupt
SP
Address of instruction
after executed instruction 32 bits
SR
Illegal slot instruction
SP
Jump destination address
of delay branch instruction 32 bits
SR
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 70 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
32 bits
32 bits
5. Exception Processing
5.8
Usage Notes
5.8.1
Value of Stack Pointer (SP)
The value of the stack pointer must always be a multiple of four. If it is not, an address error will
occur when the stack is accessed during exception processing.
5.8.2
Value of Vector Base Register (VBR)
The value of the vector base register must always be a multiple of four. If it is not, an address error
will occur when the stack is accessed during exception processing.
5.8.3
Address Errors Caused by Stacking of Address Error Exception Processing
When the stack pointer is not a multiple of four, an address error will occur during stacking of the
exception processing (interrupts, etc.) and address error exception processing will start up as soon
as the first exception processing is ended. Address errors will then also occur in the stacking for
this address error exception processing. To ensure that address error exception processing does not
go into an endless loop, no address errors are accepted at that point. This allows program control
to be shifted to the address error exception service routine and enables error processing.
When an address error occurs during exception processing stacking, the stacking bus cycle (write)
is executed. During stacking of the status register (SR) and program counter (PC), the SP is −4 for
both, so the value of SP will not be a multiple of four after the stacking either. The address value
output during stacking is the SP value, so the address where the error occurred is itself output.
This means the write data stacked will be undefined.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 71 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5. Exception Processing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 72 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
Section 6 Interrupt Controller (INTC)
6.1
Overview
The interrupt controller (INTC) ascertains the priority of interrupt sources and controls interrupt
requests to the CPU. The INTC has registers for setting the priority of each interrupt which can be
used by the user to order the priorities in which the interrupt requests are processed.
6.1.1
Features
The INTC has the following features:
• 16 levels of interrupt priority: By setting the eight interrupt-priority level registers, the
priorities of IRQ interrupts and on-chip peripheral module interrupts can be set in 16 levels for
different request sources.
• NMI noise canceler function: NMI input level bits indicate the NMI pin status. By reading
these bits with the interrupt exception service routine, the pin status can be confirmed, enabling
it to be used as a noise canceler.
6.1.2
Block Diagram
Figure 6.1 is a block diagram of the INTC.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 73 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
NMI
IRQ0
IRQ1
IRQ2
IRQ3
IRQ6
IRQ7
Input
control
CPU
Priority
ranking
judgment
Comparator
Interrupt
request
SR
DMAC
MTU
CMT
SCI
A/D
WDT
BSC
I3 I2 I1 I0
(Interrupt request)
(Interrupt request)
(Interrupt request)
(Interrupt request)
(Interrupt request)
(Interrupt request)
(Interrupt request)
CPU
ICR
IPR
ISR
Bus
interface
Module bus
INTC
Legend:
DMAC: Direct memory access controller
MTU: Multifunction timer pulse unit
CMT: Compare match timer
Serial communication interface
SCI:
A/D converter
A/D:
WDT: Watchdog timer
BSC: Bus state controller (DRAM
Interrupt control register
ICR:
IRQ ststus register
ISR:
IPRA to IPRH: Interrupt priority
registers A to H
Status register
SR:
Figure 6.1 INTC Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 74 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Internal bus
IPRA to IPRH
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
6.1.3
Pin Configuration
Table 6.1 shows the INTC pin configuration.
Table 6.1
Pin Configuration
Name
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
Non-maskable interrupt input pin
NMI
I
Input of non-maskable interrupt
request signal
Interrupt request input pins
IRQ0 to IRQ3,
IRQ6, IRQ7
I
Input of maskable interrupt request
signals
6.1.4
Register Configuration
The INTC has the 10 registers shown in table 6.2. These registers set the priority of the interrupts
and control external interrupt input signal detection.
Table 6.2
Register Configuration
Name
Abbr.
R/W
Initial Value Address
Access Sizes
Interrupt priority register A
IPRA
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8348
8, 16, 32
Interrupt priority register B
IPRB
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF834A
8, 16, 32
Interrupt priority register C
IPRC
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF834C
8, 16, 32
Interrupt priority register D
IPRD
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF834E
8, 16, 32
Interrupt priority register E
IPRE
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8350
8, 16, 32
Interrupt priority register F
IPRF
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8352
8, 16, 32
Interrupt priority register G
IPRG
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8354
8, 16, 32
Interrupt priority register H
IPRH
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8356
8, 16, 32
H'FFFF8358
8, 16, 32
H'FFFF835A
8, 16, 32
Interrupt control register
IRQ status register
ICR
ISR
R/W
*
2
1
R(W)* H'0000
Notes: 1. The value when the NMI pin is high is H'8000; when the NMI pin is low, it is H'0000.
2. Only 0 can be written, in order to clear flags.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 75 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
6.2
Interrupt Sources
There are three types of interrupt sources: NMI, IRQ, and on-chip peripheral modules. Each
interrupt has a priority expressed as a priority level (0 to 16, with 0 the lowest and 16 the highest).
Giving an interrupt a priority level of 0 masks it.
6.2.1
NMI Interrupts
The NMI interrupt has priority 16 and is always accepted. Input at the NMI pin is detected by
edge. Use the NMI edge select bit (NMIE) in the interrupt control register (ICR) to select either
the rising or falling edge. NMI interrupt exception processing sets the interrupt mask level bits (I3
to I0) in the status register (SR) to level 15.
6.2.2
IRQ Interrupts
IRQ interrupts are requested by input from pins IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7. Set the IRQ sense
select bits (IRQ0S to IRQ3S, IRQ6S, IRQ7S) of the interrupt control register (ICR) to select low
level detection or falling edge detection for each pin. The priority level can be set from 0 to 15 for
each pin using the interrupt priority registers A and B (IPRA and IPRB).
When IRQ interrupts are set to low level detection, an interrupt request signal is sent to the INTC
during the period the IRQ pin is low level. Interrupt request signals are not sent to the INTC when
the IRQ pin becomes high level. Interrupt request levels can be confirmed by reading the IRQ
flags (IRQ0F to IRQ3F, IRQ6F, IRQ7F) of the IRQ status register (ISR).
When IRQ interrupts are set to falling edge detection, interrupt request signals are sent to the
INTC upon detecting a change on the IRQ pin from high to low level. IRQ interrupt request
detection results are maintained until the interrupt request is accepted. Confirmation that IRQ
interrupt requests have been detected is possible by reading the IRQ flags (IRQ0F to IRQ3F,
IRQ6F, IRQ7F) of the IRQ status register (ISR), and by writing a 0 after reading a 1, IRQ
interrupt request detection results can be withdrawn.
In IRQ interrupt exception processing, the interrupt mask bits (I3 to I0) of the status register (SR)
are set to the priority level value of the accepted IRQ interrupt.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 76 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
6.2.3
On-Chip Peripheral Module Interrupts
On-chip peripheral module interrupts are interrupts generated by the following on-chip peripheral
modules:
• Direct memory access controller (DMAC)
• Multifunction timer pulse unit (MTU)
• Compare match timer (CMT)
• Serial communication interface (SCI)
• A/D converter (A/D)
• Watchdog timer (WDT)
• Bus state controller (BSC)
A different interrupt vector is assigned to each interrupt source, so the exception service routine
does not have to decide which interrupt has occurred. Priority levels between 0 and 15 can be
assigned to individual on-chip peripheral modules in interrupt priority registers C to H (IPRC to
IPRH).
On-chip peripheral module interrupt exception processing sets the interrupt mask level bits (I3 to
I0) in the status register (SR) to the priority level value of the on-chip peripheral module interrupt
that was accepted.
6.2.4
Interrupt Exception Vectors and Priority Rankings
Table 6.3 lists interrupt sources and their vector numbers, vector table address offsets and interrupt
priorities.
Each interrupt source is allocated a different vector number and vector table address offset. Vector
table addresses are calculated from vector numbers and address offsets. In interrupt exception
processing, the exception service routine start address is fetched from the vector table indicated by
the vector table address. See table 5.4, Calculating Exception Processing Vector Table Addresses.
IRQ interrupts and on-chip peripheral module interrupt priorities can be set freely between 0 and
15 for each pin or module by setting interrupt priority registers A to H (IPRA to IPRH). The
ranking of interrupt sources for IPRC to IPRH, however, must be the order listed under Priority
Order Within IPR Setting Range in table 6.3 and cannot be changed. A power-on reset assigns
priority level 0 to IRQ interrupts and on-chip peripheral module interrupts. If the same priority
level is assigned to two or more interrupt sources and interrupts from those sources occur
simultaneously, their priority order is the default priority order indicated at the right in table 6.3.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 77 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
Table 6.3
Interrupt Exception Processing Vectors and Priorities
Interrupt Vector
Interrupt Source
Vector Table
Vector Address
No.
Offset
Interrupt
Priority
(Initial
Value)
Priority
within IPR
Default
Corresponding Setting
Range
Priority
IPR (Bits)
NMI
11
H'0000002C to
H'0000002F
16
⎯
⎯
IRQ0
64
H'00000100 to
H'00000103
0 to 15 (0)
IPRA
(15 to 12)
⎯
IRQ1
65
H'00000104 to
H'00000107
0 to 15 (0)
IPRA
(11 to 8)
⎯
IRQ2
66
H'00000108 to
H'0000010B
0 to 15 (0)
IPRA
(7 to 4)
⎯
IRQ3
67
H'0000010C to
H'0000010F
0 to 15 (0)
IPRA
(3 to 0)
⎯
IRQ6
70
H'00000118 to
H'0000011B
0 to 15 (0)
IPRB
(7 to 4)
⎯
IRQ7
71
H'0000011C to
H'0000011F
0 to 15 (0)
IPRB
(3 to 0)
⎯
DMAC0
DEI0
72
H'00000120 to
H'00000123
0 to 15 (0)
IPRC
(15 to 12)
⎯
DMAC1
DEI1
76
H'00000130 to
H'00000133
0 to 15 (0)
IPRC
(11 to 8)
⎯
MTU0
TGI0A
88
H'00000160 to
H'00000163
0 to 15 (0)
IPRD
(15 to 12)
High
TGI0B
89
H'00000164 to
H'00000167
0 to 15 (0)
TGI0C
90
H'00000168 to
H'0000016B
0 to 15 (0)
TGI0D
91
H'0000016C to
H'0000016F
0 to 15 (0)
TCI0V
92
H'00000170 to
H'00000173
0 to 15 (0)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 78 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
High
Low
IPRD
(11 to 8)
⎯
Low
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
Interrupt Vector
Interrupt Source
Vector Table
Vector Address
No.
Offset
Interrupt
Priority
(Initial
Value)
Priority
within IPR
Default
Corresponding Setting
Range
Priority
IPR (Bits)
MTU1
TGI1A
96
H'00000180 to
H'00000183
0 to 15 (0)
IPRD
(7 to 4)
TGI1B
97
H'00000184 to
H'00000187
0 to 15 (0)
TCI1V
100
H'00000190 to
H'00000193
0 to 15 (0)
TCI1U
101
H'00000194 to
H'00000197
0 to 15 (0)
TGI2A
104
H'000001A0 to
H'000001A3
0 to 15 (0)
TGI2B
105
H'000001A4 to
H'000001A7
0 to 15 (0)
TCI2V
108
H'000001B0 to
H'000001B3
0 to 15 (0)
TCI2U
109
H'000001B4 to
H'000001B7
0 to 15 (0)
ERI0
128
H'00000200 to
H'00000203
0 to 15 (0)
RXI0
129
H'00000204 to
H'00000207
0 to 15 (0)
TXI0
130
H'00000208 to
H'0000020B
0 to 15 (0)
TEI0
131
H'0000020C to
H'0000020F
0 to 15 (0)
ERI1
132
H'00000210 to
H'00000213
0 to 15 (0)
RXI1
133
H'00000214 to
H'00000217
0 to 15 (0)
TXI1
134
H'00000218 to
H'0000021B
0 to 15 (0)
TEI1
135
H'0000021C to
H'0000021F
0 to 15 (0)
MTU2
SCI0
SCI1
High
High
Low
IPRD
(3 to 0)
High
Low
IPRE
(15 to 12)
High
Low
IPRE
(11 to 8)
High
Low
IPRF
(7 to 4)
High
Low
IPRF
(3 to 0)
High
Low
Low
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 79 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
Interrupt Vector
Interrupt Source
Vector Table
Vector Address
No.
Offset
Interrupt
Priority
(Initial
Value)
Priority
within IPR
Default
Corresponding Setting
Range
Priority
IPR (Bits)
A/D*
136
H'00000220 to
H'00000223
0 to 15 (0)
IPRG
(15 to 12)
⎯
138
H'00000228 to
H'0000022B
ADI
CMT0
CMI0
144
H'00000240 to
H'00000243
0 to 15 (0)
IPRG
(7 to 4)
⎯
CMT1
CMI1
148
H'00000250 to
H'00000253
0 to 15 (0)
IPRG
(3 to 0)
⎯
WDT
ITI
152
H'00000260 to
H'00000263
0 to 15 (0)
IPRH
(15 to 12)
High
BSC
CMI
153
H'00000264 to
H'00000267
0 to 15 (0)
Note:
*
Vector No. 136 = SH7014 only
138 = SH7016, SH7017 only
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 80 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Low
High
Low
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
6.3
Description of Registers
6.3.1
Interrupt Priority Registers A to H (IPRA to IPRH)
Interrupt priority registers A to H (IPRA to IPRH) are 16-bit readable/writable registers that set
priority levels from 0 to 15 for IRQ interrupts and on-chip peripheral module interrupts.
Correspondence between interrupt request sources and each of the IPRA to IPRH bits is shown in
table 6.4.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Table 6.4
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Interrupt Request Sources and IPRA to IPRH
Bits
Register
15 to 12
11 to 8
7 to 4
3 to 0
Interrupt priority register A
IRQ0
IRQ1
IRQ2
IRQ3
Interrupt priority register B
Reserved
Reserved
IRQ6
IRQ7
Interrupt priority register C
DMAC0
DMAC1
Reserved
Reserved
Interrupt priority register D
MTU0
MTU0
MTU1
MTU1
Interrupt priority register E
MTU2
MTU2
Reserved
Reserved
Interrupt priority register F
Reserved
Reserved
SCI0
SCI1
Interrupt priority register G
A/D
Reserved
CMT0
CMT1
Interrupt priority register H
WDT, BSC
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 81 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
As indicated in table 6.4, four IRQ pins or groups of 4 on-chip peripheral modules are allocated to
each register. Each of the corresponding interrupt priority ranks are established by setting a value
from H'0 (0000) to H'F (1111) in each of the four-bit groups 15 to 12, 11 to 8, 7 to 4 and 3 to 0.
Interrupt priority rank becomes level 0 (lowest) by setting H'0, and level 15 (highest) by setting
H'F. If multiple on-chip peripheral modules are assigned to WDT and BSC, those multiple
modules are set to the same priority rank.
IPRA to IPRH are initialized to H'0000 by a power-on reset. They are not initialized in standby
mode.
6.3.2
Interrupt Control Register (ICR)
The ICR is a 16-bit register that sets the input signal detection mode of the external interrupt input
pin NMI and IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7 and indicates the input signal level to the NMI pin. It is
initialized by power-on reset, but is not initialized by standby mode.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
NMIL
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
NMIE
Initial value:
*
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
*
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IRQ0S
IRQ1S
IRQ2S
IRQ3S
⎯
⎯
IRQ6S
IRQ7S
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
When NMI input is high: 1; when NMI input is low: 0
Bit 15⎯NMI Input Level (NMIL): Sets the level of the signal input at the NMI pin. This bit can
be read to determine the NMI pin level. This bit cannot be modified.
Bit 15
NMIL
Description
0
NMI input level is low
1
NMI input level is high
Bits 14 to 9, 3, 2⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 82 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
Bit 8⎯NMI Edge Select (NMIE)
Bit 8
NMIE
Description
0
Interrupt request is detected on falling edge of NMI input
1
Interrupt request is detected on rising edge of NMI input
(initial value)
Bits 7 to 4, 1, 0⎯IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7 Sense Select (IRQ0S to IRQ3S, IRQ6S,
IRQ7S): These bits set the IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7 interrupt request detection mode.
Bits 7 to 4, 1, 0
IRQ0S to IRQ3S, IRQ6S,
IRQ7S
Description
0
Interrupt request is detected on low level of IRQ input
1
Interrupt request is detected on falling edge of IRQ input
6.3.3
(initial value)
IRQ Status Register (ISR)
The ISR is a 16-bit register that indicates the interrupt request status of the external interrupt input
pins IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7. When IRQ interrupts are set to edge detection, held interrupt
requests can be withdrawn by writing a 0 to IRQnF after reading an IRQnF = 1.
A power-on reset initializes ISR but the standby mode does not.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IRQ0F
IRQ1F
IRQ2F
IRQ3F
⎯
⎯
IRQ6F
IRQ7F
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
Initial value:
R/W:
Bits 15 to 8, 3, 2⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 83 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
Bits 7 to 4, 1, 0⎯IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7 Flags (IRQ0F to IRQ3F, IRQ6F, IRQ7F):
These bits display the IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7 interrupt request status.
Bits 7 to 4, 1, 0
IRQ0F to IRQ3F,
Detection Setting
IRQ6F, IRQ7F
Description
0
No IRQn interrupt request exists.
Level detection
Clear conditions: When IRQn input is high level
Edge detection
No IRQn interrupt request was detected.
(initial value)
Clear conditions:
1. When a 0 is written after reading IRQnF = 1 status
2. When IRQn interrupt exception processing has been
executed
1
Level detection
An IRQn interrupt request exists.
Set conditions: When IRQn input is low level
Edge detection
An IRQn interrupt request was detected.
Set conditions: When a falling edge occurs at an IRQn input
ISR.IRQnF
IRQnS
(0: level,
1: edge)
IRQ pin
Level
detection
Edge
detection
RESIRQn
Selection
CPU
interrupt
request
S Q
R
(IRQn interrupt acceptance/IRQnF = 0 write after IRQnF = 1 read)
Figure 6.2 External Interrupt Process
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 84 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
6.4
Interrupt Operation
6.4.1
Interrupt Sequence
The sequence of interrupt operations is explained below. Figure 6.3 is a flowchart of the
operations.
1. The interrupt request sources send interrupt request signals to the interrupt controller.
2. The interrupt controller selects the highest priority interrupt in the interrupt requests sent,
following the priority levels set in interrupt priority level setting registers A to H (IPRA to
IPRH). Lower-priority interrupts are ignored. They are held pending until interrupt requests
designated as edge-detect type are accepted. For IRQ interrupts, however, withdrawal is
possible by accessing the IRQ status register (ISR). See section 6.2.2, IRQ Interrupts, for
details. Interrupts held pending due to edge detection are cleared by a power-on reset. If two of
these interrupts have the same priority level or if multiple interrupts occur within a single
module, the interrupt with the highest default priority or the highest priority within its IPR
setting range (as indicated in table 6.3) is selected.
3. The interrupt controller compares the priority level of the selected interrupt request with the
interrupt mask bits (I3 to I0) in the CPU's status register (SR). If the request priority level is
equal to or less than the level set in I3 to I0, the request is ignored. If the request priority level
is higher than the level in bits I3 to I0, the interrupt controller accepts the interrupt and sends
an interrupt request signal to the CPU.
4. The CPU detects the interrupt request sent from the interrupt controller when it decodes the
next instruction to be executed. Instead of executing the decoded instruction, the CPU starts
interrupt exception processing (figure 6.4).
5. SR and PC are saved onto the stack.
6. The priority level of the accepted interrupt is copied to the interrupt mask level bits (I3 to I0) in
the status register (SR).
7. The CPU reads the start address of the exception service routine from the exception vector
table for the accepted interrupt, jumps to that address, and starts executing the program there.
This jump is not a delay branch.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 85 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
Program
execution state
Interrupt?
No
Yes
NMI?
No
Yes
Level 15
interrupt?
No
Save SR to stack
Yes
Save PC to stack
Yes
Copy accept-interrupt
level to I3 to I0
I3 to I0 ≤
level 14?
No
Reads exception
vector table
Yes
Level 14
interrupt?
Yes
Level 1
interrupt?
I3 to I0 ≤
level 13?
Yes
No
Yes
Branches to exception
service routine
Legend:
I3 to I0: Interrupt mask bits of status register
Figure 6.3 Interrupt Sequence Flowchart
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 86 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
No
I3 to I0 =
level 0?
No
No
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
6.4.2
Stack after Interrupt Exception Processing
Figure 6.4 shows the stack after interrupt exception processing.
Address
4n–8
PC*1
32 bits
4n–4
SR
32 bits
SP*2
4n
Notes: 1.
2.
PC: Start address of the next instruction (return destination instruction)
after the executing instruction
Always be certain that SP is a multiple of 4
Figure 6.4 Stack after Interrupt Exception Processing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 87 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
6.5
Interrupt Response Time
Table 6.5 indicates the interrupt response time, which is the time from the occurrence of an
interrupt request until the interrupt exception processing starts and fetching of the first instruction
of the interrupt service routine begins. Figure 6.5 shows the pipeline when an IRQ interrupt is
accepted.
Table 6.5
Interrupt Response Time
Number of States
Item
NMI, Peripheral
Module
IRQ
Notes
DMAC active judgment
0 or 1
1
1 state required for interrupt
signals for which DMAC
activation is possible
Compare identified interrupt priority with SR mask
level
2
3
Wait for completion of
sequence currently being
executed by CPU
X (≥ 0)
The longest sequence is for
interrupt or address-error
exception processing (X = 4
+ m1 + m2 + m3 + m4). If an
interrupt-masking instruction
follows, however, the time
may be even longer.
Time from start of interrupt
exception processing until
fetch of first instruction of
exception service routine
starts
Interrupt
Total:
response
Minimum:
time
Maximum:
5 + m1 + m2 + m3
Performs the PC and SR
saves and vector address
fetch.
7 + m1 + m2 + m3
9 + m1 + m2 + m3
10
12
0.35 to 0.42 μs at 28.7 MHz
12 + 2 (m1 + m2 +
m3) + m4
13 + 2 (m1 + m2 +
m3) + m4
0.67 to 0.70 μs at 28.7
MHz*
Note: When m1 = m2 = m3 = m4 = 1
m1 to m4 are the number of states needed for the following memory accesses.
m1: SR save (longword write)
m2: PC save (longword write)
m3: Vector address read (longword read)
m4: Fetch first instruction of interrupt service routine
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 88 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
Interrupt acceptance
1
5 + m1 + m2 + m3
3
m1 m2 1 m3 1
3
IRQ
Instruction (instruction
replaced by interrupt
exception processing)
Overrun fetch
F D E E M M E M E E
F
Interrupt service routine
start instruction
F D E
Legend:
F: Instruction fetch (instruction fetched from memory where program is stored).
D: Instruction decoding (fetched instruction is decoded).
E: Instruction execution (data operation and address calculation is performed
according to the results of decoding).
M: Memory access (data in memory is accessed).
Figure 6.5 Pipeline when an IRQ Interrupt is Accepted
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 89 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
6. Interrupt Controller (INTC)
6.6
Data Transfer with Interrupt Request Signals
The following data transfers can be done using interrupt request signals:
• Activate DMAC only, without generating CPU interrupt
Among interrupt sources, those designated as DMAC activating sources are masked and not input
to the INTC. The masking condition is listed below:
Mask condition = DME × (DE0 × source selection 0 + DE1)
Figure 6.6 shows a control block diagram.
Interrupt source
Interrupt source
flag clear
(by DMAC)
DMAC
Interrupt source
(those not designated as DMAC activating sources)
CPU interrupt request
Figure 6.6 Interrupt Control Block Diagram
6.6.1
Handling DMAC Activating Sources but Not CPU Interrupt Sources
1. Select the DMAC as a source and set the DME bit to 1. CPU interrupt sources and DTC
activating sources are masked regardless of the interrupt priority level register settings or DTC
register settings.
2. Activating sources are applied to the DMAC when interrupts occur.
3. The DMAC clears activating sources at the time of data transfer.
6.6.2
Treating CPU Interrupt Sources but Not DMAC Activating Sources
1. Either do not select the DMAC as a source, or clear the DME bit to 0.
2. When interrupts occur, interrupt requests are sent to the CPU.
3. The CPU clears the interrupt source and performs the necessary processing in the interrupt
processing routine.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 90 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
Section 7 Cache Memory (CAC)
7.1
Overview
The LSI has an on-chip cache memory (CAC: CAChe) with 1 kbyte of cache data and a 256-entry
cache tag. The cache data and cache tag space can be used as on-chip RAM space when the cache
is not being used.
7.1.1
Features
The CAC has the following features. The cache tag and cache data configuration is shown in
figure 7.1.
• 1-kbyte capacity
• External memory (CS space and DRAM space) instruction code and PC relative data caching
• 256 entry cache tag (tag address 15 bits)
• 4-byte line length
• Direct map replacement algorithm
• Valid flag (1 bit) included for purges
15
CPU
address
8
2
Tag
Entry
Offset
address address
Valid bit (1 bit)
Cache tag
Tag address (15 bits)
Cache data
Data (32 bits)
256 entries
CMP
Data bus
Hit signal
Figure 7.1 Cache Tag and Cache Data Configuration
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 91 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
7.1.2
Block Diagram
Figure 7.2 shows a block diagram of the cache.
CCR
Cache tag
Cache
controller
Cache data
Internal data bus
Internal address bus
Cache
External bus
interface
Legend:
CCR: Cache control register
Figure 7.2 Cache Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 92 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Bus state
controller
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
7.1.3
Register Configuration
The cache has one register, which can be used to control the enabling or disabling of each cache
space. The register configuration is shown in table 7.1.
Table 7.1
Register Configuration
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial
Value
Address
Access Size
(Bits)
Cache control register
CCR
R/W
H'0000*
H'FFFF8740
8, 16, 32
Note:
*
Bits 15 to 5 are undefined.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 93 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
7.2
Register Explanation
7.2.1
Cache Control Register (CCR)
The cache control register (CCR) selects the cache enable/disable of each space.
The CCR is a 16-bit readable/writable register. It is initialized to H'0000 by power on resets, but is
not initialized by standby mode.
Bit:
Note:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
CE
DRAM
CE
CS3
CE
CS2
CE
CS1
CE
CS0
Initial value:
*
*
*
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
*
Bits 15 to 5 are undefined.
Bits 15 to 5⎯Reserved: Reading these bits gives undefined values. The write value should
always be 0.
Bit 4⎯DRAM Space Cache Enable (CEDRAM): Selects whether to use DRAM space as a
cache object (enable) or to exclude it (disable). A 0 disables, and a 1 enables such use.
Bit 4
CEDRAM
Description
0
DRAM space cache disabled
1
DRAM space cache enabled
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 94 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
Bit 3⎯CS3 Space Cache Enable (CECS3): Selects whether to use CS3 space as a cache object
(enable) or to exclude it (disable). A 0 disables, and a 1 enables such use.
Bit 3
CECS3
Description
0
CS3 space cache disabled
1
CS3 space cache enabled
(initial value)
Bit 2⎯CS2 Space Cache Enable (CECS2): Selects whether to use CS2 space as a cache object
(enable) or to exclude it (disable). A 0 disables, and a 1 enables such use.
Bit 2
CECS2
Description
0
CS2 space cache disabled
1
CS2 space cache enabled
(initial value)
Bit 1⎯CS1 Space Cache Enable (CECS1): Selects whether to use CS1 space as a cache object
(enable) or to exclude it (disable). A 0 disables, and a 1 enables such use.
Bit 1
CECS1
Description
0
CS1 space cache disabled
1
CS1 space cache enabled
(initial value)
Bit 0⎯CS0 Space Cache Enable (CECS0): Selects whether to use CS0 space as a cache object
(enable) or to exclude it (disable). A 0 disables, and a 1 enables such use.
Bit 0
CECS0
Description
0
CS0 space cache disabled
1
CS0 space cache enabled
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 95 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
7.3
Address Array and Data Array
There is a special cache space for controlling the cache. This space is divided into an address array
and a data array, where addresses (tag address, including valid bit) and data (4-byte line length) for
cache control are recorded. The special cache space is shown in table 7.2. It can be used as on-chip
RAM space when the cache is not being used.
Table 7.2
Special Cache Space
Space Classification
Address
Size
Bus Width
Address array
H'FFFFF000 to H'FFFFF3FF
1 kbyte
32 bits
Data array
H'FFFFF400 to H'FFFFF7FF
1 kbyte
32 bits
7.3.1
Cache Address Array Read/Write Space
The cache address array has a compulsory read/write (figure 7.3).
31
Address
10 9
Upper 22 bits of the address array space address
(22 bits)
31
Data
26 25 24
⎯
(6 bits)
2 1
Entry address
(8 bits)
⎯
(2 bits)
10 9
Tag address
(15 bits)
0
0
⎯
(10 bits)
Valid bit (1 bit)
Figure 7.3 Cache Address Array
Address Array Read: Designates entry address and reads out the corresponding tag address
value/valid bit value.
Address Array Write: Designates entry address and writes the designated tag address value/valid
bit value.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 96 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
7.3.2
Cache Data Array Read/Write Space
The cache data array has a compulsory read/write (figure 7.4).
31
10 9
Upper 22 bits of the data array space address
(22 bits)
Address
2 1
Entry address
(8 bits)
⎯
(2 bits)
31
Data
0
0
Data
(32 bits)
Figure 7.4 Cache Data Array
Data Array Read: Designates entry address and reads out the corresponding line of data.
Data Array Write: Designates entry address and writes designated data to the corresponding line.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 97 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
7.4
Usage Notes
7.4.1
Cache Initialization
Always initialize the cache before enabling it. Specifically, use an address array write to write 0 to
all valid bits for all entries (256 times), that is,those in the address range H'FFFFF000 to
H'FFFFF3FFF.
7.4.2
Forced Access to Address Array and Data Array
While the cache is enabled, it is not possible to write to the address array or data array via the
CPU, or DMAC, and a read will return an undefined value. The cache must be disabled before
making a forced access to the address array or data array.
7.4.3
Cache Miss Penalty and Cache Fill Timing
When a cache miss occurs, a single idle cycle is generated as a penalty immediately before the
cache fill (access from external memory in the event of a cache miss), as shown in figure 7.5.
However, in the case of consecutive cache misses, idle cycles are not generated for the second and
subsequent cache misses, as shown in figure 7.6.
As the timing for a cache fill from normal space, the CS assert period immediately before the end
of the bus cycle (or the last bus cycle when two or four bus cycles are generated, such as in a word
access to 8-bit space) is extended by an additional cycle, as shown in figures 7.5 and 7.6.
Similarly, as the timing for a cache fill from DRAM space, the RAS assert period immediately
before the end of the bus cycle is extended by an additional cycle as shown in figure 7.7. In RAS
down mode, the next bus cycle is delayed by one cycle as shown in figure 7.8.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 98 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
CK
Internal
address
Mis-hit
Address
Idle cycle
CSn
Idle cycle
RD
CS assert extension
Idle cycle
Data
Figure 7.5 Cache Fill Timing in Case of Non-Consecutive Cache Miss from Normal Space
(No Wait, No CS Assert Extension)
CK
Internal
address
Miss-hit
Address
CSn
CS assert additional extension
RD
Data
Figure 7.6 Cache Fill Timing in Case of Consecutive Cache Misses from Normal Space
(No Wait, CS Assert Extension)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 99 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
7. Cache Memory (CAC)
CK
Internal
address
Miss-hit
Idle cycle
Address
ROW
RAS
COLUMN
Idle cycle
RAS assert extension
CASx
Idle cycle
Data
Figure 7.7 Cache Fill Timing in Case of Non-Consecutive Cache Miss from DRAM Space
(Normal Mode, TPC = 0, RCD = 0, No Wait)
CS space
access
DRAM access
DRAM access
CK
Internal
address
Address
Miss-hit
Miss-hit
ROW
COLUMN
RAS
Wait
CS space
COLUMN
RAS assert extension
CASx
Data
Figure 7.8 Cache Fill Timing in Case of Consecutive Cache Misses from DRAM Space
(RAS Down Mode, TPC = 0, RCD = 0, No Wait)
7.4.4
Cache Hit after Cache Miss
The first cache hit after a cache miss is regarded as a cache miss, and a cache fill without idle
cycle generation is performed. The next hit operates as a cache hit.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 100 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Section 8 Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.1
Overview
The bus state controller (BSC) divides up the address spaces and outputs control for various types
of memory. This enables memories like DRAM, SRAM, and ROM to be linked directly to the LSI
without external circuitry.
8.1.1
Features
The BSC has the following features:
• Address space is divided into five spaces
⎯ A maximum linear 2 Mbytes for CS0 address space in modes with on-chip ROM enabled,
and a maximum linear 4 Mbytes in modes with on-chip ROM disabled
⎯ A maximum linear 4 Mbytes for each of address spaces CS1, CS2, and CS3
⎯ A maximum linear 16 Mbytes for DRAM dedicated space
⎯ Bus width can be selected for each space (8 or 16 bits)
⎯ Wait states can be inserted by software for each space
⎯ Wait states can be inserted via the WAIT pin in external memory space accesses
⎯ Outputs control signals for each space according to the type of memory connected
• On-chip ROM/RAM interfaces
⎯ On-chip RAM access of 32 bits in 1 state
⎯ On-chip ROM access of 32 bits in 1 state
• Direct interface to DRAM
⎯ Multiplexes row/column addresses according to DRAM capacity
⎯ Supports high-speed page mode and RAS down mode
• Access control for each type of memory, peripheral LSI
⎯ Address/data multiplex function
• Refresh
⎯ Supports CAS-before-RAS refresh (auto-refresh) and self-refresh
• Refresh counter can be used as an interval timer
⎯ Interrupt request generated upon compare match (CMI interrupt request signal)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 101 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.1.2
Block Diagram
Bus
interface
CS0 to CS3
AH
Wait
control
unit
WCR1
Area
control
unit
BCR1
WCR2
BCR2
RD
DCR
RDWR
RTCSR
WRH, WRL
Memory
control
unit
CASH, CASL
RAS
RTCNT
CMI interrupt request
Comparator
Peripheral bus
Interrupt
controller
Module bus
WAIT
RTCOR
BSC
Legend:
WCR1: Wait control register 1
WCR2: Wait control register 2
BCR1: Bus control register 1
BCR2: Bus control register 2
DCR:
RTCNT:
RTCOR:
RTCSR:
DRAM area control register
Refresh timer counter
Refresh timer constant register
Refresh timer control/status register
Figure 8.1 BSC Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 102 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Internal bus
Figure 8.1 shows the BSC block diagram.
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.1.3
Pin Configuration
Table 8.1 shows the bus state controller pin configuration.
Table 8.1
Pin Configuration
Signal
I/O
Description
A21 to A0
O
Address output (A21 to A18 become input ports in power-on reset)
D15 to D0
I/O
16-bit data bus. D15-D0 are address output and data I/O during
address/data multiplex I/O.
CS0 to CS3
O
Chip select
RD
O
Strobe that indicates the read cycle for ordinary space/multiplex I/O. Also
output during DRAM access.
WRH
O
Strobe that indicates a write cycle to the higher byte (D15 to D8) for
ordinary space/multiplex I/O. Also output during DRAM access.
WRL
O
Strobe that indicates a write cycle to the lower byte (D7 to D0) for ordinary
space/multiplex I/O. Also output during DRAM access.
RDWR
O
Strobe indicating a write cycle to DRAM (used for DRAM space)
RAS
O
RAS signal for DRAM (used for DRAM space)
CASH
O
CAS signal when accessing the higher byte (D15 to D8) of DRAM (used
for DRAM space)
CASL
O
CAS signal when accessing the lower byte (D7 to D0) of DRAM (used for
DRAM space)
AH
O
Signal to hold the address during address/data multiplex
WAIT
I
Wait state request signal
8.1.4
Register Configuration
The BSC has eight registers. These registers are used to control wait states, bus width, and
interfaces with memories like DRAM, SRAM, and ROM, as well as refresh control. The register
configurations are listed in table 8.2.
All registers are 16 bits. Do not access DRAM space before completing the memory interface
settings. All BSC registers are all initialized by a power-on reset. Values are maintained in standby
mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 103 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Table 8.2
Register Configuration
Name
Abbr.
R/W
Initial Value Address
Bus control register 1
BCR1
R/W
H'200F
H'FFFF8620 8, 16, 32
Bus control register 2
BCR2
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF8622 8, 16, 32
Wait state control register 1
WCR1
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF8624 8, 16, 32
Wait state control register 2
WCR2
R/W
H'000F
H'FFFF8626 8, 16, 32
DRAM area control register
DCR
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF862A 8, 16, 32
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF862C 8, 16, 32
Refresh timer control/status register RTCSR
Access Size
Refresh timer counter
RTCNT
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF862E 8, 16, 32
Refresh time constant register
RTCOR
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8630 8, 16, 32
8.1.5
Address Map
Figure 8.2 shows the address format used by the SH7014.
A31 to A24
A23, A22
A0
A21
Output address:
Output from the address pins
CS space selection:
Decoded, outputs CS0 to CS3 when A31 to A24 = 00000000
Space selection:
Not output externally; used to select the type of space
On-chip ROM space or CS space when 00000000 (H'00)
DRAM space when 00000001 (H'01)
Reserved (do not access) when 00000010 to 11111110 (H'02 to H'FE)
On-chip peripheral module space or on-chip RAM space when 11111111 (H'FF)
Figure 8.2 Address Format
This LSI uses 32-bit addresses:
• A31 to A24 are used to select the type of space and are not output externally.
• Bits A23 and A22 are decoded and output as chip select signals (CS0 to CS3) for the
corresponding areas when bits A31 to A24 are 00000000.
• A21 to A0 are output externally.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 104 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Table 8.3 shows an address map.
Table 8.3
Address Map
• In on-chip ROM enabled mode*
Address
5
Space
Memory
Size
4
H'00000000 to H'0001FFFF* On-chip ROM On-chip ROM
Bus Width
128 kbytes 32 bits
H'00020000 to H'001FFFFF
Reserved
H'00200000 to H'003FFFFF
CS0 space
Ordinary space
2 Mbytes
8/16 bits*
1
H'00400000 to H'007FFFFF
CS1 space
Ordinary space
4 Mbytes
8/16 bits*
1
H'00800000 to H'00BFFFFF
CS2 space
Ordinary space
4 Mbytes
8/16 bits*
1
H'00C00000 to H'00FFFFFF
CS3 space
Ordinary space or multiplex 4 Mbytes
I/O space
8/16 bits*
2
H'01000000 to H'01FFFFFF
DRAM space
DRAM
16 Mbytes 8/16 bits*
1
H'02000000 to H'FFFF7FFF
Reserved
On-chip peripheral module
2 kbytes
8/16 bits
4 kbytes
32 bits
H'FFFF8000 to H'FFFF87FF On-chip
peripheral
module
H'FFFF8800 to H'FFFFEFFF Reserved
6
H'FFFFF000 to H'FFFFFFFF* On-chip RAM On-chip RAM
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 105 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
• In on-chip ROM disabled mode
Address
Space
Memory
Size
Bus Width
H'00000000 to H'003FFFFF
CS0 space
Ordinary space
4 Mbytes
8/16 bits*
3
H'00400000 to H'007FFFFF
CS1 space
Ordinary space
4 Mbytes
8/16 bits*
1
H'00800000 to H'00BFFFFF
CS2 space
Ordinary space
4 Mbytes
8/16 bits*
1
H'00C00000 to H'00FFFFFF
CS3 space
Ordinary space or multiplex 4 Mbytes
I/O space
8/16 bits*
2
H'01000000 to H'01FFFFFF
DRAM space
DRAM
16 Mbytes 8/16 bits*
1
H'02000000 to H'FFFF7FFF
Reserved
On-chip peripheral module
2 kbytes
8/16 bits
4 kbytes
32 bits
H'FFFF8000 to H'FFFF87FF On-chip
peripheral
module
H'FFFF8800 to H'FFFFEFFF Reserved
6
H'FFFFF000 to H'FFFFFFFF* On-chip RAM On-chip RAM
Notes: Do not access reserved space, as operation cannot be guaranteed in this case.
In single-chip mode, space other than on-chip ROM, on-chip RAM, and on-chip peripheral
module space cannot be used.
1. Selected by on-chip register settings.
2. Ordinary space: selected by on-chip register settings.
Multiplex I/O space: 8/16 bits selected by the A14 bit.
3. 8/16 bits selected by the mode pin.
4. In the 64-kbyte on-chip ROM version (SH7016), on-chip ROM addresses are
H'00000000 to H'0000FFFF, and addresses H'00010000 to H'0001FFFF are reserved
space.
5. SH7016/17 only.
6. In the 3-kbyte on-chip RAM versions (SH7014/16), on-chip RAM addresses are
H'FFFFF000 to H'FFFFFBFF, and addresses H'FFFFFC00 to H'FFFFFFFF are
reserved space.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 106 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.2
Description of Registers
8.2.1
Bus Control Register 1 (BCR1)
BCR1 is a 16-bit read/write register that selects multiplex I/O, and specifies the bus size of the CS
spaces.
Write bits 8 to 0 of BCR1 during the initialization stage after a power-on reset, and do not change
the values thereafter. In on-chip ROM ineffective mode, do not access any CS space other than
CS0 until after completion of register initialization.
BCR1 is initialized by power-on resets to H'200F, but is not initialized by software standbys.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
IOE
Initial value:
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
A3SZ
A2SZ
A1SZ
A0SZ
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: Do not write 1 to bits 4 to 7, as operation is not guaranteed in this case.
Bits 15, 14, 12 to 9⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 13⎯Reserved: This bit always read as 1. The write value should always be 1.
Bit 8⎯Multiplex I/O Enable (IOE): Selects the use of CS3 space as ordinary space or
address/data multiplex I/O space. A 0 selects ordinary space and a 1 selects address/data multiplex
I/O space. When address/data multiplex I/O space is selected, the address and data are multiplexed
and output from the data bus. When CS3 space is an address/data multiplex I/O space, bus size is
decided by the A14 bit (A14 = 0: 8 bit, A14 = 1: 16 bit).
Bit 8
IOE
Description
0
CS3 space is ordinary space
1
CS3 space is address/data multiplex I/O space
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 107 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bits 7 to 4⎯Reserved: These bits read 0 after a reset. The write value should always be 0.
Operation is not guaranteed if the write value is 1.
Bit 3⎯CS3 Space Size Specification (A3SZ): Specifies the CS3 space bus size. This is effective
only when CS3 space is ordinary space. When CS3 space is an address/data multiplex I/O space,
bus size is decided by the A14 bit.
Bit 3
A3SZ
Description
0
Byte (8-bit) size
1
Word (16-bit) size
(initial value)
Bit 2⎯CS2 Space Size Specification (A2SZ): Specifies the CS2 space bus size.
Bit 2
A2SZ
Description
0
Byte (8-bit) size
1
Word (16-bit) size
(initial value)
Bit 1⎯CS1 Space Size Specification (A1SZ): Specifies the CS1 space bus size.
Bit 1
A1SZ
Description
0
Byte (8-bit) size
1
Word (16-bit) size
(initial value)
Bit 0⎯CS0 Space Size Specification (A0SZ): Specifies the CS0 space bus size.
Bit 0
A0SZ
Description
0
Byte (8-bit) size
1
Word (16-bit) size
(initial value)
Note: A0SZ is effective only in on-chip ROM effective mode. In on-chip ROM ineffective mode,
the CS0 space bus size is specified by the mode pin.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 108 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.2.2
Bus Control Register 2 (BCR2)
BCR2 is a 16-bit read/write register that specifies the number of idle cycles and CS signal assert
extension of each CS space.
BCR2 is initialized by power-on resets to H'FFFF, but is not initialized by software standbys.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
IW31
IW30
IW21
IW20
IW11
IW10
IW01
IW00
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CW3
CW2
CW1
CW0
SW3
SW2
SW1
SW0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bits 15 to 8⎯Idles between Cycles (IW31, IW30, IW21, IW20, IW11, IW10, IW01, IW00):
These bits specify idle cycles inserted between consecutive accesses when the second one is to a
different CS area after a read. Idles are used to prevent data conflict between ROM (and other
memories, which are slow to turn the read data buffer off), fast memories, and I/O interfaces. Even
when access is to the same area, idle cycles must be inserted when a read access is followed
immediately by a write access. The idle cycles to be inserted comply with the area specification of
the previous access. Refer to section 8.6, Waits between Access Cycles, for details.
IW31, IW30 specify the idle between cycles for CS3 space; IW21, IW20 specify the idle between
cycles for CS2 space; IW11, IW10 specify the idle between cycles for CS1 space and IW01, IW00
specify the idle between cycles for CS0 space.
Bit 15
IW31
Bit 14
IW30
Description
0
0
No idle cycle after accessing CS3 space
1
Inserts one idle cycle
0
Inserts two idle cycles
1
Inserts three idle cycles
1
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 109 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bit 13
IW21
Bit 12
IW20
Description
0
0
No idle cycle after accessing CS2 space
1
Inserts one idle cycle
0
Inserts two idle cycles
1
Inserts three idle cycles
Bit 11
IW11
Bit 10
IW10
Description
0
0
No idle cycle after accessing CS1 space
1
Inserts one idle cycle
0
Inserts two idle cycles
1
Inserts three idle cycles
Bit 9
IW01
Bit 8
IW00
Description
0
0
No idle cycle after accessing CS0 space
1
Inserts one idle cycle
0
Inserts two idle cycles
1
Inserts three idle cycles
1
1
1
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Bits 7 to 4⎯Idle Specification for Continuous Access (CW3, CW2, CW1, CW0): The
continuous access idle specification makes insertions to clearly delineate the bus intervals by once
negating the CSn signal when doing consecutive accesses of the same CS space. When a write
immediately follows a read, the number of idle cycles inserted is the larger of the two values
specified by IW and CW. Refer to section 8.6, Waits between Access Cycles, for details.
CW3 specifies the continuous access idles for CS3 space; CW2 specifies the continuous access
idles for CS2 space; CW1 specifies the continuous access idles for CS1 space and CW0 specifies
the continuous access idles for CS0 space.
Bit 7
CW3
Description
0
No CS3 space continuous access idle cycles
1
One CS3 space continuous access idle cycle
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 110 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bit 6
CW2
Description
0
No CS2 space continuous access idle cycles
1
One CS2 space continuous access idle cycle
Bit 5
CW1
Description
0
No CS1 space continuous access idle cycles
1
One CS1 space continuous access idle cycle
Bit 4
CW0
Description
0
No CS0 space continuous access idle cycles
1
One CS0 space continuous access idle cycle
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Bits 3 to 0⎯CS Assert Extension Specification (SW3, SW2, SW1, SW0): The CS assert cycle
extension specification is for making insertions to prevent extension of the RD signal or WRx
signal assert period beyond the length of the CSn signal assert period. Extended cycles insert one
cycle before and after each bus cycle, which simplifies interfaces with external devices and also
has the effect of extending write data hold time. Refer to section 8.3.3, CS Assert Extension
Function, for details.
SW3 specifies the CS assert extension for CS3 space access; SW2 specifies the CS assert
extension for CS2 space access; SW1 specifies the CS assert extension for CS1 space access and
SW0 specifies the CS assert extension for CS0 space access.
Bit 3
SW3
Description
0
No CS3 space CS assert extension
1
CS3 space CS assert extension
Bit 2
SW2
Description
0
No CS2 space CS assert extension
1
CS2 space CS assert extension
(initial value)
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 111 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bit 1
SW1
Description
0
No CS1 space CS assert extension
1
CS1 space CS assert extension
Bit 0
SW0
Description
0
No CS0 space CS assert extension
1
CS0 space CS assert extension
8.2.3
(initial value)
(initial value)
Wait Control Register 1 (WCR1)
WCR1 is a 16-bit read/write register that specifies the number of wait cycles (0 to 15) for each CS
space.
WCR1 is initialized by power-on resets to H'FFFF, but is not initialized by software standbys.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
W33
W32
W31
W30
W23
W22
W21
W20
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
W13
W12
W11
W10
W03
W02
W01
W00
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bits 15 to 12⎯CS3 Space Wait Specification (W33, W32, W31, W30): Specifies the number of
waits for CS3 space access.
Bit 15
W33
Bit 14
W32
Bit 13
W31
Bit 12
W30
Description
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait external wait input enabled
1
1
15 wait external wait input enabled
⋅⋅⋅
1
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 112 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bits 11 to 8⎯CS2 Space Wait Specification (W23, W22, W21, W20): Specifies the number of
waits for CS2 space access.
Bit 11
W23
Bit 10
W22
Bit 9
W21
Bit 8
W20
Description
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait external wait input enabled
1
1
1
1
15 wait external wait input enabled
⋅⋅⋅
(initial value)
Bits 7 to 4⎯CS1 Space Wait Specification (W13, W12, W11, W10): Specifies the number of
waits for CS1 space access.
Bit 7
W13
Bit 6
W12
Bit 5
W11
Bit 4
W10
Description
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait external wait input enabled
1
1
15 wait external wait input enabled
⋅⋅⋅
1
1
(initial value)
Bits 3 to 0⎯CS0 Space Wait Specification (W03, W02, W01, W00): Specifies the number of
waits for CS0 space access.
Bit 3
W03
Bit 2
W02
Bit 1
W01
Bit 0
W00
Description
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait external wait input enabled
1
1
15 wait external wait input enabled
⋅⋅⋅
1
1
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 113 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.2.4
Wait Control Register 2 (WCR2)
WCR2 is a 16-bit read/write register that specifies the number of access cycles for DRAM space
and CS space for DMA single address mode transfers.
Do not perform any DMA single address transfers before WCR2 is set.
WCR2 is initialized by power-on resets to H'000F, but is not initialized by software standbys.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
DDW1
DDW0
DSW3
DSW2
DSW1
DSW0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
R/W:
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bits 15 to 6⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bits 5 and 4⎯DRAM Space DMA Single Address Mode Access Wait Specification (DDW1,
DDW0): Specifies the number of waits for DRAM space access during DMA single address mode
accesses. These bits are independent of the DWW and DWR bits of the DCR.
Bit 5
DDW1
Bit 4
DDW0
Description
0
0
2-cycle (no wait) external wait disabled
1
3-cycle (1 wait) external wait disabled
1
0
4-cycle (2 wait) external wait enabled
1
5-cycle (3 wait) external wait enabled
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 114 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bits 3 to 0⎯CS Space DMA Single Address Mode Access Wait Specification (DSW3, DSW2,
DSW1, DSW0): Specifies the number of waits for CS space access (0 to 15) during DMA single
address mode accesses. These bits are independent of the W bits of the WCR1.
Bit 3
DSW3
Bit 2
DSW2
Bit 1
DSW1
Bit 0
DSW0
Description
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait (external wait input enabled)
1
1
15 wait (external wait input enabled)
⋅⋅⋅
1
1
8.2.5
DRAM Area Control Register (DCR)
(initial value)
DCR is a 16-bit read/write register that selects the number of waits, operation mode, number of
address multiplex shifts and the like for DRAM control.
After a power-on reset, write the initial values to the bits in DCR and do not change the values
afterward.
Do not perform any DRAM space accesses before DCR initial settings are completed.
DCR is initialized by power-on resets to H'0000, but is not initialized by software standbys.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
TPC
RCD
TRAS1
TRAS0
DWW1
DWW0
DWR1
DWR0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DIW
⎯
BE
RASD
⎯
SZ0
AMX1
AMX0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit 15⎯RAS Precharge Cycle Count (TPC): Specifies the minimum number of cycles after
RAS is negated before next assert.
Bit 15
TPC
Description
0
1.5 cycles
1
2.5 cycles
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 115 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bit 14⎯RAS-CAS Delay Cycle Count (RCD): Specifies the number of row address output
cycles.
Bit 14
RCD
Description
0
1 cycle
1
2 cycles
(initial value)
Bits 13 and 12⎯CAS-Before-RAS Refresh RAS Assert Cycle Count (TRAS1 and TRAS0):
Specify the number of RAS assert cycles for CAS before RAS refreshes.
Bit 13
TRAS1
Bit 12
TRAS0
Description
0
0
2.5 cycles
1
3.5 cycles
0
4.5 cycles
1
5.5 cycles
1
(initial value)
Bits 11 and 10⎯DRAM Write Cycle Wait Count (DWW1 and DWW0): Specifies the number
of DRAM write cycle column address output cycles.
Bit 11
DWW1
Bit 10
DWW0
Description
0
0
2-cycle (no wait) external wait disabled
1
3-cycle (1 wait) external wait disabled
0
4-cycle (2 wait) external wait enabled
1
5-cycle (3 wait) external wait enabled
1
(initial value)
Bits 9 and 8⎯DRAM Read Cycle Wait Count (DWR1 and DWR0): Specifies the number of
DRAM read cycle column address output cycles.
Bit 9
DWR1
Bit 8
DWR0
Description
0
0
2-cycle (no wait) external wait disabled
1
3-cycle (1 wait) external wait disabled
0
4-cycle (2 wait) external wait enabled
1
5-cycle (3 wait) external wait enabled
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 116 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bit 7⎯DRAM Idle Cycle Count (DIW): Specifies whether to insert idle cycles, either when
accessing a different external space (CS space) or when doing a DRAM write, after DRAM reads.
Bit 7
DIW
Description
0
No idle cycles
1
1 idle cycle
(initial value)
Bit 6⎯Reserved: This bit always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 5⎯Burst Enable (BE): Specifies the DRAM operation mode.
Bit 5
BE
Description
0
Burst disabled
1
DRAM high-speed page mode enabled.
(initial value)
Bit 4⎯RAS Down Mode (RASD): Specifies the DRAM operation mode.
Bit 4
RASD
Description
0
Access DRAM by RAS up mode
1
Access DRAM by RAS down mode
(initial value)
Bit 3⎯Reserved: This bit read 0 after a reset. The write value should always be 0. Operation is
not guaranteed if the write value is 1.
Bit 2⎯DRAM Bus Width Specification (SZ0): Specifies the DRAM space bus width.
Bit 2
SZ0
Description
0
Byte (8-bit)
1
Word (16-bit)
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 117 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bits 1 and 0⎯DRAM Address Multiplex (AMX1 and AMX0): Specifies the DRAM address
multiplex count.
Bit 1
AMX1
Bit 0
AMX0
Description
0
0
9 bit
1
10 bit
0
11 bit
1
12 bit
1
8.2.6
(initial value)
Refresh Timer Control/Status Register (RTCSR)
RTCSR is a 16-bit read/write register that selects the refresh mode and the clock input to the
refresh timer counter (RTCNT), and controls compare match interrupts (CMI).
RTCSR is initialized by power-on resets to H'0000, but is not initialized by software standbys.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
CMF
CMIE
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
RFSH
RMD
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bits 15 to 7⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be 0
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 118 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bit 6⎯Compare Match Flag (CMF): This status flag, which indicates that the values of RTCNT
and RTCOR match, is set/cleared under the following conditions:
Bit 6
CMF
Description
0
Clear condition: After RTCSR is read when CMF is 1, 0 is written in
CMF.
(initial value)
1
Set condition: RTCNT = RTCOR. When both RTCNT and RTCOR are
in an initialized state (when values have not been rewritten since
initialization, and RTCNT has not had its value changed due to a countup), RTCNT and RTCOR match, as both are H'0000, but in this case
CMF is not set.
Bit 5⎯Compare Match Interrupt Enable (CMIE): Enables or disables an interrupt request
caused by the CMF bit of the RTCSR when CMF is set to 1.
Bit 5
CMIE
Description
0
Disables an interrupt request caused by CMF
1
Enables an interrupt request caused by CMF
(initial value)
Bits 4 to 2⎯Clock Select (CKS2 to CKS0): Select the clock to input to RTCNT from among the
seven types of internal clock obtained from dividing the system clock (φ).
Bit 4
CKS2
Bit 3
CKS1
Bit 2
CKS0
Description
0
0
0
Stops count-up
1
φ/2
0
φ/8
1
φ/32
0
φ/128
1
φ/512
0
φ/2048
1
φ/4096
1
1
0
1
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 119 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Bit 1⎯Refresh Control (RFSH): Selects whether to use refresh control for DRAM.
Bit 1
RFSH
Description
0
Do not refresh DRAM
1
Refresh DRAM
(initial value)
Bit 0⎯Refresh Mode (RMD): When the RFSH bit is 1, this bit selects normal refresh or selfrefresh. When the RFSH bit is 1, self-refresh mode is entered immediately after the RMD bit is set
to 1. When RMD is cleared to 0, a CAS-before-RAS refresh is performed at the interval set in the
refresh time constant register (RTCNT).
When set for self-refresh, the this LSI enters self-refresh mode immediately unless it is in the
middle of a DRAM access. If it is, it enters self-refresh mode when the access ends. Refresh
requests from the interval timer are ignored in self-refresh mode.
Bit 0
RMD
Description
0
CAS-before-RAS refresh
1
Self-refresh
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 120 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.2.7
Refresh Timer Counter (RTCNT)
RTCNT is a 16-bit read/write register that is used as an 8-bit up counter for refreshes or generating
interrupt requests.
RTCNT counts up with the clock selected by the CKS2 to CKS0 bits of the RTCSR. RTCNT
values can always be read/written by the CPU. When RTCNT matches RTCOR, RTCNT is
cleared to H'0000 and the CMF flag of the RTCSR is set to 1. If the RFSH bit of RTCSR is 1 and
the RMD bit is 0 at this time, a CAS-before-RAS refresh is performed. Additionally, if the CMIE
bit of RTCSR is a 1, a compare match interrupt (CMI) is generated.
Bits 15 to 8 are reserved and play no part in counter operation. They are always read as 0.
RTCNT is initialized by power-on resets to H'0000, but is not initialized by software standbys.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 121 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.2.8
Refresh Time Constant Register (RTCOR)
RTCOR is a 16-bit read/write register that establishes the compare match period with RTCNT.
The values of RTCOR and RTCNT are constantly compared. When the values correspond, the
compare match flag of RTCSR is set and RTCNT is cleared to 0.
When the refresh bit (RFSH) of the RTCSR is set to 1 and the RMD bit is 0, a refresh request
signal is produced by this match. The refresh request signal is held until a refresh operation is
performed. If the refresh request is not processed before the next match, the previous request
becomes ineffective.
When the CMIE bit of the RTSCR is set to 1, an interrupt request is sent to the interrupt controller
by this match signal. The interrupt request is output continuously until the CMF bit of the RTSCR
is cleared.
Bits 15 to 8 are reserved and cannot be used in setting the period. They always read 0.
RTCOR is initialized by power-on resets to H'0000, but is not initialized by software standbys.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 122 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.3
Accessing Ordinary Space
A strobe signal is output by ordinary space accesses to provide primarily for SRAM or ROM
direct connections.
8.3.1
Basic Timing
Figure 8.3 shows the basic timing of ordinary space accesses. Ordinary access bus cycles are
performed in 2 states.
T1
T2
CK
Address
CSn
RD
Read
Data
Write
WRx
Data
Figure 8.3 Basic Timing of Ordinary Space Access
During a read, irrespective of operand size, all bits in the data bus width for the access space
(address) are fetched by the LSI on RD, using the required byte locations.
During a write, the following signals are associated with transfer of these actual byte locations:
WRH (bits 15 to 8) and WRL (bits 7 to 0).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 123 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.3.2
Wait State Control
The number of wait states inserted into ordinary space access states can be controlled using the
WCR settings (figure 8.4). The specified number of Tw cycles are inserted as software wait cycles
at the timing shown in figure 8.4.
T1
TW
T2
CK
Address
CSn
RD
Read
Data
WRx
Write
Data
Figure 8.4 Wait Timing of Ordinary Space Access (Software Wait Only)
When the wait is specified by software using WCR, the wait input WAIT signal from outside is
sampled. Figure 8.5 shows the WAIT signal sampling. The WAIT signal is sampled at the clock
rise one cycle before the clock rise when Tw state shifts to T2 state.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 124 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
T1
TW
TW
TW0
T2
CK
Address
CSn
RD
Read
Data
WRx
Write
Data
WAIT
Figure 8.5 Wait State Timing of Ordinary Space Access
(Wait States from Software Wait 2 State + WAIT Signal)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 125 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.3.3
CS Assert Period Extension
Idle cycles can be inserted to prevent extension of the RD signal or WRx signal assert period
beyond the length of the CSn signal assert period by setting the SW3 to SW0 bits of BCR2. This
allows for flexible interfaces with external circuitry. The timing is shown in figure 8.6. Th and Tf
cycles are added respectively before and after the ordinary cycle. Only CSn is asserted in these
cycles; RD and WRx signals are not. Further, data is extended up to the Tf cycle, which is
effective for gate arrays and the like, which have slower write operations.
Th
T1
T2
Tf
CK
Address
CSn
RD
Read
Data
WRx
Write
Data
DACK
Figure 8.6 CS Assert Period Extension Function
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 126 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.4
DRAM Access
8.4.1
DRAM Direct Connection
When address space A31 to A24 = H'01 has been accessed, the corresponding space becomes a
16-Mbyte DRAM space, and the DRAM interface function can be used to directly connect this
LSI to DRAM.
Row address and column address are always multiplexed for DRAM space. The amount of row
address multiplexing can be selected as from 9 to 12 bits by setting the AMX1 and AMX0 bits of
the DCR.
Table 8.4
AMX Bits and Address Multiplex Output
Row Address
Column Address
AMX1
AMX0
Shift
Amount
Output
Address
Output
Pins
Output
Address
Output
Pins
0
0
9 bits
A21 to A15
A21 to A15
A21 to A0
A21 to A0
A14 to A0
A23 to A9
A21 to A14
A21 to A14
A21 to A0
A21 to A0
A13 to A0
A23 to A10
A21 to A13
A21 to A13
A21 to A0
A21 to A0
A12 to A0
A23 to A11
A21 to A12
A21 to A12
A21 to A0
A21 to A0
A11 to A0
A23 to A12
1
1
0
1
10 bits
11 bits
12 bits
In addition to ordinary read and write accesses, burst mode access using high speed page mode is
supported.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 127 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.4.2
Basic Timing
This LSI supports 2 CAS format DRAM access. The DRAM access basic timing is a minimum of
3 cycles for normal mode. Figure 8.7 shows the basic DRAM access timing. DRAM space access
is controlled by RAS, CASx and RDWR signals. The following signals are associated with
transfer of these actual byte locations: CASH (bits 15 to 8) and CASL (bits 7 to 0). However, the
signals for ordinary space, WRx and RD, are also output during the DMAC single transfer column
address cycle period. Tp is the precharge cycle, Tr is the RAS assert cycle, Tc is the CAS assert
cycle and Tc2 is the read data fetch cycle.
Tp
Tr
Tc1
Tc2
CK
Address
Row
Column
Data
RAS
Write
CASx
RDWR
Data
RAS
Read
CASx
RDWR
Figure 8.7 DRAM Bus Cycle (Normal Mode, TPC = 0, RCD = 0, No Waits)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 128 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.4.3
Wait State Control
Wait state insertion during DRAM space access is controlled by setting the TPC, RCD, DWW1,
DWW0, DWR1, and DWR0 bits of the DCR. TPC and RCD are common to both reads and
writes. The timing with waits inserted is shown in figures 8.8 through 8.11. External waits can be
inserted at the time of software waits 2, 3. The sampling location is the same as that of ordinary
space: at one cycle before the Tc2 cycle clock rise. Wait cycles are extended by external waits.
Tp
Tr
Tc1
Tcw1
Tc2
CK
Address
Row
Column
Data
RAS
Write
CASx
RDWR
Data
RAS
Read
CASx
RDWR
Figure 8.8 DRAM Bus Cycle (Normal Mode, TPC = 0, RCD = 0, One Wait)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 129 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Tp
Tpw
Tr
Trw
Tc1
Tcw1
Tcw2
Tcw2
CK
Address
Row
Column
Data
Write
RAS
CASx
RDWR
Data
RAS
Read
CASx
RDWR
Figure 8.9 DRAM Bus Cycle (Normal Mode, TPC = 1, RCD = 1, Two Waits)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 130 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Tp
Tr
Tc1
Tcw1
Tcw2
Tcw3
Tc2
CK
Address
Row
Column
Data
RAS
Write
CASx
RDWR
Data
RAS
Read
CASx
RDWR
Figure 8.10 DRAM Bus Cycle (Normal Mode, TPC = 0, RCD = 0, Three Waits)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 131 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Tp
Tr
Tc1
Tcw1
Tcw2
Tcw0
Tc2
CK
Address
Row
Column
Data
RAS
Write
CASx
RDWR
Data
RAS
Read
CASx
RDWR
WAIT
Figure 8.11 DRAM Bus Cycle
(Normal Mode, TPC = 0, RCD = 0, Two Waits + Wait Due to WAIT Signal)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 132 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.4.4
Burst Operation
High-Speed Page Mode: When the burst enable bit (BE) of the DCR is set, burst accesses can be
performed using high speed page mode. The timing is shown in figure 8.12. Wait cycles can be
inserted during burst accesses by using the DCR.
Tp
Tr
Tc1
Tc2
Tc1
Tc2
CK
Address
Row
Column
Column
Data
RAS
Write
CASx
RDWR
Data
RAS
Read
CASx
RDWR
Figure 8.12 DRAM Bus Cycle (High-Speed Page Mode)
RAS Down Mode: There are some instances where even if burst operation is selected, continuous
accesses to DRAM will not occur, but another space will be accessed instead part way through the
access. In such cases, if the RAS signal is maintained at low level during the time the other space
is accessed, it is possible to continue burst operation at the time the next DRAM same row address
is accessed. This is called RAS down mode.
To use RAS down mode, set both the BE and RASD bits of the DCR to 1.
Figures 8.13 and 8.14 show operation in RAS up and down modes.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 133 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
DRAM access
Tp
Tr
Tc1
Tc2
CS space
access
T1
T2
DRAM access
Tp
Tr
Tc1
Tc2
CK
Address
Row
Column
CS space
Row
Column
RAS
CASx
Data
Figure 8.13 DRAM Access Normal Operation (RAS Up Mode)
DRAM access
Tp
Tr
Tc1
Tc2
CS space
access
T1
T2
DRAM
access
Tc1
Tc2
CK
Address
Row
Column
CS space
RAS
CASx
Data
Figure 8.14 RAS Down Mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 134 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Column
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.4.5
Refresh Timing
The bus state controller is equipped with a function to control refreshes of DRAM. CAS-beforeRAS (CBR) refresh or self-refresh can be selected by setting the RTCSR's RMD bit.
CAS-before-RAS Refresh: For CBR refreshes, set the RCR's RMD bit to 0 and the RFSH bit to
1. Also write the values in RTCNT and RTCOR necessary to fulfill the refresh interval prescribed
for the DRAM being used. When a clock is selected with the CKS2 to CKS0 bits of the RSTCR,
RTCNT starts counting up from the value at that time. The RTCNT value is constantly compared
to the RTCOR value and a CBR refresh is performed when the two match. RTCNT is cleared at
that time and the count starts again. Figure 8.15 shows the timing for the CBR refresh operation.
The number of RAS assert cycles in the refresh cycle is set by the TRAS1, TRAS0 bits of the
DCR.
TRp
TRr1
TRr2
TRc
TRc
CK
RAS
CASx
Figure 8.15 CAS-Before-RAS Refresh Timing (TRAS1, TRAS0 = 0, 0)
Self-Refresh: When both the RMD and RFSH bits of the RTCSR are set to 1, the CAS signal and
RAS signal are output and the DRAM enters self-refresh mode, as shown in figure 8.16. Do not
access DRAM during self-refreshes, in order to preserve DRAM data. When performing DRAM
accesses, first cancel the self-refresh, then access only after doing individual refreshes for all row
addresses within the time prescribed for the particular DRAM.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 135 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
TRp
TRr1
TRr2
TRc
TRc
CK
RAS
CASx
Figure 8.16 Self-Refresh Timing
8.5
Address/Data Multiplex I/O Space Access
When the BCR1 register IOE bit is set to 1, the D15 to D0 pins can be used for multiplexed
address/data I/O for the CS3 space. Consequently, peripheral LSIs requiring address/data
multiplexing can be directly connected to this LSI.
Address/data multiplex I/O space bus width is selected by the A14 bit, and is 8 bit when A14 = 0
and 16 bit when A14 = 1.
8.5.1
Basic Timing
When the IOE bit of the BCR1 is set to 1, CS3 space becomes address/data multiplex I/O space.
When this space is accessed, addresses and data are multiplexed. When the A14 address bit is 0,
the bus size becomes 8 bit and addresses and data are input and output through the D7 to D0 pins.
When the A14 address bit is 1, the bus size becomes 16 bit and address output and data I/O occur
through the D15 to D0 pins. Access for the address/data multiplex I/O space is controlled by the
AH, RD and WRx signals.
Address/data multiplex I/O space accesses are done after a 3-cycle (fixed) address output, as an
ordinary space type access (figure 8.17).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 136 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
Ta1
Ta2
Ta3
Ta4
T1
T2
CK
Address
CS3
AH
Read
RD
Data input
Data
Write
Address output
WRx
Data
Address output
Data output
Figure 8.17 Address/Data Multiplex I/O Space Access Timing (No Waits)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 137 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.5.2
Wait State Control
Setting the WCR controls waits during address/data multiplex I/O space accesses. Software wait
and external wait insertion timing is the same as during ordinary space accesses. The timing for
one software wait + one external wait inserted is shown in figure 8.18.
Ta1
Ta2
Ta3
Ta4
T1
TW
TWo
T2
CK
Address
CS3
AH
Read
RD
Data
Data
input
Address output
WRx
Write
Data
Address output
Data output
WAIT
Figure 8.18 Address/Data Multiplex I/O Space Access Wait State Timing (One Software
Wait + One External Wait)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 138 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.5.3
CS Assertion Extension
The timing diagram when CS assertion extension is set for address/data multiplexed I/O space
access is shown in figure 8.19.
Ta1
Ta2
Ta3
Ta4
Th
T1
T2
Tf
Address
CS3
AH
Read
RD
Data
Address output
Data input
WRx
Write
Data
Address output
Data output
Figure 8.19 Wait Timing for Address/Data Multiplexed I/O Space
When CS Assertion Extension is Set
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 139 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.6
Waits between Access Cycles
When a read from a slow device is completed, data buffers may not go off in time to prevent data
conflicts with the next access. If there is a data conflict during memory access, the problem can be
solved by inserting a wait in the access cycle.
To enable detection of bus cycle starts, waits can be inserted between access cycles during
continuous accesses of the same CS space by negating the CSn signal once.
8.6.1
Prevention of Data Bus Conflicts
For the two cases of write cycles after read cycles, and read cycles for a different area after read
cycles, waits are inserted so that the number of idle cycles specified by the IW31 to IW00 bits of
the BCR2 and the DIW of the DCR occur. When idle cycles already exist between access cycles,
only the number of empty cycles remaining beyond the specified number of idle cycles are
inserted.
Figure 8.20 shows an example of idles between cycles. In this example, 1 idle between CSn space
cycles has been specified, so when a CSm space write immediately follows a CSn space read
cycle, 1 idle cycle is inserted.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 140 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
T1
T2
Tidle
T1
T2
CK
Address
CSn
CSm
RD
WRx
Data
CSn space read
Idle cycle
CSm space write
Figure 8.20 Idle Cycle Insertion Example
IW31 and IW30 specify the number of idle cycles required after a CS3 space read either to read
other external spaces, or for this LSI, to do write accesses. In the same manner, IW21 and IW20
specify the number of idle cycles after a CS2 space read, IW11 and IW10, the number after a CS1
space read, and IW01 and IW00, the number after a CS0 space read.
DIW specifies the number of idle cycles required, after a DRAM space read either to read other
external spaces (CS space), or for this LSI, to do write accesses.
0 to 3 cycles can be specified for CS space, and 0 to 1 cycle for DRAM space.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 141 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.6.2
Simplification of Bus Cycle Start Detection
For consecutive accesses of the same CS space, waits are inserted so that the number of idle cycles
designated by the CW3 to CW0 bits of the BCR2 occur. However, for write cycles after reads, the
number of idle cycles inserted will be the larger of the two values defined by the IW and CW bits.
When idle cycles already exist between access cycles, waits are not inserted. Figure 8.21 shows an
example. A continuous access idle is specified for CSn space, and CSn space is consecutively
write accessed.
T1
T2
Tidle
T1
T2
CK
Address
CSn
RD
WRx
Data
CSn space access
Idle cycle
CSn space access
Figure 8.21 Same Space Consecutive Access Idle Cycle Insertion Example
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 142 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.7
Bus Arbitration
It has two internal bus masters, the CPU and the DMAC. The priority ranking for determining bus
right transfer between these bus masters is:
Refresh > DMAC > CPU
8.8
Memory Connection Examples
Figures 8.22 to 8.27 show examples of the memory connections.
As A21 to A18 become input ports in power-on reset, they should be handled (e.g.
pulled down) as necessary.
SH7014/16/17
32 k × 8 bits
ROM
CSn
CE
RD
OE
A0 to A14
D0 to D7
A0 to A14
I/O0 to I/O7
Figure 8.22 8-Bit Data Bus Width ROM Connection
256 k × 16 bits
ROM
SH7014/16/17
CSn
CE
RD
OE
A0
A1 to A18
A0 to A17
D0 to D15
I/O0 to I/O15
Figure 8.23 16-Bit Data Bus Width ROM Connection
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 143 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
SH7014/16/17
123 k × 8 bits
SRAM
CSn
CS
RD
OE
A0 to A16
WRL
D0 to D7
A0 to A16
WE
I/O0 to I/O7
Figure 8.24 8-Bit Data Bus Width SRAM Connection
SH7014/16/17
128 k × 8 bits
SRAM
CSn
CS
RD
A0
A1 to A17
OE
WRH
D8 to D15
A0 to A16
WE
I/O0 to I/O7
WRL
D0 to D7
CS
OE
A0 to A16
WE
I/O0 to I/O7
Figure 8.25 16-Bit Data Bus Width SRAM Connection
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 144 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
512 k × 8 bits
DRAM
SH7014/16/17
RAS
RAS
WE
RDWR
OE
A0 to A9
A0 to A9
CASL
CAS
AD0 to AD7
I/O0 to I/O7
Figure 8.26 8-Bit Data Bus Width DRAM Connection
256 k × 16 bits
DRAM
SH7014/16/17
RAS
RAS
RDWR
WE
OE
A0
A0 to A8
A1 to A9
CASH
UCAS
CASL
LCAS
AD0 to AD15
I/O0 to I/O15
Figure 8.27 16-Bit Data Bus Width DRAM Connection
8.9
On-chip Peripheral I/O Register Access
On-chip peripheral I/O registers are accessed from the bus state controller, as shown in Table 8.5.
Table 8.5
On-chip Peripheral I/O Register Access
On-chip Peripheral
Module
SCI
MTU
INTC
PFC,
PORT
CMT
A/D*
WDT
DMAC
CACHE
Connected bus width
8bit
16bit
16bit
16bit
16bit
16bit
16bit
16bit
16bit
Access cycle
2cyc
2cyc
2cyc
2cyc
2cyc
2cyc
3cyc
3cyc
3cyc
Note:
*
The A/D in the SH7016 and SH7017 has an 8-bit width and is accessed in 3 cyc.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 145 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
8. Bus State Controller (BSC)
8.10
CPU Operation when Program Is in External Memory
In the SH7014, SH7016, and SH7017 F-ZTAT™, two words (equivalent to two instructions) are
normally fetched in a single instruction fetch. This is also true when the program is located in
external memory, irrespective of whether the external memory bus width is 8 or 16 bits.
If the program counter value immediately after the program branches is an odd-word (2n + 1)
address, or if the program counter value immediately before the program branches is an even-word
(2n) address, the CPU will always fetch 32 bits (equivalent to two instructions) that include the
respective word instruction.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 146 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Section 9 Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.1
Overview
The SH7014 includes an on-chip two-channel direct memory access controller (DMAC). The
DMAC can be used in place of the CPU to perform high-speed data transfers among external
devices equipped with DACK (transfer request acknowledge signal), external memories, memorymapped external devices, and on-chip peripheral modules (except for the DMAC and BSC). Using
the DMAC reduces the burden on the CPU and increases operating efficiency of the LSI as a
whole.
9.1.1
Features
The DMAC has the following features:
• Two channels
• Four Gbytes of address space in the architecture
• Byte, word, or longword selectable data transfer unit
• 64 k (65,536) transfers
• Single or dual address mode.
⎯ Single address mode: Either the transfer source or transfer destination (peripheral device) is
accessed by a DACK signal while the other is accessed by address. One transfer unit of
data is transferred in each bus cycle.
⎯ Dual address mode: Both the transfer source and transfer destination are accessed by
address. Values set in a DMAC internal register indicate the accessed address for both the
transfer source and transfer destination. Two bus cycles are required for one data transfer.
• Channel function: Dual address mode and single address mode external requests can be
accepted.
• Transfer requests: There are three DMAC transfer activation requests, as indicated below.
⎯ External request: From two DREQ pins. DREQ can be detected either by falling edge or by
low level. These can be received by all channels.
⎯ Requests from on-chip peripheral modules: Transfer requests from on-chip modules such
as SCI or A/D. These can be received by all channels.
⎯ Auto-request: The transfer request is generated automatically within the DMAC.
• Selectable bus modes: Cycle-steal mode or burst mode
• The DMAC priority order is fixed at 0 > 1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 147 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.1.2
Block Diagram
Figure 9.1 is a block diagram of the DMAC.
DMAC module
SARn
On-chip RAM
Register
control
DARn
On-chip
peripheral
module
Internal bus
Circuit
control
Peripheral bus
On-chip ROM*
DMATCRn
Activation
control
CHCRn
DMAOR
DREQ0, DREQ1
MTU
SCI0, SCI1
A/D converter
DEIn
Request
priority
control
DACK0, DACK1
DRAK0, DRAK1
External
ROM
Bus interface
External
RAM
External I/O
(memory
mapped)
External I/O
(with
acknowledge)
Bus state
controller
Legend:
DMAC source address register
SARn:
DMAC destination address register
DARn:
DMATCRn: DMAC transfer count register
DMAC channel control register
CHCRn:
DMAOR: DMAC operation register
Notes: n = 0, 1
* SH7016, SH7017 only
Figure 9.1 DMAC Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 148 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.1.3
Pin Configuration
Table 9.1 shows the DMAC pins.
Table 9.1
DMAC Pin Configuration
Channel
Name
Symbol
I/O
Function
0
DMA transfer request
DREQ0
I
DMA transfer request input from
external device to channel 0
DMA transfer request
acknowledge
DACK0
O
DMA transfer strobe output from
channel 0 to external device
DREQ0 acceptance
confirmation
DRAK0
O
Sampling receive acknowledge output
for DMA transfer request input from
external source
DMA transfer request
DREQ1
I
DMA transfer request input from
external device to channel 1
DMA transfer request
acknowledge
DACK1
O
DMA transfer strobe output from
channel 1 to external device
DREQ1 acceptance
confirmation
DRAK1
O
Sampling receive acknowledge output
for DMA transfer request input from
external source
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 149 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.1.4
Register Configuration
Table 9.2 summarizes the DMAC registers. DMAC has a total of 9 registers. Each channel has
four control registers. One other control register is shared by all channels.
Table 9.2
DMAC Registers
Channel Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial
Value
Address
0
DMA source
address register 0
SAR0
R/W
Undefined
H'FFFF86C0 32 bit
16, 32*
2
DMA destination
address register 0
DAR0
R/W
Undefined
H'FFFF86C4 32 bit
16, 32*
2
DMA transfer count DMATCR0 R/W
register 0
Undefined
H'FFFF86C8 32 bit
16, 32*
3
H'00000000 H'FFFF86CC 32 bit
16, 32*
2
1
Shared
1
Register Access
Size
Size
DMA channel
control register 0
CHCR0
R/W*
DMA source
address register 1
SAR1
R/W
Undefined
H'FFFF86D0 32 bit
16, 32*
2
DMA destination
address register 1
DAR1
R/W
Undefined
H'FFFF86D4 32 bit
16, 32*
2
DMA transfer count DMATCR1 R/W
register 1
Undefined
H'FFFF86D8 32 bit
16, 32*
3
2
DMA channel
control register 1
CHCR1
R/W*
1
H'00000000 H'FFFF86DC 32 bit
16, 32*
DMA operation
register
DMAOR
R/W*
1
H'0000
16*
H'FFFF86B0 16 bit
4
Notes: 1. Write 0 after reading 1 in bit 1 of CHCR0, CHCR1 and in bits 1 and 2 of the DMAOR to
clear flags. No other writes are allowed.
2. For 16-bit access of SAR0, SAR1, DAR0, DAR1, and CHCR0, CHCR1, the 16-bit value
on the side not accessed is held.
3. DMATCR has a 16-bit configuration: bits 0 to 15. Writing to the upper 16 bits (bits 16 to
31) is invalid, and these bits always read 0.
4. Only 16-bit access for DMAOR.
5. Do not attempt to access an empty address. If an access is attemped, the system
operation is not guarenteed.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 150 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.2
Register Descriptions
9.2.1
DMA Source Address Registers 0, 1 (SAR0, SAR1)
DMA source address registers 0, 1 (SAR0, SAR1) are 32-bit read/write registers that specify the
source address of a DMA transfer. These registers have a count function, and during a DMA
transfer, they indicate the next source address. In single-address mode, SAR values are ignored
when a device with DACK has been specified as the transfer source.
Specify a 16-bit or 32-bit boundary address when doing 16-bit or 32-bit data transfers. Operation
cannot be guaranteed on any other addresses.
The initial value after power-on resets or in software standby mode is undefined.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
23
22
21
…
…
2
1
0
…
…
⎯
⎯
⎯
…
…
⎯
⎯
⎯
R/W
R/W
R/W
…
…
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 151 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.2.2
DMA Destination Address Registers 0, 1 (DAR0, DAR1)
DMA destination address registers 0, 1 (DAR0, DAR1) are 32-bit read/write registers that specify
the destination address of a DMA transfer. These registers have a count function, and during a
DMA transfer, they indicate the next destination address. In single-address mode, DAR values are
ignored when a device with DACK has been specified as the transfer destination.
Specify a 16-bit or 32-bit boundary address when doing 16-bit or 32-bit data transfers. Operation
cannot be guaranteed on any other address. The initial value after power-on resets or in software
standby mode, is undefined.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
23
22
21
…
…
2
1
0
…
…
⎯
⎯
⎯
…
…
⎯
⎯
⎯
R/W
R/W
R/W
…
…
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 152 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.2.3
DMA Transfer Count Registers 0, 1 (DMATCR0, DMATCR1)
DMA transfer count registers 0, 1 (DMATCR0, DMATCR1) are 16-bit read/write registers that
specify the transfer count for the channel (byte count, word count, or longword count). Specifying
a H'000001 gives a transfer count of 1, while H'000000 gives the maximum setting, 65,536
transfers. While DMAC is in operation, the number of transfers to be performed is indicated. The
initial value after power-on resets or in software standby mode is undefined.
Upper sixteen bits of this register are read as 0 and the write value should always be 0.
Bit:
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Initial value:
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value:
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
R/W:
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 153 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.2.4
DMA Channel Control Registers 0, 1 (CHCR0, CHCR1)
DMA channel control registers 0, 1 (CHCR0, CHCR1) is a 32-bit read/write register where the
operation and transmission of each channel is designated. Bits 31 to 19 and bit 7 should always
read 0. The written value should also be 0. They are initialized to 0 by a power-on reset and in
software standby mode.
Bit:
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
RL
AM
AL
Initial value:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Note:
31
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
DM1
DM0
SM1
SM0
RS3
RS2
RS1
RS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
DS
TM
TS1
TS0
IE
TE
DE
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/(W)*
R/W
*
TE bit: Allows only 0 write after reading 1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 154 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Bit 18⎯Request Check Level (RL): Selects whether to output DRAK notifying external device
of DREQ received, with active high or active low.
Bit 18
RL
Description
0
Output DRAK with active high
1
Output DRAK with active low
(initial value)
Bit 17⎯Acknowledge Mode (AM): In dual address mode, selects whether to output DACK in
the data write cycle or data read cycle. In single address mode, DACK is always output
irrespective of the setting of this bit.
Bit 17
AM
Description
0
Outputs DACK during read cycle
1
Outputs DACK during write cycle
(initial value)
Bit 16⎯Acknowledge Level (AL): Specifies whether to set DACK (acknowledge) signal output
to active high or active low.
Bit 16
AL
Description
0
Active high output
1
Active low output
(initial value)
Bits 15 and 14⎯Destination Address Mode 1, 0 (DM1 and DM0): These bits specify
increment/decrement of the DMA transfer destination address. These bit specifications are ignored
when transferring data from an external device to address space in single address mode.
Bit 15
DM1
Bit 14
DM0
Description
0
0
Destination address fixed
1
Destination address incremented (+1 during 8-bit transfer, +2
during 16-bit transfer, +4 during 32-bit transfer)
0
Destination address decremented (−1 during 8-bit transfer, −2
during 16-bit transfer, −4 during 32-bit transfer)
1
Setting prohibited
1
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 155 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Bits 13 and 12⎯Source Address Mode 1, 0 (SM1 and SM0): These bits specify
increment/decrement of the DMA transfer source address. These bit specifications are ignored
when transferring data from an external device to address space in single address mode.
Bit 13
SM1
Bit 12
SM0
Description
0
0
Source address fixed
1
Source address incremented (+1 during 8-bit transfer, +2
during 16-bit transfer, +4 during 32-bit transfer)
0
Source address decremented (−1 during 8-bit transfer, −2
during 16-bit transfer, −4 during 32-bit transfer)
1
Setting prohibited
1
(initial value)
Bits 11 to 8⎯Resource Select 3 to 0 (RS3 to RS0): These bits specify the transfer request
source.
Bit 11
RS3
Bit 10
RS2
Bit 9
RS1
Bit 8
RS0
Description
0
0
0
0
External request, dual address mode
1
Prohibited
1
0
External request, single address mode. External address
space → external device.
1
External request, single address mode. External device →
external address space.
0
0
Auto-request
1
Prohibited
1
0
MTU TGI0A
1
MTU TGI1A
0
MTU TGI2A
1
Prohibited
0
Prohibited
1
A/D ADI
0
0
SCI0 TXI0
1
SCI0 RXI0
1
0
SCI1 TXI1
1
SCI1 RXI1
1
1
0
0
1
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 156 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Bit 6⎯DREQ Select (DS): Sets the sampling method for the DREQ pin in external request mode
to either low-level detection or falling-edge detection. When specifying an on-chip peripheral
module or auto-request as the transfer request source, this bit setting is ignored. The sampling
method is fixed at falling-edge detection in cases other than auto-request.
Bit 6
DS
Description
0
Low-level detection
1
Falling-edge detection
(initial value)
Bit 5⎯Transfer Mode (TM): Specifies the bus mode for data transfer.
Bit 5
TM
Description
0
Cycle steal mode
1
Burst mode
(initial value)
Bits 4 and 3⎯Transfer Size 1, 0 (TS1, TS0): Specifies size of data for transfer.
Bit 4
TS1
Bit 3
TS0
Description
0
0
Specifies byte size (8 bits)
1
Specifies word size (16 bits)
0
Specifies longword size (32 bits)
1
Prohibited
1
(initial value)
Bit 2⎯Interrupt Enable (IE): When this bit is set to 1, interrupt requests are generated after the
number of data transfers specified in the DMATCR (when TE = 1).
Bit 2
IE
Description
0
Interrupt request not generated after DMATCR-specified transfer count
(initial value)
1
Interrupt request enabled on completion of DMATCR specified number
of transfers
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 157 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Bit 1⎯Transfer End Flag (TE): This bit is set to 1 after the number of data transfers specified
by the DMATCR. At this time, if the IE bit is set to 1, an interrupt request is generated.
If data transfer ends before TE is set to 1 (for example, due to an NMI or address error, or clearing
of the DE bit or DME bit of the DMAOR) the TE is not set to 1. With this bit set to 1, data transfer
is disabled even if the DE bit is set to 1.
Bit 1
TE
Description
0
DMATCR-specified transfer count not ended
(initial value)
Clear condition: 0 write after TE = 1 read, Power-on reset, standby
mode
1
DMATCR specified number of transfers completed
Bit 0⎯DMAC Enable (DE): DE enables operation in the corresponding channel.
Bit 0
DE
Description
0
Operation of the corresponding channel disabled
1
Operation of the corresponding channel enabled
(initial value)
Transfer mode is entered if this bit is set to 1 when auto-request is specified (RS3 to RS0 settings).
With an external request or on-chip module request, when a transfer request occurs after this bit is
set to 1, transfer is enabled. If this bit is cleared during a data transfer, transfer is suspended.
If the DE bit has been set, but TE = 1, then if the DME bit of the DMAOR is 0, and the NMI or
AE bit of the DMAOR is 1, transfer enable mode is not entered.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 158 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.2.5
DMAC Operation Register (DMAOR)
The DMAOR is a 16-bit read/write register that specifies the transfer mode of the DMAC. Bits 15
to 3 of this register always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Register values are initialized to 0 during power-on reset or in software standby mode.
Bit:
Note:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AE
NMIF
DME
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R
*
0 write only is valid after 1 is read.
Bit 2⎯Address Error Flag (AE): Indicates that an address error has occurred during DMA
transfer. If this bit is set during a data transfer, transfers on all channels are suspended. The CPU
cannot write a 1 to the AE bit. Clearing is effected by 0 write after 1 read.
Bit 2
AE
Description
0
No address error, DMA transfer enabled
(initial value)
Clearing condition: Write AE = 0 after reading AE = 1
1
Address error, DMA transfer disabled
Setting condition: Address error due to DMAC
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 159 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Bit 1⎯NMI Flag (NMIF): Indicates input of an NMI. This bit is set irrespective of whether the
DMAC is operating or suspended. If this bit is set during a data transfer, transfers on all channels
are suspended. The CPU is unable to write a 1 to the NMIF. Clearing is effected by a 0 write after
1 read.
Bit 1
NMIF
Description
0
No NMI interrupt, DMA transfer enabled
(initial value)
Clearing condition: Write NMIF = 0 after reading NMIF = 1
1
NMI has occurred, DMC transfer prohibited
Set condition: NMI interrupt occurrence
Bit 0⎯DMAC Master Enable (DME): This bit enables activation of the entire DMAC. When
the DME bit and DE bit of the CHCR for the corresponding channel are set to 1, that channel is
transfer-enabled. If this bit is cleared during a data transfer, transfers on all channels are
suspended.
Even when the DME bit is set, when the TE bit of the CHCR is 1, or its DE bit is 0, transfer is
disabled in the case of an NMI of the DMAOR or when AE = 1.
Bit 0
DME
Description
0
Disable operation on all channels
1
Enable operation on all channels
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 160 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.3
Operation
When there is a DMA transfer request, the DMAC starts the transfer according to the
predetermined channel priority order; when the transfer end conditions are satisfied, it ends the
transfer. Transfers can be requested in three modes: auto-request, external request, and on-chip
peripheral module request. Transfer can be in either the single address mode or the dual address
mode. The bus mode can be either burst or cycle steal.
9.3.1
DMA Transfer Flow
After the DMA source address registers (SAR), DMA destination address registers (DAR), DMA
transfer count register (DMATCR), DMA channel control registers (CHCR), and DMA operation
register (DMAOR) are set to the desired transfer conditions, the DMAC transfers data according
to the following procedure:
1. The DMAC checks to see if transfer is enabled (DE = 1, DME = 1, TE = 0, NMIF = 0,
AE = 0).
2. When a transfer request comes and transfer has been enabled, the DMAC transfers 1 transfer
unit of data (determined by TS0 and TS1 setting). For an auto-request, the transfer begins
automatically when the DE bit and DME bit are set to 1. The DMATCR value will be
decremented by 1 upon each transfer. The actual transfer flows vary by address mode and bus
mode.
3. When the specified number of transfers have been completed (when DMATCR reaches 0), the
transfer ends normally. If the IE bit of the CHCR is set to 1 at this time, a DEI interrupt is sent
to the CPU.
4. When an address error occurs in the DMAC or an NMI interrupt is generated, the transfer is
aborted. Transfers are also aborted when the DE bit of the CHCR or the DME bit of the
DMAOR are changed to 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 161 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.2 is a flowchart of this procedure.
Start
Initial settings
(SAR, DAR, DMATCR,
CHCR, DMAOR)
DE, DME = 1 and
NMIF, AE, TE = 0?
No
Yes
Transfer request
occurs?*1
No
*3
Yes
Transfer (1 transfer unit);
DMATCR − 1 → DMATCR, SAR and DAR
updated
DMATCR = 0?
No
Yes
DEI interrupt request (when IE = 1)
Does
NMIF = 1, AE = 1,
DE = 0, or DME
= 0?
Yes
2.
3.
Bus mode,
transfer request mode,
DREQ detection selection
system
Does
NMIF = 1, AE = 1,
DE = 0, or DME
= 0?
Yes
No
Transfer aborted
No
Transfer ends
Notes: 1.
*2
Normal end
In auto-request mode, transfer begins when NMIF, AE, and TE are all 0,
and the DE and DME bits are set to 1.
DREQ level detection in burst mode (external request) or cycle-steal
mode.
DREQ edge detection in burst mode (external request), or auto-request
mode in burst mode.
Figure 9.2 DMAC Transfer Flowchart
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 162 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.3.2
DMA Transfer Requests
DMA transfer requests are usually generated in either the data transfer source or destination, but
they can also be generated by devices and on-chip peripheral modules that are neither the source
nor the destination. Transfers can be requested in three modes: auto-request, external request, and
on-chip peripheral module request. The request mode is selected in the RS3 to RS0 bits of the
DMA channel control registers 0, 1 (CHCR0, CHCR1).
Auto-Request Mode: When there is no transfer request signal from an external source, as in a
memory-to-memory transfer or a transfer between memory and an on-chip peripheral module
unable to request a transfer, the auto-request mode allows the DMAC to automatically generate a
transfer request signal internally. When the DE bits of CHCR0, CHCR1 and the DME bit of the
DMAOR are set to 1, the transfer begins (so long as the TE bits of CHCR0, CHCR1 and the
NMIF and AE bits of DMAOR are all 0).
External Request Mode: In this mode a transfer is performed at the request signal (DREQ) of an
external device. Choose one of the modes shown in table 9.3 according to the application system.
When this mode is selected, if the DMA transfer is enabled (DE = 1, DME = 1, TE = 0, NMIF = 0,
AE = 0), a transfer is performed upon a request at the DREQ input. Choose to detect DREQ by
either the falling edge or low level of the signal input with the DS bit of CHCR0, CHCR1 (DS = 0
is level detection, DS = 1 is edge detection). The source of the transfer request does not have to be
the data transfer source or destination.
Table 9.3
Selecting External Request Modes with the RS Bits
RS3
RS2
RS1
RS0
Address Mode
Source
Destination
0
0
0
0
Dual address
mode
Any*
Any*
1
0
Single address
mode
External memory or
memory-mapped
external device
External device with
DACK
1
Single address
mode
External device with
DACK
External memory or
memory-mapped
external device
Note:
*
External memory, memory-mapped external device, on-chip memory, on-chip
peripheral module (excluding DMAC, BSC).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 163 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
On-Chip Peripheral Module Request Mode: In this mode a transfer is performed at the transfer
request signal (interrupt request signal) of an on-chip peripheral module. As indicated in table 9.4,
there are eight transfer request signals: three from the multifunction timer pulse unit (MTU),
which are compare match or input capture interrupts; the receive data full interrupts (RxI) and
transmit data empty interrupts (TxI) of the two serial communication interfaces (SCI); and the A/D
conversion end interrupt (ADI) of the A/D converter. When DMA transfers are enabled (DE = 1,
DME = 1, TE = 0, NMIF = 0, AE = 0), a transfer is performed upon the input of a transfer request
signal.
The transfer request source need not be the data transfer source or transfer destination. However,
when the transfer request is set by RxI (transfer request because SCI's receive data is full), the
transfer source must be the SCI's receive data register (RDR). When the transfer request is set by
TxI (transfer request because SCI's transmit data is empty), the transfer destination must be the
SCI's transmit data register (TDR). Also, if the transfer request is set to the A/D converter, the data
transfer destination must be the A/D converter register.
Table 9.4
Selecting On-Chip Peripheral Module Request Modes with the RS Bits
DMAC Transfer
RS3 RS2 RS1 RS0 Request Source
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
MTU*
2
TGI0A
Any*
1
Any*
1
Burst/cycle steal
1
MTU*
2
TGI1A
Any*
1
Any*
1
Burst/cycle steal
0
MTU*
2
TGI2A
Any*
1
Any*
1
Burst/cycle steal
1
Prohibited
0
Prohibited
1
A/D
ADI
ADDR* Any*
1
Burst/cycle steal
TDR0
Burst/cycle steal
1
Burst/cycle steal
0
1
1
DMA Transfer
DestinRequest Signal Source ation
Bus Mode
3
SCI0* transmit block
3
SCI0* receive block
TxI0
RxI0
4
Any*
1
RDR0
3
TxI1
Any*
3
RxI1
RDR1
0
SCI1* transmit block
1
SCI1* receive block
1
Any*
TDR1
Burst/cycle steal
1
Burst/cycle steal
Any*
Notes: 1. External memory, memory-mapped external device, on-chip memory, on-chip
peripheral module (excluding DMAC, BSC).
2. MTU: Multifunction timer pulse unit.
3. SCI0, SCI1: Serial communications interface.
4. ADDR: A/D converter's A/D register.
In order to output a transfer request from an on-chip peripheral module, set the relevant interrupt
enable bit for each module, and output an interrupt signal.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 164 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
When an on-chip peripheral module's interrupt request signal is used as a DMA transfer request
signal, interrupts for the CPU are not generated.
When a DMA transfer is conducted corresponding with one of the transfer request signals in table
9.4, it is automatically discontinued. In cycle steal mode this occurs in the first transfer, and in
burst mode with the last transfer.
9.3.3
Channel Priority
When the DMAC receives simultaneous transfer requests on two or more channels, it selects a
channel according to a predetermined priority order. The channel priority order is fixed at channel
0 > channel 1.
9.3.4
DMA Transfer Types
The DMAC supports the transfers shown in table 9.5. It can operate in the single address mode, in
which either the transfer source or destination is accessed using an acknowledge signal, or dual
address mode, in which both the transfer source and destination addresses are output. The DMAC
has two bus modes: cycle-steal mode and burst mode.
Table 9.5
Supported DMA Transfers
Destination
Source
MemoryMapped
External Device External External On-Chip
with DACK
Memory Device Memory
On-Chip
Peripheral
Module
External device with DACK Not available
Single
Single
Not available
Not available
External memory
Single
Dual
Dual
Dual
Dual
Memory-mapped external
device
Single
Dual
Dual
Dual
Dual
On-chip memory
Not available
Dual
Dual
Dual
Dual
On-chip peripheral module Not available
Dual
Dual
Dual
Dual
Notes: 1. Single: Single address mode
2. Dual: Dual address mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 165 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Address Modes
Single Address Mode: In the single address mode, both the transfer source and destination are
external; one (selectable) is accessed by a DACK signal while the other is accessed by an address.
In this mode, the DMAC performs the DMA transfer in 1 bus cycle by simultaneously outputting a
transfer request acknowledge DACK signal to one external device to access it while outputting an
address to the other end of the transfer. Figure 9.3 shows an example of a transfer between an
external memory and an external device with DACK in which the external device outputs data to
the data bus while that data is written in external memory in the same bus cycle.
External address bus External data bus
This LSI
External
memory
DMAC
External device
with DACK
DACK
DREQ
: Data flow
Figure 9.3 Data Flow in Single Address Mode
Two types of transfers are possible in the single address mode: (a) transfers between external
devices with DACK and memory-mapped external devices, and (b) transfers between external
devices with DACK and external memory. The only transfer requests for either of these is the
external request (DREQ). Figure 9.4 shows the DMA transfer timing for the single address mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 166 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
CK
A21 to A0
Address output to external memory space
CSn
D15 to D0
Data that is output from the external
device with DACK
WRH
WRL
WR signal to external memory space
DACK
DACK signal to external devices with
DACK (active low)
a. External device with DACK to external memory space
CK
A21 to A0
Address output to external memory space
CSn
D15 to D0
RD
DACK
Data that is output from external memory space
RD signal to external memory space
DACK signal to external device with DACK
(active low)
b. External memory space to external device with DACK
Figure 9.4 Example of DMA Transfer Timing in the Single Address Mode
Dual Address Mode: Dual address mode is used for access of both the transfer source and
destination by address. Transfer source and destination can be accessed either internally or
externally. In dual address mode, data is read from the transfer source during the data read cycle,
and written to the transfer destination during the write cycle, so transfer is conducted in two bus
cycles. At this time, the transfer data is temporarily stored in the DMAC. With the kind of external
memory transfer shown in figure 9.5, data is read from one of the memories by the DMAC during
a read cycle, then written to the other external memory during the subsequent write cycle. Figure
9.6 shows the timing for this operation.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 167 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
1st bus cycle
DMAC
SAR
DAR
Data bus
Address bus
Memory
Transfer source
module
Transfer destination
module
Data buffer
The SAR value is taken as the address, and data is read from the transfer source
module and stored temporarily in the DMAC.
2nd bus cycle
DMAC
SAR
DAR
Data buffer
Data bus
Address bus
Memory
Transfer source
module
Transfer destination
module
The DAR value is taken as the address, and data stored in the DMAC's data
buffer is written to the transfer destination module.
Figure 9.5 Operation during Dual Address Mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 168 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
CK
A21 to A0
Transfer source
address
Transfer destination
address
CSn
D15 to D0
RD
WRH, WRL
DACK
Data read cycle
(1st cycle)
Note:
Data write cycle
(2nd cycle)
Transfer between external memories with DACK are output during read
cycle.
Figure 9.6 Example of Transfer Timing in Dual Address Mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 169 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Bus Modes
Select the appropriate bus mode in the TM bits of CHCR0, CHCR1. There are two bus modes:
cycle steal and burst.
Cycle-Steal Mode: In the cycle steal mode, the bus right is given to another bus master after each
one-transfer-unit (byte, word, or longword) DMAC transfer. When the next transfer request
occurs, the bus rights are obtained from the other bus master and a transfer is performed for one
transfer unit. When that transfer ends, the bus right is passed to the other bus master. This is
repeated until the transfer end conditions are satisfied.
The cycle steal mode can be used with all categories of transfer destination, transfer source and
transfer request. Figure 9.7 shows an example of DMA transfer timing in the cycle steal mode.
Transfer conditions are dual address mode and DREQ level detection.
DREQ
Bus control returned to CPU
Bus cycle
CPU
CPU
CPU
DMAC DMAC
Read
Write
CPU DMAC DMAC CPU
Read
CPU
Write
Figure 9.7 DMA Transfer Example in the Cycle-Steal Mode
Burst Mode: Once the bus right is obtained, the transfer is performed continuously until the
transfer end condition is satisfied. In the external request mode with low level detection of the
DREQ pin, however, when the DREQ pin is driven high, the bus passes to the other bus master
after the bus cycle of the DMAC that currently has an acknowledged request ends, even if the
transfer end conditions have not been satisfied.
Figure 9.8 shows an example of DMA transfer timing in the burst mode. Transfer conditions are
single address mode and DREQ level detection.
DREQ
Bus cycle
CPU
CPU
CPU
DMAC DMAC DMAC DMAC DMAC DMAC
Figure 9.8 DMA Transfer Example in the Burst Mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 170 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
CPU
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Relationship between Request Modes and Bus Modes by DMA Transfer Category
Table 9.6 shows the relationship between request modes and bus modes by DMA transfer
category.
Table 9.6
Relationship of Request Modes and Bus Modes by DMA Transfer Category
5
Address
Mode
Transfer Category
Request
Mode
Bus*
Mode
Transfer Usable
Size (Bits) Channels
Single
External device with DACK and
external memory
External
B/C
8/16/32
0,1
External device with DACK and
memory-mapped external device
External
B/C
8/16/32
0, 1
Dual
External memory and external memory Any*
1
B/C
8/16/32
0, 1
External memory and memory-mapped Any*
external device
1
B/C
8/16/32
0, 1
Memory-mapped external device and
memory-mapped external device
Any*
1
B/C
8/16/32
0, 1
External memory and on-chip memory
Any*
1
B/C
External memory and on-chip
peripheral module
Any*
2
B/C*
Memory-mapped external device and
on-chip memory
Any*
1
B/C
Memory-mapped external device and
on-chip peripheral module
Any*
2
B/C*
On-chip memory and on-chip memory
Any*
1
B/C
On-chip memory and on-chip
peripheral module
Any*
2
On-chip peripheral module and onchip peripheral module
Any*
2
8/16/32
3
8/16/32*
0, 1
4
8/16/32
3
8/16/32*
0, 1
4
8/16/32
B/C*
3
B/C*
3
0, 1
0, 1
0, 1
8/16/32*
4
0, 1*
1
8/16/32*
4
0, 1
Notes: 1. External request, auto-request or on-chip peripheral module request enabled. However,
in the case of on-chip peripheral module request, it is not possible to specify the SCI or
A/D converter for the transfer request source.
2. External request, auto-request or on-chip peripheral module request possible. However,
if transfer request source is also the SCI or A/D converter, the transfer source or
transfer destination must be the SCI or A/D converter.
3. When the transfer request source is the SCI, only cycle steal mode is possible.
4. Access size permitted by register of on-chip peripheral module that is the transfer
source or transfer destination.
5. B: Burst, C: Cycle steal
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 171 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Bus Mode and Channel Priority Order
When a given channel is transferring in burst mode, and a transfer request is issued to channel 0,
which has a higher priority ranking, transfer on channel 0 begins immediately. Channel 1 transfer
is continued after transfer on channel 0 are completely ended, whether the channel 0 setting is
cycle steal mode or burst mode.
9.3.5
Number of Bus Cycle States and DREQ Pin Sample Timing
Number of States in Bus Cycle: The number of states in the bus cycle when the DMAC is the
bus master is controlled by the bus state controller (BSC) just as it is when the CPU is the bus
master. For details, see section 8, Bus State Controller.
DREQ Pin Sampling Timing and DRAK Signal: In external request mode, the DREQ pin is
sampled by either falling edge or low-level detection. When a DREQ input is detected, a DMAC
bus cycle is issued and DMA transfer effected, at the earliest, after three states. However, in burst
mode when single address operation is specified, a dummy cycle is inserted for the first bus cycle.
In this case, the actual data transfer starts from the second bus cycle. Data is transferred
continuously from the second bus cycle. The dummy cycle is not counted in the number of
transfer cycles, so there is no need to recognize the dummy cycle when setting the DMATCR.
DREQ sampling from the second time begins from the start of the transfer one bus cycle prior to
the DMAC transfer generated by the previous sampling.
DRAK is output once for the first DREQ sampling, irrespective of transfer mode or DREQ
detection method. In burst mode, using edge detection, DREQ is sampled for the first cycle only,
so DRAK is also output for the first cycle only. Therefore, the DREQ signal negate timing can be
ascertained, and this facilitates handshake operations of transfer requests with the DMAC.
Cycle Steal Mode Operations: In cycle steal mode, DREQ sampling timing is the same
irrespective of dual or single address mode, or whether edge or low-level DREQ detection is used.
For example, DMAC transfer begins (figure 9.9), at the earliest, three cycles from the first
sampling timing. The second sampling begins at the start of the transfer one bus cycle prior to the
start of the DMAC transfer initiated by the first sampling (i.e., from the start of the CPU(3)
transfer). At this point, if DREQ detection has not occurred, sampling is executed every cycle
thereafter.
As in figure 9.10, whatever cycle the CPU transfer cycle is, the next sampling begins from the
start of the transfer one bus cycle before the DMAC transfer begins.
Figure 9.9 shows an example of output during DACK read and figure 9.10 an example of output
during DACK write.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 172 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
DACK
Bus
cycle
DRAK
DREQ
CK
CPU(1)
CPU(2)
1st sampling
2nd sampling
CPU(3) DMAC(R) DMAC(W)
CPU(4) DMAC(R) DMAC(W)
CPU(5) DMAC(R) DMAC(W)
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.9 Cycle Steal, Dual Address and Level Detection (Fastest Operation)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 173 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 174 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
CPU
CPU
CPU
2nd sampling
DMAC(R)
Note: With cycle-steal and dual address operation, sampling timing is the same
whether DREQ detection is by level or by edge.
DACK
Bus
cycle
DRAK
DREQ
CK
1st sampling
DMAC(W)
CPU
DMAC
(R)
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.10 Cycle Steal, Dual Address and Level Detection (Normal Operation)
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
DACK
Bus
cycle
DRAK
DREQ
CK
CPU
CPU
CPU
DMAC
CPU
DMAC
CPU
DMAC
Figures 9.11 and 9.12 show cycle steal mode and single address mode. In this case, transfer begins
at earliest three cycles after the first DREQ sampling. The second sampling begins from the start
of the transfer one bus cycle before the start of the first DMAC transfer. In single address mode,
the DACK signal is output during the DMAC transfer period.
Figure 9.11 Cycle Steal, Single Address and Level Detection (Fastest Operation)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 175 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Note: With cycle-steal and single address operation, sampling timing is the same
whether DREQ detection is by level or by edge.
DACK
Bus
cycle
DRAK
DREQ
CK
CPU
CPU
CPU
DMAC
CPU
DMAC
CPU
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.12 Cycle Steal, Single Address and Level Detection (Normal Operation)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 176 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Burst Mode, Dual Address, and Level Detection: DREQ sampling timing in burst mode with
dual address and level detection is shown in figures 9.13 and 9.14. DREQ sampling timing in burst
mode with dual address and level detection is virtually the same as that of cycle steal mode.
For example, DMAC transfer begins (figure 9.13), at the earliest, three cycles after the timing of
the first sampling. The second sampling also begins from the start of the transfer one bus cycle
before the start of the first DMAC transfer. In burst mode, as long as transfer requests are issued,
DMAC transfer continues. Therefore, the “transfer one bus cycle before the start of the DMAC
transfer” may be a DMAC transfer.
In burst mode, the DACK output period is the same as that of cycle steal mode. Figure 9.14 shows
the normal operation of this burst mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 177 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
DACK
Bus
cycle
DRAK
DREQ
CK
CPU
CPU
CPU
DMAC(R) DMAC(W) DMAC(R) DMAC(W) DMAC(R) DMAC(W)
CPU
DMAC(R)
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.13 Burst Mode, Dual Address and Level Detection (Fastest Operation)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 178 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
DACK
Bus
cycle
DRAK
DREQ
CK
CPU
CPU
CPU
DMAC(R)
DMAC(W)
DMAC(R) DMAC(W)
DMAC(R)
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.14 Burst Mode, Dual Address and Level Detection (Normal Operation)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 179 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Burst Mode, Single Address, and Level Detection: DREQ sampling timing in burst mode with
single address and level detection is shown in figures 9.15 and 9.16.
In burst mode with single address and level detection, a dummy cycle is inserted as one bus cycle,
at the earliest, three cycles after timing of the first sampling. Data during this period is undefined,
and the DACK signal is not output. Nor is the number of DMAC transfers counted. The actual
DMAC transfer begins after one dummy bus cycle output.
The dummy cycle is not counted either at the start of the second sampling (transfer one bus cycle
before the start of the first DMAC transfer). Therefore, the second sampling is not conducted from
the bus cycle starting the dummy cycle, but from the start of the CPU(3) bus cycle.
Thereafter, as long the DREQ is continuously sampled, no dummy cycle is inserted. DREQ
sampling timing during this period begins from the start of the transfer one bus cycle before the
start of DMAC transfer, in the same way as with cycle steal mode.
As with the fourth sampling in figure 9.15, once DMAC transfer is interrupted, a dummy cycle is
again inserted at the start as soon as DMAC transfer is resumed.
The DACK output period in burst mode is the same as in cycle steal mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 180 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
DACK
Bus
cycle
DRAK
DREQ
CK
CPU(1)
1st sampling
CPU(2) CPU(3) Dummy
2nd sampling
DMAC
3rd sampling
DMAC
4th sampling
DMAC
CPU(4) Dummy
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.15 Burst Mode, Single Address and Level Detection (Fastest Operation)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 181 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
DACK
Bus
cycle
DRAK
DREQ
CK
CPU
CPU
CPU
Dummy
DMAC
DMAC
DMAC
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.16 Burst Mode, Single Address and Level Detection (Normal Operation)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 182 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Burst Mode, Dual Address, and Edge Detection: In burst mode with dual address and edge
detection, DREQ sampling is conducted only on the first cycle.
In figure 9.17, DMAC transfer begins, at the earliest, three cycles after the timing of the first
sampling. Thereafter, DMAC transfer continues until the end of the data transfer count set in the
DMATCR. DREQ sampling is not conducted during this period. Therefore, DRAK is output on
the first cycle only.
When DMAC transfer is resumed after being halted by a NMI or address error, be sure to reinput
an edge request. The remaining transfer restarts after the first DRAK output.
The DACK output period in burst mode is the same as in cycle steal mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 183 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
DACK
DRAK
Bus
cycle
DREQ
CK
CPU
CPU
CPU
DMAC(R) DMAC(W) DMAC(R) DMAC(W) DMAC(R) DMAC(W) DMAC(R) DMAC(W)
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.17 Burst Mode, Dual Address and Edge Detection
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 184 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Burst Mode, Single Address, and Edge Detection: In burst mode with single address and edge
detection, DREQ sampling is conducted only on the first cycle. In figure 9.18, a dummy cycle is
inserted, at the earliest, three cycles after the timing for the first sampling. During this period, data
is undefined, and DACK is not output. Nor is the number of DMAC transfers counted. The actual
DMAC transfer begins after one dummy bus cycle output. Thereafter, DMAC transfer continues
until the data transfer count set in the DMATCR has ended. DREQ sampling is not conducted
during this period. Therefore, DRAK is output on the first cycle only.
When DMAC transfer is resumed after being halted by a NMI or address error, be sure to reinput
an edge request. DRAK is output once, and the remaining transfer restarts after output of one
dummy cycle.
The DACK output period in burst mode is the same as in cycle steal mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 185 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
DACK
Bus
cycle
DRAK
DREQ
CK
CPU
CPU
CPU
Dummy
DMAC
DMAC
DMAC
DMAC
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
Figure 9.18 Burst Mode, Single Address and Edge Detection
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 186 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.3.6
DMA Transfer Ending Conditions
The DMA transfer ending conditions vary for individual channels ending and for all channels
ending together.
Individual Channel Ending Conditions: There are two ending conditions. A transfer ends when
the value of the channel's DMA transfer count register (DMATCR) is 0, or when the DE bit of the
channel's CHCR is cleared to 0.
• When DMATCR is 0: When the DMATCR value becomes 0 and the corresponding channel's
DMA transfer ends, the transfer end flag bit (TE) is set in the CHCR. If the IE (interrupt
enable) bit has been set, a DMAC interrupt (DEI) is requested of the CPU.
• When DE of CHCR is 0: Software can halt a DMA transfer by clearing the DE bit in the
channel's CHCR. The TE bit is not set when this happens.
Conditions for Ending All Channels Simultaneously: Transfers on all channels end when the
NMIF (NMI flag) bit or AE (address error flag) bit is set to 1 in the DMAOR, or when the DME
bit in the DMAOR is cleared to 0.
• When the NMIF or AE bit is set to 1 in DMAOR: When an NMI interrupt or DMAC address
error occurs, the NMIF or AE bit is set to 1 in the DMAOR and all channels stop their
transfers. The DMAC obtains the bus rights, and if these flags are set to 1 during execution of
a transfer, DMAC halts operation when the transfer processing currently being executed ends,
and transfers the bus right to the other bus master. Consequently, even if the NMIF or AE bits
are set to 1 during a transfer, the DMA source address register (SAR), designation address
register (DAR), and DMA transfer count register (DMATCR) are all updated. The TE bit is
not set. To resume the transfers after NMI interrupt or address error processing, clear the
appropriate flag bit to 0. To avoid restarting a transfer on a particular channel, clear its DE bit
to 0.
When the processing of a one unit transfer is complete. In a dual address mode direct address
transfer, even if an address error occurs or the NMI flag is set during read processing, the
transfer will not be halted until after completion of the following write processing. In such a
case, SAR, DAR, and DMATCR values are updated.
• When DME is cleared to 0 in DMAOR: Clearing the DME bit to 0 in the DMAOR aborts the
transfers on all channels. The TE bit is not set.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 187 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.3.7
DMAC Access from CPU
The space addressed by the DMAC is 3-cycle space. Therefore, when the CPU becomes the bus
master and accesses the DMAC, a minimum of three basic clock (CLK) cycles are required for
one bus cycle. Also, since the DMAC is located in word space, while a word-size access to the
DMAC is completed in one bus cycle, a longword-size access is automatically divided into two
word accesses, requiring two bus cycles (six basic clock cycles). These two bus cycles are
executed consecutively; a different bus cycle is never inserted between the two word accesses.
This applies to both write accesses and read accesses.
9.4
Examples of Use
9.4.1
Example of DMA Transfer between On-Chip SCI and External Memory
In this example, on-chip serial communication interface channel 0 (SCI0) received data is
transferred to external memory using the DMAC channel 1.
Table 9.7 indicates the transfer conditions and the setting values of each of the registers.
Table 9.7
Transfer Conditions and Register Set Values for Transfer between On-chip SCI
and External Memory
Transfer Conditions
Register
Value
Transfer source: RDR0 of on-chip SCI0
SAR1
H'FFFF81A5
Transfer destination: external memory
DAR1
H'00400000
Transfer count: 64 times
DMATCR1
H'00000040
Transfer source address: fixed
CHCR1
H'00004D05
DMAOR
H'0001
Transfer destination address: incremented
Transfer request source: SCI0 (RDR0)
Bus mode: cycle steal
Transfer unit: byte
Interrupt request generation at end of transfer
Channel priority ranking: 0 > 1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 188 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.4.2
Example of DMA Transfer between External RAM and External Device with
DACK
In this example, an external request, single address mode transfer with external memory as the
transfer source and an external device with DACK as the transfer destination is executed using
DMAC channel 1.
Table 9.8 indicates the transfer conditions and the setting values of each of the registers.
Table 9.8
Transfer Conditions and Register Set Values for Transfer between External
RAM and External Device with DACK
Transfer Conditions
Register
Value
Transfer source: external RAM
SAR1
H'00400000
Transfer destination: external device with DACK
DAR1
(access by DACK)
Transfer count: 32 times
DMATCR1
H'00000020
Transfer source address: decremented
CHCR1
H'00002269
DMAOR
H'0001
Transfer destination address: (setting ineffective)
Transfer request source: external pin (DREQ1) edge
detection
Bus mode: burst
Transfer unit: word
No interrupt request generation at end of transfer
Channel priority ranking: 0 > 1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 189 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
9. Direct Memory Access Controller (DMAC)
9.5
Usage Notes
1. Other than the DMA operation register (DMAOR) accessing in word (16 bit) units, access all
registers in word (16 bit) or longword (32 bit) units.
2. When rewriting the RS0 to RS3 bits of CHCR0, CHCR1, first clear the DE bit to 0 (set the DE
bit to 0 before doing rewrites with a CHCR byte address).
3. When an NMI interrupt is input, the NMIF bit of the DMAOR is set even when the DMAC is
not operating.
4. Set the DME bit of the DMAOR to 0 and make certain that any DMAC received transfer
request processing has been completed before entering standby mode.
5. Do not access the DMAC or BSC on-chip peripheral modules from the DMAC.
6. When activating the DMAC, do the CHCR or DMAOR setting as the final step. There are
instances where abnormal operation will result if any other registers are established last.
7. After the DMATCR count becomes 0 and the DMA transfer ends normally, always write a 0 to
the DMATCR, even when executing the maximum number of transfers on the same channel.
There are instances where abnormal operation will result if this is not done.
8. When detecting external requests by falling edge, maintain the external request pin at high
level when performing the DMAC establishment.
9. When operating in single address mode, establish an external address as the address. There are
instances where abnormal operation will result if an internal address is established.
10. Do not access DMAC register empty addresses (H'FFFF86B2 to H'FFFF86BF, H'FFFF86E4 to
H'FFFF86FF). Operation cannot be guaranteed when empty addresses are accessed.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 190 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Section 10 Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.1
Overview
The SuperH microcomputer has an on-chip 16-bit multifunction timer pulse unit (MTU) with three
channels of 16-bit timers.
10.1.1
Features
• Can process a maximum of eight different pulse outputs and inputs.
• Has eight timer general registers (TGR): four for channel 0, and two each for channels 1 and 2
that can be set to function independently as output compare or input capture. The channel 0
TGRC and TGRD registers can be used as buffer registers.
• Can select eight counter input clock sources for all channels
• All channels can be set for the following operating modes:
⎯ Compare match waveform output: 0 output/1 output/toggle output selectable.
⎯ Input capture function: Selectable rising edge, falling edge, or both rising and falling edge
detection.
⎯ Counter clearing function: Counters can be cleared by a compare-match or input capture.
⎯ Synchronizing mode: Two or more timer counters (TCNT) can be written to
simultaneously. Two or more timer counters can be simultaneously cleared by a comparematch or input capture. Counter synchronization functions enable synchronized register
input/output.
⎯ PWM mode: PWM output can be provided with any duty cycle. When combined with the
counter synchronizing function, up to seven-phase PWM output is enabled (with channels
0 to 2 set to PWM mode 2 and channel 0 synchronized with the TGR0A register (channels
0 to 2 phase output: 3, 2, 2)).
• Channels 0 can be set for buffer operation
⎯ Input capture register double buffer configuration possible
⎯ Output compare register automatic re-write possible
• Channels 1, 2 can be independently set to the phase counting mode
⎯ Two-phase encoder pulse up/down count possible
• Cascade connection operation
⎯ Can be operated as a 32-bit counter by using the channel 2 input clock for channel 1
overflow/underflow
• High speed access via internal 16-bit bus
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 191 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
• Thirteen interrupt sources
⎯ Channel 0 has four compare-match/input capture interrupts and one overflow interrupt
which can be requested independently.
⎯ Channels 1 and 2 have two compare-match/input capture interrupts, one overflow interrupt,
and one underflow interrupt which can be requested independently.
• Automatic transfer of register data
⎯ Block transfer, 1-word data transfers and 1-byte data transfers are possible through DMAC
activation.
• A/D converter conversion start trigger can be generated
⎯ Channels 0 to 2 compare-match/input capture signals can be used as A/D converter
conversion start triggers.
Table 10.1 summarizes the MTU functions.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 192 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Table 10.1 MTU Functions
Item
Channel 0
Channel 1
Channel 2
Counter clocks
Internal: φ/1, φ/4, φ/16, φ/64, φ/256, φ/1024
External: Eight to each channel from TCLKA, TCLKB, TCLKC, and
TCLKD
General registers
TGR0A
TGR1A
TGR2A
TGR0B
TGR1B
TGR2B
General registers/buffer
registers
TGR0C
TGR0D
No
No
Input/output pins
TIOC0A
TIOC1A
TIOC2A
TIOC0B
TIOC1B
TIOC2B
TIOC0C
TIOC0D
Counter clear function
TGR compare-match TGR compare-match TGR compare-match
or input capture
or input capture
or input capture
Compare match
output
Yes
0
Yes
Yes
1
Yes
Yes
Yes
Toggle
Yes
Yes
Yes
Input capture function
Yes
Yes
Yes
Synchronization
Yes
Yes
Yes
Buffer operation
Yes
No
No
PWM mode 1
Yes
Yes
Yes
PWM mode 2
Yes
Yes
Yes
Phase counting mode
No
Yes
Yes
DMAC activation
TGR0A compare
match or input
capture
TGR1A compare
match or input
capture
TGR2A compare
match or input
capture
TGR1A com-pare
match or input
capture
TGR2A com-pare
match or input
capture
A/D conversion start trigger TGR0A com-pare
match or input
capture
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 193 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Item
Channel 0
Channel 1
Channel 2
Interrupt sources
Compare match/input Compare match/input Compare match/input
capture 0A
capture 1A
capture 2A
Compare match/input Compare match/input Compare match/input
capture 0B
capture 1B
capture 2B
Compare match/input Overflow
capture 0C
Overflow
Compare match/input Underflow
capture 0D
Underflow
Overflow
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 194 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
⎯
⎯
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.1.2
Block Diagram
TCNT
TGRA
TGRB
TCNT
TGRA
TGRB
Module data bus
BUS I/F
TSTR TSYR
Channel 2
TCR TMDR
TIOR
TIER TSR
TCNT
TGRA
TGRB
TGRC
TGRD
Channel 2:
TIOC2A
TIOC2B
Channel 1
TCR TMDR
TIOR
TIER TSR
Channel 1:
TIOC1A
TIOC1B
Channel 0
TCR TMDR
TIORH TIORL
TIER TSR
(I/O pins)
Channel 0:
TIOC0A
TIOC0B
TIOC0C
TIOC0D
Channels 0 to 2 control logic
External clock:
TCLKA
TCLKB
TCLKC
TCLKD
Shared
(Clock input)
Internal clock:
φ/1
φ/4
φ/16
φ/64
φ/256
φ/1024
Control logic
Figure 10.1 is the block diagram of the MTU.
Internal data bus
A/D conversion
start request signal
(Interrupt
request signal)
Channel 0:
TGI0A
TGI0B
TGI0C
TGI0D
TGI0V
Channel 1:
TGI1A
TGI1B
TGI1V
TGI1U
Channel 2:
TGI2A
TGI2B
TGI2V
TGI2U
Figure 10.1 MTU Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 195 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.1.3
Pin Configuration
Table 10.2 summarizes the MTU pins.
Table 10.2 Pin Configuration
Channel Name
Pin Name I/O Function
Shared
Clock input A
TCLKA
I
Clock A input pin (A-phase input pin in channel 1
phase counting mode)
Clock input B
TCLKB
I
Clock B input pin (B-phase input pin in channel 1
phase counting mode)
Clock input C
TCLKC
I
Clock C input pin (A-phase input pin in channel 2
phase counting mode)
Clock input D
TCLKD
I
Clock D input pin (B-phase input pin in channel 2
phase counting mode)
0
1
2
Input
TIOC0A
capture/output
compare-match 0A
I/O TGR0A input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOC0B
Input
capture/output
compare-match 0B
I/O TGR0B input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
Input
TIOC0C
capture/output
compare-match 0C
I/O TGR0C input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOC0D
Input
capture/output
compare-match 0D
I/O TGR0D input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
Input
TIOC1A
capture/output
compare-match 1A
I/O TGR1A input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOC1B
Input
capture/output
compare-match 1B
I/O TGR1B input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
Input
TIOC2A
capture/output
compare-match 2A
I/O TGR2A input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
TIOC2B
Input
capture/output
compare-match 2B
I/O TGR2B input capture input/output compare
output/PWM output pin
Note: The TIOC pins output undefined values when they are set to input capture and timer output
by the pin function controller (PFC).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 196 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.1.4
Register Configuration
Table 10.3 summarizes the MTU register configuration.
Table 10.3 Register Configuration
Channel Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial
Value
Address
Shared
Timer start register
TSTR
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF8240 8, 16, 32
Timer synchro register
TSYR
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF8241
Timer control register 0
TCR0
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF8260
Timer mode register 0
TMDR0
R/W
H'C0
H'FFFF8261
0
1
Access Size
1
(Bits) *
Timer I/O control register 0H TIOR0H
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF8262
Timer I/O control register 0L TIOR0L
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF8263
Timer interrupt enable
register 0
TIER0
R/W
H'40
H'FFFF8264
Timer status register 0
TSR0
R/(W)* H'C0
H'FFFF8265
Timer counter 0
TCNT0
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8266 16, 32
General register 0A
TGR0A
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF8268
2
General register 0B
TGR0B
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF826A
General register 0C
TGR0C
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF826C
General register 0D
TGR0D
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF826E
Timer control register 1
TCR1
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF8280 8, 16, 32
Timer mode register 1
TMDR1
R/W
H'C0
H'FFFF8281
Timer I/O control register 1
TIOR1
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF8282
Timer interrupt enable
register 1
TIER1
R/W
H'40
H'FFFF8284
Timer status register 1
TSR1
R/(W)* H'C0
H'FFFF8285
Timer counter 1
TCNT1
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8286 16, 32
General register 1A
TGR1A
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF8288
General register 1B
TGR1B
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF828A
2
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 197 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Channel Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial
Value
Address
2
Timer control register 2
TCR2
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF82A0 8, 16, 32
Timer mode register 2
TMDR2
R/W
H'C0
H'FFFF82A1
Timer I/O control register 2
TIOR2
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF82A2
Timer interrupt enable
register 2
TIER2
R/W
H'40
H'FFFF82A4
Timer status register 2
TSR2
R/(W)* H'C0
H'FFFF82A5
Timer counter 2
TCNT2
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF82A6 16, 32
General register 2A
TGR2A
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF82A8
General register 2B
TGR2B
R/W
H'FFFF
H'FFFF82AA
2
Notes: Do not access empty addresses.
1. 16-bit registers (TCNT, TGR) cannot be read or written in 8-bit units.
2. Write 0 to clear flags.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 198 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Access Size
1
(Bits) *
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.2
MTU Register Descriptions
10.2.1
Timer Control Register (TCR)
The TCR is an 8-bit read/write register for controlling the TCNT counter for each channel. The
MTU has three TCR registers, one for each of the channels 0 to 2. TCR is initialized to H'00 by a
power-on reset or the standby mode.
Channel 0: TCR0
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CCLR2
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1
CKEG0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1
CKEG0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial value:
R/W:
Channels 1, 2: TCR1, TCR2
Bit:
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 199 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 7 to 5⎯Counter Clear 2 to 0 (CCLR2 to CCLR0): Select the counter clear source for the
TCNT counter.
Channels 0
Bit 7
Bit 6
CCLR2 CCLR1
Bit 5
CCLR0
0
0
TCNT clear disabled
1
TCNT is cleared by TGRA compare-match or input capture
0
TCNT is cleared by TGRB compare-match or input capture
1
Synchronizing clear: TCNT is cleared in synchronization with clear of
1
other channel counters operating in sync.*
0
TCNT clear disabled
1
TCNT is cleared by TGRC compare-match or input capture*
0
TCNT is cleared by TGRD compare-match or input capture*
1
Synchronizing clear: TCNT is cleared in synchronization with clear of
1
other channel counters operating in sync*
0
1
1
0
1
Description
(initial value)
2
2
Notes: 1. Setting the SYNC bit of the TSYR to 1 sets the synchronization.
2. When TGRC or TGRD are functioning as buffer registers, TCNT is not cleared because
the buffer registers have priority and compare-match/input captures do not occur.
Channels 1, 2
Bit 7
Bit 6
1
Reserved* CCLR1
Bit 5
CCLR0
Description
0
0
TCNT clear disabled
1
TCNT is cleared by TGRA compare-match or input capture
0
TCNT is cleared by TGRB compare-match or input capture
1
Synchronizing clear: TCNT is cleared in synchronization with
2
clear of other channel counters operating in sync*
0
1
(initial value)
Notes: 1. The bit 7 of channels 1 and 2 is reserved. It always reads 0, and cannot be modified.
2. Setting the SYNC bit of the TSYR to 1 sets the synchronization.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 200 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 4 and 3⎯Clock Edge 1, 0 (CKEG1 and CKEG0): CKEG1 and CKEG0 select the input
clock edges. When counting is done on both edges of the internal clock the input clock frequency
becomes 1/2 (Example: both edges of φ/4 = rising edge of φ/2). When phase count mode is used
with channels 1, 2, these settings are ignored, as the phase count mode settings have priority.
Bit 4
Bit 3
CKEG1 CKEG0 Description
0
1
0
Count on rising edges
(initial value)
1
Count on falling edges
X
Count on both rising and falling edges
Notes: 1. X: 0 or 1, don't care.
2. Internal clock edge selection is effective when the input clock is φ/4 or slower. These
settings are ignored when φ/1, or the overflow/underflow of another channel is selected
for the input clock.
Bits 2 to 0⎯Timer Prescaler 2 to 0 (TPSC2 to TPSC0): TPSC2 to TPSC0 select the counter
clock source for the TCNT. An independent clock source can be selected for each channel. Table
10.4 shows the possible settings for each channel.
Table 10.4 MTU Clock Sources
Internal Clock
Channel
φ/1
φ/4
φ/
16
φ/
64
φ/
256
External Clock
Other Channel
Overflow/
TCL TCL TCL
φ/
KA
KB
KC
1024 Underflow
0
O
O
O
O
X
X
X
O
O
O
O
1
O
O
O
O
O
X
O
O
O
X
X
O
O
O
O
X
O
X
O
O
O
X
2
Note:
TCL
KD
Symbols:
O: Setting possible
X: Setting impossible
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 201 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Channel 0
Bit 2
Bit 1
TPSC2 TPSC1
Bit 0
TPSC0
Description
0
0
Internal clock: count with φ/1
1
Internal clock: count with φ/4
0
Internal clock: count with φ/16
1
Internal clock: count with φ/64
0
External clock: count with the TCLKA pin input
1
External clock: count with the TCLKB pin input
0
External clock: count with the TCLKC pin input
1
External clock: count with the TCLKD pin input
Bit 2
Bit 1
TPSC2 TPSC1
Bit 0
TPSC0
Description
0
0
Internal clock: count with φ/1
1
Internal clock: count with φ/4
1
0
Internal clock: count with φ/16
1
Internal clock: count with φ/64
0
0
External clock: count with the TCLKA pin input
1
External clock: count with the TCLKB pin input
0
Internal clock: count with φ/256
1
Count with the TCNT2 overflow/underflow
0
1
1
0
1
(initial value)
Channel 1
1
0
1
Note: These settings are ineffective when channel 1 is in phase counting mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 202 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Channel 2
Bit 2
Bit 1
TPSC2 TPSC1
Bit 0
TPSC0
Description
0
0
Internal clock: count with φ/1
1
Internal clock: count with φ/4
0
Internal clock: count with φ/16
1
Internal clock: count with φ/64
0
External clock: count with the TCLKA pin input
1
External clock: count with the TCLKB pin input
0
External clock: count with the TCLKC pin input
1
Internal clock: count with φ/1024
0
1
1
0
1
(initial value)
Note: These settings are ineffective when channel 2 is in phase counting mode.
10.2.2
Timer Mode Register (TMDR)
The TMDR is an 8-bit read/write register that sets the operating mode for each channel. The MTU
has three TMDR registers, one for each channel. TMDR is initialized to H'C0 by a power-on reset
or the standby mode.
Channel 0: TMDR0
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
BFB
BFA
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
Initial value:
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Channels 1, 2: TMDR1, TMDR2
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
Initial value:
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 203 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 7 and 6⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 1. The write value should always be 1.
Bit 5⎯Buffer Operation B (BFB): Designates whether to use the TGRB register for normal
operation, or buffer operation in combination with the TGRD register. When using TGRD as a
buffer register, no TGRD register input capture/output compares are generated.
This bit is reserved in channels 1 and 2, which have no TGRD registers. This bit always read as 0.
The write value should always be 0.
Bit 5
BFB
Description
0
TGRB operates normally
1
TGRB and TGRD buffer operation
(initial value)
Bit 4⎯Buffer Operation A (BFA): Designates whether to use the TGRA register for normal
operation, or buffer operation in combination with the TGRC register. When using TGRC as a
buffer register, no TGRC register input capture/output compares are generated.
This bit is reserved in channels 1 and 2, which have no TGRC registers. This bit always read as 0.
The write value should always be 0.
Bit 4
BFA
Description
0
TGRA operates normally
1
TGRA and TGRC buffer operation
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 204 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 3 to 0⎯Modes 3 to 0 (MD3 to MD0): These bits set the timer operation mode.
Bit 3
MD3
Bit 2
MD2
Bit 1
MD1
Bit 0
MD0
0
0
0
0
Normal operation
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
PWM mode 1
1
PWM mode 2
0
Phase counting mode 1*
1
Phase counting mode 2*
0
Phase counting mode 3*
1
Phase counting mode 4*
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Note:
10.2.3
*
Description
(initial value)
Phase measurement mode can not be set for channel 0.
Timer I/O Control Register (TIOR)
The TIOR is a register that controls the TGR. The MTU has four TIOR registers, two for channels
0 and one each for channels 1 and 2. TIOR is initialized to H'00 by a power-on reset or the standby
mode.
Channel 0: TIOR0H
Channels 1, 2: TIOR1, TIOR2
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 205 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 7 to 4⎯I/O Control B3 to B0 (IOB3 to IOB0): These bits set the TGRB register function.
Bits 3 to 0⎯I/O Control A3 to B0 (IOA3 to IOA0): These bits set the TGRA register function.
Channel 0: TIOR0L
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IOD3
IOD2
IOD1
IOD0
IOC3
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: When the TGRC or TGRD registers are set for buffer operation, these settings become
ineffective and the operation is as a buffer register.
Bits 7 to 4⎯I/O Control D3 to D0 (IOD3 to IOD0): These bits set the TGRD register function.
Bits 3 to 0⎯I/O Control C3 to C0 (IOC3 to IOC0): These bits set the TGRC register function.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 206 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Channel 0 (TIOR0H Register)
Bits 7 to 4⎯I/O Control B3 to B0 (IOB3 to IOB0): These bits set the TGR0B register function.
Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4
IOB3 IOB2 IOB1 IOB0 Description
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
TGR0B
is an output
compare
register
Output disabled
Initial output is 0
0
1
1
0
0
Toggle output on compare-match
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1
Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on compare-match
0
1
1
Output 0 on compare-match
Output 1 on compare-match
1
1
(initial value)
0
TGR0B
is an input
capture
register
Capture input source Input capture on rising edge
is the TIOC0B pin
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
Capture input source Input capture on TCNT1 count
is channel 1/
up/count down
count clock
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 207 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 3 to 0⎯I/O Control A3 to A0 (IOA3 to IOA0): These bits set the TGR0A register function.
Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0
IOA3 IOA2 IOA1 IOA0 Description
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
TGR0A
is an output
compare
register
Output disabled
Initial output is 0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
Toggle output on compare-match
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1
Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on compare-match
0
1
1
(initial value)
Output 0 on compare-match
0
Capture input source Input capture on rising edge
TGR0A
is the TIOC0A pin
is an input
Input capture on falling edge
capture register
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 208 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Capture input source Input capture on TCNT1 count
is channel 1/
up/count down
count clock
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Channel 0 (TIOR0L Register)
Bits 7 to 4⎯I/O Control D3 to D0 (IOD3 to IOD0): These bits set the TGR0D register function.
Bit 7
IOD3
Bit 6
IOD2
Bit 5
IOD1
Bit 4
IOD0 Description
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
Output disabled
TGR0D
is an output
Initial output is 0
compare
register
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
Output 0 on compare-match
Output 1 on compare-match
Toggle output on compare-match
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1
Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on compare-match
0
1
1
(initial value)
0
Capture input source Input capture on rising edge
TGR0D
is an input is the TIOC0D pin
Input capture on falling edge
capture
Input capture on both edges
register
1
1
0
0
1
1
Capture input source Input capture on TCNT1 count
is channel 1/
up/count down
count clock
0
1
Note: When the BFB bit of TMDR0 is set to 1 and TGR0D is being used as a buffer register, these
settings become ineffective and input capture/output compares do not occur.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 209 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 3 to 0⎯I/O Control C3 to C0 (IOC3 to IOC0): These bits set the TGR0C register function.
Bit 3
IOC3
Bit 2
IOC2
Bit 1
IOC1
0
0
0
Bit 0
IOC0
0
1
1
0
Description
Output disabled
TGR0C
is an output
Initial output is 0
compare
register
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
Output 1 on compare-match
Toggle output on compare-match
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1
Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on compare-match
0
1
1
(initial value)
Output 0 on compare-match
0
Capture input source Input capture on rising edge
TGR0C
is an input is the TIOC0C pin
Input capture on falling edge
capture
Input capture on both edges
register
1
1
0
0
1
1
Capture input source Input capture on TCNT1 count
is channel 1/
up/count down
count clock
0
1
Note: When the BFA bit of TMDR0 is set to 1 and TGR0C is being used as a buffer register, these
settings become ineffective and input capture/output compares do not occur.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 210 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Channel 1 (TIOR1 Register)
Bits 7 to 4⎯I/O Control B3 to B0 (IOB3 to IOB0): These bits set the TGR1B register function.
Bit 7
IOB3
Bit 6
IOB2
Bit 5
IOB1
Bit 4
IOB0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
Description
TGR1B
is an output
compare
register
Output disabled
Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
Output 1 on compare-match
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
Toggle output on compare-match
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on compare-match
0
1
1
(initial value)
0
TGR1B
is an input
capture
register
Capture input
source is the
TIOC1B pin
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
Capture input
Input capture on channel
source TGR0C 0/TGR0C compare-match/input
compare/match capture generation
input capture
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 211 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 3 to 0⎯I/O Control A3 to A0 (IOA3 to IOA0): These bits set the TGR1A register function.
Bit 3
IOA3
Bit 2
IOA2
Bit 1
IOA1
0
0
0
Bit 0
IOA0
0
1
1
0
Description
TGR1A
is an output
compare
register
Output disabled
Output 1 on compare-match
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
Toggle output on compare-match
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on compare-match
0
1
1
(initial value)
Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
0
TGR1A
is an input
capture
register
Capture input
source is the
TIOC1A pin
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 212 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Capture input
Input capture on channel
source is TGR0A 0/TGR0A compare-match/input
capture generation
comparematch/input
capture
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Channel 2 (TIOR2 Register)
Bits 7 to 4⎯I/O Control B3 to B0 (IOB3 to IOB0): These bits set the TGR2B register function.
Bit 7
IOB3
Bit 6
IOB2
Bit 5
IOB1
Bit 4
IOB0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
Description
TGR2B
is an output
compare
register
Output disabled
Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
Output 1 on compare-match
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
Toggle output on compare-match
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on compare-match
0
1
1
(initial value)
0
TGR2B
is an input
capture
register
Capture input
source is the
TIOC2B pin
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
1
0
Input capture on rising edge
1
Input capture on falling edge
0
Input capture on both edges
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 213 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 3 to 0⎯I/O Control A3 to A0 (IOA3 to IOA0): These bits set the TGR2A register function.
Bit 3
IOA3
Bit 2
IOA2
Bit 1
IOA1
0
0
0
Bit 0
IOA0
0
1
1
0
Description
Output disabled
TGR2A
is an output
compare
register
Output 1 on compare-match
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
Toggle output on compare-match
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on compare-match
0
1
1
(initial value)
Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
0
TGR2A
is an input
capture
register
Capture input
source is the
TIOC2A pin
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
1
0
Input capture on rising edge
1
Input capture on falling edge
0
Input capture on both edges
1
10.2.4
Timer Interrupt Enable Register (TIER)
The TIER is an 8-bit register that controls the enable/disable of interrupt requests for each channel.
The MTU has three TIER registers, one each for channel. TIER is initialized to H'40 by a reset or
by standby mode.
Channel 0: TIER0
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TTGE
⎯
⎯
TCIEV
TGIED
TGIEC
TGIEB
TGIEA
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 214 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Channels 1, 2: TIER1, TIER2
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TTGE
⎯
TCIEU
TCIEV
⎯
⎯
TGIEB
TGIEA
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
Bit 7⎯A/D Conversion Start Request Enable (TTGE): Enables or disables generation of an
A/D conversion start request by a TGRA register input capture/compare-match.
Bit 7
TTGE
Description
0
Disable A/D conversion start requests
1
Enable A/D conversion start request generation
(initial value)
Bit 6⎯Reserved: This bit always read as 1. The write value should always be 1.
Bit 5⎯Underflow Interrupt Enable (TCIEU): Enables or disables interrupt requests when the
underflow flag (TCFU) of the channel 1, 2 timer status register (TSR) is set to 1.
This bit is reserved for channel 0. It always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 5
TCIEU
Description
0
Disable UDF interrupt requests (TCIU)
1
Enable UDF interrupt requests (TCIU)
(initial value)
Bit 4⎯Overflow Interrupt Enable (TCIEV): Enables or disables interrupt requests when the
overflow flag TCFV of the timer status register (TSR) is set to 1.
Bit 4
TCIEV
Description
0
Disable TCFV interrupt requests (TCIV)
1
Enable TCFV interrupt requests (TCIV)
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 215 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bit 3⎯TGR Interrupt Enable D (TGIED): Enables or disables interrupt TGFD requests when
the TGFD bit of the channel 0 TSR register is set to 1.
This bit is reserved for channels 1 and 2. It always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 3
TGIED
Description
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGID) due to the TGFD bit
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGID) due to the TGFD bit
(initial value)
Bit 2⎯TGR Interrupt Enable C (TGIEC): Enables or disables TGFC interrupt requests when
the TGFC bit of the Channel 0 TSR register is set to 1.
This bit is reserved for channels 1 and 2. It always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 2
TGIEC
Description
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGIC) due to the TGFC bit
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIC) due to the TGFC bit
(initial value)
Bit 1⎯TGR Interrupt Enable B (TGIEB): Enables or disables TGFB interrupt requests when
the TGFB bit of the TSR register is set to 1.
Bit 1
TGIEB
Description
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGIB) due to the TGFB bit
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIB) due to the TGFB bit
(initial value)
Bit 0⎯TGR Interrupt Enable A (TGIEA): Enables or disables TGFA interrupt requests when
the TGFA bit of the TSR register is set to 1.
Bit 0
TGIEA
Description
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGIA) due to the TGFA bit
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIA) due to the TGFA bit
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 216 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.2.5
Timer Status Register (TSR)
The timer status register (TSR) is an 8-bit register that indicates the status of each channel. The
MTU has three TSR registers, one each for channel. TSR is initialized to H'C0 by a power-on reset
or by standby mode.
Channel 0: TSR0
Bit:
Note:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
TCFV
TGFD
TGFC
TGFB
TGFA
Initial value:
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
*
Only 0 writes to clear the flags are possible.
Channels 1, 2: TSR1, TSR2
Bit:
Note:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TCFD
⎯
TCFU
TCFV
⎯
⎯
TGFB
TGFA
Initial value:
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R
R
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
*
Only 0 writes to clear the flags are possible.
Bit 7⎯Count Direction Flag (TCFD): This status flag indicates the count direction of the
channel 1, 2 TCNT counters.
This bit is reserved in channel 0. This bit always reads as 1. The write value should always be 1.
Bit 7
TCFD
Description
0
TCNT counts down
1
TCNT counts up
(initial value)
Bit 6⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 1. The write value should always be 1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 217 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bit 5⎯Underflow Flag (TCFU): This status flag indicates the occurrence of a channel 1, 2
TCNT counter underflow.
This bit is reserved in channel 0. This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 5
TCFU
Description
0
Clear condition: With TCFU = 1, a 0 write to TCFU after reading it
(initial value)
1
Set condition: When the TCNT value underflows (H'0000 → H'FFFF)
Bit 4⎯Overflow Flag (TCFV): This status flag indicates the occurrence of a TCNT counter
overflow.
Bit 4
TCFV
Description
0
Clear condition: With TCFV = 1, a 0 write to TCFV after reading it
(initial value)
1
Set condition: When the TCNT value overflows (H'FFFF → H'0000)
Bit 3⎯Input Capture/Output Compare Flag D (TGFD): This status flag indicates the
occurrence of a channel 0 TGRD register input capture or compare-match.
This bit is reserved in channels 1 and 2. It always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 3
TGFD
Description
0
Clear condition: With TGFD = 1, a 0 write to TGFD following a read
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
•
When TGRD is functioning as an output compare register
(TCNT = TGRD)
•
When TGRD is functioning as input capture (the TCNT value is sent
to TGRD by the input capture signal)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 218 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bit 2⎯Input Capture/Output Compare Flag C (TGFC): This status flag indicates the
occurrence of a Channel 0 TGRC register input capture or compare-match.
This bit is reserved for channels 1 and 2. It always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 2
TGFC
Description
0
Clear condition:
With TGFC = 1, a 0 write to TGFC following a read
1
(initial value)
Set conditions:
•
When TGRC is functioning as an output compare register
(TCNT = TGRC)
•
When TGRC is functioning as input capture (the TCNT value is sent
to TGRC by the input capture signal)
Bit 1⎯Input Capture/Output Compare Flag B (TGFB): This status flag indicates the
occurrence of a TGRB register input capture or compare-match.
Bit 1
TGFB
Description
0
Clear condition: With TGFB = 1, a 0 write to TGFB following a read
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
•
When TGRB is functioning as an output compare register
(TCNT = TGRB)
•
When TGRB is functioning as input capture (the TCNT value is sent
to TGRB by the input capture signal)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 219 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bit 0⎯Input Capture/Output Compare Flag A (TGFA): This status flag indicates the
occurrence of a TGRA register input capture or compare-match.
Bit 0
TGFA
Description
0
Clear condition: With TGFA = 1, a 0 write to TGFA following a read
(Cleared by DMAC transfer due to TGFA)
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
10.2.6
•
When TGRA is functioning as an output compare register
(TCNT = TGRA)
•
When TGRA is functioning as input capture (the TCNT value is sent
to TGRA by the input capture signal)
Timer Counters (TCNT)
The timer counters (TCNT) are 16-bit counters, with one for each channel, for a total of three.
The TCNT are initialized to H'0000 by a power-on reset and when in standby mode. Accessing the
TCNT counters in 8-bit units is prohibited. Always access in 16-bit units.
Channel Abbreviation
Function
0
TCNT0
Increment counter
1
TCNT1
Increment/decrement counter*
TCNT2
Increment/decrement counter*
2
Note:
*
Can only be used as an increment/decrement counter in phase counting mode, with
other channel overflow/underflow counting. It becomes an increment counter in all other
cases.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 220 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.2.7
Timer General Register (TGR)
Each timer general register (TGR) is a 16-bit register that can function as either an output compare
register or an input capture register. There are a total of eight TGR, four for channel 0, and two
each for channels 1 and 2. The TGRC and TGRD of channel 0 can be set to operate as buffer
registers. The TGR register and buffer register combinations are TGRA with TGRC, and TGRB
with TGRD.
The TGRs are initialized to H'FFFF by a power-on reset or in standby mode. Accessing of the
TGRs in 8-bit units is disabled; they may only be accessed in 16-bit units.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Initial value:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
R/W:
10.2.8
Timer Start Register (TSTR)
The timer start register (TSTR) is an 8-bit read/write register that starts and stops the timer
counters (TCNT) of channels 0 to 2. TSTR is initialized to H'00 upon power-on reset or standby
mode.
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
CST2
CST1
CST0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 221 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 2 to 0⎯Counter Start 4 to 0 (CST4 to CST0): Select the start and stop of the timer counters
(TCNT). The counter start to channel and bit to channel correspondence are indicated in the tables
below.
Counter Start
Channel
CST2
Channel 2 (TCNT2)
CST1
Channel 1 (TCNT1)
CST0
Channel 0 (TCNT0)
Bit n
CSTn
Description
0
TCNTn count is halted
1
TCNTn counts
(initial value)
Note: n = 2 to 0.
If 0 is written to the CST bit during operation with the TIOC pin in output status, the counter
stops, but the TIOC pin output compare output level is maintained. If a write is done to the
TIOR register while the CST bit is a 0, the pin output level is updated to the established
initial output value.
Bits 7 to 3⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
10.2.9
Timer Synchro Register (TSYR)
The timer synchro register (TSYR) is an 8-bit read/write register that selects independent or
synchronous TCNT counter operation for channels 0 to 2. Channels for which 1 is set in the
corresponding bit will be synchronized. TSYR is initialized to H'00 upon power-on reset or
standby mode.
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
SYNC2
SYNC1
SYNC0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 222 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Bits 2 to 0⎯Timer Synchronization 2 to 0 (SYNC2 to SYNC0): Selects operation independent
of, or synchronized to, other channels. Synchronous operation allows synchronous clears due to
multiple TCNT synchronous presets and other channel counter clears. A minimum of two
channels must have SYNC bits set to 1 for synchronous operation. For synchronization clearing, it
is necessary to set the TCNT counter clear sources (the CCLR2 to CCLR0 bits of the TCR
register), in addition to the SYNC bit. The counter start to channel and bit-to-channel
correspondence are indicated in the tables below.
Counter Start
Channel
SYNC2
Channel 2 (TCNT2)
SYNC1
Channel 1 (TCNT1)
SYNC0
Channel 0 (TCNT0)
Bit n
SYNCn
Description
0
Timer counter (TCNTn) independent operation
(initial value)
(TCNTn preset/clear unrelated to other channels)
1
Timer counter synchronous operation*
1
2
TCNTn synchronous preset/ synchronous clear* possible
Notes: n = 2 to 0.
1. Minimum of two channel SYNC bits must be set to 1 for synchronous operation.
2. TCNT counter clear sources (CCLR2 to CCLR0 bits of the TCR register) must be set in
addition to the SYNC bit in order to have clear synchronization.
Bits 7 to 3⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 223 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.3
Bus Master Interface
10.3.1
16-Bit Registers
The timer counters (TCNT) and general registers (TGR) are 16-bit registers. A 16-bit data bus to
the bus master enables 16-bit read/writes. 8-bit read/write is not possible. Always access in 16-bit
units. Figure 10.2 shows an example of 16-bit register access operation.
Internal data bus
Upper 8 bits
Module data bus
Bus
interface
Bus master
Lower 8 bits
TCNTH
TCNTL
Figure 10.2 16-Bit Register Access Operation (Bus Master ↔ TCNT (16 Bit))
10.3.2
8-Bit Registers
All registers other than the TCNT and general registers (TGR) are 8-bit registers. These are
connected to the CPU by a 16-bit data bus, so 16-bit read/writes and as 8-bit read/writes are both
possible (figures 10.3 to 10.5).
Internal data bus
Upper 8 bits
Module data bus
Bus
interface
Bus master
Lower 8 bits
TCR
Figure 10.3 8-Bit Register Access Operation (Bus Master ↔ TCR (Upper 8 Bits))
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 224 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Internal data bus
Upper 8 bits
Module data bus
Bus
interface
Bus master
Lower 8 bits
TMDR
Figure 10.4 8-Bit Register Access Operation (Bus Master ↔ TMDR (Lower 8 Bits))
Internal data bus
Upper 8 bits
Module data bus
Bus
interface
Bus master
Lower 8 bits
TCR
TMDR
Figure 10.5 8-Bit Register Access Operation (Bus Master ↔ TCR, TMDR (16 Bit))
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 225 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.4
Operation
10.4.1
Overview
The operation modes are described below.
Ordinary Operation: Each channel has a timer counter (TCNT) and general register (TGR). The
TCNT is an upcounter and can also operate as a free-running counter, periodic counter or external
event counter. General registers (TGR) can be used as output compare registers or input capture
registers.
Synchronized Operation: The TCNT of a channel set for synchronized operation does a
synchronized preset. When any TCNT of a channel operating in the synchronized mode is
rewritten, the TCNTs of other channels are simultaneously rewritten as well. The timer
synchronization bits of the TSYR registers of multiple channels set for synchronous operation can
be set to clear the TCNTs simultaneously.
Buffer Operation: When TGR is an output compare register, the buffer register value of the
corresponding channel is transferred to the TGR when a compare-match occurs. When TGR is an
input capture register, the TCNT counter value is transferred to the TGR when an input capture
occur simultaneously the value previously stored in the TGR is transferred to the buffer register.
Cascade Connection Operation: The channel 1 and channel 2 counters (TCNT1 and TCNT2)
can be connected together to operate as a 32-bit counter.
PWM Mode: In PWM mode, a PWM waveform is output. The output level can be set by the
TIOR register. Each TGR can be set for PWM waveform output with a duty cycle between 0%
and 100%.
Phase Counting Mode: In phase counting mode, the phase differential between two clocks input
from the channel 1 and channel 2 external clock input pins is detected and the TCNT counter
operates as an up/down counter. In phase counting mode, the corresponding TCLK pins become
clock inputs and TCNT functions as an up/down counter. It can be used as a two-phase encoder
pulse input.
10.4.2
Basic Functions
Always select MTU external pin set function using the pin function controller (PFC).
Counter Operation: When a start bit (CST0 to CST2) in the timer start register (TSTR) is set to
1, the corresponding timer counter (TCNT) starts counting. There are two counting modes: a freerunning mode and a periodic mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 226 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
To select the counting operation (figure 10.6):
1. Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in the TCR to select the counter clock. At the same time, set bits
CKEG1 and CKEG0 in the TCR to select the desired edge of the input clock.
2. To operate as a periodic counter, set the CCLR2 to CCLR0 bits in the TCR to select TGR as a
clearing source for the TCNT.
3. Set the TGR selected in step 2 as an output compare register using the timer I/O control
register (TIOR).
4. Write the desired cycle value in the TGR selected in step 2.
5. Set the CST bit in the TSTR to 1 to start counting.
Counting mode selection
Select counter clock
1
Free-running counter
Periodic counter
Select counter
clear source
2
Select output
compare register
3
Set period
4
Start counting
5
Periodic counter
Start counting
5
Free-running counter
Figure 10.6 Procedure for Selecting the Counting Operation
Free-Running Counter Operation Example: A reset of the MTU timer counters (TCNT) leaves
them all in the free-running mode. When a bit in the TSTR is set to 1, the corresponding timer
counter operates as a free-running counter and begins to increment. When the count overflows
from H'FFFF to H'0000, the TCFV bit in the timer status register (TSR) is set to 1. If the TCIEV
bit in the timer's corresponding timer interrupt enable register (TIER) is set to 1, the MTU will
make an interrupt request to the interrupt controller. After the TCNT overflows, counting
continues from H'0000. Figure 10.7 shows an example of free-running counter operation.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 227 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
TCNT value
H'FFFF
H'0000
Time
CST bit
TCFV
Figure 10.7 Free-Running Counter Operation
Periodic Counter Operation Example: Periodic counter operation is obtained for a given
channel's TCNT by selecting compare-match as a TCNT clear source. Set the TGR register for
period setting to output compare register and select counter clear upon compare-match using the
CCLR2 to CCLR0 bits of the timer control register (TCR). After these settings, the TCNT begins
incrementing as a periodic counter when the corresponding bit of TSTR is set to 1. When the
count matches the TGR register value, the TGF bit in the TSR is set to 1 and the counter is cleared
to H'0000. If the TGIE bit of the corresponding TIER is set to 1 at this point, the MTU will make
an interrupt request to the interrupt controller. After the compare-match, TCNT continues counting
from H'0000. Figure 10.8 shows an example of periodic counting.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by
TGR compare match
TGR
H'0000
Time
CST bit
Flag cleared by software
or DMAC activation
TGF
Figure 10.8 Periodic Counter Operation
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 228 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Compare-Match Waveform Output Function: The MTU can output 0 level, 1 level, or toggle
output from the corresponding output pins upon compare-matches.
Procedure for selecting the compare-match waveform output operation (figure 10.9):
1. Set the TIOR to select 0 output or 1 output for the initial value, and 0 output, 1 output, or
toggle output for compare-match output. The TIOC pin will output the set initial value until the
first compare-match occurs.
2. Set a value in the TGR to select the compare-match timing.
3. Set the CST bit in the TSTR to 1 to start counting.
Output selection
Select waveform
output mode
1
Select
output timing
2
Start counting
3
Figure 10.9 Procedure for Selecting Compare Match Waveform Output Operation
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 229 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Waveform Output Operation (0 Output/1 Output): Figure 10.10 shows 0 output/1 output. In
the example, TCNT is a free-running counter, 1 is output upon compare-match A and 0 is output
upon compare-match B. When the pin level matches the set level, the pin level does not change.
TCNT value
H'FFFF
TGRA
TGRB
H'0000
Time
TIOCA
Does not change
Does not change
TIOCB
1 output
0 output
Does not change
Does not change
Figure 10.10 Example of 0 Output/1 Output
Waveform Output Operation (Toggle Output): Figure 10.11 shows the toggle output. In the
example, the TCNT operates as a periodic counter cleared by compare-match B, with toggle
output at both compare-match A and compare-match B.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by TGRB compare match
H'FFFF
TGRB
TGRA
H'0000
Time
TIOCA
Toggle
output
TIOCB
Toggle
output
Figure 10.11 Example of Toggle Output
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 230 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Input Capture Function: In the input capture mode, the TCNT value is transferred into the TGR
register when the input edge is detected at the input capture/output compare pin (TIOC).
Detection can take place on the rising edge, falling edge, or both edges. Channels 0 and 1 can use
other channel counter input clocks or compare-match signals as input capture sources.
The procedure for selecting the input capture operation (figure 10.12) is:
1. Set the TIOR to select the input capture function of the TGR, then select the input capture
source, and rising edge, falling edge, or both edges as the input edge.
2. Set the CST bit in the TSTR to 1 to start the TCNT counting.
Input selection
Select input-capture input
1
Start counting
2
Input capture operation
Figure 10.12 Procedure for Selecting Input Capture Operation
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 231 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Input Capture Operation: Figure 10.13 shows input capture. The falling edge of TIOCB and
both edges of TIOCA are selected as input capture input edges. In the example, TCNT is set to
clear at the input capture of the TGRB register.
Counter cleared
by TIOCB input
(falling edge)
TCNT value
H'0180
H'0160
H'0010
H'0005
H'0000
Time
TIOCA
TGRA
H'0005
H'0160
H'0010
TIOCB
TGRB
H'0180
Figure 10.13 Input Capture Operation
10.4.3
Synchronous Operation
In the synchronizing mode, two or more timer counters can be rewritten simultaneously
(synchronized preset). Multiple timer counters can also be cleared simultaneously using TCR
settings (synchronized clear).
The synchronizing mode can increase the number of TGR registers for a single time base. All
three channels can be set for synchronous operation.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 232 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Procedure for Selecting the Synchronizing Mode (Figure 10.14):
1. Set 1 in the SYNC bit of the timer synchro register (TSYR) to use the corresponding channel
in the synchronizing mode.
2. When a value is written in the TCNT in any of the synchronized channels, the same value is
simultaneously written in the TCNT in the other channels.
3. Set the counter to clear with output compare/input capture using bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the
TCR.
4. Set the counter clear source to synchronized clear using the CCLR2 to CCLR0 bits of the
TCR.
5. Set the CST bits for the corresponding channels in the TSTR to 1 to start counting in the
TCNT.
Select
synchronizing mode
Set synchronizing
mode
1
Synchronized preset
Set TCNT
Synchronized preset
Synchronized clear
2
Channel that
generated clear
source?
No
Yes
Select counter
clear source
3
Set counter
synchronous clear
4
Start counting
5
Start counting
5
Counter clear
Synchronized clear
Figure 10.14 Procedure for Selecting Synchronizing Operation
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 233 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Synchronized Operation: Figure 10.15 shows an example of synchronized operation. Channels
0, 1, and 2 are set to synchronized operation and PWM mode 1. Channel 0 is set for a counter
clear upon compare-match with TGR0B. Channels 1 and 2 are set for synchronous counter clears
by synchronous presets and TGR0B register compare-matches. Accordingly, a three-phase PWM
waveform with the data set in the TGR0B register as its PWM period is output from the TIOC0A,
TIOC1A, and TIOC2A pins.
See section 10.4.6, PWM Mode, for details on the PWM mode.
TCNT0 to TCNT2
values
Synchronized clear on TGR0B compare match
TGR0B
TGR1B
TGR0A
TGR2B
TGR1A
TGR2A
H'0000
Time
TIOC0A
TIOC1A
TIOC2A
Figure 10.15 Synchronized Operation Example
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 234 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.4.4
Buffer Operation
Buffer operation is a function of channels 0, 3, and 4. TGRC and TGRD can be used as buffer
registers. Table 10.5 shows the register combinations for buffer operation.
Table 10.5 Register Combinations
Channel
General Register
Buffer Register
0
TGR0A
TGR0C
TGR0B
TGR0D
The buffer operation differs, depending on whether the TGR has been set as an input capture
register or an output compare register.
When TGR Is an Output Compare Register: When a compare-match occurs, the corresponding
channel buffer register value is transferred to the general register. Figure 10.16 shows an example.
Compare match signal
Buffer
register
General
register
Comparator
TCNT
Figure 10.16 Compare Match Buffer Operation
When TGR Is an Input Capture Register: When an input capture occurs, the timer counter
(TCNT) value is transferred to the general register (TGR), and the value that had been held up to
that time in the TGR is transferred to the buffer register (figure 10.17).
Input capture signal
Buffer
register
General
register
TCNT
Figure 10.17 Input Capture Buffer Operation
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 235 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Procedure for Setting Buffer Mode (Figure 10.18):
1. Use the timer I/O control register (TIOR) to set the TGR as either an input capture or output
compare register.
2. Use the timer mode register (TMDR) BFA, and BFB bits to set the TGR for buffer mode.
3. Set the CST bit in the TSTR to 1 to start the count operation.
Buffer mode
Select TGR function
1
Select buffer mode
2
Start counting
3
Buffer mode
Figure 10.18 Buffer Operation Setting Procedure
Buffer Operation Examples⎯when TGR Is an Output Compare Register: Figure 10.19
shows an example of channel 0 set to PWM mode 1, and the TGRA and TGRC registers set for
buffer operation.
The TCNT counter is cleared by a compare-match B, and the output is a 1 upon compare-match A
and 0 output upon compare-match B. Because buffer mode is selected, a compare-match A
changes the output, and the buffer register TGRC value is simultaneously transferred to the
general register TGRA. This operation is repeated with each occurrence of a compare-match A.
See section 10.4.6, PWM Mode, for details on the PWM mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 236 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
TCNT value
TGR0B
H'0520
H'0450
H'0200
TGR0A
H'0000
Time
H'0450
H'0200
TGR0C
Transfer
TGR0A
H'0200
H'0520
H'0450
TIOC0A
Figure 10.19 Buffer Operation Example (Output Compare Register)
Buffer Operation Examples⎯when TGR Is an Input Capture Register: Figure 10.20 shows
an example of TGRA set as an input capture register with the TGRA and TGRC registers set for
buffer operation.
The TCNT counter is cleared by a TGRA register input capture, and the TIOCA pin input capture
input edge is selected as both rising and falling edge. Because buffer mode is selected, an input
capture A causes the TCNT counter value to be stored in the TGRA register, and the value that
was stored in the TGRA up until that time is simultaneously transferred to the TGRC register.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 237 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
TCNT value
H'0F07
H'09FB
H'0532
H'0000
Time
TIOC0A
H'0532
TGRA
TGRC
H'0F07
H'09FB
H'0532
H'0F07
Figure 10.20 Buffer Operation Example (Input Capture Register)
10.4.5
Cascade Connection Mode
Cascade connection mode is a function that connects the 16-bit counters of two channels together
to act as a 32-bit counter.
This function operates by using the TPSC2 to TPSC0 bits of the TCR register to set the channel 1
counter clock to count by TCNT2 counter overflow/underflow.
Note: When channel 1 is set to phase counting mode, the counter clock settings become
ineffective.
Table 10.6 shows the cascade connection combinations.
Table 10.6 Cascade Connection Combinations
Combination
Upper 16 Bits
Lower 16 Bits
Channel 1, channel 2
TCNT1
TCNT2
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 238 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Procedure for Setting Cascade Connection Mode (Figure 10.21):
1. Set the TPSC2 to TPSC 0 bits of the channel 1 timer control register (TCR) to B'111 to select
“count by TCNT2 overflow/underflow.”
2. Set the CST bits corresponding to the upper and lower 16 bits in the TSTR to 1 to start the
count operation.
Cascade connection operation
Select cascade connection
1
Start counting
2
Cascade connection operation
Figure 10.21 Procedure for Selecting Cascade Connection Mode
Cascade Connection Operation Examples⎯Phase Counting Mode: Figure 10.22 shows an
example of operation when the TCNT1 counter is set to count on TCNT2 overflow/underflow and
channel 2 is set to phase counting mode.
The TCNT1 counter increments with a TCNT2 counter overflow and decrements with a TCNT2
underflow.
TCLKA
TCLKB
TCNT2
TCNT1
FFFD FFFE FFFF 0000
0000
0001
0002
0001
0001
0000
FFFF
0000
Figure 10.22 Cascade Connection Operation Example (Phase Counting Mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 239 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.4.6
PWM Mode
PWM mode outputs the various PWM waveforms from output pins. Output levels of 0 output, 1
output, or toggle output can be selected as the output level for the compare-match of each TGR.
A period can be set for a register by using the TGR compare-match as a counter clear source. All
channels can be independently set to PWM mode. Synchronous operation is also possible.
There are two PWM modes:
• PWM mode 1
Generates PWM output using the TGRA and TGRB registers, and TGRC and TGRD registers
as pairs. The initial output values are those established in the TGRA and TGRC registers.
When the values set in TGR registers being used as a pair are equal, output values will not
change even if a compare-match occurs.
A maximum of four-phase PWM output is possible for PWM mode 1.
• PWM mode 2
Generates PWM output using one TGR register as a period register and another as a duty cycle
register. The output value of each pin upon a counter clear is the initial value established by the
TIOR register. When the values set in the period register and duty register are equal, output
values will not change even if a compare-match occurs.
Table 10.7 lists the combinations of PWM output pins and registers.
Table 10.7 Combinations of PWM Output Pins and Registers
Output Pin
Channel
Register
PWM Mode 1
PWM Mode 2
0 (AB pair)
TGR0A
TGR0B
TIOC0A
TIOC 0A
TIOC 0B
0 (CD pair)
TGR0C
TGR0D
TIOC0C
TIOC 0C
TIOC 0D
1
TGR1A
TGR1B
TIOC1A
TIOC 1A
TIOC 1B
2
TGR2A
TGR2B
TIOC2A
TIOC 2A
TIOC 2B
Note: PWM output of the period setting TGR is not possible in PWM mode 2.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 240 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Procedure for Selecting the PWM Mode (Figure 10.23):
1. Set bits TPSC2 to TPSC0 in the TCR to select the counter clock source. At the same time, set
bits CKEG1 and CKEG0 in the TCR to select the desired edge of the input clock.
2. Set bits CCLR2 to CCLR0 in the TCR to select the TGR to be used as a counter clear source.
3. Set the period in the TGR selected in step 2, and the duty cycle in another TGR.
4. Using the timer I/O control register (TIOR), set the TGR selected in step 3 to act as an output
compare register, and select the initial value and output value.
5. Set the MD3 to MD 0 bits in TMDR to select the PWM mode.
6. Set the CST bit in the TSTR to 1 to let the TCNT start counting.
PWM mode
Select counter clock
1
Select counter clear source
2
Select waveform output level
3
Set TGR
4
Select PWM mode
5
Start counting
6
PWM mode
Figure 10.23 Procedure for Selecting the PWM Mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 241 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
PWM Mode Operation Examples⎯PWM Mode 1 (Figure 10.24): A TGRA register comparematch is used as a TCNT counter clear source, the TGRA register initial output value and output
compare output value are both 0, and the TGRB register output compare output value is a 1. In
this example, the value established in the TGRA register becomes the period and the value
established in the TGRB register becomes the duty cycle.
TCNT value
Counter cleared by TGRA compare match
TGRA
TGRB
Time
H'0000
TIOCA
Figure 10.24 PWM Mode Operation Example (Mode 1)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 242 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
PWM Mode Operation Examples⎯PWM Mode 2 (Figure 10.25): Channels 0 and 1 are set for
synchronous operation, TGR1B register compare-match is used as a TCNT counter clear source,
the other TGR register initial output value is 0 and output compare output value is 1, and a 5-phase
PWM waveform is output. In this example, the value established in the TGR1B register becomes
the period and the value established in the other TGR register becomes the duty cycle.
TCNT value
Counter cleared on TGR1B compare match
TGR1B
TGR1A
TGR0D
TGR0C
TGR0B
TGR0A
H'0000
Time
TIOC0A
TIOC0B
TIOC0C
TIOC0D
TIOC1A
Figure 10.25 PWM Mode Operation Example (Mode 2)
0% Duty Cycle: Figure 10.26 shows an example of a 0% duty cycle PWM waveform output in
PWM mode.
TCNT value
TGRB rewrite
TGRA
TGRB
TGRB rewrite
TGRB rewrite
Time
TIOCA
0% duty cycle
Figure 10.26 PWM Mode Operation Example (0% Duty Cycle)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 243 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
100% Duty Cycle: Figure 10.27 shows an example of a 100% duty cycle PWM waveform output
in PWM mode.
In PWM mode, when setting cycle = duty cycle the output waveform does not change, nor is there
a change of waveform for the first pulse immediately after clearing the counter.
TCNT value
TGRA
TGRB rewrite
Output does not change if period register and duty
cycle register compare matches occur simultaneously
TGRB rewrite
TGRB
TGRB rewrite
Time
TIOCA
100% duty cycle
TCNT value
TGRA
Output does not change if period register and duty
cycle register compare matches occur simultaneously
TGRB rewrite
TGRB rewrite
TGRB
TGRB rewrite
Time
TIOCA
100% duty cycle
0% duty cycle
Figure 10.27 PWM Mode Operation Example (100% Duty Cycle)
10.4.7
Phase Counting Mode
The phase counting mode detects the phase differential of two external clock inputs and counts the
TCNT counter up or down. This mode can be set for channels 1 and 2.
When set in the phase counting mode, an external clock is selected for the counter input clock,
regardless of the settings of the TPSC2 to TPSC0 bits of TCR or the CKEG1 and CKEG0 bits.
TCNT also becomes an up/down counter. Since the TCR CCLR1/CCLR0 bits, TIOR, TIER, and
TGR functions are all enabled, input capture and compare-match functions and interrupt sources
can be used.
When the TCNT counter is incrementing, an overflow sets the TSR register TCFV (overflow
flag). When it is decrementing, an underflow sets the TCFU (underflow flag).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 244 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
The TSR register TCFD bit is a count direction flag. Read the TCFD flag to confirm whether the
TCNT is incrementing or decrementing.
Table 10.8 shows the correspondence between channels and external clock pins.
Table 10.8 Phase Counting Mode Clock Input Pins
Channel
A Phase Input Pin
B Phase Input Pin
1
TCLKA
TCLKB
2
TCLKC
TCLKD
Procedure for Selecting the Phase Counting Mode (Figure 10.28):
1. Set the MD3 to MD0 bits of the timer mode register (TMDR) to select the phase counting
mode.
2. Set the CST bit of the timer start register (TSTR) to 1 to start the count.
Phase counting mode
Select phase counting mode
1
Start counting
2
Phase counting mode
Figure 10.28 Procedure for Selecting the Phase Counting Mode
Phase Counting Operation Examples: The phase counting mode uses the phase difference
between two external clocks to increment/decrement the TCNT counter. There are 4 modes,
depending on the count conditions.
Phase Counting Mode 1: Figure 10.29 shows an example of phase counting mode 1 operation.
Table 10.9 lists the up counting and down counting conditions for the TCNT.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 245 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
TCLKA (channel 1)
TCLKC (channel 2)
TCLKB (channel 1)
TCLKD (channel 2)
TCNT value
Increment
Decrement
Time
Figure 10.29 Phase Counting Mode 1 Operation
Table 10.9 Phase Count Mode 1 Up/Down Counting Conditions
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
Operation
1 (high level)
Rising edge
Increment
0 (low level)
Falling edge
Rising edge
0 (low level)
Falling edge
1 (high level)
1 (high level)
Falling edge
0 (low level)
Rising edge
Rising edge
1 (high level)
Falling edge
0 (low level)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 246 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Decrement
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Phase Count Mode 2: Figure 10.30 shows an example of phase counting mode 2 operation. Table
10.10 lists the up counting and down counting conditions for the TCNT.
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
TCNT value
Increment
Decrement
Time
Figure 10.30 Phase Counting Mode 2 Operation
Table 10.10 Phase Count Mode 2 Up/Down Counting Conditions
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
Operation
1 (high level)
Rising edge
Does not count (don't care)
0 (low level)
Falling edge
Rising edge
0 (low level)
Falling edge
1 (high level)
Increment
1 (high level)
Falling edge
Does not count (don't care)
0 (low level)
Rising edge
Rising edge
1 (high level)
Falling edge
0 (low level)
Decrement
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 247 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Phase Count Mode 3: Figure 10.31 shows an example of phase counting mode 3 operation. Table
10.11 lists the up counting and down counting conditions for the TCNT.
TCLKA (channel 1)
TCLKC (channel 2)
TCLKB (channel 1)
TCLKD (channel 2)
TCNT value
Increment
Decrement
Time
Figure 10.31 Phase Counting Mode 3 Operation
Table 10.11 Phase Count Mode 3 Up/Down Counting Conditions
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
Operation
1 (high level)
Rising edge
Does not count (don't care)
0 (low level)
Falling edge
Rising edge
0 (low level)
Falling edge
1 (high level)
1 (high level)
Falling edge
Decrement
0 (low level)
Rising edge
Does not count (don't care)
Rising edge
1 (high level)
Falling edge
0 (low level)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 248 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Increment
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Phase Count Mode 4: Figure 10.32 shows an example of phase counting mode 4 operation. Table
10.12 lists the up counting and down counting conditions for the TCNT.
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
TCNT value
Increment
Decrement
Time
Figure 10.32 Phase Counting Mode 4 Operation
Table 10.12 Phase Count Mode 4 Up/Down Counting Conditions
TCLKA (Channel 1)
TCLKC (Channel 2)
TCLKB (Channel 1)
TCLKD (Channel 2)
Operation
1 (high level)
Rising edge
Increment
0 (low level)
Falling edge
Rising edge
0 (low level)
Falling edge
1 (high level)
1 (high level)
Falling edge
0 (low level)
Rising edge
Rising edge
1 (high level)
Falling edge
0 (low level)
Does not count (don't care)
Decrement
Does not count (don't care)
Phase Counting Mode Application Example: Figure 10.33 shows an example where channel 1
is set to phase counting mode and is teamed with channel 0 to input a two-phase encoder pulse for
a servo motor to accurately detect position and speed.
Channel 1 is set to phase counting mode 1, and the encoder pulse A phase and B phase are input to
the TCLKA and TCLKB pins.
Channel 0 is set so that the TCNT counter is cleared on a TGR0C register compare-match, and the
TGR0A and TGR0C registers are used with the compare-match function to establish the speed
control and position control periods. The TGR0B register is used with the input capture function,
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 249 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
and the TGR0B and TGR0D registers are employed for buffer operation. The channel 1 counter
input clock is used as the TGR0B register input capture source, and a pulse width of four times the
2-phase encoder pulse is detected.
The channel 1 TGR1A and TGR1B registers are set for the input capture function, the channel 0
TGR0A and TGR0C register compare-match is used as an input capture source, and all of the
control period increment and decrement values are stored. This procedure enables the accurate
detection of position and speed.
Channel 1
TCLKA
TCLKB
Edge
detection
circuit
TCNT1
TGR1A (speed
period capture)
TGR1B (position
period capture)
TCNT0
TGR0A (speed
control period)
+
−
TGR0C (position
control period)
+
−
TGR0B (pulse
width capture)
TGR0D (buffer
operation)
Channel 0
Figure 10.33 Phase Count Mode Application Example
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 250 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.5
Interrupts
10.5.1
Interrupt Sources and Priority Ranking
The MTU has three interrupt sources: TGR register compare-match/input captures, TCNT counter
overflows and TCNT counter underflows. Because each of these three types of interrupts are
allocated its own dedicated status flag and enable/disable bit, the issuing of interrupt request
signals to the interrupt controller can be independently enabled or disabled.
When an interrupt source is generated, the corresponding status flag in the timer status register
(TSR) is set to 1. If the corresponding enable/disable bit in the timer input enable register (TIER)
is set to 1 at this time, the MTU makes an interrupt request of the interrupt controller. The
interrupt request is canceled by clearing the status flag to 0.
The channel priority order can be changed with the interrupt controller. The priority ranking
within a channel is fixed. For more information, see section 6, Interrupt Controller.
Table 10.13 lists the MTU interrupt sources.
Input Capture/Compare Match Interrupts: If the TGIE bit of the timer input enable register
(TIER) is already set to 1 when the TGF flag in the timer status register (TSR) is set to 1 by a
TGR register input capture/compare-match of any channel, an interrupt request is sent to the
interrupt controller. The interrupt request is canceled by clearing the TGF flag to 0. The MTU has
8 input capture/compare-match interrupts; four for channel 0, and two each for channels 1 and 2.
Overflow Interrupts: If the TCIEV bit of the TIER is already set to 1 when the TCFV flag in the
TSR is set to 1 by a TCNT counter overflow of any channel, an interrupt request is sent to the
interrupt controller. The interrupt request is canceled by clearing the TCFV flag to 0. The MTU
has three overflow interrupts, one for each channel.
Underflow Interrupts: If the TCIEU bit of the TIER is already set to 1 when the TCFU flag in
the TSR is set to 1 by a TCNT counter underflow of any channel, an interrupt request is sent to the
interrupt controller. The interrupt request is canceled by clearing the TCFU flag to 0. The MTU
has two underflow interrupts, one each for channels 1 and 2.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 251 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Table 10.13 MTU Interrupt Sources
Channel
Interrupt
Source
Description
DMAC
Activation
Priority*
0
TGI0A
TGR0A input capture/compare-match
Yes
High
TGI0B
TGR0B input capture/compare-match
No
TGI0C
TGR0C input capture/compare-match
No
TGI0D
TGR0D input capture/compare-match
No
1
2
Note:
10.5.2
*
TCI0V
TCNT0 overflow
No
TGI1A
TGR1A input capture/compare-match
Yes
TGI1B
TGR1B input capture/compare-match
No
TCI1V
TCNT1 overflow
No
TCI1U
TCNT1 underflow
No
TGI2A
TGR2A input capture/compare-match
Yes
TGI2B
TGR2B input capture/compare-match
No
TCI2V
TCNT2 overflow
No
TCI2U
TCNT2 underflow
No
Low
Indicates the initial status following reset. The ranking of channels can be altered using
the interrupt controller.
DMAC Activation
The TGRA register input capture/compare-match interrupt of any channel can be used as a source
to activate the on-chip DMAC. For details, refer to section 9, Direct Memory Access Controller
(DMAC).
The MTU has three TGRA register input capture/compare-match interrupts, one for any channel,
that can be used as DMAC activation sources.
10.5.3
A/D Converter Activation
The TGRA register input capture/compare-match of any channel can be used to activate the onchip A/D converter.
If the TTGE bit of the TIER is already set to 1 when the TGFA flag in the TSR is set to 1 by a
TGRA register input capture/compare-match of any of the channels, an A/D conversion start
request is sent to the A/D converter. If the MTU conversion start trigger is selected at such a time
on the A/D converter side when this happens, the A/D conversion starts.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 252 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
The MTU has three TGRA register input capture/compare-match interrupts, one for each channel,
that can be used as A/D converter activation sources.
10.6
Operation Timing
10.6.1
Input/Output Timing
TCNT Count Timing: Count timing for the TCNT counter with internal clock operation is shown
in figure 10.34. Count timing with external clock operation (normal mode) is shown in figure
10.35, and figure 10.36 shows count timing with external clock operation (phase counting mode).
φ
Internal
clock
Falling edge
Rising edge
Falling edge
TCNT
input
clock
TCNT
N−1
N
N+1
N+2
Figure 10.34 TCNT Count Timing during Internal Clock Operation
φ
Internal
clock
Falling edge
Rising edge
Falling edge
TCNT
input
clock
TCNT
N−1
N
N+1
N+2
Figure 10.35 TCNT Count Timing during External Clock Operation (Normal Mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 253 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
φ
External
clock
Falling edge
Rising edge
Falling edge
TCNT
input clock
N−1
TCNT
N
N+1
Figure 10.36 TCNT Count Timing during External Clock Operation (Phase Counting
Mode)
Output Compare Output Timing: The compare-match signal is generated at the final state of
TCNT and TGR matching. When a compare-match signal is issued, the output value set in TIOR
is output to the output compare output pin (the TIOC pin). After TCNT and TGR matching, a
compare-match signal is not issued until immediately before the TCNT input clock.
Output compare output timing (normal mode and PWM mode) is shown in figure 10.37.
φ
TCNT
input clock
TCNT
N
TGR
N
N+1
Comparematch signal
TIOC pin
Figure 10.37 Output Compare Output Timing (Normal Mode/PWM Mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 254 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Input Capture Signal Timing: Figure 10.38 illustrates input capture timing.
φ
Input capture
input
Rising edge
Falling edge
Input capture
signal
TCNT
N
N+1
N+2
N
TGR
N+2
Figure 10.38 Input Capture Input Signal Timing
Counter Clearing Timing Due to Compare-Match/Input Capture: Timing for counter clearing
due to compare-match is shown in figure 10.39. Figure 10.40 shows the timing for counter
clearing due to input capture.
φ
Comparematch signal
Counter
clear signal
TCNT
N
TGR
N
H'0000
Figure 10.39 Counter Clearing Timing (Compare-Match)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 255 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
φ
Input
capture
signal
Counter
clear signal
N
TCNT
TGR
H'0000
N
Figure 10.40 Counter Clearing Timing (Input Capture)
Buffer Operation Timing: Compare-match buffer operation timing is shown in figure 10.41.
Figure 10.42 shows input capture buffer operation timing.
φ
n
n+1
TGRA, TGRB
n
N
TGRC, TGRD
N
TCNT
Comparematch signal
Comparematch buffer
signal
Figure 10.41 Buffer Operation Timing (Compare-Match)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 256 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
φ
Input capture
signal
Input capture
signal buffer
TCNT
N
TGRA, TGRB
n
TGRC, TGRD
N+1
N
N+1
n
N
Figure 10.42 Buffer Operation Timing (Input Capture)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 257 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.6.2
Interrupt Signal Timing
Setting TGF Flag Timing during Compare-Match: Figure 10.43 shows timing for the TGF flag
of the timer status register (TSR) due to compare-match, as well as TGI interrupt request signal
timing.
φ
TCNT
input clock
TCNT
N
TGR
N
N+1
Comparematch signal
TGF flag
TGI interrupt
Figure 10.43 TGI Interrupt Timing (Compare Match)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 258 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Setting TGF Flag Timing during Input Capture: Figure 10.44 shows timing for the TGF flag
of the timer status register (TSR) due to input capture, as well as TGI interrupt request signal
timing.
φ
Input capture
signal
TCNT
TGR
N
N
TGF flag
TGI interrupt
Figure 10.44 TGI Interrupt Timing (Input Capture)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 259 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Setting Timing for Overflow Flag (TCFV)/Underflow Flag (TCFU): Figure 10.45 shows
timing for the TCFV flag of the timer status register (TSR) due to overflow, as well as TCIV
interrupt request signal timing. Figure 10.46 shows timing for the TCFU flag of the timer status
register (TSR) due to underflow, as well as TCIU interrupt request signal timing.
φ
TCNT
input clock
TCNT
(underflow)
H'FFFF
H'0000
Overflow
signal
TCFV flag
TCIV interrupt
Figure 10.45 TCIV Interrupt Setting Timing
φ
TCNT
input clock
TCNT
(underflow)
H'0000
H'FFFF
Underflow
signal
TCFU flag
TCIU interrupt
Figure 10.46 TCIU Interrupt Setting Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 260 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Status Flag Clearing Timing: The status flag is cleared when the CPU reads a 1 status followed
by a 0 write. For DMA controller activation, clearing can also be done automatically. Figure 10.47
shows the timing for status flag clearing by the CPU. Figure 10.48 shows timing for clearing due
to the DMA controller.
TSR write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
TSR address
Write signal
Status flag
Interrupt
request signal
Figure 10.47 Timing of Status Flag Clearing by the CPU
DMAC
read cycle
T1
T2
DMAC
write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
Source
address
Destination
address
Status flag
Interrupt
request signal
Figure 10.48 Timing of Status Flag Clearing by DMAC Activation
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 261 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7
Usage Notes
This section describes contention and other matters requiring special attention during MTU
operations.
10.7.1
Input Clock Limitations
The input clock pulse width, in the case of single edge, must be 1.5 states or greater, and 2.5 states
or greater for both edges. Normal operation cannot be guaranteed with lesser pulse widths.
In phase counting mode, the phase difference between the two input clocks and the overlap must
be 1.5 states or greater for each, and the pulse width must be 2.5 states or greater. Input clock
conditions for phase counting mode are shown in figure 10.49.
Phase
Phase
difference
difference
Overlap
Overlap
Pulse width
Pulse width
TCLKA
(TCLKC)
TCLKB
(TCLKD)
Pulse width
Pulse width
Notes: Phase difference and overlap: 1.5 states or greater
Pulse width: 2.5 states or greater
Figure 10.49 Phase Difference, Overlap, and Pulse Width in Phase Count Mode
10.7.2
Note on Cycle Setting
When setting a counter clearing by compare-match, clearing is done in the final state when TCNT
matches the TGR value (update timing for count value on TCNT match). The actual number of
states set in the counter is given by the following equation:
f=
φ
(N + 1)
(f: counter frequency, φ: operating frequency, N: value set in the TGR)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 262 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7.3
Contention between TCNT Write and Clear
If a counter clear signal is issued in the T2 state during the TCNT write cycle, TCNT clearing has
priority, and TCNT write is not conducted (figure 10.50).
TCNT write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
TCNT address
Write signal
Counter
clear signal
TCNT
N
H'0000
Figure 10.50 TCNT Write and Clear Contention
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 263 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7.4
Contention between TCNT Write and Increment
If a count-up signal is issued in the T2 state during the TCNT write cycle, TCNT write has priority,
and the counter is not incremented (figure 10.51).
TCNT write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
TCNT address
Write signal
TCNT input
clock
N
TCNT
M
TCNT write data
Figure 10.51 TCNT Write and Increment Contention
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 264 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7.5
Contention between Buffer Register Write and Compare Match
If a compare-match occurs in the T2 state of the TGR write cycle, data is transferred by the buffer
operation from the buffer register to the TGR. Data to be transferred on channel 0 is that after
write (figure 10.52).
TGR write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
Buffer register
address
Write signal
Compare
match
signal
Compare
match buffer
signal
Buffer register write data
Buffer
register
TGR
N
M
M
Figure 10.52 TGR Write and Compare-Match Contention (Channel 0)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 265 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7.6
Contention between TGR Read and Input Capture
If an input capture signal is issued in the T1 state of the TGR read cycle, the read data is that after
input capture transfer (figure 10.53).
TGR read cycle
T1
T2
φ
TGR
address
Address
Read signal
Input capture
signal
TGR
X
M
M
Internal data
bus
Figure 10.53 TGR Read and Input Capture Contention
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 266 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7.7
Contention between TGR Write and Input Capture
If an input capture signal is issued in the T2 state of the TGR read cycle, input capture has priority,
and TGR write does not occur (figure 10.54).
TGR write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
TGR address
Write signal
Input capture
signal
TCNT
TGR
M
M
Figure 10.54 TGR Write and Input Capture Contention
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 267 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7.8
Contention between Buffer Register Write and Input Capture
If an input capture signal is issued in the T2 state of the buffer write cycle, write to the buffer
register does not occur, and buffer operation takes priority (figure 10.55).
Buffer register write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
Buffer register
address
Write signal
Input capture
signal
TCNT
TGR
Buffer
register
N
M
N
M
Figure 10.55 Buffer Register Write and Input Capture Contention
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 268 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7.9
Contention between TGR Write and Compare Match
If a compare-match occurs in the T2 state of the TGR write cycle, data is written to the TGR and a
compare-match signal is issued (figure 10.56).
TGR write cycle
T1
T2
φ
Address
TGR address
Write signal
Compare
match signal
TCNT
N
N+1
TGR
N
M
TGR write data
Figure 10.56 TGR Write and Compare Match Contention
10.7.10 TCNT2 Write and Overflow/Underflow Contention in Cascade Connection
With timer counters TCNT1 and TCNT2 in a cascade connection, when a contention occurs
during TCNT1 count (during a TCNT2 overflow/underflow) in the T2 state of the TCNT2 write
cycle, the write to TCNT2 is conducted, and the TCNT1 count signal is prohibited. At this point, if
there is match with TGR1A and the TCNT1 value, a compare signal is issued. Furthermore, when
the TCNT1 count clock is selected as the input capture source of channel 0, TGRA0 to TGRD0
carry out the input capture operation. In addition, when the compare match/input capture is
selected as the input capture source of TGRB1, TGRB1 carries out input capture operation. The
timing is shown in figure 10.57.
For cascade connections, be sure to synchronize settings for channels 1 and 2 when setting TCNT
clearing.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 269 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
TCNT write cycle
T1
T1
φ
Address
TCNT2 address
Write signal
TCNT2
H'FFFE
H'FFFF
N
N+1
TCNT2 write data
TGR2A, TGR2B
H'FFFF
Channel 2 comparematch signal A/B
Disabled
TCNT1
input clock
TCNT1
M
TGR1A
M
Channel 1 comparematch signal A
TGR1B
N
M
Channel 1 inputcapture
signal B
TCNT0
P
TGR0A to TGR0D
Q
P
Channel 0 input capture
signal A to D
Figure 10.57 TCNT2 Write and Overflow/Underflow Contention with Cascade Connection
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 270 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7.11 Contention between Overflow/Underflow and Counter Clearing
If overflow/underflow and counter clearing occur simultaneously, the TCFV/TCFU flag in TSR is
not set and TCNT clearing takes precedence.
Figure 10.58 shows the operation timing when a TGR compare-match is specified as the clearing
source, and H'FFFF is set in TGR.
φ
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
H'FFFF
H'0000
Counter clear
signal
TGF flag
Disabled
TCFV flag
Figure 10.58 Contention between Overflow and Counter Clearing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 271 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.7.12 Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow/Underflow
If there is an up-count or down-count in the T2 state of a TCNT write cycle, and
overflow/underflow occurs, the TCNT write takes precedence and the TCFV/TCFU flag in TSR is
not set .
Figure 10.59 shows the operation timing in this case.
TCNT write cycle
T1
T2
φ
TCNT address
Address
Write signal
TCNT input
clock
TCNT
H'FFFF
N
TCNT write data
Disabled
TCFV flag
Figure 10.59 Contention between TCNT Write and Overflow
10.7.13 Cautions on Carrying Out Buffer Operation of Channel 0 in PWM Mode 1
In PWM mode 1, the TGRA and TGRB registers are used in pairs and PWM waveform is output
to the TIOCA pin. In the same manner, the TGRC and TGRD registers are used in pairs and PWM
waveform is output to the TIOCC pin. If either the TGRC or TGRD register is operating as a
buffer register, the TIOCC pin cannot execute default output setting or PWM waveform output
with the I/O control register (TIOR).
Note that for channel 0, the TIOCC pin allows both default output setting by TIOR and PWM
output when setting buffer operation only for the TGRD register in PWM mode 1.
When using channel 0 in PWM mode 1 and setting buffer operation, use both the TGRC and
TGRD registers as buffer registers.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 272 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
10.8
MTU Output Pin Initialization
10.8.1
Operating Modes
The MTU has the following four operating modes. Waveform output is possible in all of these
modes.
• Normal mode (channels 0 to 2)
• PWM mode 1 (channels 0 to 2)
• PWM mode 2 (channels 0 to 2)
• Phase counting modes 1 to 4 (channels 1 and 2)
The MTU output pin initialization method for each of these modes is described in this section.
10.8.2
Reset Start Operation
The MTU output pins (TIOC*) are initialized low by a reset and in standby mode. Since MTU pin
function selection is performed by the pin function controller (PFC), when the PFC is set, the
MTU pin states at that point are output to the ports. When MTU output is selected by the PFC
immediately after a reset, the MTU output initial level, low, is output directly at the port. When
the active level is low, the system will operate at this point, and therefore the PFC setting should
be made after initialization of the MTU output pins is completed.
Note: Channel number and port notation are substituted for *.
10.8.3
Operation in Case of Re-Setting Due to Error during Operation, Etc.
If an error occurs during MTU operation, MTU output should be cut by the system. Cutoff is
performed by switching the pin output to port output with the PFC and outputting the inverse of
the active level. The pin initialization procedures for re-setting due to an error during operation,
etc., and the procedures for restarting in a different mode after re-setting, are shown below.
The MTU has four operating modes, as stated above. There are thus 16 mode transition
combinations. Possible mode transition combinations are shown in table 10.14.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 273 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
Table 10.14 Mode Transition Combinations
After
Before
Normal
PWM1
PWM2
PCM
Normal
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
PWM1
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
PWM2
(9)
(10)
(11)
(12)
PCM
(13)
(14)
(15)
(16)
Legend:
Normal:
PWM1:
PWM2:
PCM:
Normal mode
PWM mode 1
PWM mode 2
Phase counting modes 1 to 4
The above abbreviations are used in some places in following descriptions.
10.8.4
Overview of Initialization Procedures and Mode Transitions in Case of Error
during Operation, etc.
• When making a transition to a mode (Normal, PWM1, PWM2, PCM) in which the pin output
level is selected by the timer I/O control register (TIOR) setting, initialize the pins by means of
a TIOR setting.
• In PWM mode 1, since a waveform is not output to the TIOC*B (TIOC*D) pin, setting TIOR
will not initialize the pins. If initialization is required, carry it out in normal mode, then switch
to PWM mode 1.
• In PWM mode 2, since a waveform is not output to the cycle register pin, setting TIOR will
not initialize the pins. If initialization is required, carry it out in normal mode, then switch to
PWM mode 2.
• In normal mode or PWM mode 2, if TGRC and TGRD operate as buffer registers, setting
TIOR will not initialize the buffer register pins. If initialization is required, clear buffer mode,
carry out initialization, then set buffer mode again.
• In PWM mode 1, if either TGRC or TGRD operates as a buffer register, setting TIOR will not
initialize the TGRC pin. To initialize the TGRC pin, clear buffer mode, carry out initialization,
then set buffer mode again.
Note: Channel number is substituted for * indicated in this article.
Pin initialization procedures are described below for the numbered combinations in table 10.14.
The active level is assumed to be low.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 274 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(1) Operation when Error Occurs during Normal Mode Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in Normal Mode: Figure 10.60 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in normal mode and operation is restarted in normal mode after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(normal)
3
4
5
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
6
Match
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
occurs (PORT) (0) (normal) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
TIOC*A
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.60 Error Occurrence in Normal Mode, Recovery in Normal Mode
1. After a reset, MTU output is low and ports are in the high-impedance state.
2. After a reset, the TMDR setting is for normal mode.
3. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (The example shows initial high output, with low output on
compare-match occurrence.)
4. Set MTU output with the PFC.
5. The count operation is started by TSTR.
6. Output goes low on compare-match occurrence.
7. An error occurs.
8. Set port output with the PFC and output the inverse of the active level.
9. The count operation is stopped by TSTR.
10. Not necessary when restarting in normal mode.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR.
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 275 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(2) Operation when Error Occurs during Normal Mode Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in PWM Mode 1: Figure 10.61 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in normal mode and operation is restarted in PWM mode 1 after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(normal)
3
4
5
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
6
Match
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
occurs (PORT) (0) (PWM1) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
TIOC*A
• Not initialized (TIOC*B)
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.61 Error Occurrence in Normal Mode, Recovery in PWM Mode 1
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.60.
10. Set PWM mode 1.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (In PWM mode 1, the TIOC*B side is not initialized. If
initialization is required, initialize in normal mode, then switch to PWM mode 1.)
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 276 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(3) Operation when Error Occurs during Normal Mode Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in PWM Mode 2: Figure 10.62 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in normal mode and operation is restarted in PWM mode 2 after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(normal)
3
4
5
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
6
Match
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
occurs (PORT) (0) (PWM2) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
• Not initialized (cycle register)
TIOC*A
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.62 Error Occurrence in Normal Mode, Recovery in PWM Mode 2
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.60.
10. Set PWM mode 2.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (In PWM mode 2, the cycle register pins are not initialized. If
initialization is required, initialize in normal mode, then switch to PWM mode 2.)
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 277 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(4) Operation when Error Occurs during Normal Mode Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in Phase Counting Mode: Figure 10.63 shows an explanatory diagram of the case
where an error occurs in normal mode and operation is restarted in phase counting mode after resetting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(normal)
3
4
5
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
6
Match
7
8
9
10
Error
PFC TSTR TMDR
occurs (PORT) (0)
(PCM)
11
12
13
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
TIOC*A
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.63 Error Occurrence in Normal Mode, Recovery in Phase Counting Mode
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.60.
10. Set phase counting mode.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR.
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 278 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(5) Operation when Error Occurs during PWM Mode 1 Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in Normal Mode: Figure 10.64 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in PWM mode 1 and operation is restarted in normal mode after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(PWM1)
3
4
5
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
6
Match
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
occurs (PORT) (0) (normal) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
TIOC*A
• Not initialized (TIOC*B)
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.64 Error Occurrence in PWM Mode 1, Recovery in Normal Mode
1. After a reset, MTU output is low and ports are in the high-impedance state.
2. Set PWM mode 1.
3. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (The example shows initial high output, with low output on
compare-match occurrence. In PWM mode 1, the TIOC*B side is not initialized.)
4. Set MTU output with the PFC.
5. The count operation is started by TSTR.
6. Output goes low on compare-match occurrence.
7. An error occurs.
8. Set port output with the PFC and output the inverse of the active level.
9. The count operation is stopped by TSTR.
10. Set normal mode.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR.
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 279 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(6) Operation when Error Occurs during PWM Mode 1 Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in PWM Mode 1: Figure 10.65 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in PWM mode 1 and operation is restarted in PWM mode 1 after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(PWM1)
3
4
5
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
6
Match
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
occurs (PORT) (0) (PWM1) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
TIOC*A
• Not initialized (TIOC*B)
TIOC*B
• Not initialized (TIOC*B)
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.65 Error Occurrence in PWM Mode 1, Recovery in PWM Mode 1
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.64.
10. Not necessary when restarting in PWM mode 1.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (In PWM mode 1, the TIOC*B side is not initialized.)
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 280 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(7) Operation when Error Occurs during PWM Mode 1 Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in PWM Mode 2: Figure 10.66 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in PWM mode 1 and operation is restarted in PWM mode 2 after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(PWM1)
3
4
5
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
6
Match
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
occurs (PORT) (0) (PWM2) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
• Not initialized (cycle register)
TIOC*A
• Not initialized (TIOC*B)
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.66 Error Occurrence in PWM Mode 1, Recovery in PWM Mode 2
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.64.
10. Set PWM mode 2.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (In PWM mode 2, the cycle register pins are not initialized.)
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 281 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(8) Operation when Error Occurs during PWM Mode 1 Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in Phase Counting Mode: Figure 10.67 shows an explanatory diagram of the case
where an error occurs in PWM mode 1 and operation is restarted in phase counting mode after resetting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(PWM1)
3
4
5
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
6
Match
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
occurs (PORT) (0)
(PCM) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
TIOC*A
• Not initialized (TIOC*B)
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.67 Error Occurrence in PWM Mode 1, Recovery in Phase Counting Mode
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.64.
10. Set phase counting mode.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR.
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 282 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(9) Operation when Error Occurs during PWM Mode 2 Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in Normal Mode: Figure 10.68 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in PWM mode 2 and operation is restarted in normal mode after re-setting.
1
2
3
RESET TMDR TIOR
(PWM2) (1 init
0 out)
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
PFC TSTR Match Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
(MTU)
(1)
occurs (PORT) (0) (normal) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
• Not initialized (cycle register)
TIOC*A
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.68 Error Occurrence in PWM Mode 2, Recovery in Normal Mode
1. After a reset, MTU output is low and ports are in the high-impedance state.
2. Set PWM mode 2.
3. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (The example shows initial high output, with low output on
compare-match occurrence. In PWM mode 2, the cycle register pins are not initialized. In the
example, TIOC*A is the cycle register.)
4. Set MTU output with the PFC.
5. The count operation is started by TSTR.
6. Output goes low on compare-match occurrence.
7. An error occurs.
8. Set port output with the PFC and output the inverse of the active level.
9. The count operation is stopped by TSTR.
10. Set normal mode.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR.
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 283 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(10) Operation when Error Occurs during PWM Mode 2 Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in PWM Mode 1: Figure 10.69 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in PWM mode 2 and operation is restarted in PWM mode 1 after re-setting.
1
2
3
RESET TMDR TIOR
(PWM2) (1 init
0 out)
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
PFC TSTR Match Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
(MTU)
(1)
occurs (PORT) (0) (PWM1) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
• Not initialized (cycle register)
TIOC*A
• Not initialized (TIOC*B)
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.69 Error Occurrence in PWM Mode 2, Recovery in PWM Mode 1
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.68.
10. Set PWM mode 1.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (In PWM mode 1, the TIOC*B side is not initialized.)
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 284 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(11) Operation when Error Occurs during PWM Mode 2 Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in PWM Mode 2: Figure 10.70 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in PWM mode 2 and operation is restarted in PWM mode 2 after re-setting.
1
2
3
RESET TMDR TIOR
(PWM2) (1 init
0 out)
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
PFC TSTR Match Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
(MTU)
(1)
occurs (PORT) (0) (PWM2) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
• Not initialized (cycle register)
TIOC*A
• Not initialized (cycle register)
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.70 Error Occurrence in PWM Mode 2, Recovery in PWM Mode 2
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.68.
10. Not necessary when restarting in PWM mode 2.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (In PWM mode 2, the cycle register pins are not initialized.)
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 285 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(12) Operation when Error Occurs during PWM Mode 2 Operation, and Operation is
Restarted in Phase Counting Mode: Figure 10.71 shows an explanatory diagram of the case
where an error occurs in PWM mode 2 and operation is restarted in phase counting mode after resetting.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
RESET TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR Match Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
(PWM2) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
occurs (PORT) (0)
(PCM) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
0 out)
MTU output
• Not initialized (cycle register)
TIOC*A
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.71 Error Occurrence in PWM Mode 2, Recovery in Phase Counting Mode
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.68.
10. Set phase counting mode.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR.
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 286 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(13) Operation when Error Occurs during Phase Counting Mode Operation, and Operation
is Restarted in Normal Mode: Figure 10.72 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in phase counting mode and operation is restarted in normal mode after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(PCM)
3
TIOR
(1 init
0 out)
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
PFC TSTR Match Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
(MTU)
(1)
occurs (PORT) (0) (normal) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
TIOC*A
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.72 Error Occurrence in Phase Counting Mode, Recovery in Normal Mode
1. After a reset, MTU output is low and ports are in the high-impedance state.
2. Set phase counting mode.
3. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (The example shows initial high output, with low output on
compare-match occurrence.)
4. Set MTU output with the PFC.
5. The count operation is started by TSTR.
6. Output goes low on compare-match occurrence.
7. An error occurs.
8. Set port output with the PFC and output the inverse of the active level.
9. The count operation is stopped by TSTR.
10. Set in normal mode.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR.
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 287 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(14) Operation when Error Occurs during Phase Counting Mode Operation, and Operation
is Restarted in PWM Mode 1: Figure 10.73 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in phase counting mode and operation is restarted in PWM mode 1 after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(PCM)
3
TIOR
(1 init
0 out)
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
PFC TSTR Match Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
(MTU)
(1)
occurs (PORT) (0) (PWM1) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
TIOC*A
TIOC*B
• Not initialized (TIOC*B)
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.73 Error Occurrence in Phase Counting Mode, Recovery in PWM Mode 1
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.72.
10. Set PWM mode 1.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (In PWM mode 1, the TIOC*B side is not initialized.)
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 288 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(15) Operation when Error Occurs during Phase Counting Mode Operation, and Operation
is Restarted in PWM Mode 2: Figure 10.74 shows an explanatory diagram of the case where an
error occurs in phase counting mode and operation is restarted in PWM mode 2 after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(PCM)
3
TIOR
(1 init
0 out)
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
PFC TSTR Match Error
PFC TSTR TMDR TIOR PFC TSTR
(MTU)
(1)
occurs (PORT) (0) (PWM2) (1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
• Not initialized (cycle register)
TIOC*A
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.74 Error Occurrence in Phase Counting Mode, Recovery in PWM Mode 2
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.72.
10. Set PWM mode 2.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR. (In PWM mode 2, the cycle register pins are not initialized.)
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 289 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
10. Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit (MTU)
(16) Operation when Error Occurs during Phase Counting Mode Operation, and Operation
is Restarted in Phase Counting Mode: Figure 10.75 shows an explanatory diagram of the case
where an error occurs in phase counting mode and operation is restarted in phase counting mode
after re-setting.
1
2
RESET TMDR
(PCM)
3
TIOR
(1 init
0 out)
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
PFC TSTR Match Error
PFC TSTR TMDR
(MTU)
(1)
occurs (PORT) (0)
(PCM)
11
12
13
TIOR PFC TSTR
(1 init (MTU)
(1)
0 out)
MTU output
TIOC*A
TIOC*B
Port output
PEn
Hi-Z
PEn
Hi-Z
Note: n = 0 to 15
Figure 10.75 Error Occurrence in Phase Counting Mode, Recovery
in Phase Counting Mode
1 to 9 are the same as in figure 10.72.
10. Not necessary when restarting in phase counting mode.
11. Initialize the pins with TIOR.
12. Set MTU output with the PFC.
13. Operation is restarted by TSTR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 290 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Section 11 Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.1
Overview
The watchdog timer (WDT) is a 1-channel timer for monitoring system operations. If a system
encounters a problem (crashes, for example) and the timer counter overflows without being
rewritten correctly by the CPU, an overflow signal (WDTOVF) is output externally. The WDT
can simultaneously generate an internal reset signal for the entire chip.
When the watchdog function is not needed, the WDT can be used as an interval timer. In the
interval timer operation, an interval timer interrupt is generated at each counter overflow. The
WDT is also used in recovering from the standby mode.
11.1.1
Features
The WDT has the following features:
• Works in watchdog timer mode or interval timer mode.
• Outputs WDTOVF in the watchdog timer mode. When the counter overflows in the watchdog
timer mode, overflow signal WDTOVF is output externally. You can select whether to reset
the chip internally when this happens.
• Generates interrupts in the interval timer mode. When the counter overflows, it generates an
interval timer interrupt.
• Clears standby mode.
• Works with eight counter input clocks.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 291 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.1.2
Block Diagram
Figure 11.1 is the block diagram of the WDT.
Overflow
Interrupt
control
Clock
WDTOVF
Clock
select
Reset
control
Internal
reset signal*
TCNT
RSTCSR
φ/2
φ/64
φ/128
φ/256
φ/512
φ/1024
φ/4096
φ/8192
Internal
clock sources
TCSR
Bus
interface
Module bus
Internal data bus
ITI
(interrupt
signal)
WDT
Legend:
TCSR:
Timer control/status register
TCNT:
Timer counter
RSTCSR: Reset control/status register
Note: * The internal reset signal can be generated by setting the register.
Figure 11.1 WDT Block Diagram
11.1.3
Pin Configuration
Table 11.1 shows the pin configuration.
Table 11.1 Pin Configuration
Pin
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
Watchdog timer overflow
WDTOVF
O
Outputs the counter overflow signal in the
watchdog timer mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 292 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.1.4
Register Configuration
Table 11.2 summarizes the three WDT registers. They are used to select the clock, switch the
WDT mode, and control the reset signal.
Table 11.2 WDT Registers
Address
Name
Abbreviation R/W
Timer control/status
register
TCSR
R/(W)*
Timer counter
TCNT
R/W
Reset control/status
register
RSTCSR
3
1
Initial Value
Write*
H'18
H'FFFF8610
Read*
H'00
R/(W)*
3
2
H'FFFF8610
H'FFFF8611
H'1F
H'FFFF8612
H'FFFF8613
Notes: 1. Write by word transfer. It cannot be written in byte or longword.
2. Read by byte transfer. It cannot be read in word or longword.
3. Only 0 can be written in bit 7 to clear the flag.
11.2
Register Descriptions
11.2.1
Timer Counter (TCNT)
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
The TCNT is an 8-bit read/write upcounter. (The TCNT differs from other registers in that it is
more difficult to write to. See section 11.2.4, Register Access, for details.) When the timer enable
bit (TME) in the timer control/status register (TCSR) is set to 1, the watchdog timer counter starts
counting pulses of an internal clock selected by clock select bits 2 to 0 (CKS2 to CKS0) in the
TCSR. When the value of the TCNT overflows (changes from H'FF to H'00), a watchdog timer
overflow signal (WDTOVF) or interval timer interrupt (ITI) is generated, depending on the mode
selected in the WT/IT bit of the TCSR.
The TCNT is initialized to H'00 by a power-on reset and when the TME bit is cleared to 0. It is not
initialized in the standby mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 293 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.2.2
Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR)
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
OVF
WT/IT
TME
⎯
⎯
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
R/(W)
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
The timer control/status register (TCSR) is an 8-bit read/write register. (The TCSR differs from
other registers in that it is more difficult to write to. See section 11.2.4, Register Access, for
details.) Its functions include selecting the timer mode and clock source.
Bits 7 to 5 are initialized to 000 by a power-on reset or in standby mode. Bits 2 to 0 are initialized
to 000 by a power-on reset, but retain their values in the standby mode.
Bit 7⎯Overflow Flag (OVF): Indicates that the TCNT has overflowed from H'FF to H'00 in the
interval timer mode. It is not set in the watchdog timer mode.
Bit 7
OVF
Description
0
No overflow of TCNT in interval timer mode
(initial value)
Cleared by reading OVF, then writing 0 in OVF
1
TCNT overflow in the interval timer mode
Bit 6⎯Timer Mode Select (WT/IT): Selects whether to use the WDT as a watchdog timer or
interval timer. When the TCNT overflows, the WDT either generates an interval timer interrupt
(ITI) or generates a WDTOVF signal, depending on the mode selected.
Bit 6
WT/IT
Description
0
Interval timer mode: interval timer interrupt request to the CPU when
TCNT overflows
(initial value)
1
Watchdog timer mode: WDTOVF signal output externally when TCNT
overflows. (Section 11.2.3, Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR),
describes in detail what happens when TCNT overflows in the watchdog
timer mode.)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 294 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Bit 5⎯Timer Enable (TME): Enables or disables the timer.
Bit 5
TME
Description
0
Timer disabled: TCNT is initialized to H'00 and count-up stops
(initial value)
1
Timer enabled: TCNT starts counting. A WDTOVF signal or interrupt is
generated when TCNT overflows.
Bits 4 and 3⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 1. The write value should always be 1.
Bits 2 to 0: Clock Select 2 to 0 (CKS2 to CKS0): These bits select one of eight internal clock
sources for input to the TCNT. The clock signals are obtained by dividing the frequency of the
system clock (φ).
Description
Bit 2
CKS2
Bit 1
CKS1
Bit 0
CKS0
Clock Source
0
0
0
φ/2
0
0
1
φ/64
573.4 μs
0
1
0
φ/128
1.1 ms
0
1
1
φ/256
2.3 ms
1
0
0
φ/512
4.6 ms
1
0
1
φ/1024
9.2 ms
1
1
0
φ/4096
36.7 ms
1
1
φ/8192
73.4 ms
1
Note:
*
Overflow Interval*
(φ = 28.7 MHz)
(initial value) 17.9 μs
The overflow interval listed is the time from when the TCNT begins counting at H'00
until an overflow occurs.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 295 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.2.3
Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR)
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
*
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WOVF
RSTE
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
R/(W)*
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
Only 0 can be written in bit 7 to clear the flag.
The RSTCSR is an 8-bit readable and writable register. (The RSTCSR differs from other registers
in that it is more difficult to write. See section 11.2.4, Register Access, for details.) It controls
output of the internal reset signal generated by timer counter (TCNT) overflow. RSTCR is
initialized to H'1F by input of a reset signal from the RES pin, but is not initialized by the internal
reset signal generated by the overflow of the WDT. It is initialized to H'1F in standby mode.
Bit 7⎯Watchdog Timer Overflow Flag (WOVF): Indicates that the TCNT has overflowed
(H'FF to H'00) in the watchdog timer mode. It is not set in the interval timer mode.
Bit 7
WOVF
Description
0
No TCNT overflow in watchdog timer mode
(initial value)
Cleared when software reads WOVF, then writes 0 in WOVF
1
Set by TCNT overflow in watchdog timer mode
Bit 6⎯Reset Enable (RSTE): Selects whether to reset the chip internally if the TCNT overflows
in the watchdog timer mode.
Bit 6
RSTE
Description
0
Not reset when TCNT overflows
(initial value)
LSI not reset internally, but TCNT and TCSR reset within WDT.
1
Reset when TCNT overflows
Bit 5⎯Reserved: This bit always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bits 4 to 0⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 1. The write value should always be 1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 296 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.2.4
Register Access
The watchdog timer's TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR registers differ from other registers in that they
are more difficult to write to. The procedures for writing and reading these registers are given
below.
Writing to the TCNT and TCSR: These registers must be written by a word transfer instruction.
They cannot be written by byte transfer instructions.
The TCNT and TCSR both have the same write address. The write data must be contained in the
lower byte of the written word. The upper byte must be H'5A (for the TCNT) or H'A5 (for the
TCSR) (figure 11.2). This transfers the write data from the lower byte to the TCNT or TCSR.
Writing to the TCNT
15
Address: H'FFFF8610
8
7
H'5A
0
Write data
Writing to the TCSR
15
Address: H'FFFF8610
8
H'A5
7
0
Write data
Figure 11.2 Writing to the TCNT and TCSR
Writing to the RSTCSR: The RSTCSR must be written by a word access to address
H'FFFF8612. It cannot be written by byte transfer instructions.
Procedures for writing 0 in WOVF (bit 7) and for writing to RSTE (bit 6) are different, as shown
in figure 11.3.
To write 0 in the WOVF bit, the write data must be H'A5 in the upper byte and H'00 in the lower
byte. This clears the WOVF bit to 0. The RSTE bit is not affected. To write to the RSTE bit, the
upper byte must be H'5A and the lower byte must be the write data. The values of bit 6 of the
lower byte is transferred to the RSTE bit, respectively. The WOVF bit is not affected.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 297 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Writing 0 to the WOVF bit
15
Address: H'FFFF8612
8
7
H'A5
0
H'00
Writing to the RSTE bit
15
Address: H'FFFF8612
8
H'5A
7
0
Write data
Figure 11.3 Writing to the RSTCSR
Reading from the TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR: TCNT, TCSR, and RSTCSR are read like
other registers. Use byte transfer instructions. The read addresses are H'FFFF8610 for the TCSR,
H'FFFF8611 for the TCNT, and H'FFFF8613 for the RSTCSR.
11.3
Operation
11.3.1
Watchdog Timer Mode
To use the WDT as a watchdog timer, set the WT/IT and TME bits of the TCSR to 1. Software
must prevent TCNT overflow by rewriting the TCNT value (normally by writing H'00) before
overflow occurs. No TCNT overflows will occur while the system is operating normally, but if the
TCNT fails to be rewritten and overflows occur due to a system crash or the like, a WDTOVF
signal is output externally (figure 11.4). The WDTOVF signal can be used to reset the system. The
WDTOVF signal is output for 128 φ clock cycles.
If the RSTE bit in the RSTCSR is set to 1, a signal to reset the chip will be generated internally
simultaneous to the WDTOVF signal when TCNT overflows. The internal reset signal is output
for 512 φ clock cycles.
When a watchdog overflow reset is generated simultaneously with a reset input at the RES pin, the
RES reset takes priority, and the WOVF bit is cleared to 0.
The following are not initialized a WDT reset signal:
• PFC (Pin Function Controller) function register
• I/O port register
Initializing is only possible by external power-on reset.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 298 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
TCNT
value
Overflow
H'FF
H'00
Time
WT/IT = 1
TME = 1
H'00 written
in TCNT
WOVF = 1
WT/IT = 1 H'00 written
in TCNT
TME = 1
WDTOVF and
internal reset generated
WDTOVF
signal
128 φ clocks
Internal
reset signal*
Legend:
WT/IT: Timer mode select bit
TME: Timer enable bit
512 φ clocks
Note: * Internal reset signal occurs only when the RSTE bit is set to 1.
Figure 11.4 Operation in the Watchdog Timer Mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 299 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.3.2
Interval Timer Mode
To use the WDT as an interval timer, clear WT/IT to 0 and set TME to 1. An interval timer
interrupt (ITI) is generated each time the timer counter overflows. This function can be used to
generate interval timer interrupts at regular intervals (figure 11.5).
TCNT value
Overflow
H'FF
Overflow
Overflow
Overflow
H'00
Time
WT/IT = 0
TME = 1
ITI
ITI
ITI
ITI
Legend:
ITI: Interval timer interrupt request generation
Figure 11.5 Operation in the Interval Timer Mode
11.3.3
Clearing the Standby Mode
The watchdog timer has a special function to clear the standby mode with an NMI interrupt. When
using the standby mode, set the WDT as described below.
Before Transition to the Standby Mode: The TME bit in the TCSR must be cleared to 0 to stop
the watchdog timer counter before it enters the standby mode. The chip cannot enter the standby
mode while the TME bit is set to 1. Set bits CKS2 to CKS0 so that the counter overflow interval is
equal to or longer than the oscillation settling time. See section 20.3, AC Characteristics, for the
oscillation settling time.
Recovery from the Standby Mode: When an NMI request signal is received in standby mode,
the clock oscillator starts running and the watchdog timer starts incrementing at the rate selected
by bits CKS2 to CKS0 before the standby mode was entered. When the TCNT overflows (changes
from H'FF to H'00), the clock is presumed to be stable and usable; clock signals are supplied to the
entire chip and the standby mode ends.
For details on the standby mode, see section 19, Power Down State.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 300 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.3.4
Timing of Setting the Overflow Flag (OVF)
In the interval timer mode, when the TCNT overflows, the OVF flag of the TCSR is set to 1 and
an interval timer interrupt is simultaneously requested (figure 11.6).
CK
TCNT
H'FF
H'00
Overflow signal
(internal signal)
OVF
Figure 11.6 Timing of Setting the OVF
11.3.5
Timing of Setting the Watchdog Timer Overflow Flag (WOVF)
When the TCNT overflows in the watchdog timer mode, the WOVF bit of the RSTCSR is set to 1
and a WDTOVF signal is output. When the RSTE bit is set to 1, TCNT overflow enables an
internal reset signal to be generated for the entire chip (figure 11.7).
CK
TCNT
H'FF
H'00
Overflow signal
(internal signal)
WOVF
Figure 11.7 Timing of Setting the WOVF Bit
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 301 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.4
Usage Notes
11.4.1
TCNT Write and Increment Contention
If a timer counter increment clock pulse is generated during the T3 state of a write cycle to the
TCNT, the write takes priority and the timer counter is not incremented (figure 11.8).
TCNT write cycle
T1
T2
T3
CK
Address
TCNT address
Internal
write signal
TCNT
input clock
TCNT
N
M
Counter write data
Figure 11.8 Contention between TCNT Write and Increment
11.4.2
Changing CKS2 to CKS0 Bit Values
If the values of bits CKS2 to CKS0 are altered while the WDT is running, the count may
increment incorrectly. Always stop the watchdog timer (by clearing the TME bit to 0) before
changing the values of bits CKS2 to CKS0.
11.4.3
Changing between Watchdog Timer/Interval Timer Modes
To prevent incorrect operation, always stop the watchdog timer (by clearing the TME bit to 0)
before switching between interval timer mode and watchdog timer mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 302 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
11.4.4
System Reset with WDTOVF
If a WDTOVF signal is input to the RES pin, the LSI cannot initialize correctly.
Avoid logical input of the WDTOVF output signal to the RES input pin. To reset the entire system
with the WDTOVF signal, use the circuit shown in figure 11.9.
SH7014/16/17
Reset input
Reset signal to
entire system
RES
WDTOVF
Figure 11.9 Example of a System Reset Circuit with a WDTOVF Signal
11.4.5
Internal Reset with the Watchdog Timer
If the RSTE bit is cleared to 0 in the watchdog timer mode, the LSI will not reset internally when a
TCNT overflow occurs, but the TCNT and TCSR in the WDT will reset.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 303 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
11. Watchdog Timer (WDT)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 304 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Section 12 Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.1
Overview
This LSI has a serial communication interface (SCI) with two independent channels, both of
which possess the same functions.
The SCI supports both asynchronous and clock synchronous serial communication. It also has a
multiprocessor communication function for serial communication among two or more processors.
12.1.1
Features
The SCI has the following features:
• Select asynchronous or clock synchronous as the serial communications mode.
⎯ Asynchronous mode: Serial data communications are synched by start-stop in character
units. The SCI can communicate with a universal asynchronous receiver/transmitter
(UART), an asynchronous communication interface adapter (ACIA), or any other chip that
employs a standard asynchronous serial communication. It can also communicate with two
or more other processors using the multiprocessor communication function. There are
twelve selectable serial data communication formats.
• Data length: seven or eight bits
• Stop bit length: one or two bits
• Parity: even, odd, or none
• Multiprocessor bit: one or none
• Receive error detection: parity, overrun, and framing errors
• Break detection: by reading the RxD level directly when a framing error occurs
⎯ Clocked synchronous mode: Serial data communication is synchronized with a clock
signal. The SCI can communicate with other chips having a clock synchronous
communication function. There is one serial data communication format.
• Data length: eight bits
• Receive error detection: overrun errors
• Full duplex communication: The transmitting and receiving sections are independent, so the
SCI can transmit and receive simultaneously. Both sections use double buffering, so
continuous data transfer is possible in both the transmit and receive directions.
• On-chip baud rate generator with selectable bit rates.
• Internal or external transmit/receive clock source: baud rate generator (internal) or SCK pin
(external).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 305 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
• Four types of interrupts: Transmit-data-empty, transmit-end, receive-data-full, and receiveerror interrupts are requested independently. The transmit-data-empty and receive-data-full
interrupts can start the direct memory access controller (DMAC) to transfer data.
12.1.2
Block Diagram
Bus interface
Figure 12.1 shows a block diagram of the SCI.
Module data bus
RDR
TDR
SSR
BRR
SCR
RxD
RSR
TSR
SMR
Transmit/
receive control
TxD
Parity
generation
Internal
data bus
Baud rate
generator
φ
φ/4
φ/16
φ/64
Clock
Parity check
External clock
SCK
TEI
TXI
RXI
ERI
SCI
Legend:
RSR : Receive shift register
RDR: Receive data register
TSR : Transmit shift register
TDR : Transmit data register
SMR :
SCR :
SSR :
BRR :
Serial mode register
Serial control register
Serial status register
Bit rate register
Figure 12.1 SCI Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 306 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.1.3
Pin Configuration
Table 12.1 summarizes the SCI pins by channel.
Table 12.1 SCI Pins
Channel
Pin Name
Abbreviation Input/Output
Function
0
Serial clock pin
SCK0
Input/output
SCI0 clock input/output
Receive data pin
RxD0
Input
SCI0 receive data input
Transmit data pin
TxD0
Output
SCI0 transmit data output
Serial clock pin
SCK1
Input/output
SCI1 clock input/output
Receive data pin
RxD1
Input
SCI1 receive data input
Transmit data pin
TxD1
Output
SCI1 transmit data output
1
12.1.4
Register Configuration
Table 12.2 summarizes the SCI internal registers. These registers select the communication mode
(asynchronous or clock synchronous), specify the data format and bit rate, and control the
transmitter and receiver sections.
Table 12.2 Registers
2
Channel Name
Abbreviation R/W
Initial Value Address*
0
Serial mode register
SMR0
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF81A0 8, 16
Bit rate register
BRR0
R/W
H'FF
H'FFFF81A1 8, 16
Serial control register SCR0
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF81A2 8, 16
Transmit data register TDR0
R/W
H'FF
H'FFFF81A3 8, 16
Serial status register
R/(W)* H'84
H'FFFF81A4 8, 16
Receive data register RDR0
R
H'00
H'FFFF81A5 8, 16
Serial mode register
SMR1
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF81B0 8, 16
Bit rate register
BRR1
R/W
H'FF
H'FFFF81B1 8, 16
Serial control register SCR1
R/W
H'00
H'FFFF81B2 8, 16
Transmit data register TDR1
R/W
H'FF
H'FFFF81B3 8, 16
R/(W)* H'84
H'FFFF81B4 8, 16
R
H'FFFF81B5 8, 16
1
Serial status register
SSR0
SSR1
Receive data register RDR1
1
1
H'00
Access Size
Notes: 1. The only value that can be written is a 0 to clear the flags.
2. Do not access empty addresses.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 307 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.2
Register Descriptions
12.2.1
Receive Shift Register (RSR)
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R/W:
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
The receive shift register (RSR) receives serial data. Data input at the RxD pin is loaded into the
RSR in the order received, LSB (bit 0) first, converting the data to parallel form. When one byte
has been received, it is automatically transferred to the RDR.
The CPU cannot read or write the RSR directly.
12.2.2
Receive Data Register (RDR)
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
The receive data register (RDR) stores serial receive data. The SCI completes the reception of one
byte of serial data by moving the received data from the receive shift register (RSR) into the RDR
for storage. The RSR is then ready to receive the next data. This double buffering allows the SCI
to receive data continuously.
The CPU can read but not write the RDR. The RDR is initialized to H'00 by a power-on reset or in
standby mode.
12.2.3
Transmit Shift Register (TSR)
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R/W:
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
The transmit shift register (TSR) transmits serial data. The SCI loads transmit data from the
transmit data register (TDR) into the TSR, then transmits the data serially from the TxD pin, LSB
(bit 0) first. After transmitting one data byte, the SCI automatically loads the next transmit data
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 308 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
from the TDR into the TSR and starts transmitting again. If the TDRE bit of the SSR is 1,
however, the SCI does not load the TDR contents into the TSR.
The CPU cannot read or write the TSR directly.
12.2.4
Transmit Data Register (TDR)
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
The transmit data register (TDR) is an 8-bit register that stores data for serial transmission. When
the SCI detects that the transmit shift register (TSR) is empty, it moves transmit data written in the
TDR into the TSR and starts serial transmission. Continuous serial transmission is possible by
writing the next transmit data in the TDR during serial transmission from the TSR.
The CPU can always read and write the TDR. The TDR is initialized to H'FF by a power-on reset
or in standby mode.
12.2.5
Serial Mode Register (SMR)
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
C/A
CHR
PE
O/E
STOP
MP
CKS1
CKS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
The serial mode register (SMR) is an 8-bit register that specifies the SCI serial communication
format and selects the clock source for the baud rate generator.
The CPU can always read and write the SMR. The SMR is initialized to H'00 by a power-on reset
or in standby mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 309 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Bit 7⎯Communication Mode (C/A): Selects whether the SCI operates in the asynchronous or
clock synchronous mode.
Bit 7
C/A
Description
0
Asynchronous mode
1
Clocked synchronous mode
(initial value)
Bit 6⎯Character Length (CHR): Selects 7-bit or 8-bit data in the asynchronous mode. In the
clock synchronous mode, the data length is always eight bits, regardless of the CHR setting.
Bit 6
CHR
Description
0
Eight-bit data
1
Seven-bit data*
Note:
*
(initial value)
When 7-bit data is selected, the MSB (bit 7) of the transmit data register is not
transmitted.
Bit 5⎯Parity Enable (PE): Selects whether to add a parity bit to transmit data and to check the
parity of receive data, in the asynchronous mode. In the clock synchronous mode, a parity bit is
neither added nor checked, regardless of the PE setting.
Bit 5
PE
Description
0
Parity bit not added or checked
1
Parity bit added and checked*
Note:
*
(initial value)
When PE is set to 1, an even or odd parity bit is added to transmit data, depending on
the parity mode (O/E) setting. Receive data parity is checked according to the even/odd
(O/E) mode setting.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 310 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Bit 4⎯Parity Mode (O/E): Selects even or odd parity when parity bits are added and checked.
The O/E setting is used only in asynchronous mode and only when the parity enable bit (PE) is set
to 1 to enable parity addition and check. The O/E setting is ignored in the clock synchronous
mode, or in the asynchronous mode when parity addition and check is disabled.
Bit 4
O/E
Description
0
Even parity*
1
2
Odd parity*
1
(initial value)
Notes: 1. If even parity is selected, the parity bit is added to transmit data to make an even
number of 1s in the transmitted character and parity bit combined. Receive data is
checked to see if it has an even number of 1s in the received character and parity bit
combined.
2. If odd parity is selected, the parity bit is added to transmit data to make an odd number
of 1s in the transmitted character and parity bit combined. Receive data is checked to
see if it has an odd number of 1s in the received character and parity bit combined.
Bit 3⎯Stop Bit Length (STOP): Selects one or two bits as the stop bit length in the
asynchronous mode. This setting is used only in the asynchronous mode. It is ignored in the clock
synchronous mode because no stop bits are added.
Bit 3
STOP
Description
0
One stop bit*
1
1
Two stop bits*
(initial value)
2
Notes: 1. In transmitting, a single bit of 1 is added at the end of each transmitted character.
2. In transmitting, two bits of 1 are added at the end of each transmitted character.
In receiving, only the first stop bit is checked, regardless of the STOP bit setting. If the second
stop bit is 1, it is treated as a stop bit, but if the second stop bit is 0, it is treated as the start bit of
the next incoming character.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 311 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Bit 2⎯Multiprocessor Mode (MP): Selects multiprocessor format. When multiprocessor format
is selected, settings of the parity enable (PE) and parity mode (O/E) bits are ignored. The MP bit
setting is used only in the asynchronous mode; it is ignored in the clock synchronous mode. For
the multiprocessor communication function, see section 12.3.3, Multiprocessor Communication.
Bit 2
MP
Description
0
Multiprocessor function disabled
1
Multiprocessor format selected
(initial value)
Bits 1 and 0⎯Clock Select 1 and 0 (CKS1 and CKS0): These bits select the internal clock
source of the on-chip baud rate generator. Four clock sources are available; φ, φ/4, φ/16, or φ/64.
For further information on the clock source, bit rate register settings, and baud rate, see section
12.2.8, Bit Rate Register.
Bit 1
CKS1
Bit 0
CKS0
Description
0
0
φ
1
φ/4
0
φ/16
1
φ/64
1
12.2.6
(initial value)
Serial Control Register (SCR)
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TIE
RIE
TE
RE
MPIE
TEIE
CKE1
CKE0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
The serial control register (SCR) operates the SCI transmitter/receiver, selects the serial clock
output in the asynchronous mode, enables/disables interrupt requests, and selects the
transmit/receive clock source. The CPU can always read and write the SCR. The SCR is initialized
to H'00 by a power-on reset or in standby mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 312 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Bit 7⎯Transmit Interrupt Enable (TIE): Enables or disables the transmit-data-empty interrupt
(TXI) requested when the transmit data register empty bit (TDRE) in the serial status register
(SSR) is set to 1 by transfer of serial transmit data from the TDR to the TSR.
Bit 7
TIE
Description
0
Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is disabled*
1
Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is enabled
Note:
*
(initial value)
The TXI interrupt request can be cleared by reading TDRE after it has been set to 1,
then clearing TDRE to 0, or by clearing TIE to 0.
Bit 6⎯Receive Interrupt Enable (RIE): Enables or disables the receive-data-full interrupt (RXI)
requested when the receive data register full bit (RDRF) in the serial status register (SSR) is set to
1 by transfer of serial receive data from the RSR to the RDR. It also enables or disables receiveerror interrupt (ERI) requests.
Bit 6
RIE
Description
0
Receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) and receive-error interrupt (ERI)
requests are disabled*
(initial value)
1
Receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) and receive-error interrupt (ERI)
requests are enabled
Note:
*
RXI and ERI interrupt requests can be cleared by reading the RDRF flag or error flag
(FER, PER, or ORER) after it has been set to 1, then clearing the flag to 0, or by
clearing RIE to 0.
Bit 5⎯Transmit Enable (TE): Enables or disables the SCI serial transmitter.
Bit 5
TE
Description
0
Transmitter disabled*
1
2
Transmitter enabled*
1
(initial value)
Notes: 1. The transmit data register empty bit (TDRE) in the serial status register (SSR) is locked
at 1.
2. Serial transmission starts when the transmit data register empty (TDRE) bit in the serial
status register (SSR) is cleared to 0 after writing of transmit data into the TDR. Select
the transmit format in the SMR before setting TE to 1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 313 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Bit 4⎯Receive Enable (RE): Enables or disables the SCI serial receiver.
Bit 4
RE
Description
0
Receiver disabled*
1
Receiver enabled*
1
(initial value)
2
Notes: 1. Clearing RE to 0 does not affect the receive flags (RDRF, FER, PER, ORER). These
flags retain their previous values.
2. Serial reception starts when a start bit is detected in the asynchronous mode, or
synchronous clock input is detected in the clock synchronous mode. Select the receive
format in the SMR before setting RE to 1.
Bit 3⎯Multiprocessor Interrupt Enable (MPIE): Enables or disables multiprocessor interrupts.
The MPIE setting is used only in the asynchronous mode, and only if the multiprocessor mode bit
(MP) in the serial mode register (SMR) is set to 1 during reception. The MPIE setting is ignored in
the clock synchronous mode or when the MP bit is cleared to 0.
Bit 3
MPIE
Description
0
Multiprocessor interrupts are disabled (normal receive operation)
(initial value)
MPIE is cleared when the MPIE bit is cleared to 0, or the multiprocessor
bit (MPB) is set to 1 in receive data.
1
Multiprocessor interrupts are enabled*
Receive-data-full interrupt requests (RXI), receive-error interrupt
requests (ERI), and setting of the RDRF, FER, and ORER status flags
in the serial status register (SSR) are disabled until data with the
multiprocessor bit set to 1 is received.
Note:
*
The SCI does not transfer receive data from the RSR to the RDR, does not detect
receive errors, and does not set the RDRF, FER, and ORER flags in the serial status
register (SSR). When it receives data that includes MPB = 1, MPB is set to 1, and the
SCI automatically clears MPIE to 0, generates RXI and ERI interrupts (if the TIE and
RIE bits in the SCR are set to 1), and allows the FER and ORER bits to be set.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 314 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Bit 2⎯Transmit-End Interrupt Enable (TEIE): Enables or disables the transmit-end interrupt
(TEI) requested if TDR does not contain valid transmit data when the MSB is transmitted.
Bit 2
TEIE
Description
0
Transmit-end interrupt (TEI) requests are disabled*
1
Note:
(initial value)
Transmit-end interrupt (TEI) requests are enabled.*
*
The TEI request can be cleared by reading the TDRE bit in the serial status register
(SSR) after it has been set to 1, then clearing TDRE to 0 and clearing the transmit end
(TEND) bit to 0; or by clearing the TEIE bit to 0.
Bits 1 and 0⎯Clock Enable 1 and 0 (CKE1 and CKE0): These bits select the SCI clock source
and enable or disable clock output from the SCK pin. Depending on the combination of CKE1 and
CKE0, the SCK pin can be used for serial clock output, or serial clock input. Select the SCK pin
function by using the pin function controller (PFC).
The CKE0 setting is valid only in the asynchronous mode, and only when the SCI is internally
clocked (CKE1 = 0). The CKE0 setting is ignored in the clock synchronous mode, or when an
external clock source is selected (CKE1 = 1). Select the SCI operating mode in the serial mode
register (SMR) before setting CKE1 and CKE0. For further details on selection of the SCI clock
source, see table 12.9 in section 12.3, Operation.
Bit 1 Bit 0
1
CKE1 CKE0 Description*
0
0
Asynchronous mode
Internal clock, SCK pin used for input pin (input signal is
2
ignored) or output pin (output level is undefined) *
Clock synchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin used for synchronous clock
2
output*
0
1
Asynchronous mode
Internal clock, SCK pin used for clock output*
3
Clock synchronous mode Internal clock, SCK pin used for synchronous clock output
1
0
Asynchronous mode
External clock, SCK pin used for clock input*
4
Clock synchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for synchronous clock input
1
1
Asynchronous mode
External clock, SCK pin used for clock input*
4
Clock synchronous mode External clock, SCK pin used for synchronous clock input
Notes: 1. The SCK pin is multiplexed with other functions. Use the pin function controller (PFC) to
select the SCK function for this pin, as well as the I/O direction.
2. Initial value.
3. The output clock frequency is the same as the bit rate.
4. The input clock frequency is 16 times the bit rate.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 315 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.2.7
Serial Status Register (SSR)
The serial status register (SSR) is an 8-bit register containing multiprocessor bit values, and status
flags that indicate SCI operating status.
The CPU can always read and write the SSR, but cannot write 1 in the status flags (TDRE, RDRF,
ORER, PER, and FER). These flags can be cleared to 0 only if they have first been read (after
being set to 1). Bits 2 (TEND) and 1 (MPB) are read-only bits that cannot be written. The SSR is
initialized to H'84 by a power-on reset or in standby mode.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
*
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TDRE
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
TEND
MPB
MPBT
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R
R
R/W
The only value that can be written is a 0 to clear the flag.
Bit 7⎯Transmit Data Register Empty (TDRE): Indicates that the SCI has loaded transmit data
from the TDR into the TSR and new serial transmit data can be written in the TDR.
Bit 7
TDRE
Description
0
TDR contains valid transmit data
[Clearing conditions]
1
•
When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1
•
When DMAC writes data in TDR
TDR does not contain valid transmit data
(initial value)
[Setting conditions]
•
Power-on reset or standby mode
•
When the TE bit in SCR is 0
•
When data is transferred from TDR to TSR and data can be written to TDR
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 316 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Bit 6⎯Receive Data Register Full (RDRF): Indicates that RDR contains received data.
Bit 6
RDRF
Description
0
RDR does not contain valid received data
(initial value)
[Clearing conditions]
1
•
Power-on reset or standby mode
•
When 0 is written to RDRF after reading RDRF = 1
•
When DMAC reads data from RDR
RDR contains valid received data
[Setting condition]
When serial reception ends normally and receive data is transferred from RSR to
RDR
Note: The RDR and RDRF are not affected by detection of receive errors or by clearing of the RE
bit to 0 in the serial control register. They retain their previous contents. If RDRF is still set
to 1 when reception of the next data ends, an overrun error (ORER) occurs and the
received data is lost.
Bit 5⎯Overrun Error (ORER): Indicates that data reception ended abnormally due to an
overrun error.
Bit 5
ORER
Description
0
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally*
1
(initial value)
[Clearing conditions]
1
•
Power-on reset or standby mode
•
When 0 is written to ORER after reading ORER = 1
A receive overrun error occurred
[Setting condition]
When the next serial reception is completed while RDRF = 1*
2
Notes: 1. The ORER flag is not affected and retains their previous values when the RE bit in SCR
is cleared to 0.
2. RDR continues to hold the data received before the overrun error, so subsequent
receive data is lost. Serial receiving cannot continue while ORER is set to 1. In the
clock synchronous mode, serial transmitting is disabled.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 317 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Bit 4⎯Framing Error (FER): Indicates that data reception ended abnormally due to a framing
error in the asynchronous mode.
Bit 4
FER
Description
0
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally*
1
(initial value)
[Clearing conditions]
1
•
Power-on reset or standby mode
•
When 0 is written to FER after reading FER = 1
A receive framing error occurred*
2
[Setting condition]
When at the end of an SCI receive operation the final stop bit of the receive data
2
is checked and its value* is 0
Notes: 1. The FER flag is not affected and retains their previous values when the RE bit in SCR is
cleared to 0.
2. When the stop bit length is two bits, only the first bit is checked to see if it is a 1. The
second stop bit is not checked. When a framing error occurs, the SCI transfers the
receive data into the RDR but does not set RDRF. Serial receiving cannot continue
while FER is set to 1. In the clock synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also
disabled. In addition, serial transmission cannot continue in clock synchronous mode.
Bit 3⎯Parity Error (PER): Indicates that data reception (with parity) ended abnormally due to a
parity error in the asynchronous mode.
Bit 3
PER
Description
0
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally*
1
(initial value)
[Clearing conditions]
1
•
Power-on reset or standby mode
•
When 0 is written to PER after reading PER = 1
A receive parity error occurred*
2
[Setting condition]
PER is set to 1 if the number of 1s in receive data, including the parity bit, does
not match the even or odd parity setting of the parity mode bit (O/E) in the serial
mode register (SMR)
Notes: 1. The PER flag is not affected and retains their previous values when the RE bit in SCR
is cleared to 0.
2. When a parity error occurs, the SCI transfers the receive data into the RDR but does
not set RDRF. Serial receiving cannot continue while PER is set to 1. In the clock
synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also disabled. In addition, serial transmission
cannot continue in clock synchronous mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 318 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Bit 2⎯Transmit End (TEND): Indicates that when the last bit of a serial character was
transmitted, the TDR did not contain valid data, so transmission has ended. TEND is a read-only
bit and cannot be written.
Bit 2
TEND
Description
0
Transmission is in progress
[Clearing conditions]
1
•
When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1
•
When DMAC writes data in TDR
End of transmission
(initial value)
[Setting conditions]
•
Power-on reset or standby mode
•
When the TE bit in SCR is 0
•
When TDRE = 1 at transmission of the last bit of a 1-byte serial transmit
character
Bit 1⎯Multiprocessor Bit (MPB): Stores the value of the multiprocessor bit in receive data
when a multiprocessor format is selected for receiving in the asynchronous mode. The MPB is a
read-only bit and cannot be written.
Bit 1
MPB
Description
0
Multiprocessor bit value in receive data is 0*
1
Note:
(initial value)
Multiprocessor bit value in receive data is 1
*
If RE is cleared to 0 when a multiprocessor format is selected, the MPB retains its
previous value.
Bit 0⎯Multiprocessor Bit Transfer (MPBT): Stores the value of the multiprocessor bit added to
transmit data when a multiprocessor format is selected for transmitting in the asynchronous mode.
The MPBT setting is ignored in the clock synchronous mode, when a multiprocessor format is not
selected, or when the SCI is not transmitting.
Bit 0
MPBT
Description
0
Multiprocessor bit value in transmit data is 0
1
Multiprocessor bit value in transmit data is 1
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 319 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.2.8
Bit Rate Register (BRR)
The bit rate register (BRR) is an 8-bit register that, together with the baud rate generator clock
source selected by the CKS1 and CKS0 bits in the serial mode register (SMR), determines the
serial transmit/receive bit rate.
The CPU can always read and write the BRR. The BRR is initialized to H'FF by a power-on reset
or in standby mode. Each channel has independent baud rate generator control, so different values
can be set in the two channels.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Table 12.3 lists examples of BRR settings in the asynchronous mode; table 12.4 lists examples of
BBR settings in the clock synchronous mode.
Table 12.3 Bit Rates and BRR Settings in Asynchronous Mode
φ (MHz)
4
4.9152
6
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
2
70
0.03
2
86
0.31
2
106
−0.44
150
1
207
0.16
1
255
0.00
2
77
0.16
300
1
103
0.16
1
127
0.00
1
155
0.16
600
0
207
0.16
0
255
0.00
1
77
0.16
1200
0
103
0.16
0
127
0.00
0
155
0.16
2400
0
51
0.16
0
63
0.00
0
77
0.16
4800
0
25
0.16
0
31
0.00
0
38
0.16
9600
0
12
0.16
0
15
0.00
0
19
−2.34
14400
0
8
−3.55
0
10
−3.03
0
12
0.16
19200
0
6
−6.99
0
7
0.00
0
9
−2.34
28800
0
3
8.51
0
4
6.67
0
6
−6.99
31250
0
3
0.00
0
4
−1.70
0
5
0.00
38400
0
2
8.51
0
3
0.00
0
4
−2.34
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 320 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
φ (MHz)
7.3728
8
9.8304
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
2
130
−0.07
2
141
0.03
2
174
−0.26
150
2
95
0.00
2
103
0.16
2
127
0.00
300
1
191
0.00
1
207
0.16
1
255
0.00
600
1
95
0.00
1
103
0.16
1
127
0.00
1200
0
191
0.00
0
207
0.16
0
255
0.00
2400
0
95
0.00
0
103
0.16
0
127
0.00
4800
0
47
0.00
0
51
0.16
0
63
0.00
9600
0
23
0.00
0
25
0.16
0
31
0.00
14400
0
15
0.00
0
16
2.12
0
20
1.59
19200
0
11
0.00
0
12
0.16
0
15
0.00
28800
0
7
0.00
0
8
−3.55
0
10
−3.03
31250
0
6
5.33
0
7
0.00
0
9
−1.70
38400
0
5
0.00
0
6
−6.99
0
7
0.00
φ (MHz)
10
11.0592
12
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
2
177
−0.25
2
195
0.19
2
212
0.03
150
2
129
0.16
2
143
0.00
2
155
0.16
300
2
64
0.16
2
71
0.00
2
77
0.16
600
1
129
0.16
1
143
0.00
1
155
0.16
1200
1
64
0.16
1
71
0.00
1
77
0.16
2400
0
129
0.16
0
143
0.00
0
155
0.16
4800
0
64
0.16
0
71
0.00
0
77
0.16
9600
0
32
−1.36
0
35
0.00
0
38
0.16
14400
0
21
−1.36
0
23
0.00
0
25
0.16
19200
0
15
1.73
0
17
0.00
0
19
−2.34
28800
0
10
−1.36
0
11
0.00
0
12
0.16
31250
0
9
0.00
0
10
0.54
0
11
0.00
38400
0
7
1.73
0
8
0.00
0
9
−2.34
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 321 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
φ (MHz)
12.288
14
14.7456
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
2
217
0.08
2
248
−0.17
3
64
0.70
150
2
159
0.00
2
181
0.16
2
191
0.00
300
2
79
0.00
2
90
0.16
2
95
0.00
600
1
159
0.00
1
181
0.16
1
191
0.00
1200
1
79
0.00
1
90
0.16
1
95
0.00
2400
0
159
0.00
0
181
0.16
0
191
0.00
4800
0
79
0.00
0
90
0.16
0
95
0.00
9600
0
39
0.00
0
45
−0.93
0
47
0.00
14400
0
26
−1.23
0
29
1.27
0
31
0.00
19200
0
19
0.00
0
22
−0.93
0
23
0.00
28800
0
12
2.56
0
14
1.27
0
15
0.00
31250
0
11
2.40
0
13
0.00
0
14
−1.70
38400
0
9
0.00
0
10
3.57
0
11
0.00
φ (MHz)
16
17.2032
18
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
3
70
0.03
3
75
0.48
3
79
−0.12
150
2
207
0.16
2
223
0.00
2
233
0.16
300
2
103
0.16
2
111
0.00
2
116
0.16
600
1
207
0.16
1
223
0.00
1
233
0.16
1200
1
103
0.16
1
111
0.00
1
116
0.16
2400
0
207
0.16
0
223
0.00
0
233
0.16
4800
0
103
0.16
0
111
0.00
0
116
0.16
9600
0
51
0.16
0
55
0.00
0
58
−0.69
14400
0
34
−0.79
0
36
0.90
0
38
0.16
19200
0
25
0.16
0
27
0.00
0
28
1.02
28800
0
16
2.12
0
18
−1.75
0
19
−2.34
31250
0
15
0.00
0
16
1.20
0
17
0.00
38400
0
12
0.16
0
13
0.00
0
14
−2.34
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 322 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
φ (MHz)
18.432
19.6608
20
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
3
81
−0.22
3
86
0.31
3
88
−0.25
150
2
239
0.00
2
255
0.00
3
64
0.16
300
2
119
0.00
2
127
0.00
2
129
0.16
600
1
239
0.00
1
255
0.00
2
64
0.16
1200
1
119
0.00
1
127
0.00
1
129
0.16
2400
0
239
0.00
0
255
0.00
1
64
0.16
4800
0
119
0.00
0
127
0.00
0
129
0.16
9600
0
59
0.00
0
63
0.00
0
64
0.16
14400
0
39
0.00
0
42
−0.78
0
42
0.94
19200
0
29
0.00
0
31
0.00
0
32
−1.36
28800
0
19
0.00
0
20
1.59
0
21
−1.36
31250
0
17
2.40
0
19
−1.70
0
19
0.00
38400
0
14
0.00
0
15
0.00
0
15
1.73
φ (MHz)
22
22.1184
24
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
3
97
−0.35
3
97
0.19
3
106
−0.44
150
3
71
−0.54
3
71
0.00
3
77
0.16
300
2
142
0.16
2
143
0.00
2
155
0.16
600
2
71
−0.54
2
71
0.00
2
77
0.16
1200
1
142
0.16
1
143
0.00
1
155
0.16
2400
1
71
−0.54
1
71
0.00
1
77
0.16
4800
0
142
0.16
0
143
0.00
0
155
0.16
9600
0
71
−0.54
0
71
0.00
0
77
0.16
14400
0
47
−0.54
0
47
0.00
0
51
0.16
19200
0
35
−0.54
0
35
0.00
0
38
0.16
28800
0
23
−0.54
0
23
0.00
0
25
0.16
31250
0
21
0.00
0
21
0.54
0
23
0.00
38400
0
17
−0.54
0
17
0.00
0
19
−2.34
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 323 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
φ (MHz)
24.576
25.8048
26
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
3
108
0.08
3
114
−0.40
3
114
0.36
150
3
79
0.00
3
83
0.00
3
84
−0.43
300
2
159
0.00
2
167
0.00
2
168
0.16
600
2
79
0.00
2
83
0.00
2
84
−0.43
1200
1
159
0.00
1
167
0.00
1
168
0.16
2400
1
79
0.00
1
83
0.00
1
84
−0.43
4800
0
159
0.00
0
167
0.00
0
168
0.16
9600
0
79
0.00
0
83
0.00
0
84
−0.43
14400
0
52
0.63
0
55
0.00
0
55
0.76
19200
0
39
0.00
0
41
0.00
0
41
0.76
28800
0
26
−1.23
0
27
0.00
0
27
0.76
31250
0
24
−1.70
0
25
−0.75
0
25
0.00
38400
0
19
0.00
0
20
0.00
0
20
0.76
φ (MHz)
27.0336
28
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
Error (%)
n
N
Error (%)
110
3
119
0.00
3
123
0.23
150
3
87
0.00
3
90
0.16
300
2
175
0.00
2
181
0.16
600
2
87
0.00
2
90
0.16
1200
1
175
0.00
1
181
0.16
2400
1
87
0.00
1
90
0.16
4800
0
175
0.00
0
181
0.16
9600
0
87
0.00
0
90
0.16
14400
0
58
−0.56
0
60
−0.39
19200
0
43
0.00
0
45
−0.93
28800
0
28
1.15
0
29
1.27
31250
0
26
0.12
0
27
0.00
38400
0
21
0.00
0
22
−0.93
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 324 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Table 12.4 Bit Rates and BRR Settings in Clocked Synchronous Mode
φ (MHz)
4
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
n
N
110
3
141
250
2
500
8
10
12
n
N
n
N
n
N
249
3
124
3
155
3
187
2
124
2
249
3
77
3
93
1k
1
249
2
124
2
155
2
187
2.5k
1
99
1
199
1
249
2
74
5k
0
199
1
99
1
124
1
149
10k
0
99
0
199
0
249
1
74
25k
0
39
0
79
0
99
0
119
50k
0
19
0
39
0
49
0
59
100k
0
9
0
19
0
24
0
29
250k
0
3
0
7
0
9
0
11
500k
0
1
0
3
0
4
0
5
1M
0
0*
0
1
⎯
⎯
0
2
0
0*
0
0*
2.5M
5M
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 325 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
φ (MHz)
Bit Rate
(Bits/s)
16
n
N
250
3
249
500
3
1k
2
20
24
28
n
N
n
N
n
N
124
3
155
3
187
3
218
249
3
77
3
93
3
108
110
2.5k
2
99
2
124
2
149
2
174
5k
1
199
1
249
2
74
2
87
10k
1
99
1
124
1
149
1
174
25k
0
159
0
199
0
239
1
69
50k
0
79
0
99
0
119
0
139
100k
0
39
0
49
0
59
0
69
250k
0
15
0
19
0
23
0
27
500k
0
7
0
9
0
11
0
13
1M
0
3
0
4
0
5
0
6
2.5M
⎯
⎯
0
1
⎯
⎯
0
2
0
0*
⎯
⎯
0
1
⎯
⎯
0
0*
5M
7M
Legend:
Blank: No setting available
⎯:
Setting possible, but error occurs
Notes: Settings with an error of 1% or less are recommended.
* Continuous transmission/reception is not possible.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 326 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
The BRR setting is calculated as follows:
Asynchronous mode:
N=
φ
64 ×
22n−1
×B
× 106 − 1
Synchronous mode:
N=
φ
× 106 − 1
64 × 22n−1 × B
Legend:
B: Bit rate (bit/s)
N: Baud rate generator BRR setting (0 ≤ N ≤ 255)
φ: Operating frequency (MHz)
n: Baud rate generator input clock (n = 0 to 3)
(See the following table for the clock sources and value of n.)
SMR Settings
n
Clock Source
CKS1
CKS2
0
φ
0
0
1
φ/4
0
1
2
φ/16
1
0
3
φ/64
1
1
The bit rate error in asynchronous mode is calculated as follows:
⎧
⎧
φ × 106
Error (%) = ⎨
− 1⎨ × 100
2n−1
(N
+
1)
×
B
×
64
×
2
⎩
⎩
Table 12.5 indicates the maximum bit rates in the asynchronous mode when the baud rate
generator is being used for various frequencies. Tables 12.6 and 12.7 show the maximum rates for
external clock input.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 327 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Table 12.5 Maximum Bit Rates for Various Frequencies with Baud Rate Generator
(Asynchronous Mode)
Settings
φ (MHz)
Maximum Bit Rate (Bits/s)
n
N
4
125000
0
0
4.9152
153600
0
0
6
187500
0
0
7.3728
230400
0
0
8
250000
0
0
9.8304
307200
0
0
10
312500
0
0
11.0592
345600
0
0
12
375000
0
0
12.288
384000
0
0
14
437500
0
0
14.7456
460800
0
0
16
500000
0
0
17.2032
537600
0
0
18
562500
0
0
18.432
576000
0
0
19.6608
614400
0
0
20
625000
0
0
22
687500
0
0
22.1184
691200
0
0
24
750000
0
0
24.576
768000
0
0
25.8048
806400
0
0
26
812500
0
0
27.0336
844800
0
0
28
875000
0
0
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 328 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Table 12.6 Maximum Bit Rates during External Clock Input (Asynchronous Mode)
φ (MHz)
External Input Clock (MHz)
Maximum Bit Rate (Bits/s)
4
1.0000
62500
4.9152
1.2288
76800
6
1.5000
93750
7.3728
1.8432
115200
8
2.0000
125000
9.8304
2.4576
153600
10
2.5000
156250
11.0592
2.7648
172800
12
3.0000
187500
12.288
3.0720
192000
14
3.5000
218750
14.7456
3.6864
230400
16
4.0000
250000
17.2032
4.3008
268800
18
4.5000
281250
18.432
4.6080
288000
19.6608
4.9152
307200
20
5.0000
312500
22
5.5000
343750
22.1184
5.5296
345600
24
6.0000
375000
24.576
6.1440
384000
25.8048
6.4512
403200
26
6.5000
406250
27.0336
6.7584
422400
28
7.0000
437500
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 329 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Table 12.7 Maximum Bit Rates during External Clock Input (Clock Synchronous Mode)
φ (MHz)
External Input Clock (MHz)
Maximum Bit Rate (Bits/s)
4
0.6667
666666.7
6
1.0000
1000000.0
8
1.3333
1333333.3
10
1.6667
1666666.7
12
2.0000
2000000.0
14
2.3333
2333333.3
16
2.6667
2666666.7
18
3.0000
3000000.0
20
3.3333
3333333.3
22
3.6667
3666666.7
24
4.0000
4000000.0
26
4.3333
4333333.3
28
4.6667
4666666.7
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 330 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.3
Operation
12.3.1
Overview
For serial communication, the SCI has an asynchronous mode in which characters are
synchronized individually, and a clock synchronous mode in which communication is
synchronized with clock pulses. Asynchronous/clock synchronous mode and the transmission
format are selected in the serial mode register (SMR), as shown in table 12.8. The SCI clock
source is selected by the C/A bit in the serial mode register (SMR) and the CKE1 and CKE0 bits
in the serial control register (SCR), as shown in table 12.9.
Asynchronous Mode:
• Data length is selectable: seven or eight bits.
• Parity and multiprocessor bits are selectable, as well as the stop bit length (one or two bits).
These selections determine the transmit/receive format and character length.
• In receiving, it is possible to detect framing errors (FER), parity errors (PER), overrun errors
(ORER), and the break state.
• An internal or external clock can be selected as the SCI clock source.
⎯ When an internal clock is selected, the SCI operates using the on-chip baud rate generator
clock, and can output a clock with a frequency matching the bit rate.
⎯ When an external clock is selected, the external clock input must have a frequency 16 times
the bit rate. (The on-chip baud rate generator is not used.)
Clock Synchronous Mode:
• The communication format has a fixed 8-bit data length.
• In receiving, it is possible to detect overrun errors (ORER).
• An internal or external clock can be selected as the SCI clock source.
⎯ When an internal clock is selected, the SCI operates using the on-chip baud rate generator
clock, and outputs a synchronous clock signal to external devices.
⎯ When an external clock is selected, the SCI operates on the input synchronous clock. The
on-chip baud rate generator is not used.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 331 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Table 12.8 SMR Settings and SCI Communication Formats
SMR Settings
SCI Communication Format
Mode
Bit 7
C/A
Bit 6
CHR
Bit 5
PE
Bit 2
MP
Bit 3
Data
STOP Length
Parity
Bit
Multipro- Stop Bit
cessor Bit Length
Asynchronous
0
0
0
0
0
Not set
Not set
8-bit
1
1
2 bits
0
Set
1 bit
1
1
0
0
2 bits
7-bit
Not set
1 bit
1
1
2 bits
0
Set
1 bit
1
Asynchronous
(multiprocessor
format)
0
1
Clock
synchronous
1
*
*
1
0
*
1
*
0
*
1
*
*
*
1 bit
2 bits
8-bit
Not set
Set
1 bit
2 bits
7-bit
1 bit
2 bits
8-bit
Not set
None
Note: Asterisks (*) in the table indicate don't-care bits.
Table 12.9 SMR and SCR Settings and SCI Clock Source Selection
SMR
Bit 7
C/A
Mode
Asynchronous 0
SCR Settings
SCI Transmit/Receive Clock
Bit 1
CKE1
Bit 0
CKE0
Clock Source SCK Pin Function*
0
0
Internal
1
1
0
Outputs a clock with frequency
matching the bit rate
External
Inputs a clock with frequency 16 times
the bit rate
Internal
Outputs the synchronous clock
External
Inputs the synchronous clock
1
Clock
synchronous
1
0
0
SCI does not use the SCK pin
1
1
0
1
Note:
*
Select the function in combination with the pin function controller (PFC).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 332 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.3.2
Operation in Asynchronous Mode
In the asynchronous mode, each transmitted or received character begins with a start bit and ends
with a stop bit. Serial communication is synchronized one character at a time.
The transmitting and receiving sections of the SCI are independent, so full duplex communication
is possible. The transmitter and receiver are both double buffered, so data can be written and read
while transmitting and receiving are in progress, enabling continuous transmitting and receiving.
Figure 12.2 shows the general format of asynchronous serial communication. In asynchronous
serial communication, the communication line is normally held in the marking (high) state. The
SCI monitors the line and starts serial communication when the line goes to the space (low) state,
indicating a start bit. One serial character consists of a start bit (low), data (LSB first), parity bit
(high or low), and stop bit (high), in that order.
When receiving in the asynchronous mode, the SCI synchronizes on the falling edge of the start
bit. The SCI samples each data bit on the eighth pulse of a clock with a frequency 16 times the bit
rate. Receive data is latched at the center of each bit.
Serial
data
Idling (marking state)
1
(MSB)
(LSB)
1
0
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
Start
bit
D6
D7
0/1
1
1
Parity
bit
Stop
bit
1 or
no bit
1 or
2 bits
Transmit/receive data
1 bit
7 or 8 bits
One unit of communication data (characters or frames)
Figure 12.2 Data Format in Asynchronous Communication
(Example: 8-bit Data with Parity and Two Stop Bits)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 333 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Transmit/Receive Formats: Table 12.10 shows the 12 communication formats that can be
selected in the asynchronous mode. The format is selected by settings in the serial mode register
(SMR).
Table 12.10 Serial Communication Formats (Asynchronous Mode)
SMR Bits
Serial Transmit/Receive Format and Frame Length
CHR PE
MP
STOP
0
0
0
0
START
8-Bit data
STOP
0
0
0
1
START
8-Bit data
STOP STOP
0
1
0
0
START
8-Bit data
P
STOP
0
1
0
1
START
8-Bit data
P
STOP STOP
1
0
0
0
START
7-Bit data
STOP
1
0
0
1
START
7-Bit data
STOP STOP
1
1
0
0
START
7-Bit data
P
STOP
1
1
0
1
START
7-Bit data
P
STOP STOP
0
⎯
1
0
START
8-Bit data
MPB
STOP
0
⎯
1
1
START
8-Bit data
MPB
STOP STOP
1
⎯
1
0
START
7-Bit data
MPB
STOP
1
⎯
1
1
START
7-Bit data
MPB
STOP STOP
Legend:
START:
STOP:
P:
MPB:
⎯:
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
Start bit
Stop bit
Parity bit
Multiprocessor bit
Don't care
Clock: An internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external clock input
from the SCK pin can be selected as the SCI transmit/receive clock. The clock source is selected
by the C/A bit in the serial mode register (SMR) and bits CKE1 and CKE0 in the serial control
register (SCR) (table 12.9).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 334 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
When an external clock is input at the SCK pin, it must have a frequency equal to 16 times the
desired bit rate.
When the SCI operates on an internal clock, it can output a clock signal at the SCK pin. The
frequency of this output clock is equal to the bit rate. The phase is aligned as in figure 12.3 so that
the rising edge of the clock occurs at the center of each transmit data bit.
0
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
0/1
1
1
1 frame
Figure 12.3 Output Clock and Communication Data Phase Relationship (Asynchronous
Mode)
Data Transmit/Receive Operations
SCI Initialization (Asynchronous Mode): Before transmitting or receiving, clear the TE and RE
bits to 0 in the serial control register (SCR), then initialize the SCI as follows.
When changing the operation mode or communication format, always clear the TE and RE bits to
0 before following the procedure given below. Clearing TE to 0 sets TDRE to 1 and initializes the
transmit shift register (TSR). Clearing RE to 0, however, does not initialize the RDRF, PER, FER,
and ORER flags and receive data register (RDR), which retain their previous contents.
When an external clock is used, the clock should not be stopped during initialization or subsequent
operation. SCI operation becomes unreliable if the clock is stopped.
Figure 12.4 is a sample flowchart for initializing the SCI. The procedure is as follows (the steps
correspond to the numbers in the flowchart):
1. Select the clock source in the serial control register (SCR). Leave RIE, TIE, TEIE, MPIE, TE
and RE cleared to 0. If clock output is selected in asynchronous mode, clock output starts
immediately after the setting is made to SCR.
2. Select the communication format in the serial mode register (SMR).
3. Write the value corresponding to the bit rate in the bit rate register (BRR) unless an external
clock is used.
4. Wait for at least the interval required to transmit or receive one bit, then set TE or RE in the
serial control register (SCR) to 1. Also set RIE, TIE, TEIE and MPIE as necessary. Setting TE
or RE enables the SCI to use the TxD or RxD pin. The initial states are the marking transmit
state, and the idle receive state (waiting for a start bit).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 335 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Initialize
Clear TE and RE bits to 0 in SCR
Set CKE1 and CKE0 bits in SCR
(TE and RE bits are 0)
1
Select transmit/receive format in SMR
2
Set value to BRR
3
Wait
1-bit interval elapsed?
No
Yes
Set TE or RE to 1 in SCR; Set RIE,
TIE, TEIE, and MPIE as necessary
4
End
Figure 12.4 Sample Flowchart for SCI Initialization
Transmitting Serial Data (Asynchronous Mode): Figure 12.5 shows a sample flowchart for
transmitting serial data. The procedure is as follows (the steps correspond to the numbers in the
flowchart):
1. SCI initialization: Set the TxD pin using the PFC.
2. SCI status check and transmit data write: Read the serial status register (SSR), check that the
TDRE bit is 1, then write transmit data in the transmit data register (TDR) and clear TDRE to
0.
3. Continue transmitting serial data: Read the TDRE bit to check whether it is safe to write (if it
reads 1); if so, write data in TDR, then clear TDRE to 0. When the DMAC or the DTC is
started by a transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) in order to write data in TDR, the
TDRE bit is checked and cleared automatically.
4. To output a break at the end of serial transmission, first clear the port data register (DR) to 0,
then clear the TE to 0 in SCR and use the PFC to establish the TxD pin as an output port.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 336 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Initialize
1
Start transmitting
Read TDRE bit in SSR
2
No
TDRE = 1?
Yes
Write transmission data to TDR
and clear TDRE bit in SSR to 0
3
All data transmitted?
No
Yes
Read TEND bit in SSR
No
TEND = 1?
Yes
No
Output break signal?
4
Yes
Set DR = 0
Clear TE bit in SCR to 0;
select theTxD pin as an
output port with the PFC
End transmission
Figure 12.5 Sample Flowchart for Transmitting Serial Data
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 337 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
In transmitting serial data, the SCI operates as follows:
1. The SCI monitors the TDRE bit in the SSR. When TDRE is cleared to 0, the SCI recognizes
that the transmit data register (TDR) contains new data, and loads this data from the TDR into
the transmit shift register (TSR).
2. After loading the data from the TDR into the TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE bit to 1 and starts
transmitting. If the transmit-data-empty interrupt enable bit (TIE) is set to 1 in the SCR, the
SCI requests a transmit-data-empty interrupt (TXI) at this time.
Serial transmit data is transmitted in the following order from the TxD pin:
a. Start bit: one 0 bit is output.
b. Transmit data: seven or eight bits of data are output, LSB first.
c. Parity bit or multiprocessor bit: one parity bit (even or odd parity) or one multiprocessor bit
is output. Formats in which neither a parity bit nor a multiprocessor bit is output can also
be selected.
d. Stop bit: one or two 1 bits (stop bits) are output.
e. Marking: output of 1 bits continues until the start bit of the next transmit data.
3. The SCI checks the TDRE bit when it outputs the stop bit. If TDRE is 0, the SCI loads new
data from the TDR into the TSR, outputs the stop bit, then begins serial transmission of the
next frame. If TDRE is 1, the SCI sets the TEND bit to 1 in the SSR, outputs the stop bit, then
continues output of 1 bits (marking). If the transmit-end interrupt enable bit (TEIE) in the SCR
is set to 1, a transmit-end interrupt (TEI) is requested.
Figure 12.6 shows an example of SCI transmit operation in the asynchronous mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 338 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
1
Serial
data
Start
bit
0
Parity Stop Start
bit bit
bit
Data
D0 D1
D7
0/1
1
0
Data
D0
D1
Parity Stop
bit
bit
D7 0/1
1
1
Idle
(marking
state)
TDRE
TEND
TXI
TXI interrupt
interrupt handler writes
request data in TDR
and clears
TDRE to 0
TXI
request
TEI interrupt request
1 frame
Example: 8-bit data with parity and one stop bit
Figure 12.6 SCI Transmit Operation in Asynchronous Mode
Receiving Serial Data (Asynchronous Mode): Figures 12.7 (1) and (2) show a sample flowchart
for receiving serial data. The procedure is as follows (the steps correspond to the numbers in the
flowchart).
1. SCI initialization: Set the RxD pin using the PFC.
2. Receive error handling and break detection: If a receive error occurs, read the ORER, PER,
and FER bits of the SSR to identify the error. After executing the necessary error handling,
clear ORER, PER, and FER all to 0. Receiving cannot resume if ORER, PER or FER remain
set to 1. When a framing error occurs, the RxD pin can be read to detect the break state.
3. SCI status check and receive-data read: Read the serial status register (SSR), check that RDRF
is set to 1, then read receive data from the receive data register (RDR) and clear RDRF to 0.
The RxI interrupt can also be used to determine if the RDRF bit has changed from 0 to 1.
4. Continue receiving serial data: Read the RDR and RDRF bit and clear RDRF to 0 before the
stop bit of the current frame is received. If the DMAC is started by a receive-data-full interrupt
(RxI) to read RDR, the RDRF bit is cleared automatically so this step is unnecessary.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 339 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Initialization
1
Start reception
Read ORER, PER, and
FER bits in SSR
PER, FER,
ORER = 1?
Yes
2
Error handling
No
Read the RDRF bit in SSR
No
3
RDRF = 1?
Yes
Read reception data of RDR and
clear RDRF bit in SSR to 0
No
4
All data received?
Yes
Clear the RE bit of SCR to 0
End reception
Figure 12.7 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Serial Data (1)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 340 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Start of error handling
No
ORER = 1?
Yes
Overrun error handling
No
FER = 1?
Yes
Break?
Yes
No
Framing error handling
No
Clear RE bit in SCR to 0
PER = 1?
Yes
Parity error handling
Clear ORER, PER, and FER
to 0 in SSR
End
Figure 12.7 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Serial Data (2)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 341 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
In receiving, the SCI operates as follows:
1. The SCI monitors the communication line. When it detects a start bit (0), the SCI synchronizes
internally and starts receiving.
2. Receive data is shifted into the RSR in order from the LSB to the MSB.
3. The parity bit and stop bit are received. After receiving these bits, the SCI makes the following
checks:
a. Parity check. The number of 1s in the receive data must match the even or odd parity
setting of the O/E bit in the SMR.
b. Stop bit check. The stop bit value must be 1. If there are two stop bits, only the first stop bit
is checked.
c. Status check. RDRF must be 0 so that receive data can be loaded from the RSR into the
RDR.
If the data passes these checks, the SCI sets RDRF to 1 and stores the received data in the
RDR. If one of the checks fails (receive error), the SCI operates as indicated in table 12.11.
Note: When a receive error occurs, further receiving is disabled. While receiving, the RDRF
bit is not set to 1, so be sure to clear the error flags.
4. After setting RDRF to 1, if the receive-data-full interrupt enable bit (RIE) is set to 1 in the
SCR, the SCI requests a receive-data-full interrupt (RxI). If one of the error flags (ORER,
PER, or FER) is set to 1 and the receive-data-full interrupt enable bit (RIE) in the SCR is also
set to 1, the SCI requests a receive-error interrupt (ERI).
Figure 12.8 shows an example of SCI receive operation in the asynchronous mode.
Table 12.11 Receive Error Conditions and SCI Operation
Receive Error
Abbreviation
Condition
Data Transfer
Overrun error
ORER
Receiving of next data ends while
RDRF is still set to 1 in SSR
Receive data not loaded
from RSR into RDR
Framing error
FER
Stop bit is 0
Receive data loaded from
RSR into RDR
Parity error
PER
Parity of receive data differs from
even/odd parity setting in SMR
Receive data loaded from
RSR into RDR
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 342 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
1
Serial
data
Start
bit
0
Parity Stop Start
bit bit
bit
Data
D0 D1
D7
0/1
1
0
Parity Stop
bit
bit
Data
D0
D1
D7 0/1
1
1
Idle
(marking
state)
TDRF
RXI interrupt request
FER
1 frame
RXI interrupt
handler reads
data in RDR and
clears RDRF to 0.
Framing error
generates
ERI interrupt
request.
Example: 8-bit data with parity and one stop bit.
Figure 12.8 SCI Receive Operation
12.3.3
Multiprocessor Communication
The multiprocessor communication function enables several processors to share a single serial
communication line for sending and receiving data. The processors communicate in the
asynchronous mode using a format with an additional multiprocessor bit (multiprocessor format).
In multiprocessor communication, each receiving processor is addressed by a unique ID. A serial
communication cycle consists of an ID-sending cycle that identifies the receiving processor, and a
data-sending cycle. The multiprocessor bit distinguishes ID-sending cycles from data-sending
cycles. The transmitting processor starts by sending the ID of the receiving processor with which it
wants to communicate as data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1. Next the transmitting processor
sends transmit data with the multiprocessor bit cleared to 0.
Receiving processors skip incoming data until they receive data with the multiprocessor bit set to
1. When they receive data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1, receiving processors compare the
data with their IDs. The receiving processor with a matching ID continues to receive further
incoming data. Processors with IDs not matching the received data skip further incoming data
until they again receive data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1. Multiple processors can send and
receive data in this way.
Figure 12.9 shows the example of communication among processors using the multiprocessor
format.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 343 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Communication Formats: Four formats are available. Parity-bit settings are ignored when the
multiprocessor format is selected. For details see table 12.8.
Clock: See the description in the asynchronous mode section.
Transmitting
processor
Serial communication line
Serial
data
Receiving
processor A
Receiving
processor B
Receiving
processor C
Receiving
processor D
(ID = 01)
(ID = 02)
(ID = 03)
(ID = 04)
H'01
H'AA
(MPB = 1)
ID-transmit cycle:
receiving processor address
(MPB = 0)
Data-transmit cycle:
data sent to receiving
processor specified by ID
MPB: Multiprocessor bit
Example: Sending data H'AA to receiving processor A
Figure 12.9 Communication Among Processors Using Multiprocessor Format
Transmitting Multiprocessor Serial Data: Figure 12.10 shows a sample flowchart for
transmitting multiprocessor serial data. The procedure is as follows (the steps correspond to the
numbers in the flowchart):
1. SCI initialization: Set the TxD pin using the PFC.
2. SCI status check and transmit data write: Read the serial status register (SSR), check that the
TDRE bit is 1, then write transmit data in the transmit data register (TDR). Also set MPBT
(multiprocessor bit transfer) to 0 or 1 in SSR. Finally, clear TDRE to 0.
3. Continue transmitting serial data: Read the TDRE bit to check whether it is safe to write (if it
reads 1); if so, write data in TDR, then clear TDRE to 0. When the DMAC is started by a
transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) to write data in TDR, the TDRE bit is checked and
cleared automatically.
4. Output a break at the end of serial transmission: Set the data register (DR) of the port to 0, then
clear TE to 0 in SCR and set the TxD pin function as output port with the PFC.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 344 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Initialization
1
Start transmission
Read TDRE bit in SSR
2
No
TDRE = 1?
Yes
Write transmit data in TDR
and set MPBT in SSR
Clear TDRE bit to 0
No
All data transmitted?
3
Yes
Read TEND bit in SSR
No
TEND = 1?
Yes
No
Output break signal?
4
Yes
Set DR = 0
Clear TE bit in SCR to 0;
select theTxD pin function as
an output port with the PFC
End transmission
Figure 12.10 Sample Flowchart for Transmitting Multiprocessor Serial Data
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 345 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
In transmitting serial data, the SCI operates as follows:
1. The SCI monitors the TDRE bit in the SSR. When TDRE is cleared to 0 the SCI recognizes
that the transmit data register (TDR) contains new data, and loads this data from the TDR into
the transmit shift register (TSR).
2. After loading the data from the TDR into the TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE bit to 1 and starts
transmitting. If the transmit-data-empty interrupt enable bit (TIE) in the SCR is set to 1, the
SCI requests a transmit-data-empty interrupt (TXI) at this time.
Serial transmit data is transmitted in the following order from the TxD pin:
a. Start bit: one 0 bit is output.
b. Transmit data: seven or eight bits are output, LSB first.
c. Multiprocessor bit: one multiprocessor bit (MPBT value) is output.
d. Stop bit: one or two 1 bits (stop bits) are output.
e. Marking: output of 1 bits continues until the start bit of the next transmit data.
3. The SCI checks the TDRE bit when it outputs the stop bit. If TDRE is 0, the SCI loads data
from the TDR into the TSR, outputs the stop bit, then begins serial transmission of the next
frame. If TDRE is 1, the SCI sets the TEND bit in the SSR to 1, outputs the stop bit, then
continues output of 1 bits in the marking state. If the transmit-end interrupt enable bit (TEIE)
in the SCR is set to 1, a transmit-end interrupt (TEI) is requested at this time.
Figure 12.11 shows an example of SCI receive operation in the multiprocessor format.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 346 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
1
Multiprocessor
bit
Stop Start
Data
bit
bit
Start
bit
Serial
data
0
D0 D1
D7
0/1
1
0
Multiprocessor
bit
Stop
Data
bit
D0
D1
D7 0/1
1
1
Idle
(marking
state)
TDRE
TEND
TXI
interrupt
request
TXI interrupt
handler writes
data in TDR and
clears TDRE to 0
TXI
interrupt
request
TEI
interrupt
request
1 frame
Example: 8-bit data with multiprocessor bit and one stop bit
Figure 12.11 SCI Multiprocessor Transmit Operation
Receiving Multiprocessor Serial Data: Figures 12.12 (1) and (2) show a sample flowchart for
receiving multiprocessor serial data. The procedure for receiving multiprocessor serial data is
listed below.
1. SCI initialization: Set the RxD pin using the PFC.
2. ID receive cycle: Set the MPIE bit in the serial control register (SCR) to 1.
3. SCI status check and compare to ID reception: Read the serial status register (SSR), check that
RDRF is set to 1, then read data from the receive data register (RDR) and compare with the
processor's own ID. If the ID does not match the receive data, set MPIE to 1 again and clear
RDRF to 0. If the ID matches the receive data, clear RDRF to 0.
4. Receive error handling and break detection: If a receive error occurs, read the ORER and FER
bits in SSR to identify the error. After executing the necessary error processing, clear both
ORER and FER to 0. Receiving cannot resume if ORER or FER remain set to 1. When a
framing error occurs, the RxD pin can be read to detect the break state.
5. SCI status check and data receiving: Read SSR, check that RDRF is set to 1, then read data
from the receive data register (RDR).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 347 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Initialization
1
Start reception
Set MPIE bit in SCR to 1
2
Read ORER and FER bits of SSR
FER = 1?
or ORER =1?
Yes
No
Read RDRF bit in SSR
No
3
RDRF = 1?
Yes
Read receive data from RDR
No
Is ID the station's ID
Yes
Read ORER and FER bits in SSR
FER = 1?
or ORER =1?
Yes
No
Read RDRF bit of SSR
RDRF = 1?
5
No
Yes
Read receive data from RDR
4
No
All data received?
Error processing
Yes
Clear RE bit in SCR to 0
End reception
Figure 12.12 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Multiprocessor Serial Data (1)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 348 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Start error handling
No
ORER = 1?
Yes
Overrun error handling
No
FER = 1?
Yes
Break?
Yes
No
Framing error handling
Clear RE bit in SCR to 0
Clear ORER and FER
bits in SSR to 0
End
Figure 12.12 Sample Flowchart for Receiving Multiprocessor Serial Data (2)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 349 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Figures 12.13 (1) and (2) show examples of SCI receive operation using a multiprocessor format.
1
Serial
data
Start
bit
Data
(ID1)
0
D0 D1
Stop Start Data
MPB bit bit (data 1)
D7
1
1
0
D0
D1
Stop
MPB bit
D7
0
1
1
Idling
(marking)
MPB
MPIE
RDRF
RDR
value
ID1
RXI interrupt request
(multiprocessor
interrupt), MPIE = 0
RXI interrupt handler
reads data in RDR
and clears RDRF to 0
Not station's
ID, so MPIE is
set to 1 again
No RXI interrupt,
RDR maintains
state
Figure 12.13 SCI Receive Operation (ID Does Not Match) (1)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 350 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
1
Serial
data
Start
bit
0
Data
(ID2)
D0
D1
Stop Start Data
MPB bit bit (data 2)
D7
1
1
0
D0
D1
Stop
MPB bit
D7
0
1
1
Idling
(marking)
MPB
MPIE
RDRF
RDR
value
ID1
RXI interrupt request
(multiprocessor
interrupt), MPIE = 0
ID2
RXI interrupt handler
reads data in RDR
and clears RDRF to 0
Data2
Station's ID, so receiving
MPIE
continues, with data
bit is again
received by the RXI
set to 1
interrupt processing routine
Example: Own ID matches data, 8-bit data with multiprocessor bit and one stop bit
Figure 12.13 Example of SCI Receive Operation (ID Matches) (2)
12.3.4
Clock Synchronous Operation
In the clock synchronous mode, the SCI transmits and receives data in synchronization with clock
pulses. This mode is suitable for high-speed serial communication.
The SCI transmitter and receiver are independent, so full duplex communication is possible while
sharing the same clock. The transmitter and receiver are also double buffered, so continuous
transmitting or receiving is possible by reading or writing data while transmitting or receiving is in
progress.
Figure 12.14 shows the general format in clock synchronous serial communication.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 351 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Transfer direction
One unit (character or frame) of communication data
Synchronization clock
*
*
LSB
Serial data
Bit 0
MSB
Bit 1
Bit 2
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 5
Bit 6
Bit 7
Note: * High except in continuous transmitting or receiving.
Figure 12.14 Data Format in Clock Synchronous Communication
In clock synchronous serial communication, each data bit is output on the communication line
from one falling edge of the serial clock to the next. Data are guaranteed valid at the rising edge of
the serial clock. In each character, the serial data bits are transmitted in order from the LSB (first)
to the MSB (last). After output of the MSB, the communication line remains in the state of the
MSB. In the clock synchronous mode, the SCI transmits or receives data by synchronizing with
the falling edge of the synchronization clock.
Communication Format: The data length is fixed at eight bits. No parity bit or multiprocessor bit
can be added.
Clock: An internal clock generated by the on-chip baud rate generator or an external clock input
from the SCK pin can be selected as the SCI transmit/receive clock. The clock source is selected
by the C/A bit in the serial mode register (SMR) and bits CKE1 and CKE0 in the serial control
register (SCR). See table 12.9.
When the SCI operates on an internal clock, it outputs the clock signal at the SCK pin. Eight clock
pulses are output per transmitted or received character. When the SCI is not transmitting or
receiving, the clock signal remains in the high state.
Note: An overrun error occurs only during the receive operation, and the sync clock is output
until the RE bit is cleared to 0. When you want to perform a receive operation in onecharacter units, select external clock for the clock source.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 352 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Transmit/Receive Operations
SCI Initialization (Clock Synchronous Mode): Before transmitting or receiving, software must
clear the TE and RE bits to 0 in the serial control register (SCR), then initialize the SCI as follows.
When changing the mode or communication format, always clear the TE and RE bits to 0 before
following the procedure given below. Clearing TE to 0 sets TDRE to 1 and initializes the transmit
shift register (TSR). Clearing RE to 0, however, does not initialize the RDRF, PER, FER, and
ORER flags and receive data register (RDR), which retain their previous contents.
Figure 12.15 is a sample flowchart for initializing the SCI.
1. Select the clock source in the serial control register (SCR). Leave RIE, TIE, TEIE, MPIE, TE,
and RE cleared to 0.
2. Select the communication format in the serial mode register (SMR).
3. Write the value corresponding to the bit rate in the bit rate register (BRR) unless an external
clock is used.
4. Wait for at least the interval required to transmit or receive one bit, then set TE or RE in the
serial control register (SCR) to 1. Also set RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE. The TxD, RxD pins
becomes usable in response to the PFC corresponding bits and the TE, RE bit settings.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 353 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Start of initialization
Clear TE and RE bits to 0 in SCR
Set RIE, TIE, TEIE, MPIE, CKE1,
and CKE0 bits in SCR
(TE and RE are 0)
1
Select transmit/receive
format in SMR
2
Set value in BRR
3
Wait
1-bit interval elapsed?
No
Yes
Set TE and RE to 1 in SCR;
Set RIE, TIE, TEIE, and MPIE bits
4
End
Figure 12.15 Sample Flowchart for SCI Initialization
Transmitting Serial Data (Synchronous Mode): Figure 12.16 shows a sample flowchart for
transmitting serial data and indicates the procedure to follow.
1. SCI initialization: Set the TxD pin function with the PFC.
2. SCI status check and transmit data write: Read SSR, check that the TDRE flag is 1, then write
transmit data in TDR and clear the TDRE flag to 0.
3. To continue transmitting serial data: After checking that the TDRE flag is 1, indicating that
data can be written, write data in TDR, then clear the TDRE flag to 0. When the DMAC or
DTC is activated by a transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) to write data in TDR, the
TDRE flag is checked and cleared automatically.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 354 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Initialize
1
Start transmitting
2
Read TDRE flag in SSR
No
TDRE = 1?
Yes
Write transmit data in TDR and
clear TDRE flag to 0 in SSR
No
All data transmitted?
3
Yes
Read TEND flag in SSR
TEND = 1?
No
Yes
Clear TE bit to 0 in SCR
End
Figure 12.16 Sample Flowchart for Serial Transmitting
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 355 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Figure 12.17 shows an example of SCI transmit operation.
Transmit direction
Synchronization clock
LSB
Serial data
Bit 0
MSB
Bit 1
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 6
Bit 7
TDRE
TEND
TXI
request
TXI interrupt
handler writes
data in TDR and
clears TDRE to 0
TXI
request
TEI
request
1 frame
Figure 12.17 Example of SCI Transmit Operation
SCI serial transmission operates as follows.
1. The SCI monitors the TDRE bit in the SSR. When TDRE is cleared to 0 the SCI recognizes
that the transmit data register (TDR) contains new data and loads this data from the TDR into
the transmit shift register (TSR).
2. After loading the data from the TDR into the TSR, the SCI sets the TDRE bit to 1 and starts
transmitting. If the transmit-data-empty interrupt enable bit (TIE) in the SCR is set to 1, the
SCI requests a transmit-data-empty interrupt (TXI) at this time.
If clock output mode is selected, the SCI outputs eight synchronous clock pulses. If an external
clock source is selected, the SCI outputs data in synchronization with the input clock. Data are
output from the TxD pin in order from the LSB (bit 0) to the MSB (bit 7).
3. The SCI checks the TDRE bit when it outputs the MSB (bit 7). If TDRE is 0, the SCI loads
data from the TDR into the TSR, then begins serial transmission of the next frame. If TDRE is
1, the SCI sets the TEND bit in the SSR to 1, transmits the MSB, then holds the transmit data
pin (TxD) in the MSB state. If the transmit-end interrupt enable bit (TEIE) in the SCR is set to
1, a transmit-end interrupt (TEI) is requested at this time.
4. After the end of serial transmission, the SCK pin is held in the high state.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 356 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Receiving Serial Data (Clock Synchronous Mode): Figures 12.18 (1) and (2) show a sample
flowchart for receiving serial data. When switching from the asynchronous mode to the clock
synchronous mode, make sure that ORER, PER, and FER are cleared to 0. If PER or FER is set to
1, the RDRF bit will not be set and both transmitting and receiving will be disabled.
The procedure for receiving serial data is listed below:
1. SCI initialization: Set the RxD pin using the PFC.
2. Receive error handling: If a receive error occurs, read the ORER bit in SSR to identify the
error. After executing the necessary error handling, clear ORER to 0. Transmitting/receiving
cannot resume if ORER remains set to 1.
3. SCI status check and receive data read: Read the serial status register (SSR), check that RDRF
is set to 1, then read receive data from the receive data register (RDR) and clear RDRF to 0.
The RxI interrupt can also be used to determine if the RDRF bit has changed from 0 to 1.
4. Continue receiving serial data: Read RDR, and clear RDRF to 0 before the frame MSB (bit 7)
of the current frame is received. If the DMAC is started by a receive-data-full interrupt (RXI)
to read RDR, the RDRF bit is cleared automatically so this step is unnecessary.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 357 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Initialization
1
Start reception
Read the ORER bit of SSR
Yes
ORER = 1?
2
Error processing
No
Read RDRF bit of SSR
No
3
RDRF = 1?
Yes
Read receive data from RDR
and clear RDRF bit of SSR to 0
4
No
All data received?
Yes
Clear RE bit of SCR to 0
End reception
Figure 12.18 Sample Flowchart for Serial Receiving (1)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 358 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Error handling
Overrun error processing
Clear ORER bit of SSR to 0
End
Figure 12.18 Sample Flowchart for Serial Receiving (2)
Figure 12.19 shows an example of the SCI receive operation.
Transfer direction
Synchronization clock
Serial
data
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 7
Bit 0
Bit 1
Bit 6
Bit 7
RDRF
ORER
RXI request
Read data with RXI
interrupt processing
routine and clear
RDRF bit to 0
RXI request
ERI interrupt
request generated
by overrun error
1 frame
Figure 12.19 Example of SCI Receive Operation
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 359 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
In receiving, the SCI operates as follows:
1. The SCI synchronizes with serial clock input or output and initializes internally.
2. Receive data is shifted into the RSR in order from the LSB to the MSB. After receiving the
data, the SCI checks that RDRF is 0 so that receive data can be loaded from the RSR into the
RDR. If this check passes, the SCI sets RDRF to 1 and stores the received data in the RDR. If
the check does not pass (receive error), the SCI operates as indicated in table 12.11 and no
further transmission or reception is possible. If the error flag is set to 1, the RDRF bit is not set
to 1 during reception, even if the RDRF bit is 0 cleared. When restarting reception, be sure to
clear the error flag.
3. After setting RDRF to 1, if the receive-data-full interrupt enable bit (RIE) is set to 1 in the
SCR, the SCI requests a receive-data-full interrupt (RXI). If the ORER bit is set to 1 and the
receive-data-full interrupt enable bit (RIE) in the SCR is also set to 1, the SCI requests a
receive-error interrupt (ERI).
Transmitting and Receiving Serial Data Simultaneously (Clock Synchronous Mode): Figure
12.20 shows a sample flowchart for transmitting and receiving serial data simultaneously. The
procedure is as follows (the steps correspond to the numbers in the flowchart):
1. SCI initialization: Set the TxD and RxD pins using the PFC.
2. SCI status check and transmit data write: Read the serial status register (SSR), check that the
TDRE bit is 1, then write transmit data in the transmit data register (TDR) and clear TDRE to
0. The TXI interrupt can also be used to determine if the TDRE bit has changed from 0 to 1.
3. Receive error handling: If a receive error occurs, read the ORER bit in SSR to identify the
error. After executing the necessary error processing, clear ORER to 0. Transmitting/receiving
cannot resume if ORER remains set to 1.
4. SCI status check and receive data read: Read the serial status register (SSR), check that RDRF
is set to 1, then read receive data from the receive data register (RDR) and clear RDRF to 0.
The RxI interrupt can also be used to determine if the RDRF bit has changed from 0 to 1.
5. Continue transmitting and receiving serial data: Read the RDRF bit and RDR, and clear RDRF
to 0 before the frame MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is received. Also read the TDRE bit to
check whether it is safe to write (if it reads 1); if so, write data in TDR, then clear TDRE to 0
before the MSB (bit 7) of the current frame is transmitted. When the DMAC is started by a
transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) to write data in TDR, the TDRE bit is checked and
cleared automatically. When the DMAC is started by a receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) to read
RDR, the RDRF bit is cleared automatically.
Note: In switching from transmitting or receiving to simultaneous transmitting and receiving,
simultaneously clear the TE bit and RE bit to 0, then simultaneously set the TE bit and RE
bit to 1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 360 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
Initialization
1
Start transmitting/receive
Read TDRE bit in SSR
No
2
TDRE = 1?
Yes
Write transmission data in TDR
and clear TDRE bit of SSR to 0
Read ORER bit of SSR
ORER = 1?
Yes
3
Error handling
No
Read RDRF bit of SSR
No
4
RDRF = 1?
Yes
Read receive data of RDR,
and clear RDRF bit of SSR to 0
No
5
All
data transmitted/and
received
Yes
Clear TE and RE bits of SCR to 0
End transmission/reception
Figure 12.20 Sample Flowchart for Serial Transmission
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 361 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.4
SCI Interrupt Sources and the DMAC
The SCI has four interrupt sources: transmit-end (TEI), receive-error (ERI), receive-data-full
(RXI), and transmit-data-empty (TXI). Table 12.12 lists the interrupt sources and indicates their
priority. These interrupts can be enabled and disabled by the TIE, RIE, and TEIE bits in the serial
control register (SCR). Each interrupt request is sent separately to the interrupt controller.
TXI is requested when the TDRE bit in the SSR is set to 1. TXI can start the direct memory access
controller (DMAC) to transfer data. TDRE is automatically cleared to 0 when the DMAC writes
data in the transmit data register (TDR).
RxI is requested when the RDRF bit in the SSR is set to 1. RXI can start the DMAC to transfer
data. RDRF is automatically cleared to 0 when the DMAC reads the receive data register (RDR).
ERI is requested when the ORER, PER, or FER bit in the SSR is set to 1. ERI cannot start the
DMAC.
TEI is requested when the TEND bit in the SSR is set to 1. TEI cannot start the DMAC. Where the
TXI interrupt indicates that transmit data writing is enabled, the TEI interrupt indicates that the
transmit operation is complete.
Table 12.12 SCI Interrupt Sources
Interrupt Source
Description
DMAC Activation
Priority
ERI
Receive error (ORER, PER, or FER)
No
High
RXI
Receive data full (RDRF)
Yes
TXI
Transmit data empty (TDRE)
Yes
TEI
Transmit end (TEND)
No
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 362 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Low
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.5
Usage Notes
Sections 12.5.1 through 12.5.9 provide information for using the SCI.
12.5.1
TDR Write and TDRE Flags
The TDRE bit in the serial status register (SSR) is a status flag indicating loading of transmit data
from TDR into TSR. The SCI sets TDRE to 1 when it transfers data from TDR to TSR. Data can
be written to TDR regardless of the TDRE bit status. If new data is written in TDR when TDRE is
0, however, the old data stored in TDR will be lost because the data has not yet been transferred to
the TSR. Before writing transmit data to the TDR, be sure to check that TDRE is set to 1.
12.5.2
Simultaneous Multiple Receive Errors
Table 12.13 indicates the state of the SSR status flags when multiple receive errors occur
simultaneously. When an overrun error occurs, the RSR contents cannot be transferred to the
RDR, so receive data is lost.
Table 12.13 SSR Status Flags and Transfer of Receive Data
Receive Error Status
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
Receive Data
Transfer
RSR → RDR
Overrun error
1
1
0
0
X
Framing error
0
0
1
0
O
Parity error
0
0
0
1
O
Overrun error + framing error
1
1
1
0
X
Overrun error + parity error
1
1
0
1
X
Framing error + parity error
0
0
1
1
O
Overrun error + framing error + parity error 1
1
1
1
X
SSR Status Flags
Note: O = Receive data is transferred from RSR to RDR.
X = Receive data is not transferred from RSR to RDR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 363 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.5.3
Break Detection and Processing
Break signals can be detected by reading the RxD pin directly when a framing error (FER) is
detected. In the break state, the input from the RxD pin consists of all 0s, so FER is set and the
parity error flag (PER) may also be set. In the break state, the SCI receiver continues to operate, so
if the FER bit is cleared to 0, it will be set to 1 again.
12.5.4
Sending a Break Signal
The TxD pin becomes a general I/O pin with the I/O direction and level determined by the I/O port
data register (DR) and pin function controller (PFC) control register (CR). These conditions allow
break signals to be sent. The DR value is substituted for the marking status until the PFC is set.
Consequently, the output port is set to initially output a 1. To send a break in serial transmission,
first clear the DR to 0, then establish the TxD pin as an output port using the PFC. When TE is
cleared to 0, the transmission section is initialized regardless of the present transmission status.
12.5.5
Receive Error Flags and Transmitter Operation (Clock Synchronous Mode Only)
When a receive error flag (ORER, PER, or FER) is set to 1, the SCI will not start transmitting
even if TDRE is set to 1. Be sure to clear the receive error flags to 0 before starting to transmit.
Note that clearing RE to 0 does not clear the receive error flags.
12.5.6
Receive Data Sampling Timing and Receive Margin in the Asynchronous Mode
In the asynchronous mode, the SCI operates on a base clock of 16 times the bit rate frequency. In
receiving, the SCI synchronizes internally with the falling edge of the start bit, which it samples
on the base clock. Receive data is latched on the rising edge of the eighth base clock pulse (figure
12.21).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 364 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
16 clocks
8 clocks
Internal 0
base clock
Receive
data (RxD)
78
15 0
−7.5 clocks
78
15 0
5
+7.5 clocks
Start bit
D0
D1
Synchronization
sampling timing
Data
sampling timing
Figure 12.21 Receive Data Sampling Timing in Asynchronous Mode
The receive margin in the asynchronous mode can therefore be expressed as:
M = 0.5 −
1
D − 0.5
(1 + F) × 100 %
− (L − 0.5)F −
2N
N
Legend:
M : Receive margin (%)
N : Ratio of clock frequency to bit rate (N = 16)
D : Clock duty cycle (D = 0 − 1.0)
L : Frame length (L = 9 − 12)
F : Absolute deviation of clock frequency
From the equation above, if F = 0 and D = 0.5 the receive margin is 46.875%:
D = 0.5, F = 0
M = (0.5 − 1/(2 × 16)) × 100%
= 46.875%
This is a theoretical value. A reasonable margin to allow in system designs is 20 to 30%.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 365 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
12. Serial Communication Interface (SCI)
12.5.7
Constraints on DMAC Use
• When using an external clock source for the synchronization clock, update the TDR with the
DMAC, and then after five system clocks or more elapse, input a transmit clock. If a transmit
clock is input in the first four system clocks after the TDR is written, an error may occur
(figure 12.22).
• Before reading the receive data register (RDR) with the DMAC, select the receive-data-full
interrupt (RXI) of the SCI as a start-up source.
SCK
t
TDRE
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Note: During external clock operation, an error may occur if t is 4φ or less.
Figure 12.22 Example of Clock Synchronous Transmission with DMAC
12.5.8
Cautions for Clock Synchronous External Clock Mode
• Set TE = RE = 1 only when the external clock SCK is 1.
• Do not set TE = RE = 1 until at least four clocks after the external clock SCK has changed
from 0 to 1.
• When receiving, RDRF is 1 when RE is set to zero 2.5 to 3.5 clocks after the rising edge of the
RxD D7 bit SCK input, but it cannot be copied to RDR.
12.5.9
Caution for Clock Synchronous Internal Clock Mode
When receiving, RDRF is 1 when RE is set to zero 1.5 clocks after the rising edge of the RxD D7
bit SCK output, but it cannot be copied to RDR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 366 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Section 13 High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.1
Overview
The high speed A/D converter has 10-bit resolution, and can select from a maximum of eight
channels of analog inputs.
13.1.1
Features
The high speed A/D converter has the following features:
• 10-bit resolution
• Eight input channels
• High-speed conversion
⎯ Minimum conversion time: 2.9 μs per channel (for 28-MHz operation)
1.4 μs per channel during continuous conversion
• Multiple conversion modes
⎯ Select mode/group mode
⎯ Single mode/scan mode
⎯ Buffered operation possible
⎯ 2 channel simultaneous sampling possible
• Two types of conversion start
⎯
Software, or timer conversion start trigger (MTU) can be selected.
• Eight data registers
⎯ Conversion results stored in 16-bit data registers corresponding to each channel.
• Sample and hold function
• A/D conversion end interrupt generation
⎯ An A/D conversion end interrupt (ADI) request can be generated on completion of A/D
conversions
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 367 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.1.2
Block Diagram
Figure 13.1 is the block diagram of the high speed A/D converter.
D/A
conversion
circuit
Internal
data bus
Bus I/F
AVCC
ADDRA
S&H A
ADDRC
AN3
AN4
AN5
S&H B
+
−
CMP
Control logic
ADDRB
AN2
Multiplexer
AN1
Module internal data bus
AN0
ADDRD
ADDRE
ADDRF
AN6
ADDRG
AN7
AVss
ADCR ADCSR
ADDRH
MTU conversion
start trigger
Legend:
ADCR:
ADCSR:
ADDRA:
ADDRB:
ADDRC:
ADDRD:
Interrupt signal
ADI
A/D control register
A/D control status register
A/D data register A
A/D data register B
A/D data register C
A/D data register D
CMP:
S&H:
ADDRE:
ADDRF:
ADDRG:
ADDRH:
Comparator array
Sample and hold circuit
A/D data register E
A/D data register F
A/D data register G
A/D data register H
Figure 13.1 High Speed A/D Converter Block Diagram
13.1.3
Pin Configuration
Table 13.1 shows the input pins used by the high speed A/D converter.
The AVCC and AVSS pins are for the high speed A/D converter internal analog section power
supply.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 368 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Table 13.1 Pin Configuration
Pin
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
Analog supply
AVCC
I
Analog section power supply
Analog ground
AVSS
I
Analog section ground and A/D conversion
reference voltage
Analog input 0
AN0
I
Analog input channel 0
Analog input 1
AN1
I
Analog input channel 1
Analog input 2
AN2
I
Analog input channel 2
Analog input 3
AN3
I
Analog input channel 3
Analog input 4
AN4
I
Analog input channel 4
Analog input 5
AN5
I
Analog input channel 5
Analog input 6
AN6
I
Analog input channel 6
Analog input 7
AN7
I
Analog input channel 7
13.1.4
Register Configuration
Table 13.2 shows the configuration of the high speed A/D converter registers.
Table 13.2 Register Configuration
Name
Abbreviation R/W
Initial Value
Address
Access Size
A/D data register A
ADDRA
H'0000
H'FFFF83F0
8,16
R
A/D data register B
ADDRB
R
H'0000
H'FFFF83F2
A/D data register C
ADDRC
R
H'0000
H'FFFF83F4
A/D data register D
ADDRD
R
H'0000
H'FFFF83F6
A/D data register E
ADDRE
R
H'0000
H'FFFF83F8
A/D data register F
ADDRF
R
H'0000
H'FFFF83FA
A/D data register G
ADDRG
R
H'0000
H'FFFF83FC
A/D data register H
ADDRH
R
H'0000
H'FFFF83FE
A/D control/status register ADCSR
R/(W)* H'00
H'FFFF83E0
A/D control register
R/W
H'FFFF83E1
Note:
*
ADCR
H'00
Only 0 can be written to bit 7 to clear the flag.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 369 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.2
Register Descriptions
13.2.1
A/D Data Registers A to H (ADDRA to ADDRH)
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD9
AD8
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
The ADDR are 16-bit read only registers for storing A/D conversion results. There are eight of
these registers, ADDRA through ADDRH.
The A/D converted data is 10-bit data which is sent to the ADDR for the corresponding converted
channel for storage. The lower 8 bits of the A/D converted data are transferred to and stored in the
lower byte (bits 7 to 0) of the ADDR, and the upper 2 bits are stored into the upper byte (bits 9, 8).
Bits 15 to 10 always read as 0. Data reads can be either byte or word. The upper 8 bits of the
converted data are transferred upon byte data reads. Additionally, buffered operation is possible by
combining ADDRA to ADDRD.
Table 13.3 shows the correspondence between the analog input channels and the ADDR.
The ADDR are initialized to H'0000 by power-on reset or in standby mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 370 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Table 13.3 Analog Input Channel and ADDR Correspondence
Analog Input Channel
A/D Data Register
AN0
ADDRA*
AN1
ADDRB*
AN2
ADDRC*
AN3
ADDRD*
AN4
ADDRE
AN5
ADDRF
AN6
ADDRG
AN7
ADDRH
Note:
*
13.2.2
Except during buffer operation
A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR)
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
*
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ADF
ADIE
ADST
CKS
GRP
CH2
CH1
CH0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Only 0 can be written to bit 7 to clear the flag.
The ADCSR is an 8-bit read/write register used for A/D conversion operation control and to
indicate status.
The ADCSR is initialized to H'00 by power-on reset or in standby mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 371 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Bit 7⎯A/D End Flag (ADF): This status flag indicates that A/D conversion has ended.
Bit 7
ADF
Description
0
[Clear conditions]
1
(initial value)
•
With ADF = 1, by reading the ADF flag then writing 0 in ADF
•
When the DMAC is activated by an ADI interrupt
[Set conditions]
•
Single mode: When A/D conversion ends after conversion for all
designated channels (during buffer operation, this is not set until
operation of the specified buffer has ended)
•
Scan mode: After one round of A/D conversion for all specified
channels
Bit 6⎯A/D Interrupt Enable (ADIE): Enables or disables interrupt requests (ADI) after A/D
conversion ends. Set the ADIE bit while conversion is suspended.
Bit 6
ADIE
Description
0
Disables interrupt requests (ADI) after A/D conversion ends
(initial value)
1
Enables interrupt requests (ADI) after A/D conversion ends
Bit 5⎯A/D Start (ADST): Selects start or stop for A/D conversion. A 1 is maintained during A/D
conversions.
The ADST bit can be set to 1 by software, or timer conversion start triggers.
Bit 5
ADST
Description
0
A/D conversion halted
1
•
Single mode: Start A/D conversion. Automatically cleared to 0 after
conversion for the designated channel ends.
•
Scan mode: Start A/D conversion. Continuous conversion until 0
cleared by software.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 372 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Bit 4⎯Clock Select (CKS): Sets the A/D conversion time. Set so that the conversion time is 2 μs
or greater in proportion to the operating frequency.
Make conversion time changes only while conversion is halted.
Bit 4
CKS
Description
0
Conversion time = 40 states
(high speed A/D converter standard clock = φ/2)
(initial value)
Conversion time = 80 states (when φ/4 is selected)
1
Bit 3⎯Group Mode (GRP): Designates either select mode or group mode for the A/D
conversion channel selection.
Set the GRP bit only while conversion is halted.
Bit 3
GRP
Description
0
Select mode
1
Group mode
(initial value)
Bits 2 to 0⎯Channel Select 2 to 0 (CH2 to CH0): These bits, along with the GRP bit, select the
analog input channel.
Set the input channel only while conversion is halted.
Description
Bit 2
CH2
Bit 1
CH1
Bit 0
CH0
Select Mode (GRP = 0)
0
0
0
AN0
1
AN1
AN0 to AN1
0
AN2
AN0 to AN2
1
AN3
AN0 to AN3
0
AN4
AN0 to AN4
1
AN5
AN0 to AN5
0
AN6
AN0 to AN6
1
AN7
AN0 to AN7
1
1
0
1
Group Mode (GRP = 1)
(initial value) AN0
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 373 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.2.3
A/D Control Register (ADCR)
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
PWR
TRGS1
TRGS0
SCAN
DSMP
BUFE1
BUFE0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
The ADCR is an 8-bit read/write register used for A/D conversion operation control. The ADCR is
initialized to H'00 by power-on reset or in standby mode.
Bit 7⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 6⎯Power (PWR): Designates the conversion start mode for the high speed A/D converter.
Setting the PWR bit to 1 sets high speed start mode, and a 0 sets to low power conversion mode.
See section 13.4.7, Conversion Start Modes for details on the conversion start operation.
Set the PWR bit only while conversion is halted.
Bit 6
PWR
Description
0
Low power conversion mode
1
High speed start mode
(initial value)
Bits 5 and 4⎯Timer Trigger Select 1, 0 (TRGS1, TRGS0): These bits enable or prohibit A/D
conversion starts by trigger signals.
Set the TRGS1, TRGS0 bits only while conversion is halted.
Bit 5
TRGS1
Bit 4
TRGS0
Description
0
0
Enable A/D conversion start by software
1
Enables A/D conversion start by MTU conversion start trigger
0
Reserved
1
Reserved
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 374 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Bit 3⎯Scan Mode (SCAN): Selects either single mode or scan mode for the A/D conversion
operation mode. See section 13.4, Operation, for details on single mode and scan mode operation.
Set the SCAN bit only while conversion is halted.
Bit 3
SCAN
Description
0
Single mode
1
Scan mode
(initial value)
Bit 2⎯Simultaneous Sampling (DSMP): Enables or disables the simultaneous sampling of two
channels. See section 13.4.6, Simultaneous Sampling Operation, for details on simultaneous
sampling.
Set the DSMP bit only while conversion is halted.
Bit 2
DSMP
Description
0
Normal sampling operation
1
Simultaneous sampling operation
(initial value)
Bits 1 and 0⎯Buffer Enable 1, 0 (BUFE1, BUFE0): These bits select whether to use the
ADDRB to ADDRD as buffer registers.
Set the BUFE1 and BUFE0 bits only while conversion is halted.
Bit 1
BUFE1
Bit 0
BUFE0
Description
0
0
Normal operation
1
ADDRA and ADDRB buffer operation: conversion result →
ADDRA → ADDRB (ADDRB is the buffer register)
0
ADDRA and ADDRC, also ADDRB and ADDRD buffer
operation: conversion result 1 → ADDRA → ADDRC,
conversion result 2 → ADDRB → ADDRD (ADDRC and
ADDRD are buffer registers)
1
ADDRA to ADDRD buffer operation: conversion result →
ADDRA → ADDRB → ADDRC → ADDRD (ADDRB to ADDRD
are buffer registers)
1
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 375 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.3
Bus Master Interface
The ADDRA to ADDRH are 16-bit registers with a 16-bit width data bus to the bus master. The
bus master can read from ADDRA to ADDRH in either word or byte units.
When an ADDR is read in word units, the ADDR contents are transferred to the bus master 16 bits
at a time. In byte unit reads, the contents of the most significant eight bits (AD9 to AD2) of the
converted data (AD9 to AD0) are transferred to the bus master.
Figures 13.2 (1) and (2) show an example of the ADDR read operation.
Word data read
Data
register
Bus I/F
0
0
0
Internal data bus
0
Upper 8 bits
0
0
AD 9
AD 8
AD 7
AD 6
AD 5
AD 4
Lower 8 bits
AD 3
AD 2
AD 1
AD 0
Figure 13.2 ADDR Read Operation (1)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 376 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Byte data read
Data register
Bus I/F
0
0
0
Internal data bus
0
Upper 8 bits
0
0
AD 9
AD 8
AD 7
AD 6
AD 5
AD 4
AD 3
AD 2
AD 1
AD 0
Figure 13.2 ADDR Read Operation (2)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 377 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.4
Operation
• The high speed A/D converter has 10-bit resolution.
• In addition to the four operating modes of select or group, and single or scan can be set in
combination with buffer operation.
• Select mode uses one channel and group mode selects multiple channels.
• One start in the single mode performs conversions on all selected channels, and one start in the
scan mode performs repeated conversions until stopped by software.
• In buffer operation, the previous conversion result is saved in a buffer register at the end of a
conversion for the relevant channel.
• In simultaneous sampling operation, the analog input voltages of two channels are sampled
simultaneously then converted in order.
• Software, a timer conversion start trigger (MTU) can be selected as the conversion start
condition.
• High speed start mode or low power conversion mode can be selected for A/D conversion
using the PWR bit setting.
• When changing the operation mode or input channel, rewrite the ADCSR, ADCR while the
ADST bit is cleared to 0. After rewriting the ADCSR, ADCR, A/D conversion will be restarted
when the ADST bit is set to 1. Operation mode or input channel changes can be made
simultaneously with ADST bit setting. When stopping an A/D conversion before completion, 0
clear the ADST bit.
13.4.1
Select-Single Mode
Choose select-single mode when doing A/D conversions for one channel only.
When the ADST bit is set to 1, A/D conversion is started according to the designated conversion
start conditions. The ADST bit is held to 1 during the A/D conversion and is automatically cleared
to 0 upon completion.
The ADF flag is also set to 1 at the end of conversion. If the ADIE bit is set to 1 at this time, an
ADI interrupt request is generated. The ADF flag is cleared by reading the ADCSR, then writing a
0.
Figure 13.3 shows an example of operation in the select-single mode when AN1 is selected.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 378 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
ADF
Set to 1 by software
ADST
Channel 0
Channel 1
Automatic clear
Conversion standby
A/D
Conversion
Conversion
Sampling 1
standby
conversion 1 standby
Channel 2
Conversion standby
Channel 3
Conversion standby
ADDRA
ADDRB
Conversion result 1
ADDRC
ADDRD
Figure 13.3 High Speed A/D Converter Operation Example (Select-Single Mode)
13.4.2
Select-Scan Mode
Choose select-scan mode when doing repeated A/D conversions for one channel. This is useful
when doing continuous monitoring of the analog input of one channel.
When the ADST bit is set to 1, A/D conversion is started according to the designated conversion
start conditions. The ADST bit is held to 1 until 0 cleared by software. A/D conversion for the
selected input channel is repeated during that interval.
The ADF flag is set to 1 at the end of the first conversion. At this point, if the ADIE bit is set, an
ADI interrupt request is issued, and the high speed A/D converter is halted. With the high speed
A/D converter in stop mode due to an ADI interrupt request, conversion is restarted when the ADF
flag is cleared to 0. The ADF flag is cleared by reading the ADCSR then writing a 0.
Figure 13.4 shows an example of operation in the select-scan mode when AN1 is selected.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 379 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
ADF
ADST
Channel 0
Set to 1 by software
Cleared to 0 by software
Conversion standby
A/D conversion 5
Channel 1
ConverSampling
sion
1
standby
A/D
conversion 1
Sampling
3
A/D
conversion 3
Sampling
5
Conversion
standby
Sampling
2
A/D
conversion 2
Sampling
4
A/D
conversion 4
Conversion
stopped
Sampling 6
Channel 2
Conversion standby
Channel 3
Conversion standby
ADDRA
ADDRB
Conversion
result 1
Conversion
result 2
Conversion
result 3
Conversion
result 4
ADDRC
ADDRD
Figure 13.4 High Speed A/D Converter Operation Example (Select-Scan Mode)
13.4.3
Group-Single Mode
Choose group-single mode when doing A/D conversions for multiple channels.
When the ADST bit is set to 1, A/D conversion is started according to the designated conversion
start conditions. The ADST bit is held to 1 during A/D conversion and is automatically cleared to
0 when all conversions for the designated input channels are completed.
The ADF flag is set to 1 when all conversions for the designated input channels are completed. If
the ADIE bit is set to 1 at this time, an ADI interrupt request is generated. The ADF flag is cleared
by reading the ADCSR then writing a 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 380 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Figure 13.5 shows an example of operation in the group-single mode when AN0 to AN2 are
selected.
ADF
ADST
Channel 0
Channel 1
A/D
Conversion Sampling conversion Conversion
standby
standby
1
1
Conversion standby
Channel 2 Conversion standby
Channel 3
Automatic clear
Set to 1 by software
A/D
Sampling conversion
2
2
Sampling
3
Conversion standby
A/D
Conversion
conversion
standby
3
Conversion standby
ADDRA
ADDRB
ADDRC
Conversion result 1
Conversion result 2
Conversion result 3
ADDRD
Figure 13.5 High Speed A/D Converter Operation Example (Group-Single Mode)
13.4.4
Group-Scan Mode
Choose group-scan mode when doing repeated A/D conversions for multiple channels. This is
useful when doing continuous monitoring of the analog inputs of multiple channels.
When the ADST bit is set to 1, A/D conversion is started according to the designated conversion
start conditions. The ADST bit is held to 1 until 0 cleared by software. A/D conversion for the
selected input channels is repeated during that interval.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 381 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
The ADF flag is set to 1 at the completion of the first conversions of all the designated input
channels. At this point, if the ADIE bit is set to 1, an ADI interrupt request is issued, and the high
speed A/D converter is temporarily halted. With the high speed A/D converter in stop mode due to
an ADI interrupt request, conversion is restarted when the ADF flag is cleared to 0. The ADF flag
is cleared by reading the ADCSR, then writing a 0.
Figure 13.6 shows an example of operation in the group-scan mode when AN0 to AN2 are
selected.
Conversion standby
ADF
Cleared to 0 by software
Set to 1 by software
ADST
Conversion
stopped
Channel 0
Channel 1
Channel 2
Conversion
standby
Sampling
1
Conversion
standby
A/D
conversion 1
Sampling
2
Conversion standby
Channel 3
ADDRA
ADDRB
Sampling
4
A/D
conversion 4
A/D
conversion 2
Conversion
standby
Sampling
5
A/D
conversion 5
Sampling
3
A/D
conversion 3
Conversion
standby
Sampling
6
Conversion standby
Conversion result 1
Conversion result 4
Conversion result 2
Conversion result 5
ADDRC
Conversion result 3
ADDRD
Figure 13.6 High Speed A/D Converter Operation Example (Group-Scan Mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 382 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.4.5
Buffer Operation
When conversion ends on the relevant channel, the conversion result is stored in the ADDR, and
simultaneously, the previously stored result is transferred to another ADDR. Buffer operation can
be selected from the following:
• AN0 → ADDRA → ADDRB (Two-stage, one-group operation)
• AN0 → ADDRA → ADDRC, AN1 → ADDRB → ADDRD (Two-stage, two-group
operation)
• AN0 → ADDRA → ADDRB → ADDRC → ADDRD (Four-stage, one-group operation)
To use in combination with simultaneous sampling, set GRP = 1, BUFE1, BUFE0 = B'10 and
CH2 = 0. Buffer operation timing is shown in figure 13.7.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 383 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
ADF
Set to 1
by software
ADST
Channel 0
Conversion
standby
Sampling
1
Conversion
standby
Cleared to 0
by software
A/D
conversion 1
Sampling
3
A/D
conversion 3
Sampling
5
Sampling
2
A/D
conversion 2
Sampling
4
A/D
conversion 4
Conversion
result 1
Conversion
result 2
Conversion
result 3
Conversion
result 4
Conversion
result 1
Conversion
result 2
Conversion
result 3
Channel 1 Conversion standby
Channel 2 Conversion standby
Channel 3 Conversion standby
ADDRA
ADDRB
ADDRC
ADDRD
Figure 13.7 Buffer Operation Example
(Select Scan Mode: Two-Stage One-Group Operation, When CH2 to CH0 = B'001)
Buffer-Only Operation: When performing conversion only on the analog input channels
specified by the BUFE1 and BUFE0 bits, select group mode, and you can select the ADF flag
setting conditions with the CH2 to CH0 bits.
Table 13.4 shows conversion during buffer operation and ADF flag setting conditions. The ADF
flag is set at the point in the table when the final conversion has ended. In single mode, conversion
is halted after the ADF flag is set to 1. In scan mode, conversion continues, and the converted data
is stored in sequence in the buffer registers specified by the BUFE1 and BUFE0 bits.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 384 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
When the ADF flag is set to 1, if the ADIE bit is also set to 1, an ADI interrupt is issued. After the
ADCSR is read, the ADF flag is cleared by a 0 write.
With select single mode, the high speed A/D converter goes into standby mode at the end of every
conversion cycle. The high speed A/D converter is restarted by software, or a timer trigger. When
the number of conversion cycles shown in table 13.4 have ended, the ADF flag is set to 1.
Table 13.4 Conversion Channel and ADF Flag Setting/Clearing Conditions During Buffer
Operation 1
Channel Setting
Sampling Channel
CH2 CH1 CH0
BUFE1, BUFE0 = B'01
BUFE1, BUFE0 = B'10
BUFE1, BUFE0 = B'11
0
0
AN0 1 time (ADDRA)
AN0, AN1 1 time
(ADDRB)
AN0 1 time (ADDRA)
1
AN0 2 times (ADDRB)
0
*
1
*
⎯
*
0
1
1
Note:
⎯
*
AN0 2 times (ADDRB)
AN0, AN1 2 times
(ADDRD)
AN0 3 times (ADDRC)
AN0 4 times (ADDRD)
*
*
See table 13.5.
Combined Group Mode and Buffer Operation: Continuous conversion is possible on analog
input channels (AN0 and AN1) specified by bits BUFE1 and BUFE0 as well as AN4 to AN7 due
to setting of bits CH2 to CH0.
Table 13.5 shows conversion during buffer operation and ADF flag setting conditions. The ADF
flag is set at the point in the table when the final conversion has ended. In this case, conversion is
performed on the analog input corresponding with the ADDR specified in the buffer register. For
example, when BUFE1 and BUFE0 = B'11 and CH2 to CH0 = B'110, conversion results are stored
in ADDRA and ADDRE to ADDRG. Also, contents of ADDRA to ADDRC before the start of
conversion are transferred to ADDRB to ADDRD.
In single mode, conversion is halted after the ADF flag has been set to 1. Conversion continues in
scan mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 385 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Table 13.5 Conversion Channel and ADF Flag Setting/Clearing Conditions During Buffer
Operation 2
Channel Setting
CH2 CH1 CH0
0
1
Sampling Channel
BUFE1, BUFE0 = B'01 BUFE1, BUFE0 = B'10 BUFE1, BUFE0 = B'11
0
⎯
*
1
0
AN0, AN2 (ADDRC)
1
AN0, AN2, AN3
(ADDRD)
0
0
1
Note:
*
*
*
AN0, AN2 to AN4
(ADDRE)
AN0, AN1, AN4
(ADDRE)
AN0, AN4 (ADDRE)
1
AN0, AN2 to AN5
(ADDRF)
AN0, AN1, AN4, AN5
(ADDRF)
AN0, AN4, AN5
(ADDRF)
0
AN0, AN2 to AN6
(ADDRG)
AN0, AN1, AN4 to AN6 AN0, AN4 to AN6
(ADDRG)
(ADDRG)
1
AN0, AN2 to AN7
(ADDRH)
AN0, AN1, AN4 to AN7 AN0, AN4 to AN7
(ADDRH)
(ADDRH)
See table 13.4.
ADF Flag Clearing: When the DMAC is started up due to an A/D conversion end interrupt, the
ADF flag is cleared when the ADDR specified in table 13.4 or 13.5 has been read.
Resetting the Number of Buffer Operations: Clear the BUFE1 and BUFE0 bits to B'00 in
conversion standby mode or when the converter has been halted. The number of buffer operations
is cleared to 0.
Updating Buffer Operations: Clear the BUFE1 and BUFE0 bits to B'00 in conversion standby
mode or when the converter has been halted. Thereafter, set BUFE1 and BUFE0, and the buffer
operations shown in table 13.4 and 13.5 are performed when conversion is resumed.
13.4.6
Simultaneous Sampling Operation
With simultaneous sampling, continuous conversion is conducted with sampling of the input
voltages on two channels at the same time. Simultaneous sampling is valid in group mode.
Channels for sampling are determined by the CH2 and CH1 bits of the RDSCR. The combinations
are shown in table 13.6. For example, if GRP = 1 when CH2 and CH1 = B'11, sampling occurs in
order in the following pairs: AN0, AN1→AN2, AN3→AN4, AN5→AN6, AN7. Sampling timing
is shown in figure 13.9.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 386 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Table 13.6 Simultaneous Sampling Channels
Channel Setting
CH2
CH1
Sampling Channels, GRP 1
0
0
AN0, AN1
1
AN0, AN1 → AN2, AN3
0
AN0, AN1 → AN2, AN3 → AN4, AN5
1
AN0, AN1 → AN2, AN3 → AN4, AN5 → AN6, AN7
1
ADF
Set to 1 by software
ADST
Channel 0
Conversion
standby
Sampling
1
Channel 1
Conversion
standby
ConverSampling
sion
2
standby
Channel 2
Conversion standby
Channel 3
Conversion standby
ADDRA
ADDRB
A/D
conversion 1
Automatically cleared
Conversion
standby
conversion
standby
A/D
conversion 2
Conversion result 1
Conversion result 2
ADDRC
ADDRD
Figure 13.8 Simultaneous Sampling Operation (Group Single Mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 387 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.4.7
Conversion Start Modes
The conversion start mode of the high speed A/D converter is set by the PWR bit of the ADCSR.
When the PWR bit is cleared to 0, low-power conversion mode is set and the internal analog
circuit becomes inactive. High-speed start mode is set by setting the PWR bit to 1, and the analog
circuit becomes active.
In the low-power conversion mode, power is applied to the analog circuitry simultaneous to the
conversion start (ADST set). When 200 cycles of the reference clock have elapsed, conversion
becomes possible for the analog circuit and the first A/D conversion begins. When performing
consecutive conversions, the second and later conversions are executed in 20 cycles. Select the
basic clock with the CKS bit of the ADCSR. When the A/D conversion ends, ADST is cleared to
0 and the analog circuit power supply is automatically cut off. Because the analog circuit is only
active during the A/D conversion operation period in this mode, current consumption can be
reduced.
In high-speed start mode, ADST is cleared to 0 when A/D conversion ends. Power continues to be
supplied to the analog circuitry, and conversion-ready status is maintained. Conversion is restarted
immediately by resetting ADST to 1. However, the first conversion after power-on begins 200
cycles after setting ADST. Clear the PWR bit to 0 to switch off the analog power supply. When
performing consecutive conversions, the second and later conversions are executed in 20 cycles.
Because the analog circuit is always active in this mode, A/D conversion can be executed at high
speed.
When A/D conversion is forcibly halted by clearing the ADST bit to 0 during conversion in highspeed start mode (when ADST = 1), the first conversion following a restart may not be performed
normally. The second and subsequent conversions are performed normally.
Figures 13.9 and 13.10 show the timing of the conversion start operation.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 388 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Figures 13.9 and 13.10 show examples of conversion start operation timing.
ADF
Analog circuit
power supply
Set
ADST
Clear
Set to 1 by software
Channel 0
Conversion
standby
Channel 1
Conversion
standby
Channel 2
Conversion
standby
Channel 3
Conversion
standby
Sampling
1
Cleared to 0 by software
A/D
conversion 1
Sampling
3
Sampling
2
A/D
conversion 2
A/D
conversion 3
200 cycles
ADDRA
ADDRB
Conversion
result 1
Conversion
result 3
Conversion
result 2
ADDRC
ADDRD
Figure 13.9 Conversion Start Operation (Low-Power Conversion Mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 389 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
ADF
Analog
circuit
power
supply
(PWR set to 0)
Switched on by software (PWR set to 1)
ADST
Switched off
by software
Set to 1 by software
Set to 1 by software
Channel 0
Conversion
standby
Channel 1
Conversion
standby
Channel 2
Conversion
standby
Channel 3
Conversion
standby
Sampling
1
A/D
conversion 1
Sampling
2
A/D
conversion 2
200 cycles
Conversion result 2
Conversion result 1
ADDRA
ADDRB
ADDRC
ADDRD
Figure 13.10 Conversion Start Operation (High-Speed Start Mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 390 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.4.8
A/D Conversion Time
The high speed A/D converter has an on-chip sample and hold circuit. The high speed A/D
converter samples the input at time tD after the ADST bit is set to 1, and then starts the conversion.
The A/D conversion time tCONV is the sum of the conversion start delay time tD, the input sampling
time tSPL, and the operating time tCP. This conversion time is not a set value, but is decided by the tD
ADCSR write timing, or the timer conversion start trigger generation timing.
Figure 13.11 shows an example of A/D conversion timing. Table 13.7 lists A/D conversion times.
φ
Address
Write signal
ADST
Sampling
timing
ADF
tD
tSPL
tCP
tCONV
Legend:
tD:
A/D conversion start delay time
tSPL: Input sampling time
tCONV: A/D conversion time
Operation time
tCP:
Figure 13.11 A/D Conversion Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 391 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Table 13.7 A/D Conversion Times
CKS = 0
CKS = 1
Time
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Min
Typ
Max
A/D conversion start
delay time
tD
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.5
Input sampling time
tSPL
20
20
20
40
40
40
A/D conversion time
tCONV
42.5
42.5
42.5
82.5
82.5
82.5
Notes: 1. Unit: states
2. Table entries are for when PWR = 1. If 200 states have not elapsed since the ADST bit
has been set, no conversions are done until after those 200 states have occurred.
When PWR = 0, add 200 states to the first A/D conversion start delay time. When two
or more conversions are performed in succession, tcp is 20 cycles when CKS = 0, and
40 cycles when CKS = 1.
The CKS bit of the ADCSR is the operation time tCONV, but set so that this is 2 μs or greater. Table
13.8 shows the operating frequency and CKS bit settings.
Table 13.8 Operating Frequency and CKS Bit Settings
Minimum Conversion Time (μs)
CKS
Conversion Time (States)
28 MHz
20 MHz
16 MHz
10 MHz
8 MHz
0
42.5
⎯
2.1
2.6
4.3
5.3
1
82.5
2.9
4.2
5.0
8.3
10.3
Note: The indication "⎯" means the setting is not available.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 392 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.5
Interrupts
The high speed A/D converter generates an A/D conversion end interrupt (ADI) upon completion
of A/D conversions. The ADI interrupt request can be enabled or disabled by the ADIE bit of the
ADCSR.
The DMAC can be activated by ADI interrupts. When converted data is read by the DMAC upon
an ADI interrupt, consecutive conversions can be done without software responsibility.
Table 13.9 lists the high speed A/D converter interrupt sources.
During scan mode, if the ADIE bit is set to 1, A/D conversion is temporarily suspended
immediately when the ADF flag is set to 1. A/D conversion is restarted when the ADF flag is
cleared to 0.
When the DMAC is activated by an ADI interrupt, the ADF flag is cleared to 0 when the final
specified data register is read.
Table 13.9 High Speed A/D Converter Interrupt Sources
Interrupt Source
Description
DMAC Activation
ADI
Interrupt caused by conversion end
Possible
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 393 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.6
Usage Notes
Note the following points concerning the high speed A/D converter.
13.6.1
Analog Input Voltage Range
During A/D conversions, see that the voltage applied to the analog input pins AN0 to AN7 is
within the range of AVSS ≤ AN0 to AN7 ≤ AVCC.
13.6.2
AVCC, AVSS Input Voltages
The AVCC, AVSS input voltages should be AVCC = VCC ±10%, and AVSS = VSS. When not using the
high speed A/D converter, make AVCC = VCC and AVSS = VSS. When in standby mode, make VRAM ≤
AVCC ≤ 5.5 V, and AVSS = VSS. VRAM is the RAM standby voltage.
13.6.3
Input Ports
Make the time constant of circuitry connected to an input port shorter than the high speed A/D
converter sampling time. If the time constant of the circuit is longer, there will be occasions where
the input voltage is not adequately sampled.
13.6.4
Conversion Start Modes
Current consumption will be different for the A/D conversion operation in high speed start mode
and low-power conversion mode according to the PWR bit setting.
13.6.5
A/D Conversion Termination (HD6417014R only)
If conversion is terminated while in progress (when ADST = 1) in high-speed start mode (PWR =
1) by clearing the ADST bit, there may be a large degree of error in the first conversion following
the restart (on channel 1 in normal mode, or channel 2 in simultaneous sampling mode).
Subsequent conversions will be performed normally
If A/D conversion is terminated while in progress, use one of the following methods to solve this
problem:
(a) Ignore the first data following a restart after termination.
(b) If the first data after a restart is used, perform a single dummy conversion in single mode after
the termination, terminate A/D conversion, then restart.
(c) After termination, write 0 to the PWR bit before restarting. (In this case, the first conversion
after the restart will begin after the elapse of 200 A/D reference clock cycles.)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 394 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
13.6.6
Handling of Analog Input Pins
To prevent damage from surges and other abnormal voltages at the analog input pins (AN0 to
AN7), connect a protection circuit such as that shown in figure 13.12. This circuit also includes a
CR filter function that suppresses error due to noise. The circuit shown here is only a design
example; circuit constants must be decided on the basis of the actual operating conditions.
Figure 13.13 shows an equivalent circuit for the analog input pins, and table 13.10 summarizes the
analog input pin specifications.
AVcc
100Ω
AN0 to AN7
SH7014
0.1 μF
*
AVss
Note: *
10 μF
0.01 μF
Figure 13.12 Example of Analog Input Pin Protection Circuit
1.0 kΩ
AN0 to AN7
20 pF
Analog multiplexer
1 MΩ
High speed
A/D converter
Note: Numeric values are reference values.
Figure 13.13 Analog Input Pin Equivalent Circuit
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 395 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
13. High Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Table 13.10 Analog Input Pin Specifications
Item
Min
Max
Unit
Analog input capacitance
⎯
20
pF
Permissible signal source impedance
⎯
1
kΩ
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 396 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Section 14 Mid-Speed A/D Converter
⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.1
Overview
The mid-speed A/D converter has 10 bit resolution, and can select from a maximum of eight
channels of analog input.
14.1.1
Features
The mid-speed A/D converter has the following features:
• 10-bit resolution
• Eight input channels
• Conversion time
⎯ Minimum conversion time: per channel: 6.7 μs (20MHz)
• Multiple conversion modes: Single mode/scan mode
⎯ Single mode: 1 channel A/D conversion
⎯ 1 to 4 channel simultaneous conversion
• Four 16-bit data registers
⎯ The results of A/D conversion are transferred to and held in the data register for the
relevant channel.
• Sample and hold function
• A/D conversion end interrupt generation
⎯ An A/D conversion end interrupt (ADI) can be generated on completion of A/D
conversion.
• A/D conversion can be started by MTU trigger input.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 397 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.1.2
Block Diagram
Figure 14.1 is the block diagram of the mid-speed A/D converter.
Analog multiplexer
AN0
AN1
AN2
AN3
AN4
AN5
AN6
AN7
ADCR
Bus interface
Internal data bus
ADCSR
ADDRD
ADDRC
ADDRB
10-bit D/A
AVSS
ADDRA
AVCC
Continuous
comparison
register
Module data bus
+
φ/8
−
Conparator
Control circuit
φ/16
Sample & hold circuit
Interrupt
signal ADI
A/D Converter
MTU trigger
Legend:
ADCR:
ADCSR:
ADDRA:
ADDRB:
ADDRC:
ADDRD:
A/D control register
A/D control status register
A/D data register A
A/D data register B
A/D data register C
A/D data register D
Figure 14.1 Mid-speed A/D converter block diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 398 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.1.3
Pin Configuration
Table 14.1 shows the input pins used with the mid-speed A/D converter.
The eight analog input pins are divided into two groups, with analog input pins 0 to 3 (AN0 to
AN3) comprising group 0, and analog input pins 4 to 7 (AN4 to AN7) comprising group 1.
The AVCC and AVSS pins are for the mid-speed A/D converter internal analog section power
supply.
Table 14.1 Pin Configuration
Pin
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
Analog supply
AVCC
I
Analog section power supply
Analog ground
AVSS
I
Analog section ground and A/D conversion
standard voltage
Analog input 0
AN0
I
Analog input group 0
Analog input 1
AN1
I
Analog input 2
AN2
I
Analog input 3
AN3
I
Analog input 4
AN4
I
Analog input 5
AN5
I
Analog input 6
AN6
I
Analog input 7
AN7
I
Analog input group 1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 399 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.1.4
Register Configuration
Table 14.2 shows the register configuration of the mid-speed A/D converter.
Table 14.2 Register Configuration
Name
Abbreviation R/W
Initial Value Address
Access Size
A/D data register AH
ADDRAH
R
H'00
H'FFFF8420
8, 16
A/D data register AL
ADDRAL
R
H'00
H'FFFF8421
8
A/D data register BH
ADDRBH
R
H'00
H'FFFF8422
8, 16
A/D data register BL
ADDRBL
R
H'00
H'FFFF8423
8
A/D data register CH
ADDRCH
R
H'00
H'FFFF8424
8, 16
A/D data register CL
ADDRCL
R
H'00
H'FFFF8425
8
A/D data register DH
ADDRDH
R
H'00
H'FFFF8426
8, 16
A/D data register DL
ADDRDL
R
H'00
H'FFFF8427
8
A/D control/status register
ADCSR
R/(W)* H'00
H'FFFF8428
8, 16
A/D control register
ADCR
R/W
H'FFFF8429
8, 16
Note:
*
H'7F
Only 0 can be written to bit 7 to clear the flag.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 400 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.2
Register Descriptions
14.2.1
A/D Data Register A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD)
Bit :
15
ADDRn : AD9
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value :
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W :
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note: n = A to D
A/D registers are special registers that read stored results of A/D conversion in 16 bits. There are
four registers: ADDRA to ADDRD.
The A/D converted data is 10 bit data which is to the ADDR of the corresponding converted
channel for storage. The upper 8 bits of the A/D converted data correspond to the upper byte of the
ADDR and the lower 2 bits correspond to the lower byte. Bits 5 to 0 of the lower byte of ADDR
are reserved and always read 0. Analog input channels and correspondence to ADDR are shown in
table 14.3.
ADDR can always be read from the CPU. The upper byte may be read directly. The lower byte is
transferred through the temporary register (TEMP). For details, see section 14.3, Interface with
CPU.
ADDR is initialized to H'0000 during power-on reset.
Table 14.3 Analog Input Channel and ADDRA to ADDRD Correspondence
Analog Input Channel
Group
Group 1
A/D Data Register
AN0
AN4
ADDRA
AN1
AN5
ADDRB
AN2
AN6
ADDRC
AN3
AN7
ADDRD
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 401 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.2.2
A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR)
Bit :
Initial value :
R/W :
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ADF
ADIE
ADST
SCAN
CKS
CH2
CH1
CH0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note: * Only 0 can be written to clear the flag.
The A/D control/status register (ADCSR) is register that can read/write in 8 bits and control midspeed A/D converter operations such as mode selection.
The ADCSR is initialized to H'00 during power-on reset.
Bit 7⎯A/D End Flag (ADF): Status flag that indicates end of A/D conversion.
Bit 7
ADF
Description
0
[Clear conditions]
(Initial value)
1. Writing 0 to ADF after reading ADF with ADF = 1
2. When registers of the mid-speed converter are accessed after the DMAC is
activated by ADI interrupt.
1
[Set conditions]
1.
Single mode: When A/D conversion is complete
2.
Scan mode: When A/D conversion of all designated channels are complete
Bit 6⎯A/D Interrupt Enable (ADIE): Enables or disables interrupt request (ADI) due to
completion of A/D conversion.
Bit 6
ADIE
Description
0
Disables interrupt request (ADI) due to completion of A/D conversion
1
Enables interrupt request (ADI) due to completion of A/D conversion
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 402 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(Initial value)
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Bit 5⎯A/D Start (ADST): Selects start/end of A/D conversion. A 1 is maintained during A/D
conversion start. It is also possible to set a 1 by the MTU trigger input.
Bit 5
ADST
Description
0
A/D conversion halted
1
1. Single mode: Starts A/D conversion. Automatically clears to 0 when conversion of
the designated channel is complete
(Initial value)
2. Scan mode: Starts A/D conversion. Continuous conversion until cleared to 0 by the
software
Bit 4⎯Scan Mode (SCAN): Selects the A/D conversion mode from single mode and scan mode.
For operations during single/scan mode, see section 14.4, Operation. When switching modes,
proceed while ADST = 0.
Bit 4
SCAN
Description
0
Single mode
1
Scan mode
(Initial value)
Bit 3⎯Clock Select (CKS): Sets the A/D conversion time. Proceed conversion time switch while
ADST = 0. Always set CKS = 0 when operating frequency exceeds 20MHz.
Bit 3
CKS
Description
0
Conversion time = 266 states (max)
1
Conversion time = 134 states (max)
(Initial value)
Bits 2 to 0⎯Channel select 2 to 0 (CH2 to CH0): Selects the analog input channel along with
the SCAN bit. Switch channels while ADST = 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 403 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Group
Selection
Channel Selection
Description
CH2
CH1
CH0
Single Mode
0
0
0
AN0
1
AN1
AN0, AN1
0
AN2
AN0 to AN2
1
AN3
AN0 to AN3
0
AN4
AN4
1
AN5
AN4, AN5
0
AN6
AN4 to AN6
1
AN7
AN4 to AN7
1
1
0
1
14.2.3
Scan Mode
(Initial value) AN0
(Initial value)
A/D Control Register (ADCR)
Bit :
Initial value :
R/W :
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TRGE
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
A/D control register (ADCR) is register that can read/write in 8 bits and enables or disables A/D
conversion start of the MTU trigger input.
ADCR is initialized to H'7F during power-on reset.
Bit 7⎯Trigger Enable (TRGE): Enables or disables A/D conversion start of input from MTU
trigger.
Bit 7
TRGE
Description
0
Disables A/D conversion start of MTU trigger
1
Starts A/D conversion on MTU trigger.
(Initial value)
Bits 6 to 0⎯Reserved bits: These bits always read as 1. The write value should always be 1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 404 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.3
Interface with CPU
Although A/D data register ADDRA to ADDRD are 16-bit registers, the bus width within the chip
that integrates with the CPU is 8-bits. So, the lower byte data is read through the temporary
register (TEMP). The upper byte data can be read directly.
The procedure for reading data from ADDR is as follows: First, read the upper byte data from
ADDR. At this time, the upper byte data is read directly into the CPU and the lower byte data is
transferred to TEMP of the mid-speed A/D converter. Next, read the lower byte to read the TEMP
contents into the CPU.
When reading the ADDR in byte size, read the upper byte before the lower byte. Furthermore, it is
possible to read only the upper byte, however, please note that contents are not guaranteed when
reading only the lower byte. In this case, ADDR can be read from the upper-byte address with a
word transfer instruction (such as MOV.W).
Figure 14.2 shows the data flow when reading from ADDR.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 405 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
<Reading the upper byte>
Module data bus
CPU
(H'AA)
Bus interface
TEMP
(H'40)
ADDRnH
(H'AA)
ADDRnL
(H'40)
<Reading of the lower byte>
Module data bus
CPU
(H'40)
Bus interface
TEMP
(H'40)
ADDRnH
(H'AA)
ADDRnL
(H'40)
Note: n = A to D
Figure 14.2 ADDR Access Operation (During Reading of (H'AA40))
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 406 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.4
Operation
The mid-speed converter operates using the continuous comparison method and is equipped with
10-bit resolution. Operations for the single and scan modes are explained below.
14.4.1
Single Mode (SCAN = 0)
The single mode is selected when executing A/D conversion for one channel only. A/D conversion
is initiated when the ADST bit of the A/D control/status register is set to 1 by the software or
external trigger input. The ADST bit is held to 1 during the A/D conversion and is automatically
cleared to 0 upon completion.
When conversion is complete, the ADF bit of ADCSR is set to 1. At this time, if the ADIE bit of
ADCSR is 1, ADI interrupt request occurs.
The ADF bit can be cleared by writing 0 after reading ADF = 1.
To switch modes or analog input channels during A/D conversion, clear the ADST bit to 0 and
stop A/D conversion to avoid malfunction. After switching (mode/channel change and ADST bit
setting can be made at the same time), set the ADST bit to 1 to restart A/D conversion.
An example of operation when channel 1 (AN1) is selected in the single mode is shown in figure
14.3.
1. Set operation mode to single mode (SCAN = 0), input channel to AN1 (CH2 = CH1 = 0, CH0
= 1) and A/D interrupt request to enable (ADIE = 1) then start A/D conversion (ADST = 1).
2. When A/D conversion is complete, A/D conversion result is transferred to ADDRB. At the
same time, ADF = 1 will become ADF = 0 and the mid-speed converter will standby for
conversion.
3. Since ADF = 1 and ADIE = 1, ADI interrupt request will occur.
4. The A/D interrupt process routine will start.
5. After reading ADF = 1, write 0 to ADF.
6. Read the A/D conversion result (ADDRB) and process.
7. End A/D interrupt process routine execution. When ADST bit is set to 1, A/D conversion
starts, following steps (2) to (7) above.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 407 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 408 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Figure 14.3 Operation Example of Mid-speed A/D Converter
(Single Mode, Channel 1 Selected)
Note: *
ADDRD
ADDRC
ADDRB
ADDRA
Channel 3 (AN3)
Operation state
A/D conversion (1)
Set *
indicates command execution by the software
Conversion standby
Conversion standby
Conversion standby
Channel 1 (AN1)
Operation state
Channel 2 (AN2)
Operation state
Conversion standby
A/D conversion start
Channel 0 (AN0)
Operation state
ADF
ADST
ADIE
Set *
A/D conversion (2)
A/D conversion result (1)
Reading conversion result
Conversion standby
Clear *
Set *
A/D conversion result (2)
Reading conversion result
Conversion standby
Clear *
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.4.2
Scan Mode (SCAN = 1)
The scan mode is optimal for monitoring analog input of multiple channels (including channel 1).
A/D conversion is started from channel 1 (AN0 for CH2 = 0 and AN4 for CH1 = 1) of the group
when the ADST bit of the A/D control/status register (ADCSR) is set to 1 by the software or
external trigger input.
When multiple channels are selected, A/D conversion of channel 2 (AN1 or AN5) is initiated
immediately after completion of the channel 1 conversion.
A/D conversion is performed repeatedly on the selected channels until the ADST bit is cleared to
0. The results of conversion are transferred to and held in the ADDR registers for the relevant
channels.
To switch modes or analog input channels during A/D conversion, clear the ADST bit to 0 and
stop A/D conversion to avoid malfunction. After switching (mode/channel change and ADST bit
setting can be made at the same time), set ADST bit to 1 to restart A/D conversion from channel 1.
An example of operation in scan mode when three channels of group 0 (AN0 to AN2) are selected
for A/D conversion is shown in figure 14.4.
1. Set the operation mode to scan mode (SCAN = 1), set the scan group to group 0 (CH2 = 0), set
the analog channels to AN0 to AN2 (CH1 = 1, CH0 = 0), and then start A/D conversion
(ADST = 1).
2. When A/D conversion for channel 1 (AN0) is complete, A/D conversion result is transferred to
ADDRA.
Next, channel 2 (AN1) will automatically be selected and conversion will begin.
3. In the same manner, channel 3 (AN2) will be converted.
4. When conversion of all of the selected channels (AN0 to AN2) are complete, ADF will
become 1 and channel 1 (AN0) will again be selected and conversion will begin.
At this time, if the ADIE bit is set to 1, ADI interrupt request will occur after completing A/D
conversion.
5. Steps (2) to (4) will be repeated while ADST bit is set to 1.
A/D conversion will stop when setting the ADST bit to 0. When setting the ADST bit to 1,
A/D conversion will start again from channel 1 (AN0).
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 409 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 410 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Notes:
Figure 14.4 Operation Example of Mid-speed A/D Converter
(Scan Mode, Three Channels Selected) (AN0 to AN2)
Transfer
Conversion standby
A/D conversion(3)
Conversion standby
Clear *1
A/D conversion result(3)
A/D conversion result(2)
A/D conversion result(4)
Conversion standby
Conversion standby
Clear *1
A/D conversion(5) * 2
A/D conversion time
A/D conversion(4)
A/D conversion result(1)
A/D conversion(2)
Conversion standby
indicates command execution by the software
Conversion standby
Conversion standby
Conversion standby A/D conversion(1)
2. Data is ignored during conversion
1.
ADDRD
ADDRC
ADDRB
ADDRA
Channel 3 (AN3)
Operation condition
Channel 2 (AN2)
Operation condition
Channel 1 (AN1)
Operation condition
Channel 0 (AN0)
Operation condition
ADF
ADST
Set *1
A/D continuous conversion
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.4.3
Input Sampling and A/D Conversion Time
The mid-speed A/D converter is equipped with a sample and hold circuit. The mid-speed A/D
converter samples input after tD hours has elapsed since setting the ADST bit of the A/D
control/status register (ADCSR) to 1, then begins conversion. The A/D conversion timing is
shown in table 14.4.
The A/D conversion time, as shown in figure 14.5, includes both tD and input sampling time. Here,
tD is determined by the write timing to ADCSR and is not constant. Thus the conversion time
changes in the range shown in table 14.4.
The conversion time shown in table 14.4 is the time for the first conversion. For the second
conversion and after, the time will be 256 state (fixed) for CKS = 0 and 128 state (fixed) for CKS
= 1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 411 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
(1)
CK
Address
(2)
Write signal
Input sampling
timing
ADF
t
t
D
SPL
t
CONV
Legend:
(1):
Write cycle of ADCSR
(2):
Address of ADCSR
tD:
A/D conversion start delay time
tSPL: Input sampling time
tCONV: A/D conversion time
Figure 14.5 A/D Conversion Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 412 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Table 14.4 A/D Conversion Time (Single Mode)
CKS = 0
Notation Min
CKS = 1
Typ
Max
Min
Typ
Max
A/D conversion start delay time tD
10
⎯
17
6
⎯
9
Input sampling time
tSPL
⎯
64
⎯
⎯
32
⎯
A/D conversion time
tCCNV
259
⎯
266
131
⎯
134
Note: Numbers in the table are in states (tcyc).
14.4.4
MTU Trigger Input Timing
It is possible to start A/D conversion from an MTU trigger input. MTU trigger input is input from
MTU when the TRGE bit of the A/D control register (ADCR) is set to 1.
A/D conversion is started when the ADST bit of the A/D control/status register (ADCSR) is set to
1 by MTU trigger. Other operations, regardless of whether in the single or scan mode, are the
same as when setting the ADST bit to 1 with the software.
Figure 14.6 shows an example of external trigger input timing.
CK
MTU trigger
signal
ADST
A/D conversion
Figure 14.6 External Trigger Input Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 413 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.5
Interrupt
The mid-speed A/D converter generates an A/D conversion end interrupt (ADI) on completion of
A/D conversion. ADI interrupt requests can be enabled or disabled by means of the ADIE bit in
ADCSR.
The DMAC can be activated by an ADI interrupt. Having converted data read by the DMAC by
means of ADI interrupts allows continuous conversion to be carried out without imposing a load
on the software.
The mid-speed A/D converter's interrupt source is summarized in table 14.5.
When the DMAC are activated by an ADI interrupt, the ADF flag of ADCSR is cleared to 0 by
register access of A/D.
Table 14.5 Mid-speed A/D converter interrupt factors
Interrupt Factor
Content
DMAC
ADI
Interrupt by conversion complete
Activation enabled
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 414 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.6
A/D Conversion Precision Definitions
The mid-speed A/D converter converts analog values input from analog input channels to 10-bit
digital values by comparing them with an analog reference voltage. In this operation, the absolute
precision of the A/D conversion (i.e. the deviation between the input analog value and the output
digital value) includes the following kinds of error.
(1) Offset error
(2) Full-scale error
(3) Quantization error
(4) Nonlinearity error
The above four kinds of error are described below with reference to figure 14.7. For the sake of
clarity, this figure shows 3-bit mid-speed A/D conversion rather than 10-bit mid-speed A/D
conversion. Offset error (see figure 14.7 (1)) is the deviation between the actual A/D conversion
characteristic and the ideal A/D conversion characteristic when the digital output value changes
from the minimum value (zero voltage) of 0000000000 (000 in the figure) to 0000000001 (001 in
the figure ). Full-scale error (see figure 14.7 (2)) is the deviation between the actual A/D
conversion characteristic and the ideal A/D conversion characteristic when the digital output value
changes from 1111111110 (110 in the figure) to the maximum value (full-scale voltage) of
111111111 (111 in the figure). Quantization error is the deviation inherent in the mid-speed A/D
converter, given by 1/2 LSB (see figure 14.7 (3)). Nonlinearity error is the deviation between the
actual A/D conversion characteristic and the ideal A/D conversion characteristic from zero voltage
to full-scale voltage (see figure 14.7 (4)). This does not include offset error, full-scale error, and
quantization error.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 415 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
(2) Full-scale error
Digital output
Digital output
Ideal A/D conversion
Characteristic
111
Ideal A/D conversion
Characteristic
110
101
100
(4) Nonlinearity error
011
(3) Quantization error
010
Actual A/D conversion
characteristic
001
000
0
1/8
2/8
3/8
4/8
5/8
6/8
7/8 FS
Analog input
voltage
(1) Offset error
Legend:
FS: Full-scale voltage
Figure 14.7 A/D Conversion Precision Definitions
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 416 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
FS
Analog input
voltage
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
14.7
Usage Notes
The following points should be noted when using the mid-speed A/D converter.
14.7.1
Analog Voltage Settings
(1) Analog input voltage range
The voltage applied to analog input pins during A/D conversion should be in the range AVSS ≤
ANn ≤ AVCC (n = 0 to 7).
(2) AVCC and AVSS input voltages
For the AVCC and AVSS input voltages, set AVCC = VCC = 5V ±10% and AVSS = VSS. When the
mid-speed A/D converter is not used, set AVCC = VCC and AVSS = VSS.
14.7.2
Handling of Analog Input Pins
To prevent damage from surges and other abnormal voltages at the analog input pins (AN0 to
AN7), connect a protection circuit such as that shown in figure 14.8. This circuit also includes a
CR filter function that suppresses error due to noise. The circuit shown here is only a design
example; circuit constants must be decided on the basis of the actual operating conditions.
Figure 14.9 shows an equivalent circuit for the analog input pins, and table 14.6 summarizes the
analog input pin specifications.
AVCC
100 Ω
AN0 to AN7
*
SH7016
SH7017
0.1 μF
AVSS
Note: *
10 μF
0.01 μF
Figure 14.8 Example of Analog Input Pin Protection Circuit
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 417 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
14. Mid-Speed A/D Converter ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
1.0 kΩ
AN0 to AN7
20 pFΩ
Analog multiplexer
1 MΩ
Mid-speed A/D converter
Note: Numbers are only to be noted as reference value
Figure 14.9 Equivalent Circuit for the Analog Input Pins
Table 14.6 Analog Pin Specifications
Item
Min
Max
Unit
Analog input capacitance
⎯
20
pF
Permissible signal source impedance
⎯
1
kΩ
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 418 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
Section 15 Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.1
Overview
This LSI has an on-chip compare match timer (CMT) configured of 16-bit timers for two
channels. The CMT has 16-bit counters and can generate interrupts at set intervals.
15.1.1
Features
The CMT has the following features:
• Four types of counter input clock can be selected
⎯ One of four internal clocks (φ/8, φ/32, φ/128, φ/512) can be selected independently for each
channel.
• Interrupt sources
⎯ A compare match interrupt can be requested independently for each channel.
15.1.2
Block Diagram
Figure 15.1 shows a block diagram of the CMT.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 419 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Clock selection
Control circuit
Clock selection
CMCNT0
Module bus
CMCNT1
Control circuit
Comparator
φ/8 φ/32 φ/128 φ/512
CMCOR1
CMI1
CMCSR1
φ/8 φ/32 φ/128 φ/512
Comparator
CMI0
CMCOR0
CMCSR0
CMSTR
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
Bus
interface
CMT
Internal bus
Legend:
CMSTR:
CMCSR:
CMCOR:
CMCNT:
CMI:
Compare match timer start register
Compare match timer control/status register
Compare match timer constant register
Compare match timer counter
Compare match interrupt
Figure 15.1 CMT Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 420 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.1.3
Register Configuration
Table 15.1 summarizes the CMT register configuration.
Table 15.1 Register Configuration
Channel Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial
Value
Address
Access Size
(Bits)
Shared
Compare match timer CMSTR
start register
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83D0 8, 16, 32
0
Compare match timer CMCSR0
control/status register 0
R/(W)*
H'0000
H'FFFF83D2 8, 16, 32
Compare match timer CMCNT0
counter 0
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83D4 8, 16, 32
Compare match timer CMCOR0
constant register 0
R/W
H'FFFF H'FFFF83D6 8, 16, 32
Compare match timer CMCSR1
control/status register 1
R/(W)*
H'0000
H'FFFF83D8 8, 16, 32
Compare match timer CMCNT1
counter 1
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83DA 8, 16, 32
Compare match timer CMCOR1
constant register 1
R/W
H'FFFF H'FFFF83DC 8, 16, 32
1
Note:
*
The only value that can be written to the CMCSR0 and CMCSR1 CMF bits is a 0 to
clear the flags.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 421 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.2
Register Descriptions
15.2.1
Compare Match Timer Start Register (CMSTR)
The compare match timer start register (CMSTR) is a 16-bit register that selects whether to
operate or halt the channel 0 and channel 1 counters (CMCNT). It is initialized to H'0000 by
power-on resets and by standby mode.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
STR1
STR0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
Bits 15 to 2⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 1⎯Count Start 1 (STR1): Selects whether to operate or halt compare match timer counter 1.
Bit 1
STR1
Description
0
CMCNT1 count operation halted
1
CMCNT1 count operation
(initial value)
Bit 0⎯Count Start 0 (STR0): Selects whether to operate or halt compare match timer counter 0.
Bit 0
STR0
Description
0
CMCNT0 count operation halted
1
CMCNT0 count operation
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 422 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.2.2
Compare Match Timer Control/Status Register (CMCSR)
The compare match timer control/status register (CMCSR) is a 16-bit register that indicates the
occurrence of compare matches, sets the enable/disable of interrupts, and establishes the clock
used for incrementation. It is initialized to H'0000 by power-on resets and by standby mode.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
*
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CMF
CMIE
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
CKS1
CKS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/(W)*
R/W
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
The only value that can be written is a 0 to clear the flag.
Bits 15 to 8 and 5 to 2⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be
0.
Bit 7⎯Compare Match Flag (CMF): This flag indicates whether or not the CMCNT and
CMCOR values have matched.
Bit 7
CMF
Description
0
CMCNT and CMCOR values have not matched
(initial status)
Clear condition: Write a 0 to CMF after reading a 1 from it
1
CMCNT and CMCOR values have matched
Bit 6⎯Compare Match Interrupt Enable (CMIE): Selects whether to enable or disable a
compare match interrupt (CMI) when the CMCNT and CMCOR values have matched (CMF = 1).
Bit 6
CMIE
Description
0
Compare match interrupts (CMI) disabled
1
Compare match interrupts (CMI) enabled
(initial status)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 423 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
Bits 1, 0⎯Clock Select 1, 0 (CKS1, CKS0): These bits select the clock input to the CMCNT
from among the four internal clocks obtained by dividing the system clock (φ). When the STR bit
of the CMSTR is set to 1, the CMCNT begins incrementing with the clock selected by CKS1 and
CKS0.
Bit 1
CKS1
Bit 0
CKS0
Description
0
0
φ/8
1
φ/32
0
φ/128
1
φ/512
1
15.2.3
(initial status)
Compare Match Timer Counter (CMCNT)
The compare match timer counter (CMCNT) is a 16-bit register used as an upcounter for
generating interrupt requests.
When an internal clock is selected with the CKS1, CKS0 bits of the CMCSR register and the STR
bit of the CMSTR is set to 1, the CMCNT begins incrementing with that clock. When the CMCNT
value matches that of the compare match timer constant register (CMCOR), the CMCNT is
cleared to H'0000 and the CMF flag of the CMCSR is set to 1. If the CMIE bit of the CMCSR is
set to 1 at this time, a compare match interrupt (CMI) is requested.
The CMCNT is initialized to H'0000 by power-on resets and by standby mode.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
R/W:
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 424 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.2.4
Compare Match Timer Constant Register (CMCOR)
The compare match timer constant register (CMCOR) is a 16-bit register that sets the compare
match period with the CMCNT.
The CMCOR is initialized to H'FFFF by power-on resets and by standby mode.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Initial value:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Initial value:
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
R/W:
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 425 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.3
Operation
15.3.1
Period Count Operation
When an internal clock is selected with the CKS1, CKS0 bits of the CMCSR register and the STR
bit of the CMSTR is set to 1, the CMCNT begins incrementing with the selected clock. When the
CMCNT counter value matches that of the compare match constant register (CMCOR), the
CMCNT counter is cleared to H'0000 and the CMF flag of the CMCSR register is set to 1. If the
CMIE bit of the CMCSR register is set to 1 at this time, a compare match interrupt (CMI) is
requested. The CMCNT counter begins counting up again from H'0000.
Figure 15.2 shows the compare match counter operation.
CMCNT value
Counter cleared by
CMCOR compare match
CMCOR
H'0000
Time
Figure 15.2 Counter Operation
15.3.2
CMCNT Count Timing
One of four clocks (φ/8, φ/32, φ/128, φ/512) obtained by dividing the system clock (CK) can be
selected by the CKS1, CKS0 bits of the CMCSR. Figure 15.3 shows the timing.
CK
Internal clock
CMCNT input
clock
CMCNT
N−1
N
Figure 15.3 Count Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 426 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
N+1
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.4
Interrupts
15.4.1
Interrupt Sources
The CMT has a compare match interrupt for each channel, with independent vector addresses
allocated to each of them. The corresponding interrupt request is output when the interrupt request
flag CMF is set to 1 and the interrupt enable bit CMIE has also been set to 1.
When activating CPU interrupts by interrupt request, the priority between the channels can be
changed by using the interrupt controller settings. See section 6, Interrupt Controller, for details.
15.4.2
Compare Match Flag Set Timing
The CMF bit of the CMCSR register is set to 1 by the compare match signal generated when the
CMCOR register and the CMCNT counter match. The compare match signal is generated upon
the final state of the match (timing at which the CMCNT counter matching count value is
updated). Consequently, after the CMCOR register and the CMCNT counter match, a compare
match signal will not be generated until a CMCNT counter input clock occurs. Figure 15.4 shows
the CMF bit set timing.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 427 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
CK
CMCNT
input clock
CMCNT
N
CMCOR
N
0
Compare
match signal
CMF
CMI
Figure 15.4 CMF Set Timing
15.4.3
Compare Match Flag Clear Timing
The CMF bit of the CMCSR register is cleared either by writing a 0 to it after reading a 1. Figure
15.5 shows the timing when the CMF bit is cleared by the CPU.
CMCSR write cycle
T1
T2
CK
CMF
Figure 15.5 Timing of CMF Clear by the CPU
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 428 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.5
Usage Notes
Take care that the contentions described in sections 15.5.1 to 15.5.3 do not arise during CMT
operation.
15.5.1
Contention between CMCNT Write and Compare Match
If a compare match signal is generated during the T2 state of the CMCNT counter write cycle, the
CMCNT counter clear has priority, so the write to the CMCNT counter is not performed. Figure
15.6 shows the timing.
CMCNT write cycle
T1
T2
CK
Address
CMCNT
Internal
write signal
Compare
match signal
CMCNT
N
H'0000
Figure 15.6 CMCNT Write and Compare Match Contention
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 429 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.5.2
Contention between CMCNT Word Write and Incrementation
If an increment occurs during the T2 state of the CMCNT counter word write cycle, the counter
write has priority, so no increment occurs. Figure 15.7 shows the timing.
CMCNT write cycle
T1
T2
CK
Address
CMCNT
Internal
write signal
CMCNT
input clock
CMCNT
N
M
CMCNT write data
Figure 15.7 CMCNT Word Write and Increment Contention
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 430 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
15.5.3
Contention between CMCNT Byte Write and Incrementation
If an increment occurs during the T2 state of the CMCNT byte write cycle, the counter write has
priority, so no increment of the write data results on the writing side. The byte data on the side not
performing the writing is also not incremented, so the contents are those before the write.
Figure 15.8 shows the timing when an increment occurs during the T2 state of the CMCNTH write
cycle.
CMCNT write cycle
T1
T2
CK
Address
CMCNTH
Internal
write signal
CMCNT
input clock
CMCNTH
N
M
CMCNTH write data
CMCNTL
X
X
Figure 15.8 CMCNT Byte Write and Increment Contention
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 431 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
15. Compare Match Timer (CMT)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 432 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Section 16 Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.1
Overview
The pin function controller (PFC) is composed of registers for selecting the function of
multiplexed pins and the direction of input/output. Table 16.1 lists this LSI's multiplexed pins. The
multiplex pin functions have restrictions dependent on the operating mode. Table 16.2 lists the pin
functions and initial values for each operating mode.
Table 16.1 Multiplexed Pins
Function 1
Function 2
Port (Related Module) (Related Module)
Function 3
Function 4
(Related Module) (Related Module)
Pin No.
A
PA15 I/O (port)
CK output (CPG)
⎯
⎯
83
A
PA14 I/O (port)*
RD output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
34
A
PA13 I/O (port)*
WRH output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
36
A
PA12 I/O (port)*
WRL output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
38
A
PA11 I/O (port)*
CS1 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
40
A
PA10 I/O (port)*
CS0 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
41
A
PA9 I/O (port)
TCLKD input (MTU)
IRQ3 (INTC)
⎯
42
A
PA8 I/O (port)
TCLKC input (MTU)
IRQ2 (INTC)
⎯
43
A
PA7 I/O (port)
TCLKB input (MTU)
CS3 output (BSC) ⎯
44
A
PA6 I/O (port)
TCLKA input (MTU)
CS2 output (BSC) ⎯
45
A
PA5 I/O (port)
SCK1 I/O (SCI)
DREQ1 input
(DMAC)
IRQ1 input (INTC)
46
A
PA4 I/O (port)
TxD1 output (SCI)
⎯
⎯
47
A
PA3 I/O (port)
RxD1 input (SCI)
⎯
⎯
48
A
PA2 I/O (port)
SCK0 I/O (SCI)
DREQ0 input
(DMAC)
IRQ0 input
(INTC)
49
A
PA1 I/O (port)
TxD0 output (SCI)
⎯
⎯
50
A
PA0 I/O (port)
RxD0 input (SCI)
⎯
⎯
51
B
PB9 I/O (port)
IRQ7 input (INTC)
A21 output (BSC)
⎯
32
B
PB8 I/O (port)
IRQ6 input (INTC)
A20 output (BSC)
WAIT input (BSC)
31
B
PB7 I/O (port)
⎯
A19 output (BSC)
⎯
30
B
PB6 I/O (port)
⎯
A18 output (BSC)
⎯
29
B
PB5 I/O (port)
IRQ3 input (INTC)
⎯
RDWR output (BSC) 28
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 433 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Function 1
Function 2
Port (Related Module) (Related Module)
Function 3
Function 4
(Related Module) (Related Module)
Pin No.
B
PB4 I/O (port)
IRQ2 input (INTC)
⎯
CASH output (BSC) 26
B
PB3 I/O (port)
IRQ1 input (INTC)
⎯
CASL output (BSC) 25
B
PB2 I/O (port)
IRQ0 input (INTC)
⎯
RAS output (BSC)
24
B
PB1 I/O (port)*
A17 input (BSC)
⎯
⎯
22
B
PB0 I/O (port)*
A16 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
20
C
PC15 I/O (port)*
A15 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
19
C
PC14 I/O (port)*
A14 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
18
C
PC13 I/O (port)*
A13 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
17
C
PC12 I/O (port)*
A12 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
16
C
PC11 I/O (port)*
A11 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
15
C
PC10 I/O (port)*
A10 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
14
C
PC9 I/O (port)*
A9 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
13
C
PC8 I/O (port)*
A8 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
12
C
PC7 I/O (port)*
A7 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
11
C
PC6 I/O (port)*
A6 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
10
C
PC5 I/O (port)*
A5 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
9
C
PC4 I/O (port)*
A4 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
8
C
PC3 I/O (port)*
A3 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
7
C
PC2 I/O (port)*
A2 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
6
C
PC1 I/O (port)*
A1 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
5
C
PC0 I/O (port)*
A0 output (BSC)
⎯
⎯
4
D
PD15 I/O (port)*
D15 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
52
D
PD14 I/O (port)*
D14 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
53
D
PD13 I/O (port)*
D13 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
54
D
PD12 I/O (port)*
D12 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
56
D
PD11 I/O (port)*
D11 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
57
D
PD10 I/O (port)*
D10 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
58
D
PD9 I/O (port)*
D9 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
59
D
PD8 I/O (port)*
D8 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
60
D
PD7 I/O (port)*
D7 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
62
D
PD6 I/O (port)*
D6 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
63
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 434 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Function 1
Function 2
Port (Related Module) (Related Module)
Function 3
Function 4
(Related Module) (Related Module)
Pin No.
D
PD5 I/O (port)*
D5 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
64
D
PD4 I/O (port)*
D4 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
66
D
PD3 I/O (port)*
D3 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
67
D
PD2 I/O (port)*
D2 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
68
D
PD1 I/O (port)*
D1 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
69
D
PD0 I/O (port)*
D0 I/O (BSC)
⎯
⎯
70
E
PE15 I/O (port)
⎯
DACK1 output
(DMAC)
⎯
2
E
PE14 I/O (port)
⎯
DACK0 output
(DMAC)
AH output (BSC)
1
E
PE13 I/O (port)
⎯
⎯
⎯
112
E
PE12 I/O (port)
⎯
⎯
⎯
111
E
PE11 I/O (port)
⎯
⎯
⎯
110
E
PE10 I/O (port)
⎯
⎯
⎯
108
E
PE9 I/O (port)
⎯
⎯
⎯
107
E
PE8 I/O (port)
⎯
⎯
⎯
106
E
PE7 I/O (port)
TIOC2B I/O (MTU)
⎯
⎯
105
E
PE6 I/O (port)
TIOC2A I/O (MTU)
⎯
⎯
104
E
PE5 I/O (port)
TIOC1B I/O (MTU)
⎯
⎯
102
E
PE4 I/O (port)
TIOC1A I/O (MTU)
⎯
⎯
89
E
PE3 I/O (port)
TIOC0D I/O (MTU)
DRAK1 output
(DMAC)
⎯
88
E
PE2 I/O (port)
TIOC0C I/O (MTU)
DREQ1 input
(DMAC)
⎯
87
E
PE1 I/O (port)
TIOC0B I/O (MTU)
DRAK0 output
(DMAC)
⎯
86
E
PE0 I/O (port)
TIOC0A I/O (MTU)
DREQ0 input
(DMAC)
⎯
85
F
PF7 input (port)
AN7 input (A/D)
⎯
⎯
99
F
PF6 input (port)
AN6 input (A/D)
⎯
⎯
98
F
PF5 input (port)
AN5 input (A/D)
⎯
⎯
96
F
PF4 input (port)
AN4 input (A/D)
⎯
⎯
95
F
PF3 input (port)
AN3 input (A/D)
⎯
⎯
94
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 435 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Function 1
Function 2
Port (Related Module) (Related Module)
Function 3
Function 4
(Related Module) (Related Module)
Pin No.
F
PF2 input (port)
AN2 input (A/D)
⎯
⎯
93
F
PF1 input (port)
AN1 input (A/D)
⎯
⎯
92
F
PF0 input (port)
AN0 input (A/D)
⎯
⎯
91
Note:
*
SH7016, SH7017 only
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 436 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Table 16.2 Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode (SH7014)
Pin Name
On-Chip ROM Disabled
Pin No.
MPU Mode 0
MPU Mode 1
FP-112
Initial
Function
Function Settable
by PFC
Initial
Function
Function Settable
by PFC
21, 37, 65, 103
Vcc
Vcc
Vcc
Vcc
3, 23, 27, 33,
39, 55, 61, 71,
90, 101, 109
Vss
Vss
Vss
Vss
70
D0
D0
D0
D0
69
D1
D1
D1
D1
68
D2
D2
D2
D2
67
D3
D3
D3
D3
66
D4
D4
D4
D4
64
D5
D5
D5
D5
63
D6
D6
D6
D6
62
D7
D7
D7
D7
60
D8
D8
D8
D8
59
D9
D9
D9
D9
58
D10
D10
D10
D10
57
D11
D11
D11
D11
56
D12
D12
D12
D12
54
D13
D13
D13
D13
53
D14
D14
D14
D14
52
D15
D15
D15
D15
4
A0
A0
A0
A0
5
A1
A1
A1
A1
6
A2
A2
A2
A2
7
A3
A3
A3
A3
8
A4
A4
A4
A4
9
A5
A5
A5
A5
10
A6
A6
A6
A6
11
A7
A7
A7
A7
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 437 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Pin Name
On-Chip ROM Disabled
Pin No.
MPU Mode 0
MPU Mode 1
FP-112
Initial
Function
Function Settable
by PFC
Initial
Function
Function Settable
by PFC
12
A8
A8
A8
A8
13
A9
A9
A9
A9
14
A10
A10
A10
A10
15
A11
A11
A11
A11
16
A12
A12
A12
A12
17
A13
A13
A13
A13
18
A14
A14
A14
A14
19
A15
A15
A15
A15
20
A16
A16
A16
A16
22
A17
A17
A17
A17
24
PB2
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
PB2
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
25
PB3
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
PB3
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
26
PB4
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
PB4
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
28
PB5
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
PB5
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
29
PB6
PB6/A18
PB6
PB6/A18
30
PB7
PB7/A19
PB7
PB7/A19
31
PB8
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
PB8
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
32
PB9
PB9/IRQ7/A21
PB9
PB9/IRQ7/A21
51
PA0
PA0/RXD0
PA0
PA0/RXD0
50
PA1
PA1/TXD0
PA1
PA1/TXD0
49
PA2
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
PA2
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
48
PA3
PA3/RXD1
PA3
PA3/RXD1
47
PA4
PA4/TXD1
PA4
PA4/TXD1
46
PA5
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
PA5
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
45
PA6
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
PA6
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
44
PA7
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PA7
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
43
PA8
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA8
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
42
PA9
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
PA9
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
41
CS0
CS0
CS0
CS0
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 438 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Pin Name
On-Chip ROM Disabled
Pin No.
MPU Mode 0
MPU Mode 1
FP-112
Initial
Function
Function Settable
by PFC
Initial
Function
Function Settable
by PFC
40
CS1
CS1
CS1
CS1
38
WRL
WRL
WRL
WRL
36
WRH
WRH
WRH
WRH
34
RD
RD
RD
RD
83
CK
PA15/CK
CK
PA15/CK
80
PLLVCC
PLLVCC
PLLVCC
PLLVCC
82
PLLVSS
PLLVSS
PLLVSS
PLLVSS
74
EXTAL
EXTAL
EXTAL
EXTAL
72
XTAL
XTAL
XTAL
XTAL
81
PLLCAP
PLLCAP
PLLCAP
PLLCAP
76
NMI
NMI
NMI
NMI
84
RES
RES
RES
RES
35
WDTOVF
WDTOVF
WDTOVF
WDTOVF
79
MD0
MD0
MD0
MD0
78
MD1
MD1
MD1
MD1
75
MD2
MD2
MD2
MD2
73
MD3
MD3
MD3
MD3
77
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
100
AVCC
AVCC
AVCC
AVCC
97
AVSS
AVSS
AVSS
AVSS
91
PF0/AN0
PF0/AN0
PF0/AN0
PF0/AN0
92
PF1/AN1
PF1/AN1
PF1/AN1
PF1/AN1
93
PF2/AN2
PF2/AN2
PF2/AN2
PF2/AN2
94
PF3/AN3
PF3/AN3
PF3/AN3
PF3/AN3
95
PF4/AN4
PF4/AN4
PF4/AN4
PF4/AN4
96
PF5/AN5
PF5/AN5
PF5/AN5
PF5/AN5
98
PF6/AN6
PF6/AN6
PF6/AN6
PF6/AN6
99
PF7/AN7
PF7/AN7
PF7/AN7
PF7/AN7
85
PE0
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
PE0
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 439 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Pin Name
On-Chip ROM Disabled
Pin No.
MPU Mode 0
MPU Mode 1
FP-112
Initial
Function
Function Settable
by PFC
Initial
Function
Function Settable
by PFC
86
PE1
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
PE1
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
87
PE2
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
PE2
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
88
PE3
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
PE3
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
89
PE4
PE4/TIOC1A
PE4
PE4/TIOC1A
102
PE5
PE5/TIOC1B
PE5
PE5/TIOC1B
104
PE6
PE6/TIOC2A
PE6
PE6/TIOC2A
105
PE7
PE7/TIOC2B
PE7
PE7/TIOC2B
106
PE8
PE8
PE8
PE8
107
PE9
PE9
PE9
PE9
108
PE10
PE10
PE10
PE10
110
PE11
PE11
PE11
PE11
111
PE12
PE12
PE12
PE12
112
PE13
PE13
PE13
PE13
1
PE14
PE14/DACK0/AH
PE14
PE14/DACK0/AH
2
PE15
PE15/DACK1
PE15
PE15/DACK1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 440 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
VSS
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
D13
D14
D15
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11
A12
70
69
68
67
66
64
63
62
60
59
58
57
56
54
53
52
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
VCC
21,37,65
103
3,23,27,33
39,55,61,71
90,101,109
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
FP-112
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
D13
D14
D15
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11
A12
VSS
VCC
Pin Name
On-Chip ROM Disabled
MPU Mode0
Pin No.
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
D13
D14
D15
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11
A12
VSS
VCC
VSS
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
PD8
PD9
PD10
PD11
PD12
PD13
PD14
PD15
PC0
PC1
PC2
PC3
PC4
PC5
PC6
PC7
PC8
PC9
PC10
PC11
PC12
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
D9
D10
D11
D12
D13
D14
D15
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11
A12
VCC
PD0/D0
PD1/D1
PD2/D2
PD3/D3
PD4/D4
PD5/D5
PD6/D6
PD7/D7
PD8/D8
PD9/D9
PD10/D10
PD11/D11
PD12/D12
PD13/D13
PD14/D14
PD15/D15
PC0/A0
PC1/A1
PC2/A2
PC3/A3
PC4/A4
PC5/A5
PC6/A6
PC7/A7
PC8/A8
PC9/A9
PC10/A10
PC11/A11
PC12/A12
VSS
VCC
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
On-Chip ROM Enabled
MPU Mode2
VSS
VCC
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
MPU Mode 1
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
PD8
PD9
PD10
PD11
PD12
PD13
PD14
PD15
PC0
PC1
PC2
PC3
PC4
PC5
PC6
PC7
PC8
PC9
PC10
PC11
PC12
VSS
VCC
PD0
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
PD8
PD9
PD10
PD11
PD12
PD13
PD14
PD15
PC0
PC1
PC2
PC3
PC4
PC5
PC6
PC7
PC8
PC9
PC10
PC11
PC12
VSS
VCC
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
Single Chip Mode
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Table 16.3 Pin Arrangement in Each Operating Mode (SH7016, SH7017)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 441 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
A13
A14
A15
A16
A17
PB2
PB3
PB4
PB5
PB6
PB7
PB8
PB9
PA0
PA1
PA2
PA3
PA4
PA5
PA6
PA7
PA8
PA9
CS0
CS1
WRL
WRH
RD
CK
PLLVCC
PLLVSS
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
NMI
RES
WDTOVF
MD0
MD1
MD2
MD3
VCC
AVCC
AVSS
FP-112
17
18
19
20
22
24
25
26
28
29
30
31
32
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
38
36
34
83
80
82
74
72
81
76
84
35
79
78
75
73
77
100
97
A13
A14
A15
A16
A17
PB2/IRQ0/POE0/RAS
PB3/IRQ1/POE1/CASL
PB4/IRQ2/POE2/CASH
PB5/IRQ3/POE3/RDWR
PB6/A18
PB7/A19
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
PB9/IRQ7/A21
PA0/RXD0
PA1/TXD0
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
PA3/RXD1
PA4/TXD1
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
CS0
CS1
WRL
WRH
RD
PA15/CK
PLLVCC
PLLVSS
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
NMI
RES
WDTOVF
MD0
MD1
MD2
MD3
VCC
AVCC
AVSS
Pin Name
On-Chip ROM Disabled
MPU Mode0
Pin No.
A13
A14
A15
A16
A17
PB2
PB3
PB4
PB5
PB6
PB7
PB8
PB9
PA0
PA1
PA2
PA3
PA4
PA5
PA6
PA7
PA8
PA9
CS0
CS1
WRL
WRH
RD
CK
PLLVCC
PLLVSS
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
NMI
RES
WDTOVF
MD0
MD1
MD2
MD3
VCC
AVCC
AVSS
A13
A14
A15
A16
A17
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
PB6/A18
PB7/A19
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
PB9/IRQ7/A21
PA0/RXD0
PA1/TXD0
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
PA3/RXD1
PA4/TXD1
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
CS0
CS1
WRL
WRH
RD
PA15/CK
PLLVCC
PLLVSS
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
NMI
RES
WDTOVF
MD0
MD1
MD2
MD3
VCC
AVCC
AVSS
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
MPU Mode 1
PC13
PC14
PC15
PB0
PB1
PB2
PB3
PB4
PB5
PB6
PB7
PB8
PB9
PA0
PA1
PA2
PA3
PA4
PA5
PA6
PA7
PA8
PA9
PA10
PA11
PA12
PA13
PA14
CK
PLLVCC
PLLVSS
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
NMI
RES
WDTOVF
MD0
MD1
MD2
MD3
VCC
AVCC
AVSS
PC13/A13
PC14/A14
PC15/A15
PB0/A16
PB1/A17
PB2/IRQ0/RAS
PB3/IRQ1/CASL
PB4/IRQ2/CASH
PB5/IRQ3/RDWR
PB6/A18
PB7/A19
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
PB9/IRQ7/A21
PA0/RXD0
PA1/TXD0
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0
PA3/RXD1
PA4/TXD1
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1
PA6/TCLKA/CS2
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
PA10/CS0
PA11/CS1
PA12/WRL
PA13/WRH
PA14/RD
PA15/CK
PLLVCC
PLLVSS
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
NMI
RES
WDTOVF
MD0
MD1
MD2
MD3
VCC
AVCC
AVSS
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
On-Chip ROM Enabled
MPU Mode2
PC13
PC14
PC15
PB0
PB1
PB2
PB3
PB4
PB5
PB6
PB7
PB8
PB9
PA0
PA1
PA2
PA3
PA4
PA5
PA6
PA7
PA8
PA9
PA10
PA11
PA12
PA13
PA14
PA15
PLLVCC
PLLVSS
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
NMI
RES
WDTOVF
MD0
MD1
MD2
MD3
VCC
AVCC
AVSS
PC13
PC14
PC15
PB0
PB1
PB2/IRQ0
PB3/IRQ1
PB4/IRQ2
PB5/IRQ3
PB6
PB7
PB8/IRQ6
PB9/IRQ7
PA0/RXD0
PA1/TXD0
PA2/SCK0/IRQ0
PA3/RXD1
PA4/TXD1
PA5/SCK1/IRQ1
PA6/TCLKA
PA7/TCLKB
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
PA10
PA11
PA12
PA13
PA14
PA15/CK
PLLVCC
PLLVSS
EXTAL
XTAL
PLLCAP
NMI
RES
WDTOVF
MD0
MD1
MD2
MD3
VCC
AVCC
AVSS
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
Single Chip Mode
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 442 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
PE0
PE1
PE2
PE3
PE4
PE5
PE6
PE7
PE8
PE9
PE10
PE11
PE12
PE13
PE14
PE15
FP-112
91
92
93
94
95
96
98
99
85
86
87
88
89
102
104
105
106
107
108
110
111
112
1
2
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
PE4/TIOC1A
PE5/TIOC1B
PE6/TIOC2A
PE7/TIOC2B
PE8
PE9
PE10
PE11
PE12
PE13
PE14/DACK0/AH
PE15/DACK1
Pin Name
On-Chip ROM Disabled
MPU Mode0
Pin No.
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
PE0
PE1
PE2
PE3
PE4
PE5
PE6
PE7
PE8
PE9
PE10
PE11
PE12
PE13
PE14
PE15
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
PE4/TIOC1A
PE5/TIOC1B
PE6/TIOC2A
PE7/TIOC2B
PE8
PE9
PE10
PE11
PE12
PE13
PE14/DACK0/AH
PE15/DACK1
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
MPU Mode 1
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
PE0
PE1
PE2
PE3
PE4
PE5
PE6
PE7
PE8
PE9
PE10
PE11
PE12
PE13
PE14
PE15
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1
PE4/TIOC1A
PE5/TIOC1B
PE6/TIOC2A
PE7/TIOC2B
PE8
PE9
PE10
PE11
PE12
PE13
PE14/DACK0/AH
PE15/DACK1
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
On-Chip ROM Enabled
MPU Mode2
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
PE0
PE1
PE2
PE3
PE4
PE5
PE6
PE7
PE8
PE9
PE10
PE11
PE12
PE13
PE14
PE15
PF0/AN0
PF1/AN1
PF2/AN2
PF3/AN3
PF4/AN4
PF5/AN5
PF6/AN6
PF7/AN7
PE0/TIOC0A
PE1/TIOC0B
PE2/TIOC0C
PE3/TIOC0D
PE4/TIOC1A
PE5/TIOC1B
PE6/TIOC2A
PE7/TIOC2B
PE8
PE9
PE10
PE11
PE12
PE13
PE14
PE15
Initial Function PFC Selected Function Possiblilities
Single Chip Mode
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 443 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.2
Register Configuration
Table 16.4 summarizes the registers of the pin function controller.
Table 16.4 Pin Function Controller Registers
Name
Abbreviation R/W
Initial Value
Address
Access Size
Port A I/O register L
PAIORL
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8386
H'FFFF8387
8, 16, 32
Port A control register L1 PACRL1
R/W
H'0000*
H'4000
H'FFFF838C
H'FFFF838D
8, 16, 32
Port A control register L2 PACRL2
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF838E
H'FFFF838F
8, 16, 32
Port B I/O register
PBIOR
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8394
H'FFFF8395
8, 16, 32
Port B control register 1 PBCR1
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8398
H'FFFF8399
8, 16, 32
Port B control register 2 PBCR2
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF839A
H'FFFF839B
8, 16, 32
PCIOR
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8396
H'FFFF8397
8, 16, 32
PCCR
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF839C
H'FFFF839D
8, 16, 32
PDIORL
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83A6
H'FFFF83A7
8, 16, 32
Port D control register L* PDCRL
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83AC
H'FFFF83AD
8, 16, 32
Port E I/O register
PEIOR
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83B4
H'FFFF83B5
8, 16, 32
Port E control register 1 PECR1
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83B8
H'FFFF83B9
8, 16, 32
Port E control register 2 PECR2
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83BA
H'FFFF83BB
8, 16, 32
Port C I/O register*
2
Port C control register*
Port D I/O register L*
2
2
2
1
Notes: 1. The port A control register L1 initial value varies depending on the operating mode.
2. SH7016, SH7017 only.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 444 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.3
Register Descriptions
16.3.1
Port A I/O Register L (PAIORL)
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
*
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PA15
IOR
PA14
IOR
PA13
IOR
PA12
IOR
PA11
IOR
PA10
IOR
PA9
IOR
PA8
IOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PA7
IOR
PA6
IOR
PA5
IOR
PA4
IOR
PA3
IOR
PA2
IOR
PA1
IOR
PA0
IOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R only in the SH7014
The port A I/O register L (PAIORL) is a 16-bit read/write register that selects input or output for
the 16 pins of port A (11 pins in the SH7014). Bits PA15IOR to PA0IOR correspond to pins
PA15/CK to PA0/RXD0. PAIORL is enabled when the port A pins function as general
input/outputs (PA15 to PA0), or with the serial clock (SCK1, SCK0). For other functions, it is
disabled.
When the port A pin functions PA15 to PA0 are SCK1, SCK0, a given pin in port A is an output
pin if its corresponding PAIORL bit is set to 1, and an input pin if the bit is cleared to 0.
PAIORL is initialized to H'0000 by external power-on reset; however, it is not initialized for reset
by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is maintained.
The settings of bits 14 to 10 of this register are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the
SH7014, there are no pins corresponding to bits 14 to 10; these bits are always read as 0, and their
write value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 445 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.3.2
Port A Control Registers L1, L2 (PACRL1 and PACRL2)
PACRL1 and PACRL2 are 16-bit read/write registers that select the functions of the 16
multiplexed pins of port A (11 pins in the SH7014). PACRL1 selects the function of the PA15/CK
to PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2 pins of port A; PACRL2 selects the function of the PA7/TCLKB/CS3 to
PA0/RXD0 pins of port A.
Port A includes bus control signals (RD, WRH, WRL, CS0 to CS3, and AH) and DMAC control
signals (DREQ0 and DREQ1), but in the SH7016 and SH7017, register settings relating to the
selection of these pin functions may be invalid depending on the operating mode. For details, see
table 16.2, Pin Functions in Each Operating Mode.
PACRL1 is initialized by external power-on reset to H'4000 in extended mode, and to H'0000 in
single chip mode. PACRL2 is initialized by external power-on reset to H'0000. Neither register is
initialized by reset by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is maintained.
The settings of bits 12, 10, 8, 6, and 4 of PACRL1 are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017.
In the SH7014, there are no pins corresponding to these bits; they are always read as 0, and their
write value should always be 0.
Port A Control Register L1 (PACRL1):
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
PA15MD
⎯
PA14MD
⎯
PA13MD
⎯
PA12MD
0
0 (1)*1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R/W*
1
0
R
R/W
R
7
6
5
⎯
PA11MD
⎯
0
0
0
R
R/W*
2
R
R/W*
4
R
R/W*
3
2
2
2
PA10MD PA9MD1 PA9MD0 PA8MD1 PA8MD0
0
R/W*
Notes: 1. Bit 14 is initialized to 1 in extended mode.
2. R only in the SH7014.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 446 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
2
2
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 15⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 14⎯PA15 Mode (PA15MD): Selects the function of the PA15/CK pin.
Bit 14
PA15MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA15)
1
Clock output (CK)
(single chip mode initial value)
(extended mode initial value)
Bits 13⎯Reserved: This bit always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 12⎯PA14 Mode (PA14MD) ⎯SH7016, SH7017⎯: Selects the function of the PA14/RD
pin.
Bit 12
PA14MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA14)
(initial value)
(RD in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Read output (RD) (PA14 in single chip mode)
Bit 11⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 10⎯PA13 Mode (PA13MD) ⎯SH7016, SH7017⎯: Selects the function of the PA13/WRH
pin.
Bit 10
PA13MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA13)
(initial value)
(WRH in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Most significant side write output (WRH) (PA13 in single chip mode)
Bit 9⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 447 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 8⎯PA12 Mode (PA12MD) ⎯SH7016, SH7017⎯: Selects the function of the PA12/WRL
pin.
Bit 8
PA12MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA12)
(initial value)
(WRL in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Least significant side write output (WRL) (PA12 in single chip mode)
Bit 7⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 6⎯PA11 Mode (PA11MD) ⎯SH7016, SH7017⎯: Selects the function of the PA11/CS1
pin.
Bit 6
PA11MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA11)
(initial value)
(CS1 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Chip select output (CS1) (PA11 in single chip mode)
Bit 5⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 4⎯PA10 Mode (PA10MD) ⎯SH7016, SH7017⎯: Selects the function of the PA10/CS0
pin.
Bit 4
PA10MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA10)
(CS0 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Chip select output (CS0) (PA10 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 448 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bits 3 and 2⎯PA9 Mode 1, 0 (PA9MD1 and PA9MD0): These bits select the function of the
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3 pin.
Bit 3
PA9MD1
Bit 2
PA9MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PA9)
1
MTU timer clock input (TCLKD)
0
Interrupt request input (IRQ3)
1
Reserved
1
(initial value)
Bits 1 and 0⎯PA8 Mode 1, 0 (PA8MD1 and PA8MD0): These bits select the function of the
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2 pin.
Bit 1
PA8MD1
Bit 0
PA8MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PA8)
1
MTU timer clock input (TCLKC)
0
Interrupt request input (IRQ2)
1
Reserved
1
(initial value)
Port A Control Register L2 (PACRL2):
Bit:
Initial value:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PA7
MD1
PA7
MD0
PA6
MD1
PA6
MD0
PA5
MD1
PA5
MD0
⎯
PA4MD
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
PA3MD
PA2
MD1
PA2
MD0
⎯
PA1MD
⎯
PA0MD
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
R/W:
Bit:
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 449 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bits 15 and 14⎯PA7 Mode 1, 0 (PA7MD1 and PA7MD0): These bits select the function of the
PA7/TCLKB/CS3 pin.
Bit 15
PA7MD1
Bit 14
PA7MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PA7)
1
MTU timer clock input (TCLKB)
0
Chip select output (CS3) (PA7 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
1
(initial value)
Bits 13 and 12⎯PA6 Mode 1, 0 (PA6MD1 and PA6MD0): These bits select the function of the
PA6/TCLKA/CS2 pin.
Bit 13
PA6MD1
Bit 12
PA6MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PA6)
1
MTU timer clock input (TCLKA)
0
Chip select output (CS2) (PA6 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
1
(initial value)
Bits 11 and 10⎯PA5 Mode 1, 0 (PA5MD1 and PA5MD0): These bits select the function of the
PA5/SCK1/DREQ1/IRQ1 pin.
Bit 11
PA5MD1
Bit 10
PA5MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PA5)
1
Serial clock input/output (SCK1)
0
DMA transfer request received input (DREQ1)
(PA5 in single-chip mode)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ1)
1
Bit 9⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 450 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 8⎯PA4 Mode (PA4MD): Selects the function of the PA4/TxD1 pin.
Bit 8
PA4MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA4)
1
Transmit data output (TxD1)
(initial value)
Bit 7⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 6⎯PA3 Mode (PA3MD): Selects the function of the PA3/RxD1 pin.
Bit 6
PA3MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA3)
1
Receive data input (RxD1)
(initial value)
Bits 5 and 4⎯PA2 Mode 1, 0 (PA2MD1 and PA2MD0): These bits select the function of the
PA2/SCK0/DREQ0/IRQ0 pin.
Bit 5
PA2MD1
Bit 4
PA2MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PA2)
1
Serial clock input/output (SCK0)
0
DMA transfer request received input (DREQ0)
1
(initial value)
(PA2 in single-chip mode)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ0)
Bit 3⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 2⎯PA1 Mode (PA1MD): Selects the function of the PA1/TxD0 pin.
Bit 2
PA1MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA1)
1
Transmit data output (TxD0)
(initial value)
Bit 1⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 451 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 0⎯PA0 Mode (PA0MD): Selects the function of the PA0/RxD0 pin.
Bit 0
PA0MD
Description
0
General input/output (PA0)
1
Receive data input (RxD0)
16.3.3
Port B I/O Register (PBIOR)
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
PB9
IOR
PB8
IOR
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PB7
IOR
PB6
IOR
PB5
IOR
PB4
IOR
PB3
IOR
PB2
IOR
PB1
IOR
PB0
IOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W*
R/W*
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
(initial value)
*
R only in the SH7014.
The port B I/O register L (PBIOR) is a 16-bit read/write register that selects input or output for the
ten pins of port B (eight pins in the SH7014). Bits PB9IOR to PB0IOR correspond to the
PB9/IRQ7/A21 pin to PB0/A16 pin. PBIOR is enabled when the port B pins function as
input/outputs (PB9 to PB0). For other functions, it is disabled.
For port B pin functions PB9 to PB0, a given pin in port B is an output pin if its corresponding
PBIOR bit is set to 1, and an input pin if the bit is cleared to 0.
PBIOR is initialized to H'0000 by external power-on reset; however, it is not initialized for reset
by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is maintained.
The settings of bits 1 and 0 of PBIOR are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the
SH7014, there are no pins corresponding to these bits; they are always read as 0, and their write
value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 452 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.3.4
Port B Control Registers (PBCR1 and PBCR2)
PBCR1 and PBCR2 are 16-bit read/write registers that select the functions of the ten multiplexed
pins of port B (eight pins in the SH7014). PBCR1 selects the functions of the top two bits of port
B; PBCR2 selects the functions of the bottom eight bits of port B (six bits in the SH7014).
Port B includes bus control signals (RDWR, RAS, CASH, CASL, and WAIT) and address outputs
(A21 to A16), but in the SH7016 and SH7017, settings in these registers relating to the selection
of these pin functions may be invalid in single-chip mode. For details, see table 16.3, Pin
Functions in Each Operating Mode.
PBCR1 and PBCR2 are both initialized to H'0000 by external power-on reset but are not
initialized for reset by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is maintained.
The settings of bits 2 and 0 of PBCR2 are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the
SH7014, there are no pins corresponding to these bits; they are always read as 0, and their write
value should always be 0.
Port B Control Register 1 (PBCR1):
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
PB9
MD1
PB9
MD0
PB8
MD1
PB8
MD0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 453 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bits 15 to 4⎯Reserved: These bits always read as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bits 3 and 2⎯PB9 Mode 1, 0 (PB9MD1 and PB9MD0): PB9MD1 and PB9MD0 select the
function of the PB9/IRQ7/A21 pin.
Bit 3
PB9MD1
Bit 2
PB9MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PB9)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ7)
0
Address output (A21) (PB9 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
1
(initial value)
Bits 1 and 0⎯PB8 Mode 1, 0 (PB8MD1 and PB8MD0): PB8MD1 and PB8MD0 select the
function of the PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT pin.
Bit 1
PB8MD1
Bit 0
PB8MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PB8)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ6)
1
0
Address output (A20) (PB8 in single-chip mode)
1
Wait state request input (WAIT)
(PB8 in single-chip mode)
(initial value)
Port B Control Register 2 (PBCR2):
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PB7MD1 PB7MD0 PB6MD1 PB6MD0 PB5MD1 PB5MD0 PB4MD1 PB4MD0
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
PB3MD1 PB3MD0 PB2MD1 PB2MD0
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
*
3
2
1
0
⎯
PB1MD
⎯
PB0MD
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W*
R
R/W*
R only in the SH7014.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 454 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bits 15 and 14⎯PB7 Mode 1, 0 (PB7MD1 and PB7MD0): PB7MD1 and PB7MD0 select the
function of the PB7/A19 pin.
Bit 15
PB7MD1
Bit 14:
PB7MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PB7)
1
Reserved
0
Address output (A19) (PB7 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
1
(initial value)
Bits 13 and 12⎯PB6 Mode 1, 0 (PB6MD1 and PB6MD0): PB6MD1 and PB6MD0 select the
function of the PB6/A18 pin.
Bit 13
PB6MD1
Bit 12
PB6MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PB6)
1
Reserved
0
Address output (A18) (PB6 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
1
(initial value)
Bits 11 and 10⎯PB5 Mode 1, 0 (PB5MD1 and PB5MD0): PB5MD1 and PB5MD0 select the
function of the PB5/IRQ3/RDWR pin.
Bit 11
PB5MD1
Bit 10
PB5MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PB5)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ3)
0
Reserved
1
Read/write output (RDWR) (PB5 in single-chip mode)
1
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 455 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bits 9 and 8⎯PB4 Mode 1, 0 (PB4MD1 and PB4MD0): PB4MD1 and PB4MD0 select the
function of the PB4/IRQ2/CASH pin.
Bit 9
PB4MD1
Bit 8
PB4MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PB4)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ2)
0
Reserved
1
Column address strobe (CASH) (PB4 in single-chip mode)
1
(initial value)
Bits 7 and 6⎯PB3 Mode 1, 0 (PB3MD1 and PB3MD0): PB3MD1 and PB3MD0 select the
function of the PB3/IRQ1/CASL pin.
Bit 7
PB3MD1
Bit 6
PB3MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PB3)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ1)
0
Reserved
1
Column address strobe (CASL) (PB3 in single-chip mode)
1
(initial value)
Bits 5 and 4⎯PB2 Mode 1, 0 (PB2MD1 and PB2MD0): PB2MD1 and PB2MD0 select the
function of the PB2/IRQ0/RAS pin.
Bit 5
PB2MD1
Bit 4
PB2MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PB2)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ0)
0
Reserved
1
Row address strobe (RAS) (PB2 in single-chip mode)
1
Bit 3⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 456 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 2⎯PB1 Mode (PB1MD) ⎯SH7016, SH7017⎯: Selects the function of the PB1/A17 pin.
Bit 2
PB1MD
Description
0
General input/output (PB1)
(initial value)
(A17 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A17) (PB1 in single chip mode)
Bit 1⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 0⎯PB0 Mode (PB0MD) ⎯SH7016, SH7017⎯: Selects the function of the PB0/A16 pin.
Bit 0
PB0MD
Description
0
General input/output (PB0)
(initial value)
(A16 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A16) (PB0 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 457 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.3.5
Port C I/O Register (PCIOR) ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PC15
IOR
PC14
IOR
PC13
IOR
PC12
IOR
PC11
IOR
PC10
IOR
PC9
IOR
PC8
IOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PC7
IOR
PC6
IOR
PC5
IOR
PC4
IOR
PC3
IOR
PC2
IOR
PC1
IOR
PC0
IOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
The port C I/O register (PCIOR) is a 16-bit read/write register that selects input or output for the
16 port C pins. Bits PC15IOR to PC0IOR correspond to pins PC15/A15 to PC0/A0. PCIOR is
enabled when the port C pins function as general input/outputs (PC15 to PC0). For other
functions, it is disabled.
When the port C pin functions are as PC15 to PC0, a given pin in port C is an output pin if its
corresponding PCIOR bit is set to 1, and an input pin if the bit is cleared to 0.
PCIOR is initialized to H'0000 by external power-on reset; however, it is not initialized for reset
by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous values are maintained.
The settings in this register are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the SH7014, there
are no pins corresponding to this register, and it should not be read or written to.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 458 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Port C Control Register (PCCR) ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
16.3.6
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PC15
MD
PC14
MD
PC13
MD
PC12
MD
PC11
MD
PC10
MD
PC9
MD
PC8
MD
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PC7
MD
PC6
MD
PC5
MD
PC4
MD
PC3
MD
PC2
MD
PC1
MD
PC0
MD
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
PCCR is a 16-bit read/write register that selects the functions for the sixteen port C multiplexed
pins. There are instances when these register settings will be ignored, depending on the operation
mode. Refer to table 16.3, Pin Arrangement by Mode, for details.
PCCR is initialized to H'0000 by power-on resets but is not initialized for reset by WDT, standby
mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is maintained.
The settings in this register are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the SH7014, there
are no pins corresponding to this register, and it should not be read or written to.
Bit 15⎯PC15 Mode (PC15MD): Selects the function of the PC15/A15 pin.
Bit 15
PC15MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC15)
(initial value)
(A15 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A15) (PC15 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 459 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 14⎯PC14 Mode (PC14MD): Selects the function of the PC14/A14 pin.
Bit 14
PC14MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC14)
(initial value)
(A14 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A14) (PC14 in single chip mode)
Bit 13⎯PC13 Mode (PC13MD): Selects the function of the PC13/A13 pin.
Bit 13
PC13MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC13)
(initial value)
(A13 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A13) (PC13 in single chip mode)
Bit 12⎯PC12 Mode (PC12MD): Selects the function of the PC12/A12 pin.
Bit 12
PC12MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC12)
(initial value)
(A12 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A12) (PC12 in single chip mode)
Bit 11⎯PC11 Mode (PC11MD): Selects the function of the PC11/A11 pin.
Bit 11
PC11MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC11)
(A11 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A11) (PC11 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 460 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 10⎯PC10 Mode (PC10MD): Selects the function of the PC10/A10 pin.
Bit 10
PC10MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC10)
(initial value)
(A10 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A10) (PC10 in single chip mode)
Bit 9⎯PC9 Mode (PC9MD): Selects the function of the PC9/A9 pin.
Bit 9
PC9MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC9)
(initial value)
(A9 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A9) (PC9 in single chip mode)
Bit 8⎯PC8 Mode (PC8MD): Selects the function of the PC8/A8 pin.
Bit 8
PC8MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC8)
(initial value)
(A8 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A8) (PC8 in single chip mode)
Bit 7⎯PC7 Mode (PC7MD): Selects the function of the PC7/A7 pin.
Bit 7
PC7MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC7)
(initial value)
(A7 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A7) (PC7 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 461 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 6⎯PC6 Mode (PC6MD): Selects the function of the PC6/A6 pin.
Bit 6
PC6MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC6)
(initial value)
(A6 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A6) (PC6 in single chip mode)
Bit 5⎯PC5 Mode (PC5MD): Selects the function of the PC5/A5 pin.
Bit 5
PC5MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC5)
(initial value)
(A5 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A5) (PC5 in single chip mode)
Bit 4⎯PC4 Mode (PC4MD): Selects the function of the PC4/A4 pin.
Bit 4
PC4MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC4)
(initial value)
(A4 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A4) (PC4 in single chip mode)
Bit 3⎯PC3 Mode (PC3MD): Selects the function of the PC3/A3 pin.
Bit 3
PC3MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC3)
(A3 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A3) (PC3 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 462 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 2⎯PC2 Mode (PC2MD): Selects the function of the PC2/A2 pin.
Bit 2
PC2MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC2)
(initial value)
(A2 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A2) (PC2 in single chip mode)
Bit 1⎯PC1 Mode (PC1MD): Selects the function of the PC1/A1 pin.
Bit 1
PC1MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC1)
(initial value)
(A1 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A1) (PC1 in single chip mode)
Bit 0⎯PC0 Mode (PC0MD): Selects the function of the PC0/A0 pin.
Bit 0
PC0MD
Description
0
General input/output (PC0)
(initial value)
(A0 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A0) (PC0 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 463 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.3.7
Port D I/O Register L (PDIORL) ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PD15
IOR
PD14
IOR
PD13
IOR
PD12
IOR
PD11
IOR
PD10
IOR
PD9
IOR
PD8
IOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PD7
IOR
PD6
IOR
PD5
IOR
PD4
IOR
PD3
IOR
PD2
IOR
PD1
IOR
PD0
IOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
The port D I/O register L (PDIORL) is a 16-bit read/write register that selects input or output for
the sixteen port D pins. Bits PD15IOR to PD0IOR correspond to the PD15/D15 pin to PD0/D0
pin. PDIORL is enabled when the port D pins function as general input/outputs (PD15 to PD0).
For other functions, it is disabled.
For port D pin functions PD15 to PD0, a given pin in port D is an output pin if its corresponding
PDIORL bit is set to 1, and an input pin if the bit is cleared to 0.
PDIORL is initialized to H'0000 by external power-on reset; however, it is not initialized for reset
by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is maintained.
The settings in this register are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the SH7014, there
are no pins corresponding to this register, and it should not be read or written to.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 464 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.3.8
Port D Control Register L (PDCRL) ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PD15
MD
PD14
MD
PD13
MD
PD12
MD
PD11
MD
PD10
MD
PD9
MD
PD8
MD
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PD7
MD
PD6
MD
PD5
MD
PD4
MD
PD3
MD
PD2
MD
PD1
MD
PD0
MD
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
PDCRL is a 16-bit read/write register that selects the multiplexed pin functions for the least
significant sixteen port D pins. There are instances when these register settings will be ignored,
depending on the operation mode.
On-Chip ROM-Disabled Extended Mode:
⎯ Mode 0 (8-bit bus): Port D pins are data I/O pins; PDCRL settings are disabled.
⎯ Mode 1 (16-bit bus): Port D pins are data I/O pins; PDCRL settings are disabled.
On-Chip ROM-Enabled Extended Mode: The port D pins are shared as data I/O pins and
general I/O pins; PDCRL settings are enabled.
Single Chip Mode: The port D pins are general I/O pins; PDCRL settings are disabled.
PDCRL is initialized to H'0000 by external power-on reset but is not initialized for reset by WDT,
standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is maintained.
The settings in this register are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the SH7014, there
are no pins corresponding to this register, and it should not be read or written to.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 465 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 15⎯PD15 Mode (PD15MD): Selects the function of the PD15/D15 pin.
Bit 15
PD15MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD15)
(initial value)
(D15 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D15) (PD15 in single chip mode)
Bit 14⎯PD14 Mode (PD14MD): Selects the function of the PD14/D14 pin.
Bit 14
PD14MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD14)
(initial value)
(D14 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D14) (PD14 in single chip mode)
Bit 13⎯PD13 Mode (PD13MD): Selects the function of the PD13/D13 pin.
Bit 13
PD13MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD13)
(initial value)
(D13 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D13) (PD13 in single chip mode)
Bit 12⎯PD12 Mode (PD12MD): Selects the function of the PD12/D12 pin.
Bit 12
PD12MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD12)
(D12 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D12) (PD12 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 466 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 11⎯PD11 Mode (PD11MD): Selects the function of the PD11/D11 pin.
Bit 11
PD11MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD11)
(initial value)
(D11 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D11) (PD11 in single chip mode)
Bit 10⎯PD10 Mode (PD10MD): Selects the function of the PD10/D10 pin.
Bit 10
PD10MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD10)
(initial value)
(D10 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D10) (PD10 in single chip mode)
Bit 9⎯PD9 Mode (PD9MD): Selects the function of the PD9/D9 pin.
Bit 9
PD9MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD9)
(initial value)
(D9 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D9) (PD9 in single chip mode)
Bit 8⎯PD8 Mode (PD8MD): Selects the function of the PD8/D8 pin.
Bit 8
PD8MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD8)
(initial value)
(D8 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D8) (PD8 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 467 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 7⎯PD7 Mode (PD7MD): Selects the function of the PD7/D7 pin.
Bit 7
PD7MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD7)
(initial value)
(D7 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D7) (PD7 in single chip mode)
Bit 6⎯PD6 Mode (PD6MD): Selects the function of the PD6/D6 pin.
Bit 6
PD6MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD6)
(initial value)
(D6 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D6) (PD6 in single chip mode)
Bit 5⎯PD5 Mode (PD5MD): Selects the function of the PD5/D5 pin.
Bit 5
PD5MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD5)
(initial value)
(D5 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D5) (PD5 in single chip mode)
Bit 4⎯PD4 Mode (PD4MD): Selects the function of the PD4/D4 pin.
Bit 4
PD4MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD4)
(D4 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D4) (PD4 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 468 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 3⎯PD3 Mode (PD3MD): Selects the function of the PD3/D3 pin.
Bit 3
PD3MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD3)
(initial value)
(D3 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D3) (PD3 in single chip mode)
Bit 2⎯PD2 Mode (PD2MD): Selects the function of the PD2/D2 pin.
Bit 2
PD2MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD2)
(initial value)
(D2 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D2) (PD2 in single chip mode)
Bit 1⎯PD1 Mode (PD1MD): Selects the function of the PD1/D1 pin.
Bit 1
PD1MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD1)
(initial value)
(D1 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D1) (PD1 in single chip mode)
Bit 0⎯PD0 Mode (PD0MD): Selects the function of the PD0/D0 pin.
Bit 0
PD0MD
Description
0
General input/output (PD0)
(initial value)
(D0 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D0) (PD0 in single chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 469 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.3.9
Port E I/O Register (PEIOR)
The port E I/O register (PEIOR) is a 16-bit read/write register that selects input or output
for the 16 port E pins. Bits PE15IOR to PE0IOR correspond to pins PE15/DACK1 to
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0. PEIOR is enabled when the port E pins function as general input/outputs
(PE15 to PE0) or TIOC pin of the MTU. For other functions, it is disabled.
When the port E pin functions are as PE15 to PE0, or TIOC pin of the MTU, a given pin in port E
is an output pin if its corresponding PEIOR bit is set to 1, and an input pin if the bit is cleared to 0.
PEIOR is initialized to H'0000 by external power-on reset; however, it is not initialized for reset
by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is maintained.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PE15
IOR
PE14
IOR
PE13
IOR
PE12
IOR
PE11
IOR
PE10
IOR
PE9
IOR
PE8
IOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PE7
IOR
PE6
IOR
PE5
IOR
PE4
IOR
PE3
IOR
PE2
IOR
PE1
IOR
PE0
IOR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 470 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
16.3.10 Port E Control Registers 1, 2 (PECR1 and PECR2)
PECR1 and PECR2 are 16-bit read/write registers that select the functions of the sixteen
multiplexed pins of port E. PECR1 selects the functions of the upper eight bit pins of port E;
PECR2 selects the function of the lower eight bit pins of port E.
Port E includes a bus control signal (AH) and DMAC control signals (DACK1, DACK0, DRAK1,
and DRAK0), but in the SH7016 and SH7017, settings in these registers relating to the selection
of these pin functions may be invalid in single-chip mode. For details, see table 16.3, Pin
Functions in Each Operating Mode.
PECR1 and PECR2 are both initialized to H'0000 by external power-on reset but are not initialized
for reset by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is maintained.
Port E Control Register 1 (PECR1):
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PE15
MD1
PE15
MD0
PE14
MD1
PE14
MD0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Bits 15 and 14⎯PE15 Mode 1, 0 (PE15MD1 and PE15MD0): These bits select the function of
the PE15/DACK1 pin.
Bit 15
PE15MD1
Bit 14
PE15MD0
Description
0
0
Input/output (PE15)
1
Reserved
0
DMA request received output (DACK1)
(PE15 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
1
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 471 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bits 13 and 12⎯PE14 Mode 1, 0 (PE14MD1 and PE14MD0): These bits select the function of
the PE14/DACK0/AH pin.
Bit 13
PE14MD1
Bit 12
PE14MD0
Description
0
0
Input/output (PE14)
1
Reserved
0
DMA request received output (DACK0) (PE14 in single-chip mode)
1
Address hold output (AH) (PE14 in single-chip mode)
1
(initial value)
Bits 11 to 0⎯Reserved: These bits always reads as 0. The write values should always be 0.
Port E Control Register 2 (PECR2):
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
PE7MD
⎯
PE6MD
⎯
PE5MD
⎯
PE4MD
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PE3
MD1
PE3
MD0
PE2
MD1
PE2
MD0
PE1
MD1
PE1
MD0
PE0
MD1
PE0
MD0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit 15⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 14⎯PE7 Mode (PE7MD): Selects the function of the PE7/TIOC2B pin.
Bit 14
PE7MD
Description
0
General input/output (PE7)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC2B)
Bit 13 ⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 472 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bit 12⎯PE6 Mode (PE6MD): Selects the function of the PE6/TIOC2A pin.
Bit 12
PE6MD
Description
0
General input/output (PE6)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC2A)
(initial value)
Bit 11⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 10⎯PE5 Mode (PE5MD): Selects the function of the PE5/TIOC1B pin.
Bit 10
PE5MD
Description
0
General input/output (PE5)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC1B)
(initial value)
Bit 9⎯Reserved: This bit always reads as 0. The write value should always be 0.
Bit 8⎯PE4 Mode (PE4MD): Selects the function of the PE4/TIOC1A pin.
Bit 8
PE4MD
Description
0
General input/output (PE4)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC1A)
(initial value)
Bits 7 and 6⎯PE3 Mode 1, 0 (PE3MD1 and PE3MD0): These bits select the function of the
PE3/TIOC0D/DRAK1 pin.
Bit 7
PE3MD1
Bit 6
PE3MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PE3)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC0D)
1
0
DREQ1 request received output (DRAK1) (PE3 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 473 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
16. Pin Function Controller (PFC)
Bits 5 and 4⎯PE2 Mode 1, 0 (PE2MD1 and PE2MD0): These bits select the function of the
PE2/TIOC0C/DREQ1 pin.
Bit 5
PE2MD1
Bit 4
PE2MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PE2)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC0C)
1
0
DREQ1 request receive input (PE2 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
(initial value)
Bits 3 and 2⎯PE1 Mode 1, 0 (PE1MD1 and PE1MD0): These bits select the function of the
PE1/TIOC0B/DRAK0 pin.
Bit 3
PE1MD1
Bit 2
PE1MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PE1)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC0B)
0
DREQ0 request received output (DRAK0) (PE1 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
1
(initial value)
Bits 1 and 0⎯PE0 Mode 1, 0 (PE0MD1 and PE0MD0): These bits select the function of the
PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0 pin.
Bit 1
PE0MD1
Bit 0
PE0MD0
Description
0
0
General input/output (PE0)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC0A)
0
DREQ0 request receive input (PE0 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 474 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
Section 17 I/O Ports (I/O)
17.1
Overview
The SH7016 and SH7017 have six ports, A to F, and the SH7014 has four ports, A, B, E, and F.
The pins of the ports are multiplexed for use as general-purpose I/Os (the port F pins are general
input) or for other functions. Use the pin function controller (PFC) to select the function of
multiplexed pins. The ports each have one data register for storing pin data. The initialize function
after power-on reset differs depending on the operating mode of each pin. See tables 16.2 and
16.3, Pin Arrangement by Mode, for details.
17.2
Port A
Port A is a 16-pin input/output port (11-pin in the SH7014) as shown in table 17.1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 475 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
Table 17.1 Port A
ROM Disabled Extended
Mode (Modes 0, 1)
ROM Enabled Extended
Mode (Mode 2)*
Single Chip Mode*
PA15 (I/O)/CK (output)
PA15 (I/O)/CK (output)
PA15 (I/O)/CK (output)
RD (output)
PA14 (I/O)/RD (output)
PA14 (I/O)
WRH (output)
PA13 (I/O)/WRH (output)
PA13 (I/O)
WRL (output)
PA12 (I/O)/WRL (output)
PA12 (I/O)
CS1 (output)
PA11 (I/O)/CS1 (output)
PA11 (I/O)
CS0 (output)
PA10 (I/O)/CS0 (output)
PA10 (I/O)
PA9 (I/O)/TCLKD
(input)/IRQ3 (input)
PA9 (I/O)/TCLKD (input)/
IRQ3 (input)
PA9 (I/O)/TCLKD
(input)/IRQ3 (input)
PA8 (I/O)/TCLKC
(input)/IRQ2 (input)
PA8 (I/O)/TCLKC (input)/
IRQ2 (input)
PA8 (I/O)/TCLKC
(input)/IRQ2 (input)
PA7 (I/O)/TCLKB (input)/
CS3 (input)
PA7 (I/O)/TCLKB (input)/
CS3 (input)
PA7 (I/O)/TCLKB (input)
PA6 (I/O)/TCLKA (input)/
CS2 (input)
PA6 (I/O)/TCLKA (input)/
CS2 (input)
PA6 (I/O)/TCLKA (input)
PA5 (I/O)/SCK1 (I/O)/
DREQ1 (input)/IRQ1 (input)
PA5 (I/O)/SCK1 (I/O)/
DREQ1 (input)/IRQ1 (input)
PA5 (I/O)/SCK1 (I/O)/
IRQ1 (input)
PA4 (I/O)/TXD1 (output)
PA4 (I/O)/TXD1 (output)
PA4 (I/O)/TXD1 (output)
PA3 (I/O)/RXD1 (input)
PA3 (I/O)/RXD1 (input)
PA3 (I/O)/RXD1 (input)
PA2 (I/O)/SCK0 (I/O)/
DREQ0 (input)/IRQ0 (input)
PA2 (I/O)/SCK0 (I/O)/
DREQ0 (input)/IRQ0 (input)
PA2 (I/O)/SCK0 (I/O)/
IRQ0 (input)
PA1 (I/O)/TXD0 (output)
PA1 (I/O)/TXD0 (output)
PA1 (I/O)/TXD0 (output)
PA0 (I/O)/RXD0 (input)
PA0 (I/O)/RXD0 (input)
PA0 (I/O)/RXD0 (input)
Note:
17.2.1
*
SH7016, SH7017 only.
Register Configuration
Table 17.2 summarizes the port A register.
Table 17.2 Port A Register
Name
Abbreviation
Port A data register L PADRL
R/W
Initial Value
Address
Access Size
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8382
H'FFFF8383
8, 16, 32
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 476 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.2.2
Port A Data Register L (PADRL)
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
PA15DR PA14DR PA13DR PA12DR PA11DR PA10DR
Initial value:
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
*
9
8
PA9DR
PA8DR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W*
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PA7DR
PA6DR
PA5DR
PA4DR
PA3DR
PA2DR
PA1DR
PA0DR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R only in the SH7014.
PADRL is a 16-bit read/write register that stores data for port A. The bits PA15DR to PA0DR
correspond to the PA15/CK to PA0/RXD0 pins. When the pins are used as ordinary outputs, they
will output whatever value is written in the PADRL; when PADRL is read, the register value will
be output regardless of the pin status. When the pins are used as ordinary inputs, the pin status
rather than the register value is read directly when PADRL is read. When a value is written to
PADRL, that value can be written into PADRL, but it will not affect the pin status. Table 17.3
shows the read/write operations of the port A data register.
PADRL is initialized by an external power-on reset. However, PADRL is not initialized for a reset
by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode.
The settings of bits 14 to 10 of this register are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the
SH7014, there are no pins corresponding to bits 14 to 10; these bits are always read as 0, and their
write value should always be 0.
Table 17.3 Read/Write Operation of the Port A Data Register (PADR)
PAIOR Pin Status
Read
Write
0
Ordinary input
Pin status
Can write to PADR, but it has no effect on pin status
Other function
Pin status
Can write to PADR, but it has no effect on pin status
Ordinary output
PADR value
Value written is output by pin
Other function
PADR value
Can write to PADR, but it has no effect on pin status
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 477 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.3
Port B
Port B is a 10-pin input/output port (8-pin in the SH7014) as shown in table 17.4.
Table 17.4 Port B
ROM Disabled Extended
Mode (Modes 0, 1)
ROM Enabled Extended
Mode (Mode 2)*
PB9 (I/O)/IRQ7 (input)/
A21 (output)
PB9 (I/O)/IRQ7 (input)/
A21 (output)
PB9 (I/O)/IRQ7 (input)
PB8 (I/O)/IRQ6 (input)/
A20 (output)/WAIT (input)
PB8 (I/O)/IRQ6 (input)/
A20 (output)/WAIT (input)
PB8 (I/O)/IRQ6 (input)
PB7 (I/O)/A19 (output)
PB7 (I/O)/A19 (output)
PB7 (I/O)
PB6 (I/O)/A18 (output)
PB6 (I/O)/A18 (output)
PB6 (I/O)
PB5 (I/O)/IRQ3
(input)/RDWR (output)
PB5 (I/O)/IRQ3 (input)/
RDWR (output)
PB5 (I/O)/IRQ3 (input)
PB4 (I/O)/IRQ2 (input)/
CASH (output)
PB4 (I/O)/IRQ2 (input)/
CASH (output)
PB4 (I/O)/IRQ2 (input)
PB3 (I/O)/IRQ1 (input)/
CASL (output)
PB3 (I/O)/IRQ1 (input)/
CASL (output)
PB3 (I/O)/IRQ1 (input)
PB2 (I/O)/IRQ0 (input)/
RAS (output)
PB2 (I/O)/IRQ0 (input)/
RAS (output)
PB2 (I/O)/IRQ0 (input)
A17 (output)
PB1 (I/O)/A17 (output)
PB1 (I/O)
A16 (output)
PB0 (I/O)/A16 (output)
PB0 (I/O)
Note:
17.3.1
*
Single Chip Mode*
SH7016 and SH7017 only.
Register Configuration
Table 17.5 summarizes the port B register.
Table 17.5 Port B Register
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
Address
Access Size
Port B data register
PBDR
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8390
H'FFFF8391
8, 16, 32
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 478 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.3.2
Port B Data Register (PBDR)
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
PB9DR
PB8DR
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PB7DR
PB6DR
PB5DR
PB4DR
PB3DR
PB2DR
PB1DR
PB0DR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W*
R/W*
Initial value:
R/W:
Note:
*
R only in the SH7014.
PBDR is a 16-bit read/write register that stores data for port B. The bits PB9DR to PB0DR
correspond to the PB9/IRQ7/A21 to PB0/A16 pins. When the pins are used as ordinary outputs,
they will output whatever value is written in the PBDR; when PBDR is read, the register value
will be read regardless of the pin status. When the pins are used as ordinary inputs, the pin status
rather than the register value is read directly when PBDR is read. When a value is written to
PBDR, that value can be written into PBDR, but it will not affect the pin status. table 17.6 shows
the read/write operations of the port B data register.
PBDR is initialized by an external power-on reset. However, PBDR is not initialized for a reset by
WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode.
The settings of bits 1 and 0 of this register are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the
SH7014, there are no pins corresponding to these bits; they are always read as 0, and their write
value should always be 0.
Table 17.6 Read/Write Operation of the Port B Data Register (PBDR)
PBIOR
Pin Status
Read
Write
0
Ordinary input
Pin status
Can write to PBDR, but it has no effect on pin status
Other function
Pin status
Can write to PBDR, but it has no effect on pin status
Ordinary output
PBDR value
Value written is output by pin
Other function
PBDR value
Can write to PBDR, but it has no effect on pin status
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 479 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.4
Port C ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Port C is a 16 pin input/output port as listed in table 17.7. There is no port C in the SH7014.
Table 17.7 Port C
ROM Disabled Extended
Mode (Modes 0, 1)
ROM Enabled Extended
Mode (Mode 2)
Single Chip Mode
A15 (output)
PC15 (I/O)/A15 (output)
PC15 (I/O)
A14 (output)
PC14 (I/O)/A14 (output)
PC14 (I/O)
A13 (output)
PC13 (I/O)/A13 (output)
PC13 (I/O)
A12 (output)
PC12 (I/O)/A12 (output)
PC12 (I/O)
A11 (output)
PC11 (I/O)/A11 (output)
PC11 (I/O)
A10 (output)
PC10 (I/O)/A10 (output)
PC10 (I/O)
A9 (output)
PC9 (I/O)/A9 (output)
PC9 (I/O)
A8 (output)
PC8 (I/O)/A8 (output)
PC8 (I/O)
A7 (output)
PC7 (I/O)/A7 (output)
PC7 (I/O)
A6 (output)
PC6 (I/O)/A6 (output)
PC6 (I/O)
A5 (output)
PC5 (I/O)/A5 (output)
PC5 (I/O)
A4 (output)
PC4 (I/O)/A4 (output)
PC4 (I/O)
A3 (output)
PC3 (I/O)/A3 (output)
PC3 (I/O)
A2 (output)
PC2 (I/O)/A2 (output)
PC2 (I/O)
A1 (output)
PC1 (I/O)/A1 (output)
PC1 (I/O)
A0 (output)
PC0 (I/O)/A0 (output)
PC0 (I/O)
17.4.1
Register Configuration
Table 17.8 summarizes the port C register.
Table 17.8 Port C Register
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
Address
Access Size
Port C data register
PCDR
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF8392
H'FFFF8393
8, 16, 32
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 480 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.4.2
Port C Data Register (PCDR)
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
PC15DR PC14DR PC13DR PC12DR PC11DR PC10DR PC9DR
Initial value:
R/W:
PC8DR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PC7DR
PC6DR
PC5DR
PC4DR
PC3DR
PC2DR
PC1DR
PC0DR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
8
PCDR is a 16-bit read/write register that stores data for port C. The bits PC15DR to PC0DR
correspond to the PC15/A15 to PC0/A0 pins. When the pins are used as ordinary outputs, they
will output whatever value is written in the PCDR; when PCDR is read, the register value will be
read regardless of the pin status. When the pins are used as ordinary inputs, the pin status rather
than the register value is read directly when PCDR is read. When a value is written to PCDR, that
value can be written into PCDR, but it will not affect the pin status. Table 17.9 shows the
read/write operations of the port C data register.
PCDR is initialized by an external power-on reset. However, PCDR is not initialized for a reset by
WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode.
The settings in this register are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the SH7014, there
are no pins corresponding to this register, and it should not be read or written to.
Table 17.9 Read/Write Operation of the Port C Data Register (PCDR)
PCIOR
Pin Status
Read
Write
0
Ordinary input
Pin status
Can write to PCDR, but it has no effect on pin status
Other function
Pin status
Can write to PCDR, but it has no effect on pin status
1
Ordinary output
PCDR value
Value written is output by pin
Other function
PCDR value
Can write to PCDR, but it has no effect on pin status
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 481 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.5
Port D ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Port D is a 16-pin input/output port, as shown in table 17.10. There is no port D in the SH7014.
Table 17.10 Port D
Extended Mode
Without ROM
(Mode 0)
Extended Mode
Without ROM
(Mode 1)
Extended Mode With
ROM (Mode 2)
Single Chip Mode
D15 (I/O)
D15 (I/O)
PD15 (I/O)/D15 (I/O)
PD15 (I/O)
D14 (I/O)
D14 (I/O)
PD14 (I/O)/D14 (I/O)
PD14 (I/O)
D13 (I/O)
D13 (I/O)
PD13 (I/O)/D13 (I/O)
PD13 (I/O)
D12 (I/O)
D12 (I/O)
PD12 (I/O)/D12 (I/O)
PD12 (I/O)
D11 (I/O)
D11 (I/O)
PD11 (I/O)/D11 (I/O)
PD11 (I/O)
D10 (I/O)
D10 (I/O)
PD10 (I/O)/D10 (I/O)
PD10 (I/O)
D9 (I/O)
D9 (I/O)
PD9 (I/O)/D9 (I/O)
PD9 (I/O)
D8 (I/O)
D8 (I/O)
PD8 (I/O)/D8 (I/O)
PD8 (I/O)
D7 (I/O)
D7 (I/O)
PD7 (I/O)/D7 (I/O)
PD7 (I/O)
D6 (I/O)
D6 (I/O)
PD6 (I/O)/D6 (I/O)
PD6 (I/O)
D5 (I/O)
D5 (I/O)
PD5 (I/O)/D5 (I/O)
PD5 (I/O)
D4 (I/O)
D4 (I/O)
PD4 (I/O)/D4 (I/O)
PD4 (I/O)
D3 (I/O)
D3 (I/O)
PD3 (I/O)/D3 (I/O)
PD3 (I/O)
D2 (I/O)
D2 (I/O)
PD2 (I/O)/D2 (I/O)
PD2 (I/O)
D1 (I/O)
D1 (I/O)
PD1 (I/O)/D1 (I/O)
PD1 (I/O)
D0 (I/O)
D0 (I/O)
PD0 (I/O)/D0 (I/O)
PD0 (I/O)
17.5.1
Register Configuration
Table 17.11 summarizes the port D register.
Table 17.11 Port D Register
Name
Abbreviation
Port D data register L PDDRL
R/W
Initial Value
Address
Access Size
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83A2
H'FFFF83A3
8, 16, 32
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 482 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.5.2
Port D Data Register L (PDDRL)
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
PD15DR PD14DR PD13DR PD12DR PD11DR PD10DR PD9DR
Initial value:
8
PD8DR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PD7DR
PD6DR
PD5DR
PD4DR
PD3DR
PD2DR
PD1DR
PD0DR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
PDDRL is a 16-bit read/write register that stores data for port D. The bits PD15DR to PD0DR
correspond to the PD15/D15 to PD0/D0 pins. When the pins are used as ordinary outputs, they
will output whatever value is written in the PDDRL; when PDDRL is read, the register value will
be read regardless of the pin status. When the pins are used as ordinary inputs, the pin status rather
than the register value is read directly when PDDRL is read. When a value is written to PDDRL,
that value can be written into PDDRL, but it will not affect the pin status. Table 17.12 shows the
read/write operations of the port D data register.
PDDRL is initialized by an external power-on reset. However, PDDRL is not initialized for a reset
by WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode.
The settings in this register are functional only in the SH7016 and SH7017. In the SH7014, there
are no pins corresponding to this register, and it should not be read or written to.
Table 17.12 Read/Write Operation of the Port D Data Register (PDDR)
PDIOR
Pin Status
Read
Write
0
Ordinary input
Pin status
Can write to PDDR, but it has no effect on pin status
Other function
Pin status
Can write to PDDR, but it has no effect on pin status
1
Ordinary output
PDDR value
Value written is output by pin
Other function
PDDR value
Can write to PDDR, but it has no effect on pin status
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 483 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.6
Port E
Port E is a 16-pin input/output port, as listed in table 17.13.
Table 17.13 Port E
1
2
Extended Modes (Modes 0, 1, 2)*
Single Chip Mode*
PE15 (I/O)/ DACK1 (output)
PE15 (I/O)
PE14 (I/O)/DACK0 (output)/AH (output)
PE14 (I/O)
PE13 (I/O)
PE13 (I/O)
PE12 (I/O)
PE12 (I/O)
PE11 (I/O)
PE11 (I/O)
PE10 (I/O)
PE10 (I/O)
PE9 (I/O)
PE9 (I/O)
PE8 (I/O)
PE8 (I/O)
PE7 (I/O)/TIOC2B (I/O)
PE7 (I/O)/TIOC2B (I/O)
PE6 (I/O)/TIOC2A (I/O)
PE6 (I/O)/TIOC2A (I/O)
PE5 (I/O)/TIOC1B (I/O)
PE5 (I/O)/TIOC1B (I/O)
PE4 (I/O)/TIOC1A (I/O)
PE4 (I/O)/TIOC1A (I/O)
PE3 (I/O)/TIOC0D (I/O)/DRAK1 (output)
PE3 (I/O)/TIOC0D (I/O)
PE2 (I/O)/TIOC0C (I/O)/DREQ1 (input)
PE2 (I/O)/TIOC0C (I/O)
PE1 (I/O)/TIOC0B (I/O)/DRAK0 (output)
PE1 (I/O)/TIOC0B (I/O)
PE0 (I/O)/TIOC0A (I/O)/DREQ0 (input)
PE0 (I/O)/TIOC0A (I/O)
Notes: 1. Modes 0 and 1 only in the SH7014.
2. SH7016 and SH7017 only.
17.6.1
Register Configuration
Table 17.14 summarizes the port E register.
Table 17.14 Port E Register
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
Address
Access Size
Port E data register
PEDR
R/W
H'0000
H'FFFF83B0
H'FFFF83B1
8, 16, 32
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 484 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.6.2
Port E Data Register (PEDR)
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
PE15DR PE14DR PE13DR PE12DR PE11DR PE10DR PE9DR
Initial value:
8
PE8DR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PE7DR
PE6DR
PE5DR
PE4DR
PE3DR
PE2DR
PE1DR
PE0DR
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W:
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
PEDR is a 16-bit read/write register that stores data for port E. The bits PE15DR to PE0DR
correspond to the PE15/DACK1 to PE0/TIOC0A/DREQ0 pins. When the pins are used as
ordinary outputs, they will output whatever value is written in the PEDR; when PEDR is read, the
register value will be read regardless of the pin status. When the pins are used as ordinary inputs,
the pin status rather than the register value is read directly when PEDR is read. When a value is
written to PEDR, that value can be written into PEDR, but it will not affect the pin status. Table
17.15 shows the read/write operations of the port E data register.
PEDR is initialized by a external power-on reset. However, PEDR is not initialized for a reset by
WDT, standby mode, or sleep mode, so the previous data is retained.
Table 17.15 Read/Write Operation of the Port E Data Register (PEDR)
PEIOR
Pin Status
Read
Write
0
Ordinary input
Pin status
Can write to PEDR, but it has no effect on pin status
Other function
Pin status
Can write to PEDR, but it has no effect on pin status
Ordinary output
PEDR value
Value written is output by pin
Other function
PEDR value
Can write to PEDR, but it has no effect on pin status
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 485 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.7
Port F
Port F is an 8-pin input port. All modes are configured in the following way:
• PF7 (input)/AN7 (input)
• PF6 (input)/AN6 (input)
• PF5 (input)/AN5 (input)
• PF4 (input)/AN4 (input)
• PF3 (input)/AN3 (input)
• PF2 (input)/AN2 (input)
• PF1 (input)/AN1 (input)
• PF0 (input)/AN0 (input)
17.7.1
Register Configuration
Table 17.16 summarizes the port F register.
Table 17.16 Port F Register
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
Address
Access Size
Port F data register
PFDR
R
External pin
dependent
H'FFFF83B3
8
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 486 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
17.7.2
Port F Data Register (PFDR)
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PF7DR
PF6DR
PF5DR
PF4DR
PF3DR
PF2DR
PF1DR
PF0DR
Initial value:
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note:
*
Initial values are dependent on the status of the pins at the time of the reads.
PFDR is an 8-bit read-only register that stores data for port F. The bits PF7DR to PF0DR
correspond to the PF7/AN7 to PF0/AN0 pins. Any value written into these bits is ignored, and
there is no effect on the status of the pins. When any of the bits are read, the pin status rather than
the bit value is read directly. However, when an A/D converter analog input is being sampled,
values of 1 are read out. Table 17.17 shows the read/write operations of the port F data register.
PFDR is not initialized by power-on resets, standby mode, or sleep mode (the bits always reflect
the pin status).
Table 17.17 Read/Write Operation of the Port F Data Register (PFDR)
Pin I/O
Pin Function
Read
Write
Input
Ordinary
Pin status is read
Ignored (no effect on pin status)
ANn: analog input
1 is read
Ignored (no effect on pin status)
Note: n = 7 to 0
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 487 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
17. I/O Ports (I/O)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 488 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Section 18 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.1
Features
The SH7017 has 128 kbytes of on-chip flash memory. The features of the flash memory are
summarized below.
• Four flash memory operating modes
⎯ Program mode
⎯ Erase mode
⎯ Program-verify mode
⎯ Erase-verify mode
• Programming/erase methods
The flash memory is programmed 32 bytes at a time. Block erase (in single-block units) can be
performed. Erasing the entire memory requires erasure of each block in turn. Block erasing can
be performed as required on 1 kB, 28 kB, and 32 kB blocks.
• Programming/erase times
The flash memory programming time is 10 ms (typ.) for simultaneous 32-byte programming,
equivalent to 300 μs (typ.) per byte, and the erase time is 100 ms (typ.) per block.
• Reprogramming capability
The flash memory can be reprogrammed up to 100 times.
• On-board programming modes
There are two modes in which flash memory can be programmed/erased/verified on-board:
⎯ Boot mode
⎯ User program mode
• Automatic bit rate adjustment
With data transfer in boot mode, the SH7017's bit rate can be automatically adjusted to match
the transfer bit rate of the host.
• Flash memory emulation in RAM
Flash memory programming can be emulated in real time by overlapping a part of RAM onto
flash memory.
• Protect modes
There are two protect modes, hardware and software, which allow protected status to be
designated for flash memory program/erase/verify operations
• Programmer mode
Flash memory can be programmed/erased in programmer mode, using a PROM programmer,
as well as in on-board programming mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 489 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.2
Overview
18.2.1
Block Diagram
Internal address bus
Module bus
Internal data bus (32 bits)
FLMCR1
FLMCR2
EBR1
Bus interface/controller
Operating
mode
RAMER
Flash memory
(128 kB)
Legend:
FLMCR1:
FLMCR2:
EBR1:
RAMER:
Flash memory control register 1
Flash memory control register 2
Erase block register 1
RAM emulation register
Figure 18.1 Block Diagram of Flash Memory
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 490 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
FWP pin
Mode pin
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.2.2
Mode Transitions
When the mode pins and the FWP pin are set in the reset state and a reset-start is executed, the
SH7017 enters one of the operating modes shown in figure 18.2. In user mode, flash memory can
be read but not programmed or erased.
Flash memory can be programmed and erased in boot mode, user program mode, and programmer
mode.
MD1 = 1,
FWP = 1
*1
Reset state
RES = 0
RES = 0
User mode
MD1 = 1,
FWP = 0
FWP = 0
RES = 0
MD1 = 0,
FWP = 0
FWP = 1
User
program mode
*2
RES = 0
Programmer
mode
*1
Boot mode
On-board programming mode
Notes: Only make a transition between user mode and user program mode when the CPU is
not accessing the flash memory.
1. RAM emulation possible
2. MD0 = 1, MD1 = 0, MD2 = 1, MD3 = 1
Figure 18.2 Flash Memory Mode Transitions
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 491 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.2.3
On-Board Programming Modes
Boot Mode
1. Initial state
The old program version or data remains written
in the flash memory. The user should prepare the
programming control program and new
application program beforehand in the host.
2. Programming control program transfer
When boot mode is entered, the boot program in
the SH7050 (originally incorporated in the chip) is
started and the programming control program in
the host is transferred to RAM via SCI
communication. The boot program required for
flash memory erasing is automatically transferred
to the RAM boot program area.
Host
Host
Programming control
program
New application
program
New application
program
SH7017
SH7017
SCI1
Boot program
Flash memory
SCI1
Boot program
Flash memory
RAM
RAM
Boot program area
Application program
(old version)
Application program
(old version)
3. Flash memory initialization
The erase program in the boot program area (in
RAM) is executed, and the flash memory is
initialized (to H'FF). In boot mode, entire flash
memory erasure is performed, without regard to
blocks.
Programming control
program
4. Writing new application program
The programming control program transferred
from the host to RAM is executed, and the new
application program in the host is written into the
flash memory.
Host
Host
New application
program
SH7017
SH7017
SCI1
Boot program
Flash memory
Flash memory
RAM
Boot program area
Flash memory
erase
Programming control
program
SCI1
Boot program
RAM
Boot program area
New application
program
Programming control
program
Program execution state
Figure 18.3 Boot Mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 492 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
User Program Mode
1. Initial state
The FWP assessment program that confirms that
user program mode has been entered, and the
program that will transfer the programming/erase
control program from flash memory to on-chip
RAM should be written into the flash memory by
the user beforehand. The programming/erase
control program should be prepared in the host
or in the flash memory.
2. Programming/erase control program transfer
When user program mode is entered, user
software confirms this fact, executes transfer
program in the flash memory, and transfers the
programming/erase control program to RAM.
Host
Host
Programming/
erase control program
New application
program
New application
program
SH7017
SH7017
SCI
Boot program
Flash memory
RAM
SCI
Boot program
Flash memory
RAM
FWP assessment
program
FWP assessment
program
Transfer program
Transfer program
Programming/
erase control program
Application program
(old version)
Application program
(old version)
3. Flash memory initialization
The programming/erase program in RAM is
executed, and the flash memory is initialized (to
H'FF). Erasing can be performed in block units,
but not in byte units.
4. Writing new application program
Next, the new application program in the host is
written into the erased flash memory blocks. Do
not write to unerased blocks.
Host
Host
New application
program
SH7017
SH7017
SCI
Boot program
Flash memory
RAM
FWP assessment
program
SCI
Boot program
Flash memory
RAM
FWP assessment
program
Transfer program
Programming/
erase control program
Flash memory
erase
Programming/
erase control program
New application
program
Program execution state
Figure 18.4 User Program Mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 493 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.2.4
Flash Memory Emulation in RAM
Emulation should be performed in user mode or user program mode. When the emulation block
set in RAMER is accessed while the emulation function is being executed, data written in the
overlap RAM is read.
• User Mode
• User Program Mode
SCI
RAM
Flash memory
Application program
Execution state
Overlap RAM
(emulation is performed
on data written in RAM)
Emulation block
Figure 18.5 Emulation
When overlap RAM data is confirmed, the RAMS bit is cleared, RAM overlap is released, and
writes should actually be performed to the flash memory.
When the programming control program is transferred to RAM, ensure that the transfer
destination and the overlap RAM do not overlap, as this will cause data in the overlap RAM to
be rewritten.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 494 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
• User Program Mode
SCI
RAM
Flash memory
Programming control
program execution state
Application program
Overlap RAM
(programming data)
Programming data
Figure 18.6 Programming to the Flash Memory
18.2.5
Differences between Boot Mode and User Program Mode
Table 18.1 Differences between Boot Mode and User Program Mode
Boot Mode
User Program Mode
Entire memory erase
Yes
Yes
Block erase
No
Yes
Programming control program*
(2)
(1) (2) (3)
(1)
Erase/erase-verify
(2)
Program/program-verify
(3)
Emulation
Note: * To be provided by the user, in accordance with the recommended algorithm.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 495 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.2.6
Block Configuration
The flash memory is divided into three 32 kB blocks, one 28 kB blocks, and four 1 kB blocks.
Address H'00000
32 kB
32 kB
128 kB
32 kB
28 kB
1 kB
1 kB
1 kB
1 kB
Address H'1FFFF
Figure 18.7 Block Configuration
18.3
Pin Configuration
The flash memory is controlled by means of the pins shown in table 18.2.
Table 18.2 Flash Memory Pins
Pin Name
Abbreviation
I/O
Function
Power-on reset
RES
Input
Power-on reset
Flash memory protect
FWP
Input
Flash program/erase protection by hardware
Mode 3
MD3
Input
Sets SH7017 operating mode
Mode 2
MD2
Input
Sets SH7017 operating mode
Mode 1
MD1
Input
Sets SH7017 operating mode
Mode 0
MD0
Input
Sets SH7017 operating mode
Transmit data
TxD1
Output
Serial transmit data output
Receive data
RxD1
Input
Serial receive data input
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 496 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.4
Register Configuration
The registers used to control the on-chip flash memory when enabled are shown in table 18.3.
Table 18.3 Flash Memory Registers
Register Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Flash memory control
register 1
FLMCR1
R/W*
Flash memory control
register 2
FLMCR2
R*
Erase block register 1
EBR1
R/W*
RAM emulation register
RAMER
R/W
Initial Value
1
2
H'00*
3
H'00
1
H'00*
4
H'0000
Address
Access Size
H'FFFF8580
8
H'FFFF8581
8
H'FFFF8582
8
H'FFFF8628
8, 16, 32
Notes: FLMCR1, FLMCR2, and EBR1 are 8-bit registers, and RAMER is a 16-bit register.
Only byte accesses are valid for FLMCR1, FLMCR2, and EBR1, the access requiring 3
cycles. Three cycles are required for a byte or word access to RAMER, and 6 cycles for a
longword access.
When a longword write is performed on RAMER, 0 must always be written to the lower
word (address H'FFFF8630). Operation is not guaranteed if any other value is written.
1. In modes in which the on-chip flash memory is disabled, a read will return H'00, and
writes are invalid. Writes are also disabled when the FWE bit is set to 1 in FLMCR1.
2. A read in a mode in which on-chip flash memory is disabled will return H'00.
3. When a low level is input to the FWP pin, the initial value is H'80.
4. When a high level is input to the FWP pin, or if a low level is input and the SWE bit in
FLMCR1 is not set, these registers are initialized to H'00.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 497 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.5
Register Descriptions
18.5.1
Flash Memory Control Register 1 (FLMCR1)
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FWE
SWE
ESU
PSU
EV
PV
E
P
1/0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
FLMCR1 is an 8-bit register used for flash memory operating mode control. Program-verify mode
or erase-verify mode is entered by setting SWE to 1 when FWE = 1. Program mode is entered by
setting SWE to 1 when FWE = 1, then setting the PSU bit, and finally setting the P bit. Erase
mode is entered by setting SWE to 1 when FWE = 1, then setting the ESU bit, and finally setting
the E bit. FLMCR1 is initialized by a reset, and in hardware standby mode and software standby
mode. Its initial value is H'80 when a high level is input to the FWE pin, and H'00 when a low
level is input. When on-chip flash memory is disabled, a read will return H'00, and writes are
invalid.
Writes to bits SWE, ESU, PSU, EV, and PV are enabled only when FWE = 1 and SWE = 1; writes
to the E bit only when FWE = 1, SWE = 1, and ESU = 1; and writes to the P bit only when FWE =
1, SWE = 1, and PSU = 1.
Bit 7⎯Flash Write Enable Bit (FWE): Sets hardware protection against flash memory
programming/erasing.
Bit 7
FWE
Description
0
When a low level is input to the FWP pin (hardware-protected state)
1
When a high level is input to the FWP pin
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 498 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(Initial value)
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Bit 6⎯Software Write Enable Bit (SWE): Enables or disables the flash memory. This bit should
be set before setting bits 5 to 0, and EBR1 bits 7 to 0.
Bit 6
SWE
Description
0
Writes disabled
1
Writes enabled
(Initial value)
[Setting condition]
When FWE = 1
Bit 5⎯Erase Setup Bit (ESU): Prepares for a transition to erase mode. Do not set the SWE, PSU,
EV, PV, E, or P bit at the same time.
Bit 5
ESU
Description
0
Erase setup cleared
1
Erase setup
(Initial value)
[Setting condition]
When FWE = 1 and SWE = 1
Bit 4⎯Program Setup Bit (PSU): Prepares for a transition to program mode. Do not set the
SWE, ESU, EV, PV, E, or P bit at the same time.
Bit 4
PSU
Description
0
Program setup cleared
1
Program setup
(Initial value)
[Setting condition]
When FWE = 1 and SWE = 1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 499 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Bit 3⎯Erase-Verify (EV): Selects erase-verify mode transition or clearing. Do not set the SWE,
ESU, PSU, PV, E, or P bit at the same time.
Bit 3
EV
Description
0
Erase-verify mode cleared
1
Transition to erase-verify mode
(Initial value)
[Setting condition]
When FWE = 1 and SWE = 1
Bit 2⎯Program-Verify (PV): Selects program-verify mode transition or clearing. Do not set the
SWE, ESU, PSU, EV, E, or P bit at the same time.
Bit 2
PV
Description
0
Program-verify mode cleared
1
Transition to program-verify mode
(Initial value)
[Setting condition]
When FWE = 1 and SWE = 1
Bit 1⎯Erase (E): Selects erase mode transition or clearing. Do not set the SWE, ESU, PSU, EV,
PV, or P bit at the same time.
Bit 1
E
Description
0
Erase mode cleared
1
Transition to erase mode
[Setting condition]
When FWE = 1, SWE = 1, and ESU = 1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 500 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(Initial value)
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Bit 0⎯Program (P): Selects program mode transition or clearing. Do not set the SWE, PSU,
ESU, EV, PV, or E bit at the same time.
Bit 0
P
Description
0
Program mode cleared
1
Transition to program mode
(Initial value)
[Setting condition]
When FWE = 1, SWE = 1, and PSU = 1
18.5.2
Flash Memory Control Register 2 (FLMCR2)
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FLER
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
FLMCR2 is an 8-bit register that monitors the presence or absence of flash memory program/erase
protection (error protection). FLMCR2 is initialized to H'00 by a reset, and in hardware standby
mode.
When on-chip flash memory is disabled, a read will return H'00.
Bit 7⎯Flash Memory Error (FLER): Indicates that an error has occurred during an operation on
flash memory (programming or erasing). When FLER is set to 1, flash memory goes to the errorprotection state.
Bit 7
FLER
Description
0
Flash memory is operating normally.
(Initial value)
Flash memory program/erase protection (error protection) is disabled.
[Clearing condition]
Power-on reset
1
An error has occurred during flash memory programming/erasing.
Flash memory program/erase protection (error protection) is enabled.
[Setting condition]
See section 18.8.3, Error Protection.
Bits 6 to 0⎯Reserved: These bits are always read as 0.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 501 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.5.3
Erase Block Register 1 (EBR1)
EBR1 is an 8-bit readable/writable register that specifies the flash memory erase area block by
block. EBR1 is initialized to H'00 by a reset, in hardware standby mode and software standby
mode, when a low level is input to the FWE pin, and when a high level is input to the FWE pin
and the SWE bit in FLMCR1 is not set. When a bit in EBR1 is set to 1, the corresponding block
can be erased. Other blocks are erase-protected. Set only one bit in EBR1 (more than one bit
cannot be set). When on-chip flash memory is disabled, a read will return H'00, and writes are
invalid.
The flash memory block configuration is shown in table 18.4.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EB7
EB6
EB5
EB4
EB3
EB2
EB1
EB0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Table 18.4 Flash Memory Erase Blocks
Block (Size)
Address
EB0 (32 kB)
H'000000 to H'007FFF
EB1 (32 kB)
H'008000 to H'00FFFF
EB2 (32 kB)
H'010000 to H'017FFF
EB3 (28 kB)
H'018000 to H'01EFFF
EB4 (1 kB)
H'01F000 to H'01F3FF
EB5 (1 kB)
H'01F400 to H'01F7FF
EB6 (1 kB)
H'01F800 to H'01FBFF
EB7 (1 kB)
H'01FC00 to H'01FFFF
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 502 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.5.4
RAM Emulation Register (RAMER)
RAMER specifies the area of flash memory to be overlapped with part of RAM when emulating
real-time flash memory programming. RAMER is initialized to H'0000 by a reset and in hardware
standby mode. It is not initialized in software standby mode. RAMER settings should be made in
user mode or user program mode.
Flash memory area divisions are shown in table 18.5. To ensure correct operation of the emulation
function, the ROM for which RAM emulation is performed should not be accessed immediately
after this register has been modified. Normal execution of an access immediately after register
modification is not guaranteed.
Bit:
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
RAMS
RAM1
RAM0
Initial value:
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W:
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bits 15 to 3⎯Reserved: These bits are always read as 0.
Bit 2⎯RAM Select (RAMS): Specifies selection or non-selection of flash memory emulation in
RAM. When RAMS = 1, all flash memory block are program/erase-protected.
Bit 2
RAMS
Description
0
Emulation not selected
(Initial value)
Program/erase-protection of all flash memory blocks is disabled
1
Emulation selected
Program/erase-protection of all flash memory blocks is enabled
Bits 1 and 0⎯Flash Memory Area Selection (RAM1, RAM0): These bits are used together
with bit 2 to select the flash memory area to be overlapped with RAM. (See table 18.5.)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 503 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Table 18.5 Flash Memory Area Divisions
Addresses
Block Name
RAMS
RAM1
RAM0
H'FFF800 to H'FFFBFF
RAM area 1 kB
0
*
*
H'01F000 to H'01F3FF
EB4 (1 kB)
1
0
0
H'01F400 to H'01F7FF
EB5 (1 kB)
1
0
1
H'01F800 to H'01FBFF
EB6 (1 kB)
1
1
0
H'01FC00 to H'01FFFF
EB7 (1 kB)
1
1
1
Legend:
*: Don't care
18.6
On-Board Programming Modes
When pins are set to on-board programming mode and a reset-start is executed, a transition is
made to the on-board programming state in which program/erase/verify operations can be
performed on the on-chip flash memory. There are two on-board programming modes: boot mode
and user program mode. The pin settings for transition to each of these modes are shown in table
18.6. For a diagram of the transitions to the various flash memory modes, see figure 18.2.
Table 18.6 Setting On-Board Programming Modes
Mode
Boot mode
Expanded mode
PLL Multiple
FWP
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
×1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
Single chip mode
Expanded mode
×2
Single chip mode
Expanded mode
×4
Single chip mode
User program
mode
Expanded mode
×1
Single chip mode
Expanded mode
×2
Single chip mode
Expanded mode
×4
Single chip mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 504 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
0
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.6.1
Boot Mode
When boot mode is used, the flash memory programming control program must be prepared in the
host beforehand. The SCI to be used is set to channel asynchronous mode.
When a reset-start is executed after the SH7017 pins have been set to boot mode, the boot program
built into the SH7017 is started and the programming control program prepared in the host is
serially transmitted to the SH7017 via the SCI. In the SH7017, the programming control program
received via the SCI is written into the programming control program area in on-chip RAM. After
the transfer is completed, control branches to the start address of the programming control
program area and the programming control program execution state is entered (flash memory
programming is performed).
The transferred programming control program must therefore include coding that follows the
programming algorithm given later.
The system configuration in boot mode is shown in figure 18.8, and the boot mode execution
procedure in figure 18.9.
SH7017
Flash memory
Host
Write data reception
Verify data transmission
RXD1
SCI1
On-chip RAM
TXD1
Figure 18.8 System Configuration in Boot Mode
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 505 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Start
Set pins to boot mode
and execute reset-start
Host transfers data (H'00)
continuously at prescribed bit rate
SH7017 measures low period
of H'00 data transmitted by host
SH7017 calculates bit rate and
sets value in bit rate register
After bit rate adjustment, SH7017
transmits one H'00 data byte to
host to indicate end of adjustment
Host confirms normal reception
of bit rate adjustment end
indication (H'00), and transmits
one H'55 data byte
After receiving H'55,
SH7017 transmits one H'AA
data byte to host
Host transmits number
of programming control program
bytes (N), upper byte followed
by lower byte
SH7017 transmits received
number of bytes to host as verify
data (echo-back)
n=1
Host transmits programming control
program sequentially in byte units
SH7017 transmits received
programming control program to
host as verify data (echo-back)
n+1→n
Transfer received programming
control program to on-chip RAM
No
n = N?
Yes
End of transmission
Check flash memory data, and
if data has already been written,
erase all blocks
After confirming that all flash
memory data has been erased,
SH7017 transmits one H'AA data
byte to host
Execute programming control
program transferred to on-chip RAM
Note: If a memory cell does not operate normally and cannot be erased, one H'FF byte is
transmitted as an erase error, and the erase operation and subsequent operations
are halted.
Figure 18.9 Boot Mode Execution Procedure
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 506 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Automatic SCI Bit Rate Adjustment
Start
bit
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Low period (9 bits) measured (H'00 data)
Stop
bit
High period
(1 or more bits)
Figure 18.10 Automatic SCI Bit Rate Adjustment
When boot mode is initiated, the SH7017 measures the low period of the asynchronous SCI
communication data (H'00) transmitted continuously from the host. The SCI transmit/receive
format should be set as follows: 8-bit data, 1 stop bit, no parity. The SH7017 calculates the bit rate
of the transmission from the host from the measured low period, and transmits one H'00 byte to
the host to indicate the end of bit rate adjustment. The host should confirm that this adjustment
end indication (H'00) has been received normally, and transmit one H'55 byte to the SH7017. If
reception cannot be performed normally, initiate boot mode again (reset), and repeat the above
operations. Depending on the host's transmission bit rate and the SH7017's system clock
frequency, there will be a discrepancy between the bit rates of the host and the SH7017. To ensure
correct SCI operation, the host's transfer bit rate should be set to 4800bps, 9600bps.
Table 18.7 shows host transfer bit rates and system clock frequencies for which automatic
adjustment of the SH7017 bit rate is possible. The boot program should be executed within this
system clock range.
Table 18.7 System Clock Frequencies for which Automatic Adjustment of SH7017 Bit Rate
is Possible
Host Bit Rate
System Clock Frequency for which Automatic Adjustment
of SH7017 Bit Rate is Possible
9600bps
8 to 28.7MHz
4800bps
4 to 20MHz
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 507 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
On-Chip RAM Area Divisions in Boot Mode: In boot mode, the RAM area is divided into an
area used by the boot program and an area to which the programming control program is
transferred via the SCI, as shown in figure 18.11. The boot program area cannot be used until the
execution state in boot mode switches to the programming control program transferred from the
host.
H'FFFFF000
Programming
control program area
(2 kbytes)
H'FFFFF800
Boot program area
(2 kbytes)
H'FFFFFFFF
Figure 18.11 RAM Areas in Boot Mode
Note: The boot program area cannot be used until a transition is made to the execution state for
the programming control program transferred to RAM. Note also that the boot program
remains in this area of the on-chip RAM even after control branches to the programming
control program.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 508 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.6.2
User Program Mode
After setting FWP, the user should branch to, and execute, the previously prepared
programming/erase control program.
As the flash memory itself cannot be read while flash memory programming/erasing is being
executed, the control program that performs programming and erasing should be run in on-chip
RAM or external memory.
Use the following procedure (figure 18.12) to execute the programming control program that
writes to flash memory (when transferred to RAM).
1
Write FWP assessment program
and transfer program
2
FWP = 1
(user program mode)
3
Transfer programming/erase
control program to RAM
4
Execute programming/
erase control program in RAM
(flash memory rewriting)
5
Execute user application
program
Figure 18.12 User Program Mode Execution Procedure
Note: When programming and erasing, start the watchdog timer so that measures can be taken to
prevent program runaway, etc. Memory cells may not operate normally if
overprogrammed or overerased due to program runaway.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 509 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.7
Programming/Erasing Flash Memory
A software method, using the CPU, is employed to program and erase flash memory in the onboard programming modes. There are four flash memory operating modes: program mode, erase
mode, program-verify mode, and erase-verify mode. Transitions to these modes can be made by
setting the PSU, ESU, P, E, PV, and EV bits in FLMCR1.
The flash memory cannot be read while being programmed or erased. Therefore, the program
(programming control program) that controls flash memory programming/erasing should be
located and executed in on-chip RAM or external memory.
Notes: 1. Operation is not guaranteed if setting/resetting of the SWE, ESU, PSU, EV, PV, E, and
P bits in FLMCR1 is executed by a program in flash memory.
2. When programming or erasing, a low level is input to the FWP pin
(programming/erasing will not be executed if a high level is input to the FWP pin).
3. Programming should be performed in the erased state. Do not perform additional
programming on previously programmed addresses.
18.7.1
Program Mode
Follow the procedure shown in the program/program-verify flowchart in figure 18.7 to write data
or programs to flash memory. Performing program operations according to this flowchart will
enable data or programs to be written to flash memory without subjecting the device to voltage
stress or sacrificing program data reliability. Programming should be carried out 32 bytes at a
time.
Following the elapse of 10 μs or more after the SWE bit is set to 1 in flash memory control
register 1 (FLMCR1), 32-byte program data is stored in the program data area and reprogram data
area, and the 32-byte data in the program data area in RAM is written consecutively to the
program address (the lower 8 bits of the first address written to must be H'00, H'20, H'40, H'60,
H'80, H'A0, H'C0, or H'E0). Thirty-two consecutive byte data transfers are performed. The
program address and program data are latched in the flash memory. A 32-byte data transfer must
be performed even if writing fewer than 32 bytes; in this case, H'FF data must be written to the
extra addresses.
Next, the watchdog timer is set to prevent overprogramming in the event of program runaway, etc.
Set a minimum value of 300 μs or more as the WDT overflow period. After this, preparation for
program mode (program setup) is carried out by setting the PSU bit in FLMCR1, and after the
elapse of 50 μs or more, the operating mode is switched to program mode by setting the P bit in
FLMCR1. The time during which the P bit is set is the flash memory programming time. Use a
fixed 200 μs pulse for the write time.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 510 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.7.2
Program-Verify Mode
In program-verify mode, the data written in program mode is read to check whether it has been
correctly written in the flash memory.
After the elapse of a given programming time, the programming mode is exited (the P bit in
FLMCR1 is cleared, then the PSUn bit is cleared at least 10 μs later). The watchdog timer is
cleared after the elapse of 10 μs or more, and the operating mode is switched to program-verify
mode by setting the PV bit in FLMCR1. Before reading in program-verify mode, a dummy write
of H'FF data should be made to the addresses to be read. The dummy write should be executed
after the elapse of 4 μs or more. When the flash memory is read in this state (verify data is read in
32-bit units), the data at the latched address is read. Wait at least 2 μs after the dummy write
before performing this read operation. Next, the written data is compared with the verify data, and
reprogram data is computed (see figure 18.13) and transferred to the reprogram data area. After 32
bytes of data have been verified, exit program-verify mode, wait for at least 4 μs, then clear the
SWE bit in FLMCR1. If reprogramming is necessary, set program mode again, and repeat the
program/program-verify sequence as before. However, ensure that the program/program-verify
sequence is not repeated more than 1000 times on the same bits.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 511 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Start
Data writes must be performed in the memoryerased state. Do not write additional data to an
address to which data is already written.
Set SWE-bit of FLMCR1
Wait 10 μs
*5
Store 32 bytes write data in write
data area and rewrite data area
*4
n=1
m=0
Successively write 32-byte data in rewrite data
area in RAM to flash memory
*1
Enable WDT
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
Wait 50 μs
*5
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
Write start
Wait 200 μs
*5
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
Write end
Wait 10 μs
*5
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
n←n+1
Wait 10 μs
*5
Disable WDT
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
Wait 4 μs
*5
Perform dummy-write of H'FF to verify address
Wait 2 μs
*5
Read verify data
*2
Increment address
*3
Write data = Verify data?
NG
m=1
OK
NG
Operate rewrite data
*3
Transfer rewrite data to rewrite data area
*4
32 byte data
verify complete?
OK
Set PSU bit in FLMCR1(2)
RAM
Wait 4 μs
Write data storage area
(32 byte)
*5
NG
m = 0?
Rewrite data storage area
(32 byte)
*5
n ≥ 1000?
NG
OK
OK
Clear SWE bit of FLMCR1
Clear SWE bit of FLMCR1
Write end
Write failure
Notes: 1. Transfer data in a byte unit. The lower eight bits of the start address to which data is written must be H'00, H'20, H'40, H'60, H'80, H'A0, H'C0, or
H'E0. Transfer 32-byte data even when writing fewer than 32 bytes. In this case, Set H'FF in unused addresses.
2. Read verify data in logword form (32 bits).
3. Already programmed bits are not reprogrammed. Reprogram data is determined by the computation shown below.
4. The write data storage area (32 bytes) and rewrite data storage area (32 bytes) must be located in RAM. The contents of the rewrite data storage
area are rewritten as writing progresses.
5. Set the values of x, y, z, α, β, γ, ε, η, and N to match the characteristics of the memory device.
Previous write data
0
0
1
1
Verify data (V) Rewrite data (X)
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
Description
Rewrite should not be performed to bits already written to.
Write is incomplete; rewrite should be performed.
⎯
Left in the erased state.
Figure 18.13 Program/Program-Verify Flowchart
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 512 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
• Sample 32-byte programming program
The wait time set values (number of loops) are for the case where f = 28.7 MHz. For other
frequencies, the set value is given by the following expression:
Wait time (μs) × f (MHz) ÷ 4
Registers Used
R4 (input):
R5 (input):
R7 (output):
R0 to R3, R8 to R13:
Program data storage address
Programming destination address
OK (normal) or NG (error)
Work registers
FLMCR1
.EQU
H'80
FLMCR2
.EQU
H'81
OK
.EQU
H'0
NG
.EQU
H'1
Wait10u
.EQU
72
Wait50u
.EQU
359
Wait4u
.EQU
29
Wait2u
.EQU
14
Wait200u
.EQU
1435
WDT_TCSR
.EQU
H'FFFF8610
WDT_573u
.EQU
H'A579
SWESET
.EQU
B'01000000
PSU1SET
.EQU
B'00010000
P1SET
.EQU
B'00000001
P1CLEAR
.EQU
B'11111110
PSU1CLEAR
.EQU
B'11101111
PVSET
.EQU
B'00000100
PVCLEAR
.EQU
B'11111011
SWECLEAR
.EQU
B'10111111
MAXVerify
.EQU
1000
.EQU
$
;
FlashProgram
MOV
#H'01,R2
; R2 work register (1)
MOV.L
#PdataBuff,R0
; Save program data to work area
MOV
R4,R12
MOV
#8,R13
COPY_LOOP
.EQU
$
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 513 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
MOV.L
@R12+,R1
MOV.L
R1,@R0
ADD.L
#4,R0
ADD.L
#-1,R13
CMP/PL
R13
BT
COPY_LOOP
MOV.L
#H'FFFF8500,R0
LDC
R0,GBR
MOV.L
#Wait10u,R3
; Initialize GBR
;
Wait_1
MOV.L
#FLMCR1,R0
; Initialize R0 to FLCMR1 address
OR.B
#SWESET,@(R0,GBR)
; Set SWE
SUBC
R2,R3
; Wait 10 μs
BF
Wait_1
MOV.L
#H'20000,R9
CMP/GT
R5,R9
BT
Program_Start
MOV.L
#FLMCR2,R0
;
Program_Start
MOV.L
.EQU
$
; Initialize n (R9) to 0
#0,R9
;
Program_loop
.EQU
$
MOV.L
#0,R10
; Initialize m (R10) to 0
MOV.L
#32,R3
; Write 32-byte data consecutively
MOV.L
#PdataBuff,R12
MOV.L
R5,R13
Write_Loop
.EQU
$
MOV.B
@R12+,R1
MOV.B
R1,@R13
ADD.L
#1,R13
ADD.L
#-1,R3
CMP/PL
R3
BT
Write_Loop
MOV.L
#WDT_TCSR,R1
; Enable WDT
MOV.W
#WDT_573u,R3
; 573.4 μs cycle
MOV.W
R3,@R1
;
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 514 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
;
MOV.L
Wait_2
#Wait50u,R3
OR.B
#PSU1SET,@(R0,GBR)
; Set PSU
SUBC
R2,R3
; Wait 50 μs
BF
Wait_2
MOV.L
#Wait200u,R3
OR.B
#P1SET,@(R0,GBR)
; Set P
; Wait 200 μs
;
Wait_3
SUBC
R2,R3
BF
Wait_3
MOV.L
#Wait10u,R3
AND.B
#P1CLEAR,@(R0,GBR)
; Clear P
SUBC
R2,R3
; Wait 10 μs
BF
Wait_4
MOV.L
#Wait10u,R3
AND.B
#PSU1CLEAR,@(R0,GBR) ; Clear PSU
SUBC
R2,R3
BF
Wait_5
MOV.L
#WDT_TCSR,R1
MOV.W
#H'A55F,R3
MOV.W
R3,@R1
MOV.L
#Wait4u,R3
OR.B
#PVSET,@(R0,GBR)
; Set PV
SUBC
R2,R3
; Wait 4 μs
BF
Wait_6
MOV.L
PdataBuff,R3
MOV.L
R4,R1
MOV.L
R5,R12
MOV.L
#8,R13
MOV.L
#H'FFFFFFFF,R11
;
Wait_4
;
Wait_5
; Wait 10 μs
;
; Disable WDT
;
Wait_6
;
;
VerifyLoop
MOV.L
.EQU
R11,@R12
$
; Write H'FF to verify address
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 515 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Wait_7
; Reprogram data RAM (PdataBuff) initialization
MOV.L
R11,@R3
MOV.L
#Wait2u,R7
; Wait 2 μs
SUBC
R2,R7
BF
Wait_7
MOV.L
@R12+,R7
MOV.L
@R1+,R8
CMP/EQ
R7,R8
BT
Verify_OK
MOV.L
#1,R10
; Verify NG, m <- 1
XOR
R8,R7
; Program data computation
NOT
R7,R7
OR
R7,R8
MOV.L
R8,@R3
;
Verify_OK
.EQU
; Verify
; Store in reprogram data RAM (PdataBuff)
$
ADD.L
#4,R3
ADD.L
#-1,R13
CMP/PL
R13
BT
VerifyLoop
MOV.L
#Wait4u,R7
AND.B
#PVCLEAR,@(R0,GBR)
; Clear PV
; Wait 4 μs
;
Wait_8
SUBC
R2,R7
BF
Wait_8
CMP/PL
R10
BF
Program_OK
ADD
#1,R9
MOV.L
#NG,R7
; R7 <- NG (return value)
MOV.L
#MAXVerify,R12
; if n>=MAXVerify then Program NG
CMP/EQ
R9,R12
BT
Program_end
BRA
Program_loop
;
; if m=0 then GOTO Program_OK
NOP
Program_OK
MOV.L
Program_end
MOV.B
.EQU
$
; R7 <- OK (return value)
#OK,R7
.EQU
$
#H'00,R0
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 516 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
MOV.B
R0,@(FLMCR1,GBR)
; Clear SWE
;
RTS
NOP
;
.ALIGN
PdataBuff
18.7.3
4
.RES.B
32
Erase Mode
When erasing flash memory, the erase/erase-verify flowchart shown in figure 18.14 should be
followed.
To perform data or program erasure, set the 1 bit flash memory area to be erased in erase block
register 1 (EBR1) at least 10 μs after setting the SWE bit to 1 in flash memory control register 1
(FLMCR1). Next, the watchdog timer is set to prevent overerasing in the event of program
runaway, etc. Set 9.2 ms as the WDT overflow period. After this, preparation for erase mode
(erase setup) is carried out by setting the ESU bit in FLMCR1, and after the elapse of 200 μs or
more, the operating mode is switched to erase mode by setting the E bit in FLMCR1. The time
during which the E bit is set is the flash memory erase time. Ensure that the erase time does not
exceed 5 ms.
Note: With flash memory erasing, preprogramming (setting all memory data in the memory to
be erased to all “0”) is not necessary before starting the erase procedure.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 517 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.7.4
Erase-Verify Mode
In erase-verify mode, data is read after memory has been erased to check whether it has been
correctly erased.
After the elapse of the erase time, erase mode is exited (the E bit in FLMCR1 is cleared, then the
ESU bit is cleared at least 10 μs later), the watchdog timer is cleared after the elapse of 10 μs or
more, and the operating mode is switched to erase-verify mode by setting the EV bit in FLMCR1.
Before reading in erase-verify mode, a dummy write of H'FF data should be made to the addresses
to be read. The dummy write should be executed after the elapse of 20 μs or more. When the flash
memory is read in this state (verify data is read in 32-bit units), the data at the latched address is
read. Wait at least 2 μs after the dummy write before performing this read operation. If the read
data has been erased (all “1”), a dummy write is performed to the next address, and erase-verify is
performed. If the read data has not been erased, set erase mode again, and repeat the erase/eraseverify sequence in the same way. However, ensure that the erase/erase-verify sequence is not
repeated more than 60 times. When verification is completed, exit erase-verify mode, and wait for
at least 5 μs. If erasure has been completed on all the erase blocks, clear the SWE bit in FLMCR1.
If there are any unerased blocks, set 1 bit for the flash memory area to be erased, and repeat the
erase/erase-verify sequence in the same way.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 518 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Start
*1
Set SWE bit in FLMCR1
Wait 10 μs
n=1
Set EBR1
*3
WDT Enable
Set ESU-bit of FLMCR1
Wait 200 μs
Erase start
Set E-bit of FLMCR1
Wait 5 ms
Clear E-bit of FLMCR1
Erase stop
Wait 10 μs
Clear ESU-bit of FLMCR1
Wait 10 μs
WDT Disable
Set EV-bit of FLMCR1
Wait 20 μs
n←n+1
Set top block address to verify address
Dummy write H'FF to verify address
Wait 2 μs
Read verify data
Address
increment
Verify data = all "1"?
*2
NG
OK
NG
NG
Notes: 1.
2.
3.
4.
Last block address?
OK
Clear EV-bit of FLMCR1
Clear EV-bit of FLMCR1
Wait 5 μs
Wait 5 μs
*4
All
objective blocks
erased?
OK
n > 60
Clear SWE-bit in FLMCR1
OK
Clear SWE-bit of FLMCR1
Erase complete
Erase error
NG
Preprogramming (setting erase block data to all "0") is not necessary.
Verify data is read in 32-bit (longword) units.
Set only one bit in EBR1. More than one bit cannot be set.
Erasing is performed in block units. To erase a number of blocks, each block must be erased in turn.
Figure 18.14 Erase/Erase-Verify Flowchart (Single-Block Erase)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 519 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
• Sample one-block erase program
The wait time set values (number of loops) are for the case where f = 28.7 MHz. For other
frequencies, the set value is given by the following expression:
Wait time (μs) × f (MHz) ÷ 4
The WDT overflow cycle set value is for the case where f = 28.7 MHz. For other frequencies,
ensure that the overflow cycle is a minimum of 5.3 ms.
Registers Used
R5 (input):
Memory block table pointer
R7 (output):
OK (normal) or NG (error)
R0 to R3, R6, R8 and R9: Work registers
FLMCR1
.EQU
H'80
FLMCR2
.EQU
H'81
EBR1
.EQU
H'82
EBR2
.EQU
H'83
Wait10u
.EQU
72
Wait2u
.EQU
14
Wait200u
.EQU
1435
Wait5m
.EQU
35875
Wait20u
.EQU
144
Wait5u
.EQU
36
WDT_TCSR
.EQU
H'FFFF8610
WDT_9m
.EQU
H'A57D
SWESET
.EQU
B'01000000
ESUSET
.EQU
B'00100000
ESET
.EQU
B'00000010
ECLEAR
.EQU
B'11111101
ESUCLEAR
.EQU
B'11011111
EVSET
.EQU
B'00001000
EVCLEAR
.EQU
B'11110111
SWECLEAR
.EQU
B'10111111
MAXErase
.EQU
60
.EQU
$
;
FlashErase
MOV.L
#H'FFFF8500,R0
LDC
R0,GBR
MOV.L
#1,R2
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 520 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
; Initialize GBR
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
;
MOV.L
#Wait10u,R3
MOV.L
#FLMCR1,R0
OR.B
#SWESET,@(R0,GBR)
; Set SWE
R2,R3
; Wait 10 μs
EWait_1 SUBC
BF
EWait_1
MOV.L
#0,R9
MOV.B
@(6,R5),R0
MOV.B
R0,@(EBR1,GBR)
MOV.B
@(7,R5),R0
MOV.B
R0,@(EBR2,GBR)
MOV.L
#FLMCR1,R0
MOV.L
@R5,R6
MOV.L
#H'020000,R7
CMP/GT
R6,R7
BT
EraseLoop
MOV.L
#FLMCR2,R0
;
; Initialize n (R9) to 0
;
; Erase memory block (EBR1) setting
; Erase memory block (EBR2) setting
;
; Erase memory block start address -> R6
;
EraseLoop
.EQU
$
MOV.L
#WDT_TCSR,R1
; Enable WDT
MOV.W
#WDT_9m,R3
; 9.2 ms cycle
MOV.W
R3,@R1
MOV.L
#Wait200u,R3
OR.B
#ESUSET,@(R0,GBR)
; Set ESU
R2,R3
; Wait 200 μs
;
EWait_2 SUBC
BF
EWait_2
MOV.L
#Wait5m,R3
;
OR.B
EWait_3 SUBC
#ESET,@(R0,GBR)
; Set E
R2,R3
; Wait 5 ms
BF
EWait_3
MOV.L
#Wait10u,R3
AND.B
#ECLEAR,@(R0,GBR)
;
; Clear E
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 521 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
EWait_4 SUBC
; Wait 10 μs
R2,R3
BF
EWait_4
MOV.L
#Wait10u,R3
;
AND.B
EWait_5 SUBC
BF
#ESUCLEAR,@(R0,GBR) ; Clear ESU
; Wait 10 μs
R2,R3
EWait_5
;
; Disable WDT
MOV.L
#WDT_TCSR,R1
MOV.W
#H'A55F,R3
MOV.W
R3,@R1
MOV.L
#Wait20u,R3
OR.B
#EVSET,@(R0,GBR)
; Set EV
R2,R3
; Wait 20 μs
;
EWait_6 SUBC
BF
EWait_6
MOV.L
@R5,R6
;
BlockVerify_1
MOV.L
.EQU
; Erase memory block start address -> R6
$
MOV.L
R8,@R6
MOV.L
#Wait2u,R3
EWait_7 SUBC
; Erase-verify
#H'FFFFFFFF,R8
; H'FF dummy write
R2,R3
BF
EWait_7
MOV.L
@R6+,R1
CMP/EQ
R8,R1
BF
BlockVerify_NG
MOV.L
@(8,R5),R7
CMP/EQ
R6,R7
BF
BlockVerify_1
MOV.L
#Wait5u,R3
AND.B
#EVCLEAR,@(R0,GBR)
; Clear EV
R2,R3
; Wait 5 μs
;
EWait_8 SUBC
; Read verify data
; Check for last address of memory block
BF
EWait_8
MOV.L
#OK,R7
; R7 <- OK (return value)
BRA
FlashErase_end
; Verify OK
;
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 522 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
NOP
;
BlockVerify_NG
.EQU
$
; Verify NG, n <- n + 1
ADD.L
#1,R9
MOV.L
#Wait5u,R3
AND.B
#EVCLEAR,@(R0,GBR)
; Clear EV
R2,R3
; Wait 5 μs
EWait_9 SUBC
BF
EWait_9
MOV.L
#MAXErase,R7
CMP/EQ
R7,R9
BF
EraseLoop
MOV.L
#NG,R7
FlashErase_end
.EQU
; If n > MAXErase then erase NG
; R7 <- NG (return value)
$
MOV.L
#FLMCR1,R0
AND.B
#SWECLEAR,@(R0,GBR) ; Clear SWE
;
RTS
NOP
;
; Memory block table
.ALIGN
Flash_BlockData
Memory block start address: EBR value
4
.EQU
$
EB0
.DATA.L H'00000000,H'00000100
EB1
.DATA.L H'00008000,H'00000200
EB2
.DATA.L H'00010000,H'00000400
EB3
.DATA.L H'00018000,H'00000800
EB4
.DATA.L H'00020000,H'00000001
EB5
.DATA.L H'00028000,H'00000002
EB6
.DATA.L H'00030000,H'00000004
EB7
.DATA.L H'00038000,H'00000008
EB8
.DATA.L H'0003F000,H'00000010
EB9
.DATA.L H'0003F400,H'00000020
EB10
.DATA.L H'0003F800,H'00000040
EB11
.DATA.L H'0003FC00,H'00000080
Dummy
.DATA.L H'00040000
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 523 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.8
Protection
There are two kinds of flash memory program/erase protection, hardware protection and software
protection.
18.8.1
Hardware Protection
Hardware protection refers to a state in which programming/erasing of flash memory is forcibly
disabled or aborted. Hardware protection is reset by settings in flash memory control register 1
(FLMCR1) and erase block register 1 (EBR1). The FLMCR1 and EBR1 settings are retained in
the error-protected state. (See table 18.8.)
Table 18.8 Hardware Protection
Functions
Item
Description
Program
Erase
FWP pin protection
•
When a low level is input to the FWP pin,
FLMCR1 and EBR1 are initialized, and the
program/erase-protected state is entered.
Yes
Yes
Reset/standby
protection
•
In a reset (including a WDT overflow reset)
and in standby mode, FLMCR1 and EBR1
are initialized, and the program/eraseprotected state is entered.
Yes
Yes
•
In a power-on reset via the RES pin, the
reset state is not entered unless the RES pin
is held low until oscillation stabilizes after
powering on. In the case of a reset during
operation, hold the RES pin low for the RES
pulse width specified in the AC
Characteristics section.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 524 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.8.2
Software Protection
Software protection can be implemented by setting the SWE bit in FLMCR1, erase block register
1 (EBR1) and the RAMS bit in the RAM emulation register (RAMER). When software protection
is in effect, setting the P or E bit in flash memory control register 1 (FLMCR1) does not cause a
transition to program mode or erase mode. (See table 18.9.)
Table 18.9 Software Protection
Functions
Item
Description
Program
Erase
SWE pin protection
•
Clearing the SWE bit to 0 in FLMCR1 sets
the program/erase-protected state for all
blocks.
(Execute in on-chip RAM or external
memory.)
Yes
Yes
Block specification
protection
•
Erase protection can be set for individual
blocks by settings in erase block register 1
(EBR1).
⎯
Yes
•
Setting EBR1 to H'00 places all blocks in the
erase-protected state.
Emulation protection •
Yes
Setting the RAMS bit to 1 in the RAM
emulation register (RAMER) places all blocks
in the program/erase-protected state.
Yes
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 525 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.8.3
Error Protection
In error protection, an error is detected when SH7017 runaway occurs during flash memory
programming/erasing, or operation is not performed in accordance with the program/erase
algorithm, and the program/erase operation is aborted. Aborting the program/erase operation
prevents damage to the flash memory due to overprogramming or overerasing.
If the SH7017 malfunctions during flash memory programming/erasing, the FLER bit is set to 1 in
FLMCR2 and the error protection state is entered. The FLMCR1 and EBR1 settings are retained,
but program mode or erase mode is aborted at the point at which the error occurred. Program
mode or erase mode cannot be re-entered by re-setting the P or E bit. However, PV and EV bit
setting is enabled, and a transition can be made to verify mode.
FLER bit setting conditions are as follows:
1. When flash memory is read during programming/erasing (including a vector read or instruction
fetch)
2. Immediately after exception handling (excluding a reset) during programming/erasing
3. When a SLEEP instruction (including software standby) is executed during
programming/erasing
4. When the bus is released during programming/erasing
Error protection is released only by a power-on reset and in hardware standby mode.
Figure 18.15 shows the flash memory state transition diagram.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 526 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Program mode
Erase mode
Reset or standby
(hardware protection)
RES = 0
RD VF PR ER FLER = 0
RD VF PR ER FLER = 0
Error occurrence
(Standby)
RES = 0
Error
occurrence
RES = 0
Error protection mode
RD VF PR ER FLER = 1
Standby mode
Standby mode
release
FLMCR1, EBR1
initialization state
Error protection mode
(Standby)
RD VF PR ER FLER = 1
FLMCR1, EBR1
initialization state
Legend:
RD: Memory read possible
VF: Verify-read possible
PR: Programming possible
ER: Erasing possible
RD:
VF:
PR:
ER:
Memory read not possible
Verify-read not possible
Programming not possible
Erasing not possible
Figure 18.15 Flash Memory State Transitions
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 527 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.9
Flash Memory Emulation in RAM
Making a setting in the RAM emulation register (RAMER) enables part of RAM to be overlapped
onto the flash memory area so that data to be written to flash memory can be emulated in RAM in
real time. After the RAMER setting has been made, accesses cannot be made from the flash
memory area or the RAM area overlapping flash memory. Emulation can be performed in user
mode and user program mode. Figure 18.16 shows an example of emulation of real-time flash
memory programming.
Start emulation program
Set RAMER
Write tuning data to overlap
RAM
Execute application program
No
Tuning OK?
Yes
Clear RAMER
Write to flash memory emulation
block
End of emulation program
Figure 18.16 Flowchart for Flash Memory Emulation in RAM
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 528 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
H'000000
Flash memory
EB0 to EB3
H'01F000
EB4
This area can be accessed
from both the RAM area
and flash memory area
H'01F400
EB5
H'01F800
EB6
H'01FC00
H'01FFFF
EB7
H'FFFFF800
H'FFFFFBFF
On-chip RAM
Figure 18.17 Example of RAM Overlap Operation
Example in Which Flash Memory Block Area (EB4) is Overlapped
1. Set bits RAMS, RAM1, and RAM0 in RAMER to 1, 0, 1, to overlap part of RAM onto the
area (EB4) for which real-time programming is required.
2. Real-time programming is performed using the overlapping RAM.
3. After the program data has been confirmed, the RAMS bit is cleared, releasing RAM overlap.
4. The data written in the overlapping RAM is written into the flash memory space (EB4).
Notes: 1. When the RAMS bit is set to 1, program/erase protection is enabled for all blocks
regardless of the value of RAM1 and RAM0 (emulation protection). In this state,
setting the P or E bit in flash memory control register 1 (FLMCR1) will not cause a
transition to program mode or erase mode. When actually programming a flash
memory area, the RAMS bit should be cleared to 0.
2. A RAM area cannot be erased by execution of software in accordance with the erase
algorithm while flash memory emulation in RAM is being used.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 529 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.10
Note on Flash Memory Programming/Erasing
In the on-board programming modes (user mode and user program mode), NMI input should be
disabled to give top priority to the program/erase operations (including RAM emulation).
18.11
Flash Memory Programmer Mode
Programs and data can be written and erased in programmer mode as well as in the on-board
programming modes. In programmer mode, flash memory read mode, auto-program mode, autoerase mode, and status read mode are supported. In auto-program mode, auto-erase mode, and
status read mode, a status polling procedure is used, and in status read mode, detailed internal
signals are output after execution of an auto-program or auto-erase operation.
In programmer mode, set the mode pins to PLL×2 mode (see table 18.10) and input a 6 MHz input
clock, so that the SH7017 runs at 12 MHz.
Table 18.10 shows the pin settings for programmer mode. For the pin names in programmer mode,
see section 1.3.2, Pin Arrangement by Mode.
Table 18.10 PROM Mode Pin Settings
Pin Names
Settings
Mode pins: MD3, MD2, MD1, MD0
1101 (PLL × 2)
FWE pin
High level input (in auto-program and auto-erase
modes)
RES pin
Power-on reset circuit
XTAL, EXTAL, PLLVCC, PLLCAP,
PLLVSS pins
Oscillator circuit
Note: In programmer mode, the FWP pin has its polarity reversed and functions as the FWE
(flash write enable) pin.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 530 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.11.1 Socket Adapter Pin Correspondence Diagram
Connect the socket adapter to the chip as shown in figure 18.19. This will enable conversion to a
32-pin arrangement. The on-chip ROM memory map is shown in figure 18.18, and the socket
adapter pin correspondence diagram in figure 18.19.
Addresses in
MCU mode
Addresses in
programmer mode
H'00000000
H'00000
On-chip ROM space
128 kB
H'0001FFFF
H'1FFFF
Figure 18.18 On-Chip ROM Memory Map
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 531 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
HD64F7017 (112 Pins)
Pin Name
Pin No.
FWE
77
13
20
19
A9
A16
44
70
WE
D0
D1
69
68
67
66
64
63
62
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
43
14
15
16
17
18
42
21, 37, 46, 49, 50, 65,
73, 75, 76, 79, 100, 103
Socket Adapter
(Conversion to 32-Pin
Arrangement)
26
2
3
A15
31
13
D2
D3
D4
D5
I/O4
I/O5
10
9
8
7
6
5
27
24
23
25
4
28
29
22
32
16
30
VCC
3, 23, 27, 33, 39, 55, 61, 71
78, 90, 91, 92, 93, 94, 95, 96,
97, 98, 99, 101, 109
26
84
72
74
XTAL
EXTAL
Oscillator circuit
80
81
82
PLLVCC
PLLCAP
PLLVSS
PLL circuit
Other than the above
N.C.(OPEN)
VSS
Power-on reset circuit
A15
WE
I/O0
18
12
11
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
OE
A10
A11
A12
A13
A14
CE
FWE
A9
A16
I/O1
I/O2
21
A0
A1
A2
Pin Name
14
15
17
19
20
D6
D7
A17
RES
HN28F101P (32 Pins)
Pin No.
1
Legend:
FWE:
I/O7 to I/O0:
A17 to A0:
OE:
CE:
WE:
I/O3
I/O6
I/O7
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
OE
A10
A11
A12
A13
A14
CE
VCC
VSS
A17
Flash write enable
Data input/output
Address input
Output enable
Chip enable
Write enable
Note: Use address pin A17 as VSS.
Figure 18.19 Socket Adapter Pin Correspondence Table (SH7017: FP-112)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 532 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.11.2 Programmer Mode Operation
Table 18.11 shows how the different operating modes are set when using programmer mode, and
table 18.12 lists the commands used in programmer mode. Details of each mode are given below.
• Memory Read Mode
Memory read mode supports byte reads.
• Auto-Program Mode
Auto-program mode supports programming of 128 bytes at a time. Status polling is used to
confirm the end of auto-programming.
• Auto-Erase Mode
Auto-erase mode supports automatic erasing of the entire flash memory. Status polling is used
to confirm the end of auto-programming.
• Status Read Mode
Status polling is used for auto-programming and auto-erasing, and normal termination can be
confirmed by reading the I/O 6 signal. In status read mode, error information is output if an
error occurs.
Table 18.11 Settings for Various Operating Modes In Programmer Mode
Pin Names
Mode
FWE
CE
OE
WE
I/O0 to I/O7
A0 to A17
Read
H or L
L
L
H
Data output
Ain
Output disable
H or L
L
H
H
Hi-z
X
Command write
H or L
L
H
L
Data input
*Ain
Chip disable
H or L
H
X
X
Hi-z
X
Notes: 1. Chip disable is not a standby state; internally, it is an operation state.
2. *Ain indicates that there is also address input in auto-program mode.
3. For command writes in auto-program and auto-erase modes, input a high level to the
FWE pin.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 533 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Table 18.12 Programmer Mode Commands
Command Name
Number of
Cycles
Mode
Memory read mode
1+n
Auto-program mode
1st Cycle
2nd Cycle
Address Data
Mode
Address Data
Write
X
H'00
Read
RA
Dout
129
Write
X
H'40
Write
WA
Din
Auto-erase mode
2
Write
X
H'20
Write
X
H'20
Status read mode
2
Write
X
H'71
Write
X
H'71
Notes: 1. In auto-program mode. 129 cycles are required for command writing by a simultaneous
128-byte write.
2. In memory read mode, the number of cycles depends on the number of address write
cycles (n).
18.11.3 Memory Read Mode
1. After completion of auto-program/auto-erase/status read operations, a transition is made to the
command wait state. When reading memory contents, a transition to memory read mode must
first be made with a command write, after which the memory contents are read.
2. In memory read mode, command writes can be performed in the same way as in the command
wait state.
3. Once memory read mode has been entered, consecutive reads can be performed.
4. After powering on, memory read mode is entered.
Table 18.13 AC Characteristics in Transition to Memory Read Mode
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, VSS = 0 V, Ta = 25°C ±5°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Command write cycle
tnxtc
20
μs
CE hold time
tceh
0
ns
CE setup time
tces
0
ns
Data hold time
tdh
50
ns
Data setup time
tds
50
ns
Write pulse width
twep
70
ns
WE rise time
tr
30
ns
WE fall time
tf
30
ns
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 534 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Max
Unit
Notes
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Command write
Memory read mode
Address stable
A16 to A0
tces
tceh
tnxtc
CE
OE
twep
tf
tr
WE
tds
tdh
I/O7 to I/O0
Note: Data is latched on the rising edge of WE.
Figure 18.20 Timing Waveforms for Memory Read after Memory Write
Table 18.14 AC Characteristics in Transition from Memory Read Mode to Another Mode
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, VSS = 0 V, Ta = 25°C ±5°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Command write cycle
tnxtc
20
μs
CE hold time
tceh
0
ns
CE setup time
tces
0
ns
Data hold time
tdh
50
ns
Data setup time
tds
50
ns
Write pulse width
twep
70
ns
WE rise time
tr
30
ns
WE fall time
tf
30
ns
Notes
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 535 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Memory read mode
A16 to A0
Other mode command write
Address stable
tces
tnxtc
tceh
CE
OE
twep
tf
tr
WE
tds
tdh
I/O7 to I/O0
Note: Do not enable WE and OE at the same time.
Figure 18.21 Timing Waveforms in Transition from Memory Read Mode to Another Mode
Table 18.15 AC Characteristics in Memory Read Mode
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, VSS = 0 V, Ta = 25°C ±5°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Access time
tacc
20
μs
CE output delay time
tce
150
ns
OE output delay time
toe
150
ns
Output disable delay time
tdf
100
ns
Data output hold time
toh
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 536 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
5
ns
Notes
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Address stable
A16 to A0
CE
VIL
OE
VIL
WE
VIH
Address stable
tacc
tacc
toh
toh
I/O7 to I/O0
Figure 18.22 CE and OE Enable State Read Timing Waveforms
Address stable
A16 to A0
Address stable
tce
tce
CE
toe
toe
OE
WE
VIH
tacc
tacc
toh
tdf
toh
tdf
I/O7 to I/O0
Figure 18.23 CE and OE Clock System Read Timing Waveforms
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 537 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.11.4 Auto-Program Mode
1. In auto-program mode, 128 bytes are programmed simultaneously. This should be carried out
by executing 128 consecutive byte transfers.
2. A 128-byte data transfer is necessary even when programming fewer than 128 bytes. In this
case, H'FF data must be written to the extra addresses.
3. The lower 8 bits of the transfer address must be H'00, H'80. If a value other than an effective
address is input, processing will switch to a memory write operation but a write error will be
flagged.
4. Memory address transfer is performed in the second cycle (figure 18.24). Do not perform
transfer after the third cycle.
5. Do not perform a command write during a programming operation.
6. Perform one auto-program operation for a 128-byte block for each address. Two or more
additional programming operations cannot be performed on a previously programmed address
block.
7. Confirm normal end of auto-programming by checking I/O6. Alternatively, status read mode
can also be used for this purpose (I/O7status polling uses the auto-program operation end
identification pin).
8. Status polling I/O6 and I/O7 pin information is retained until the next command write. As long
as the next command write has not been performed, reading is possible by enabling CE and
OE.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 538 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Table 18.16 AC Characteristics in Auto-Program Mode
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, VSS = 0 V, Ta = 25°C ±5°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Command write cycle
tnxtc
20
μs
CE hold time
tceh
0
ns
CE setup time
tces
0
ns
Data hold time
tdh
50
ns
Data setup time
tds
50
ns
Write pulse width
twep
70
ns
Status polling start time
twsts
1
ms
Status polling access time
tspa
Address setup time
tas
0
ns
Address hold time
tah
60
ns
Memory write time
twrite
1
Write setup time
tpns
100
Write end setup time
tpnh
100
WE rise time
tr
30
ns
WE fall time
tf
30
ns
150
Notes
ns
3000
ms
ns
ns
FWE
tpnh
A16 to A0
tpns
tces
tceh
tnxtc
Address
stable
tnxtc
CE
OE
tf
twep
tr
tas
tah
twsts
tspa
WE
tds
tdh
Data transfer
1 to 128 byte
twrite
I/O7
Write operation complete verify signal
I/O6
Write normal complete verify signal
I/O5 to I/O0
H'40
H'00
Figure 18.24 Auto-Program Mode Timing Waveforms
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 539 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.11.5 Auto-Erase Mode
1. Auto-erase mode supports only entire memory erasing.
2. Do not perform a command write during auto-erasing.
3. Confirm normal end of auto-erasing by checking I/O6. Alternatively, status read mode can also
be used for this purpose (I/O7 status polling uses the auto-erase operation end identification
pin).
4. Status polling I/O6 and I/O7 pin information is retained until the next command write. As long
as the next command write has not been performed, reading is possible by enabling CE and
OE.
Table 18.17 AC Characteristics in Auto-Erase Mode
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, VSS = 0 V, Ta = 25°C ±5°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Command write cycle
tnxtc
20
μs
CE hold time
tceh
0
ns
CE setup time
tces
0
ns
Data hold time
tdh
50
ns
Data setup time
tds
50
ns
Write pulse width
twep
70
ns
Status polling start time
tests
1
Status polling access time
tspa
Memory erase time
terase
100
Erase setup time
tens
100
ns
Erase end setup time
tenh
100
ns
WE rise time
tr
30
ns
WE fall time
tf
30
ns
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 540 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Max
Unit
ms
150
ns
40000
ms
Notes
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
FWE
tenh
A16 to A0
tens
tces
tceh
tnxtc
tnxtc
CE
OE
tf
twep
tr
tests
tspa
WE
tds
terase
tdh
I/O7
Erase complete
verify signal
I/O6
I/O5 to I/O0
Erase normal
complete
verify signal
H'20
H'20
H'00
Figure 18.25 Auto-Erase Mode Timing Waveforms
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 541 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.11.6 Status Read Mode
1. Status read mode is provided to specify the kind of abnormal end. Use this mode when an
abnormal end occurs in auto-program mode or auto-erase mode.
2. The return code is retained until a command write other than a status read mode command
write is executed.
Table 18.18 AC Characteristics in Status Read Mode
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, VSS = 0 V, Ta = 25°C ±5°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Read time after command write tstrd
20
μs
CE hold time
tceh
0
ns
CE setup time
tces
0
ns
Data hold time
tdh
50
ns
Data setup time
tds
50
ns
Write pulse width
twep
70
ns
OE output delay time
toe
150
ns
Disable delay time
tdf
100
ns
CE output delay time
tce
150
ns
WE rise time
tr
30
ns
WE fall time
tf
30
ns
Notes
A16 to A0
tces
tceh
tnxtc tces
tceh
tnxtc
tnxtc
CE
tce
OE
twep
tf
tr
twep
tf
tr
toe
WE
tds
I/O7 to I/O0
tdh
H'71
tds
tdh
H'71
Note: I/O2 and I/O3 are undefined.
Figure 18.26 Status Read Mode Timing Waveforms
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 542 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
tdf
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Table 18.19 Status Read Mode Return Commands
I/O6
Pin Name I/O7
Attribute
Normal
Command
end
error
identification
I/O5
I/O4
I/O3
I/O2
I/O1
Programming Erase
error
error
⎯
⎯
Programming Effective
address error
or erase
count
exceeded
0
0
0
⎯
⎯
Effective
Count
exceeded: 1 address
Initial value 0
0
0
Indications Normal
end: 0
Command
Programming Erasing
Error: 1
Error: 1
Abnormal
end: 1
0
Error: 1
I/O0
0
Otherwise: 0 Error: 1
Otherwise: 0 Otherwise: 0 Otherwise: 0
Otherwise: 0
Note: I/O2 and I/O3 are undefined at present.
18.11.7 Status Polling
1. I/O7 status polling is a flag that indicates the operating status in auto-program/auto-erase
mode.
2. I/O6 status polling is a flag that indicates a normal or abnormal end in auto-program/auto-erase
mode.
Table 18.20 Status Polling Output Truth Table
Pin Name
During Internal
Operation
Abnormal End
⎯
Normal End
I/O7
0
1
0
1
I/O6
0
0
1
1
I/O0 to I/O5
0
0
0
0
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 543 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.11.8 Programmer Mode Transition Time
Commands cannot be accepted during the oscillation stabilization period or the programmer mode
setup period. After the programmer mode setup time, a transition is made to memory read mode.
Table 18.21 Stipulated Transition Times to Command Wait State
Item
Symbol
Min
Standby release
(oscillation stabilization time)
tosc1
10
ms
Programmer mode setup time
tbmv
10
ms
VCC hold time
tdwn
0
ms
tOSC1
tbmv
Max
Memory read
mode
Command
Auto-program mode
wait state
Auto-erase mode
Unit
Notes
Command wait state
Normal/abnormal
complete verify
tdwn
VCC
RES
FWE
Note: For the level of FWE input pin, set VIL when using other than the auto-program mode
and auto-erase mode.
Figure 18.27 Oscillation Stabilization Time, Boot Program Transfer Time,
and Power-Down Sequence
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 544 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
18.11.9 Notes on Memory Programming
1. When programming addresses which have previously been programmed, carry out autoerasing before auto-programming.
2. When performing programming using PROM mode on a chip that has been
programmed/erased in an on-board programming mode, auto-erasing is recommended before
carrying out auto-programming.
Notes: 1. The flash memory is initially in the erased state when the device is shipped by Renesas
Technology. For other chips for which the erasure history is unknown, it is
recommended that auto-erasing be executed to check and supplement the initialization
(erase) level.
2. Auto-programming should be performed once only on the same address block.
Additional programming cannot be performed on previously programmed address
blocks.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 545 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
18. 128 kB Flash Memory (F-ZTAT)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 546 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
19. Mask ROM
Section 19 Mask ROM
19.1
Overview
This LSI is available with 64 kbytes or 128 kbytes of on-chip ROM. The on-chip ROM is
connected to the CPU, direct memory access controller (DMAC) through a 32-bit data bus (figures
19.1 and 19.2). The CPU and DMAC can access the on-chip ROM in 8, 16 and 32-bit widths.
Data in the on-chip ROM can always be accessed in one cycle.
Internal data bus (32-bit)
H'00000000
H'00000001
H'00000002
H'00000003
H'00000004
H'00000005
H'00000006
H'00000007
On-chip ROM
H'0000FFFC
H'0000FFFD
H'0000FFFE
H'0000FFFF
Figure 19.1 Mask ROM Block Diagram (64 kbyte version)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 547 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
19. Mask ROM
Internal data bus (32-bit)
H'00000000
H'00000001
H'00000002
H'00000003
H'00000004
H'00000005
H'00000006
H'00000007
On-chip ROM
H'0001FFFC
H'0001FFFD
H'0001FFFE
H'0001FFFF
Figure 19.2 Mask ROM Block Diagram (128 kbyte version)
The operating mode determines whether the on-chip ROM is valid or not. The operating mode is
selected using mode-setting pins MD3 to MD0 as shown in table 19.1. If you are using the on-chip
ROM, select mode 2 or mode 3; if you are not, select mode 0 or 1. The on-chip ROM is allocated
to addresses H'00000000 to H'0000FFFF of memory area 0 for the 64 kbyte version and
H'00000000 to H'0001FFFF of memory area 0 for the 128 kbyte version.
Table 19.1 Operation Modes and ROM
Mode Setting Pin
Operation Mode
MD3 MD2 MD1 MD0 Area 0
Mode 0 (MCU mode 0)
*
*
0
0
On-chip ROM invalid, external 8-bit space
Mode 1 (MCU mode 1)
*
*
0
1
On-chip ROM invalid, external 16-bit space
Mode 2 (MCU mode 2)
*
*
1
0
On-chip ROM valid, external space
(bus width set with bus state controller)
Mode 3 (MCU mode 3)
*
*
1
1
On-chip ROM valid, single-chip mode
Legend:
0: Low
1: High
Note: *
Refer to section 3, Operating Modes.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 548 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
20. RAM
Section 20 RAM
20.1
Overview
The SH7014 and SH7016 have 3 kbytes of on-chip RAM, and the SH7017 has 4 kbytes. The onchip RAM is linked to the CPU and direct memory access controller (DMAC) with a 32-bit data
bus (figure 20.1). The CPU can access data in the on-chip RAM in 8, 16, or 32 bit widths. The
DMAC can access 8 or 16 bit widths. On-chip RAM data can always be accessed in one state,
making the RAM ideal for use as a program area, stack area, or data area, which require highspeed access. The contents of the on-chip RAM are held in both the sleep and standby modes.
Memory area 0 addresses H'FFFFF000 to H'FFFFFBFF (SH7014, SH7016) or H'FFFFF000 to
H'FFFFFFFF (SH7017) are allocated to the on-chip RAM.
The on-chip RAM is also used as cache memory. When the cache is used, 1 kbyte of on-chip
RAM is available in the SH7014 and SH7016, and 2 kbytes in the SH7017. See section 7, Cache
Memory, for details.
Internal data bus (32-bit)
H'FFFFF000
H'FFFFF001
H'FFFFF002
H'FFFFF003
H'FFFFF004
H'FFFFF005
H'FFFFF006
H'FFFFF007
On-chip RAM
H'FFFFFBFC
H'FFFFFBFD
H'FFFFFBFE
H'FFFFFBFF
H'FFFFFFFC
H'FFFFFFFD
H'FFFFFFFE
H'FFFFFFFF
Note: Operation is not guaranteed if addresses H'FFFFFC00 to H'FFFFFFFF
are accessed in the SH7014 or SH7016.
Figure 20.1 Block Diagram of RAM
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 549 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
20. RAM
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 550 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
21. Power-Down State
Section 21 Power-Down State
21.1
Overview
In the power-down state, the CPU functions are halted. This enables a great reduction in power
consumption.
21.1.1
Power-Down States
The power-down state is effected by the following two modes:
• Sleep mode
• Standby mode
Table 21.1 describes the transition conditions for entering the modes from the program execution
state as well as the CPU and peripheral function status in each mode and the procedures for
canceling each mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 551 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
21. Power-Down State
Table 21.1 Power-Down State Conditions
State
Entering
Mode Procedure
Clock CPU
Sleep Execute SLEEP Run
instruction with
SBY bit set to 0
in SBYCR
Stand- Execute SLEEP Halt
by
instruction with
SBY bit set to 1
in SBYCR
Halt
Halt
On-Chip
Peripheral CPU
Modules Registers RAM
I/O
Ports
Canceling
Procedure
Run
Held
•
Interrupt
•
DMAC
address error
•
Power-on
reset
Held
Halt*
1
Held
Held
Held
Held or •
high
•
impe2
dance*
NMI interrupt
Power-on
reset
Legend:
SBYCR: standby control register
SBY:
standby bit
Notes: 1. Some bits within on-chip peripheral module registers are initialized by the standby
mode; some are not. Refer to table 21.3, Register States in the Standby Mode, in
section 21.4.1, Transition to Standby Mode. Also refer to the register descriptions for
each peripheral module.
2. The status of the I/O port in standby mode is set by the port high impedance bit (HIZ) of
the SBYCR. Refer to section 21.2, Standby Control Register. For pin status other than
for the I/O port, refer to Appendix C, Pin Status.
21.1.2
Related Register
Table 21.2 shows the register used for power-down state control.
Table 21.2 Related Register
Name
Abbreviation
R/W
Initial Value
Address
Access Size
Standby control register
SBYCR
R/W
H'1F
H'FFFF8614
8, 16, 32
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 552 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
21. Power-Down State
21.2
Standby Control Register (SBYCR)
The standby control register (SBYCR) is a read/write 8-bit register that sets the transition to
standby mode, and the port status in standby mode. The SBYCR is initialized to H'1F when reset.
Bit:
Initial value:
R/W:
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SBY
HIZ
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit 7⎯Standby (SBY): Specifies transition to the standby mode. The SBY bit cannot be set to 1
while the watchdog timer is running (when the timer enable bit (TME) of the WDT timer
control/status register (TCSR) is set to 1). To enter the standby mode, always halt the WDT by 0
clearing the TME bit, then set the SBY bit.
Bit 7
SBY
Description
0
Executing SLEEP instruction puts the LSI into sleep mode
1
Executing SLEEP instruction puts the LSI into standby mode
(initial value)
Bit 6⎯Port High Impedance (HIZ): In the standby mode, this bit selects whether to set the I/O
port pin to high impedance or hold the pin status. The HIZ bit cannot be set to 1 when the TME bit
of the WDT timer control/status register (TCSR) is set to 1. When making the I/O port pin status
high impedance, always clear the TME bit to 0 before setting the HIZ bit.
Bit 6
HIZ
Description
0
Holds pin status while in standby mode
1
Keeps pin at high impedance while in standby mode
(initial value)
Bits 5 to 0⎯Reserved: Bit 5 always reads as 0. Always write 0 to bit 5. Bits 4 to 0 always read as
1. Always write 1 to these bits.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 553 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
21. Power-Down State
21.3
Sleep Mode
21.3.1
Transition to Sleep Mode
Executing the SLEEP instruction when the SBY bit of SBYCR is 0 causes a transition from the
program execution state to the sleep mode. Although the CPU halts immediately after executing
the SLEEP instruction, the contents of its internal registers remain unchanged. The on-chip
peripheral modules continue to run during the sleep mode.
21.3.2
Canceling Sleep Mode
Sleep mode is canceled by an interrupt, DMAC address error, or power-on reset.
Cancellation by an Interrupt: When an interrupt occurs, the sleep mode is canceled and interrupt
exception processing is executed. The sleep mode is not canceled if the interrupt cannot be
accepted because its priority level is equal to or less than the mask level set in the CPU's status
register (SR) or if an interrupt by an on-chip peripheral module is disabled at the peripheral
module.
Cancellation by a DMAC Address Error: If a DMAC address error occurs, the sleep mode is
canceled and DMAC address error exception processing is executed.
Cancellation by a Power-On Reset: A power-on reset resulting from setting the RES pin to low
level cancels the sleep mode.
21.4
Standby Mode
21.4.1
Transition to Standby Mode
To enter the standby mode, set the SBY bit to 1 in SBYCR, then execute the SLEEP instruction.
The LSI moves from the program execution state to the standby mode. In the standby mode,
power consumption is greatly reduced by halting not only the CPU, but the clock and on-chip
peripheral modules as well. CPU register contents and on-chip RAM data are held as long as the
prescribed voltages are applied. The register contents of some on-chip peripheral modules are
initialized, but some are not (table 21.3). The I/O port status can be selected as held or high
impedance by the port high impedance bit (HIZ) of the SBYCR. For pin status other than for the
I/O port, refer to Appendix B, Pin Status.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 554 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
21. Power-Down State
Table 21.3 Register States in the Standby Mode
Module
Registers Initialized
Registers that
Retain Data
Registers with
Undefined Contents
Interrupt controller
(INTC)
⎯
All registers
⎯
Cache memory (CAC) ⎯
All registers
⎯
⎯
All registers
⎯
⎯
•
DMA source
address registers
0, 1 (SAR0, SAR1)
•
DMA destination
address registers
0, 1 (DAR0, DAR1)
•
DMA transfer count
registers 0, 1
(DMATCR0,
DMATCR1)
Bus state controller
(BSC)
Direct memory access •
controller (DMAC)
DMA channel control
registers 0, 1 (CHCR0,
CHCR1)
•
DMA operation register
(DMAOR)
⎯
⎯
Multifunction timer
pulse unit (MTU)
MTU associated registers
Watchdog timer
(WDT)
•
Bits 7 to 5 (OVF, WT/IT, TME) •
of the timer control status
register (TCSR)
•
Reset control/status register
(RSTCSR)
•
Receive data register (RDR)
⎯
⎯
All registers
⎯
⎯
Compare match timer All registers
(CMT)
⎯
⎯
Pin function controller ⎯
(PFC)
All registers
⎯
Serial communication •
interface (SCI)
•
A/D converter (A/D)
⎯
Bits 2 to 0
(CKS2 to
CKS0) of the
TCSR
Timer counter
(TCNT)
Transmit data register (TDR)
•
Serial mode register (SMR)
•
Serial control register (SCR)
•
Serial status register (SSR)
•
Bit rate register (BBR)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 555 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
21. Power-Down State
Module
Registers Initialized
Registers that
Retain Data
Registers with
Undefined Contents
I/O port (I/O)
⎯
All registers
⎯
Power-down state
related
⎯
Standby control ⎯
register (SBYCR)
21.4.2
Canceling the Standby Mode
The standby mode is canceled by an NMI interrupt or a power-on reset.
Cancellation by an NMI: Clock oscillation starts when a rising edge or falling edge (selected by
the NMI edge select bit (NMIE) of the interrupt control register (ICR) of the INTC) is detected in
the NMI signal. This clock is supplied only to the watchdog timer (WDT). A WDT overflow
occurs if the time established by the clock select bits (CKS2 to CKS0) in the TCSR of the WDT
elapses before transition to the standby mode. The occurrence of this overflow is used to indicate
that the clock has stabilized, so the clock is supplied to the entire chip, the standby mode is
canceled, and NMI exception processing begins.
When canceling standby mode with NMI interrupts, set the CKS2 to CKS0 bits so that the WDT
overflow period is longer than the oscillation stabilization time.
When canceling standby mode with an NMI pin set for falling edge, be sure that the NMI pin level
upon entering standby (when the clock is halted) is high level, and that the NMI pin level upon
returning from standby (when the clock starts after oscillation stabilization) is low level. When
canceling standby mode with an NMI pin set for rising edge, be sure that the NMI pin level upon
entering standby (when the clock is halted) is low level, and that the NMI pin level upon returning
from standby (when the clock starts after oscillation stabilization) is high level.
Cancellation by a Power-On Reset: A power-on reset caused by setting the RES pin to low level
cancels the standby mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 556 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
21. Power-Down State
21.4.3
Standby Mode Application Example
This example describes a transition to standby mode on the falling edge of an NMI signal, and a
cancellation on the rising edge of the NMI signal. The timing is shown in figure 21.1.
When the NMI pin is changed from high to low level while the NMI edge select bit (NMIE) of the
ICR is set to 0 (falling edge detection), the NMI interrupt is accepted. When the NMIE bit is set to
1 (rising edge detection) by an NMI exception service routine, the standby bit (SBY) of the
SBYCR is set to 1, and a SLEEP instruction is executed, standby mode is entered. Thereafter,
standby mode is canceled when the NMI pin is changed from low to high level.
Oscillator
CK
NMI
NMIE
SBY
Oscillation
settling time
NMI
Exception
exception
service
processing
routine
SBY = 1
SLEEP
instruction
Standby Oscillation
mode
start
time
WDT
time
set
NMI
exception
processing
Figure 21.1 Standby Mode NMI Timing (Application Example)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 557 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
21. Power-Down State
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 558 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Section 22 Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.1
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Table 22.1 shows the absolute maximum ratings.
Table 22.1 Absolute Maximum Ratings
Item
Symbol
Rating
Unit
Power supply voltage
VCC
−0.3 to +7.0
V
Input voltage (other than A/D ports)
Vin
−0.3 to VCC +0.3
V
Input voltage (A/D ports)
Vin
−0.3 to AVCC +0.3
V
Analog supply voltage
AVCC
−0.3 to +7.0
V
Analog input voltage
VAN
−0.3 to AVCC +0.3
V
Operating temperature
Topr
−20 to +75
°C
Programming temperature (F-ZTAT version only)
TWE
−20 to +75
°C
Storage temperature
Tstg
−55 to +125
°C
Note: Operating the LSI in excess of the absolute maximum ratings may result in permanent
damage.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 559 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.2
DC Characteristics
Table 22.2 DC Characteristics
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75° C
Item
Max
Measurement
Unit Conditions
VCC −0.7 ⎯
VCC +0.3
V
⎯
EXTAL
VCC × 0.7 ⎯
VCC +0.3
V
⎯
A/D port
2.2
⎯
AVCC +0.3 V
⎯
Other input pins
2.2
⎯
VCC +0.3
V
⎯
−0.3
⎯
0.5
V
⎯
−0.3
⎯
0.8
V
⎯
⎯
⎯
V
VT ≥ VCC −0.7 (max)
Pin
Symbol Min
Input highRES, NMI, MD3 VIH
level voltage to MD0, FWP,
PA2, PA5, PA6
to PA9, PE0 to
PE15
Input lowRES, NMI,
level voltage MD3 to MD0,
PA2, PA5,
PA6 to PA9,
PE0 to PE15
VIL
Other input pins
Schmitt
PA2, PA5,
trigger
PA6 to PA9
input voltage
PE0 to PE15
Input
leakage
current
Three-state
leak current
(while off)
RES, NMI,
MD3 to MD0,
PA2, PA5,
PA6 to PA9,
PE0 to PE15
−
VT − VT 0.4
+
Typ
+
VT− ≤ 0.5 (min)
⎯
⎯
1.0
μA
Vin = 0.5 to VCC −0.5 V
A/D port
⎯
⎯
1.0
μA
Vin = 0.5 to AVCC −0.5 V
Other input pins
⎯
⎯
1.0
μA
Vin = 0.5 to VCC −0.5 V
A21 to A0, D15 | ITSI |
to D0, CS3 to
CS0, RDWR,
RAS, CASx,
WRx, RD,
ports A, B, E
⎯
⎯
1.0
μA
Vin = 0.5 to VCC −0.5 V
| Iin |
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 560 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Item
Pin
Symbol Min
Typ
Max
Measurement
Unit Conditions
Output high- All output pins VOH
level voltage
VCC −0.5 ⎯
⎯
V
IOH = −200 μA
3.5
⎯
⎯
V
IOH = −1 mA
Output low- All output pins VOL
level voltage
⎯
⎯
0.4
V
IOL = 1.6 mA
Input
RES
capacitance
NMI
⎯
⎯
80
pF
⎯
⎯
50
pF
Vin = 0 V, f = 1 MHz,
Ta = 25°C
⎯
⎯
20
pF
⎯
130
180
mA
f = 28 MHz
⎯
100
150
mA
f = 28 MHz
⎯
0.01
5
μA
Ta ≤ 50°C
⎯
⎯
20
μA
Ta > 50°C
⎯
140
180
mA
f = 28 MHz
⎯
110
150
mA
f = 28 MHz
⎯
0.01
5
μA
Ta ≤ 50°C
⎯
⎯
20
μA
Ta > 50°C
Cin
All other input
pins
Current
Ordinary
consumption operation
(SH7014)
Sleep
ICC
Standby
Current
Ordinary
consumption operation
(SH7016,
Sleep
SH7017)
Standby
ICC
Analog supply
current
(SH7014)
AICC
⎯
13
22
mA
Analog supply
current
(SH7016,
SH7017)
AICC
⎯
5
10
mA
RAM standby
voltage
VRAM
2.0
⎯
⎯
V
Notes: 1. When the A/D converter is not used (including during standby), do not release the AVCC
and AVSS pins. Connect the AVCC pin to VCC and the AVSS pin to VSS.
2. The current consumption is measured when VIHmin = VCC −0.5 V, VIL max = 0.5 V, with
all output pins unloaded.
3. The F-ZTAT and mask versions have the same functions, and the electrical
characteristics of both are within specification, but characteristic-related performance
values, operating margins, noise margins, noise emission, etc., are different. Caution is
therefore required in carrying out system design, and when switching between F-ZTAT
and mask versions.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 561 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Table 22.3 Permitted Output Current Values
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75° C
Item
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Output low-level permissible current (per pin)
IOL
⎯
⎯
2.0
mA
Output low-level permissible current (total)
∑ IOL
⎯
⎯
80
mA
Output high-level permissible current (per pin)
−IOH
⎯
⎯
2.0
mA
Output high-level permissible current (total)
∑ (−IOH)
⎯
⎯
25
mA
Note: To assure LSI reliability, do not exceed the output values listed in this table.
22.3
AC Characteristics
22.3.1
Clock Timing
Table 22.4 Clock Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75° C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Figures
Operating frequency
fOP
4
28.7
MHz
22.1
Clock cycle time
tcyc
34.8
250
ns
Clock low-level pulse width
tCL
10
⎯
ns
Clock high-level pulse width
tCH
10
⎯
ns
Clock rise time
tCR
⎯
5
ns
Clock fall time
tCF
⎯
5
ns
EXTAL clock input frequency
fEX
4
10
MHz
EXTAL clock input cycle time
tEXcyc
100
250
ns
EXTAL clock low-level input pulse width
tEXL
40
⎯
ns
EXTAL clock high-level input pulse width tEXH
40
⎯
ns
EXTAL clock input rise time
tEXR
⎯
5
ns
EXTAL clock input fall time
tEXF
⎯
5
ns
Reset oscillation settling time
tOSC1
10
⎯
ms
Standby return clock settling time
tOSC2
10
⎯
ms
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 562 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22.2
22.3
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
tcyc
tCH
CK
tCL
1/2 VCC
1/2 VCC
tCF
tCR
Figure 22.1 System Clock Timing
TEXcyc
TEXH
EXTAL
1/2 VCC
VIH
TEXL
VIH
VIL
VIL
TEXF
VIH
1/2 VCC
TEXR
Figure 22.2 EXTAL Clock Input Timing
CK
VCC
VCC min
tOSC2
tOSC1
RES
Figure 22.3 Oscillation Settling Time
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 563 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.3.2
Control Signal Timing
Table 22.5 Control Signal Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75° C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Figure
RES rise/fall
tRESr, tRESf
⎯
RES pulse width
tRESW
20
200
ns
22.4
⎯
tcyc
NMI rise/fall
tNMIr, tNMIf
⎯
200
ns
RES setup time*
tRESS
35
⎯
ns
NMI setup time*
tNMIS
35
⎯
ns
IRQ7, IRQ6, IRQ3 to IRQ0 setup time
(edge detection)*
tIRQES
35
⎯
ns
IRQ7, IRQ6, IRQ3 to IRQ0 setup time
(level detection)*
tIRQLS
35
⎯
ns
NMI hold time
tNMIH
35
⎯
ns
IRQ7, IRQ6, IRQ3 to IRQ0 hold time
tIRQEH
35
⎯
ns
Note:
*
22.4,
22.5
22.5
The RES, NMI, IRQ7, IRQ6, and IRQ3 to IRQ0 signals are asynchronous inputs, but
when the setup times shown here are provided, the signals are considered to have
produced changes at clock rise (for RES) or clock fall (for NMI, IRQ7, IRQ6, and IRQ3
to IRQ0). If the setup times are not provided, recognition is delayed until the next clock
rise or fall.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 564 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
CK
tRESr
tRESf
tRESS
tRESS
RES
VIH
VIH
VIL
VIL
tRESW
Figure 22.4 Reset Input Timing
CK
tNMIH
VIH
NMI
VIL
tIRQEH
IRQ edge
tNMIS
tIRQES
VIH
VIL
tIRQLS
IRQ level
Figure 22.5 Interrupt Signal Input Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 565 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.3.3
Bus Timing
Table 22.6 Bus Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
Item
Symbol Min
Address delay time
tAD
2*
3
Max Unit Figure
18
ns
CS delay time 1
tCSD1
2*
3
21
ns
CS delay time 2
tCSD2
2*
3
21
ns
Read strobe delay time 1
tRSD1
2*
3
18
ns
2*
3
18
ns
15
⎯
ns
0
Read strobe delay time 2
tRSD2
Read data setup time
tRDS*
Read data hold time
tRDH
Write strobe delay time 1
4
tWSD1
⎯
ns
2*
3
18
ns
3
18
ns
Write strobe delay time 2
tWSD2
2*
Write data delay time
tWDD
⎯
35
ns
tWDH
0
10* ns
WAIT setup time
tWTS
15
⎯
ns
WAIT hold time
tWTH
0
RAS delay time 2
CAS delay time 1
CAS delay time 2
Read data access time
tRASD1
tRASD2
tCASD1
tCASD2
⎯
ns
2*
3
18
ns
2*
3
18
ns
2*
3
18
ns
2*
3
18
ns
ns
tcyc × (n + 2) − 40
⎯
1
tcyc × (n + 1.5) − 40
⎯
ns
1
tcyc × (n + 2) − 40
⎯
ns
tACC*
1
Access time from read strobe
tOE*
Access time from column
address
tAA*
Access time from RAS
tRAC*
1
tcyc × (n + RCD + 2.5) − 40 ⎯
ns
Access time from CAS
tCAC*
1
tcyc × (n + 1) − 40
⎯
ns
Row address hold time
tRAH
tcyc × (RCD + 0.5) − 15
⎯
ns
tcyc × 0.5 − 17.5
⎯
ns
5
Row address setup time
tASR*
Data input setup time
tDS
tcyc × (m + 0.5) − 25
⎯
ns
Data input hold time
tDH
20
⎯
ns
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 566 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22.6, 22.7,
22.9 to 22.14,
22.17
2
Write data hold time
RAS delay time 1
22.6, 22.7,
22.9 to 22.14,
22.17
22.6, 22.7, 22.17
22.8, 22.13,
22.17
22.9 to 22.16
22.6, 22.7
22.9 to 22.14
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Notes: n is the number of waits. m is 0 when the number of DRAM write cycle waits is 0, and 1
otherwise. RCD is the set value of the RCD bit in DCR.
1. If the access time is satisfied, tRDS need not be satisfied.
2. tWDH (max) is a reference value.
3. The delay time Min values are reference values (typ).
4. tRDS is a reference value.
5. At 28.7 MHz, tASR = 0 ns (min)
Table 22.7 Bus Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
Item
Symbol Min
Max
Unit Figure
Write address setup time
tAS
0
⎯
ns
Write address hold time
tWR
5
⎯
ns
Write data hold time
tWRH
0
⎯
ns
Read/write strobe delay time 1 tRWD1
2*
18
ns
Read/write strobe delay time 2 tRWD2
2*
18
ns
High-speed page mode CAS
precharge time
tCP
tcyc −25
⎯
ns
22.14
RAS precharge time
tRP
tcyc × (TPC + 1.5) − 15 ⎯
ns
22.9 to 22.14
CAS setup time
tCSR
10
⎯
ns
22.15, 22.16
AH delay time 1
tAHD1
2*
18
ns
22.17
AH delay time 2
tAHD2
2*
18
ns
Multiplex address delay time
tMAD
2*
18
ns
Multiplex address hold time
tMAH
0
⎯
ns
DACK delay time
tDACKD1
2*
21
ns
22.6 to 22.7
22.9 to 22.14
22.6, 22.7, 22.9 to
22.14, 22.17
Notes: TPC is the set value of the TPC bit in DCR.
* The delay time Min values are reference values (typ).)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 567 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
T1
T2
CK
tAD
A21 to A0
tCSD1
tCSD2
CSn
tRSD1
tOE
tRSD2
RD
(During read)
tRDH
tRDS
tACC
D15 to D0
(During read)
tWSD1
WRx
(During write)
tWSD2
tAS
tWR
tWRH
tWDD
tWDH
D15 to D0
(During write)
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
DACKn
Note: tRDH is specified from the first negate timing for A21 to A0, CSn, and RD.
Figure 22.6 Basic Cycle (No Waits)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 568 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Tw
T1
T2
CK
tAD
A21 to A0
tCSD1
tCSD2
CSn
tRSD1
tOE
tRSD2
RD
(During read)
tRDS
tACC
tRDH
D15 to D0
(During read)
tWSD1
WRx
(During write)
tWSD2
tAS
tWR
tWRH
tWDH
tWDD
D15 to D0
(During write)
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
DACKn
Note: tRDH is specified from the first negate timing for A21 to A0, CSn, and RD.
Figure 22.7 Basic Cycle (Software Waits)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 569 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
T1
Tw
Tw
Two
T2
CK
A21 to A0
CSn
RD
(During read)
D15 to D0
(During read)
WRx
(During write)
D15 to D0
(During write)
tWTS
tWTH tWTS
tWTH
WAIT
DACKn
Figure 22.8 Basic Cycle (2 Software Waits + Wait due to WAIT Signal)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 570 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Tp
CK
Tr
tAD
A21 to A0
RAS
tASR
Tc2
Tc1
tAD
Row address
tRASD1
tRAH
Column address
tRASD2
tRP
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
(During read)
RDWR
(During read)
D15 to D0
(During read)
tCAC tRDS
tAA
tRDH
tRAC
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
(During write)
tRWD1
tRWD2
RDWR
(During write)
tWDD
tDS
tDH
tWDH
D15 to D0
(During write)
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
DACKn
tRSD1
tRSD2
RD
(During read)
WRx
(During write)
tWSD1
tWSD2
Note: tRDH is specified from the first negate timing for A21 to A0, RAS, and CAS.
Figure 22.9 DRAM Cycle (Normal Mode, No Waits)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 571 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Tp
CK
Tr
tAD
A21 to A0
tASR
RAS
Tcw1
Tc1
Tc2
tAD
Row
address
tRASD1
tRAH
Column address
tRASD2
tRP
tCASD2
tCASD1
CASx
(During read)
RDWR
(During read)
D15 to D0
(During read)
tAA
tRDS
tCAC
tRDH
tRAC
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
(During write)
tRWD1
tRWD2
RDWR
(During write)
tWDD
tDS
tDH
tWDH
D15 to D0
(During write)
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
DACKn
tRSD1
tRSD2
RD
(During read)
WRx
(During write)
tWSD1
tWSD2
Note: tRDH is specified from the first negate timing for A21 to A0, RAS, and CAS.
Figure 22.10 DRAM Cycle (Normal Mode, 1 Wait, TPC = 0, RCD = 0)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 572 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Tp
CK
Tpw
Tr
tAD
A21 to A0
Tc2
Tcw2
tAD
Column address
Row address
tASR
RAS
Tcw1
Tc1
Trw
tRASD1
tRAH
tRASD2
tRP
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
(During read)
RDWR
(During read)
tRAC
tAA
tCAC
tRDS
tRDH
tCASD1
tCASD2
D15 to D0
(During read)
CASx
(During write)
tRWD1
tRWD2
RDWR
(During write)
tWDD
tDS
tDH
tWDH
D15 to D0
(During write)
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
DACKn
tRSD1
tRSD2
RD
(During read)
tWSD1
tWSD2
WRx
(During write)
Note: tRDH is specified from the first negate timing for A21 to A0, RAS, and CAS.
Figure 22.11 DRAM Cycle (Normal Mode, 2 Waits, TPC = 1, RCD = 1)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 573 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Tp
CK
Tpw
Tr
tAD
A21 to A0
Tcw2
Tcw3
Tc2
tAD
Row address
tASR
RAS
Tcw1
Tc1
Trw
Column address
tRASD1
tRAH
tRP
tRASD2
tCASD2
tCASD1
CASx
(During read)
RDWR
(During read)
tRDS
tCAC
tRAC
tAA
tRDH
D15 to D0
(During read)
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
(During write)
tRWD1
tRWD2
RDWR
(During write)
tWDD
tDS
tDH
tWDH
D15 to D0
(During write)
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
DACKn
tRSD1
tRSD2
RD
(During read)
tWSD1
WRx
(During write)
Note: tRDH is specified from the first negate timing for A21 to A0, RAS, and CAS.
Figure 22.12 DRAM Cycle (Normal Mode, 3 Waits, TPC = 1, RCD = 1)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 574 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
tWSD2
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Tp
CK
Tr
tAD
A21 to A0
tASR
RAS
Tc1
Tcw1
Tcw2
Tc2
Tcwo
tAD
Row
address
tRASD1
tRAH
tRP
Column address
tRASD2
tCASD2
tCASD1
CASx
(During read)
RDWR
(During read)
tRDS
tRDH
tCAC
tAA
tRAC
D15 to D0
(During read)
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
(During write)
tRWD1
tRWD2
RDWR
(During write)
tWDD
tDH
tDS
tWDH
D15 to D0
(During write)
tWTS tWTH tWTS tWTH
WAIT
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
DACKn
RD
(During read)
tRSD1
tRSD2
tWSD1
tWSD2
WRx
(During write)
Note: tRDH is specified from the first negate timing for A21 to A0, RAS, and CAS.
Figure 22.13 DRAM Cycle (Normal Mode, 2 Waits + Wait due to WAIT Signal)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 575 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Tp
CK
Tr
tASR
RAS
Tc2
Tc1
Tc2
tAD
tAD
A21 to A0
Tc1
Row
address
tRASD1
tRAH
Column address
Column address
tRASD2
tRP
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
(During read)
tCASD1
tCASD2
tCP
RDWR
(During read)
tCAC
tAA
tRDS
tRAC
D15 to D0
(During read)
tCAC
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
(During write)
tAA
tRDH
tRDS
tRDH
tCASD2
tCASD1
tCP
tRWD1
tRWD2
tDS
tDH
tRWD2
tRWD1
RDWR
(During write)
tWDD
tDS
tWDH
tWDD
tDH
tWDH
D15 to D0
(During write)
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
DACKn
tRSD1
tRSD2
tRSD1
tRSD2
RD
(During read)
tWSD1
tWSD2
tWSD1
WRx
(During write)
Note: tRDH is specified from the first negate timing for A21 to A0, RAS, and CAS.
Figure 22.14 DRAM Cycle (High-Speed Page Mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 576 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
tWSD2
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
TRp
TRr1
TRr2
CK
TRc
TRc
tRASD1
RAS
tRASD2
tCSR
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
RDWR
Figure 22.15 CAS Before RAS Refresh (TRAS1 = 0, TRAS0 = 0)
TRp
CK
RAS
TRr1
TRr2
TRc
tRASD1
TRcc
tRASD2
tCSR
tCASD1
tCASD2
CASx
RDWR
Figure 22.16 Self Refresh
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 577 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Ta1
CK
Ta2
Ta3
Ta4
T1
TW
TWo
T2
tAD
A21 to A0
tCSD1
tCSD2
CS3
tAHD1
tAHD2
AH
tRSD2
tRSD1
RD
(During read)
tMAD
tRDS
tMAH
tRDH
D15 to D0
(During read)
WRx
(During write)
tWSD1
tMAD
tMAH
tWDD
tWSD2
tWDH
D15 to D0
(During write)
tWTS tWTH tWTS tWTH
WAIT
tDACKD1
tDACKD1
DACKn
Note: tRDH is specified from the first negate timing for A21 to A0, CS3, and RD.
Figure 22.17 Address Data Multiplex I/O Space Cycle (1 Software Wait + 1 External Wait)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 578 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.3.4
Direct Memory Access Controller Timing
Table 22.8 shows the Direct Memory Access Controller Timing.
Table 22.8 Direct Memory Access Controller Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Figure
DREQ0 and DREQ1 setup time
tDRQS
18
⎯
ns
22.18
DREQ0 and DREQ1 hold time
tDRQH
18
⎯
ns
DREQ0 and DREQ1 pulse width tDRQW
1.5
⎯
tcyc
22.19
DRAK output delay time
18
⎯
ns
22.20
tDRAKD
CK
tDRQS
DREQ0,
DREQ1
Level
tDRQS
tDRQH
DREQ0,
DREQ1
Edge
tDRQS
DREQ0,
DREQ1
Level clear
Figure 22.18 DREQ0 and DREQ1 Input Timing (1)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 579 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
CK
DREQ0,
DREQ1
Edge
tDRQW
Figure 22.19 DREQ0 and DREQ1 Input Timing (2)
CK
tDRAKD
tDRAKD
DRAKn
Figure 22.20 DRAK Output Delay Time
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 580 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.3.5
Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit Timing
Table 22.9 shows the Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit Timing
Table 22.9 Multifunction Timer Pulse Unit Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Figure
Output compare output delay time tTOCD
⎯
100
ns
22.21
Input capture input setup time
tTICS
30
⎯
ns
Timer input setup time
tTCKS
35
⎯
ns
Timer clock pulse width (single
edge specification)
tTCKWH/L
1.5
⎯
tcyc
Timer clock pulse width (both
edges specified)
tTCKWH/L
2.5
⎯
tcyc
Timer clock pulse width (phase
measurement mode)
tTCKWH/L
2.5
⎯
tcyc
22.22
CK
tTOCD
Output
compare
output
tTICS
Input
capture
input
Figure 22.21 MTU I/O Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 581 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
CK
tTCKS
tTCKS
TCLKA
to TCLKD
tTCKWL
tTCKWH
Figure 22.22 MTU Clock Input Timing
22.3.6
I/O Port Timing
Table 22.10 shows the I/O Port Timing.
Table 22.10 I/O Port Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Port output data delay time
tPWD
⎯
Port input hold time
tPRH
35
Port input setup time
tPRS
35
⎯
ns
T1
Max
Unit
Figure
100
ns
22.23
⎯
ns
T2
CK
tPRS
tPRH
Port
(Read)
tPWD
Port
(Write)
Figure 22.23 I/O Port I/O Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 582 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.3.7
Watchdog Timer Timing
Table 22.11 shows the Watchdog Timer Timing.
Table 22.11 Watchdog Timer Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Figure
WDTOVF delay time
tWOVD
⎯
100
ns
22.24
CK
tWOVD
tWOVD
WDTOVF
Figure 22.24 Watchdog Timer Timing
22.3.8
Serial Communication Interface Timing
Table 22.12 shows the Serial Communication Interface Timing.
Table 22.12 Serial Communication Interface Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
Item
Symbol
Min
Max
Unit
Figure
Input clock cycle
tscyc
4
⎯
tcyc
22.25
Input clock cycle (clock sync)
tscyc
6
⎯
tcyc
Input clock pulse width
tsckw
0.4
0.6
tscyc
Input clock rise time
tsckr
⎯
1.5
tcyc
Input clock fall time
tsckf
⎯
1.5
tcyc
Transmit data delay time (clock sync) tTXD
⎯
100
ns
Receive data setup time (clock sync)
tRXS
100
⎯
ns
Receive data hold time (clock sync)
tRXH
100
⎯
ns
22.26
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 583 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
tsckw
tsckr
tsckf
SCK0, SCK1
tscyc
Figure 22.25 Input Clock Timing
tscyc
SCK0, SCK1
tTXD
TXD0, TXD1
(Transmit data)
tRXS
tRXH
RXD0, RXD1
(Receive data)
Figure 22.26 SCI I/O Timing (Clock Sync Mode)
22.3.9
High Speed A/D Converter Timing ⎯ SH7014 ⎯
Table 22.13 shows the High-speed A/D Converter Timing.
Table 22.13 High-speed A/D Converter Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AV CC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
Item
A/D conversion start
CKS = 0
delay time
CKS = 1
Input sampling time
CKS = 0
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Figure
tD
1.5
1.5
1.5
tcyc
22.27
1.5
1.5
1.5
20
20
20
40
40
40
42.5
42.5
42.5
82.5
82.5
82.5
tSPL
CKS = 1
A/D conversion time
CKS = 0
tCONV
CKS = 1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 584 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
φ
Address
Write signal
ADST
Sampling
timing
ADF
tD
tSPL
tCP
tCONV
Legend:
tD:
A/D conversion start delay time
Input sampling time
tSPL:
tCONV: A/D conversion time
Operation time
tCP:
Figure 22.27 Analog Conversion Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 585 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.3.10 Mid-speed Converter Timing ⎯ SH7016, SH7017 ⎯
Table 22.14 shows the Mid-speed A/D Converter Timing.
Table 22.14 Mid-speed A/D Converter Timing
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
Item
A/D conversion start
CKS = 0
delay time
CKS = 1
Input sampling time
CKS = 0
Symbol
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Figure
tD
10
⎯
17
tcyc
22.28
6
⎯
9
⎯
64
⎯
⎯
32
⎯
259
⎯
266
131
⎯
134
tSPL
CKS = 1
A/D conversion time
CKS = 0
tCONV
CKS = 1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 586 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
(1)
CK
Address
(2)
Write signal
Input sampling
timing
ADF
tSPL
tD
tCONV
Legend:
(1): Write cycle of ADCSR
(2): Address of ADCSR
tD:
A/D conversion start delay time
tSPL: Input sampling time
tCONV: A/D conversion time
Figure 22.28 Analog Conversion Timing
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 587 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.3.11 Measuring Conditions for AC Characteristics
• Input reference levels:
⎯ High level: 2.2 V
⎯ Low level: 0.8 V
• Output reference levels:
⎯ High level: 2.0 V
⎯ Low level: 0.8 V
IOL
LSI output pin
DUT output
CL
V
Vref
IOH
Note: CL is set with the following pins, including the total capacitance of the
measurement jig, etc:
30 pF:
50 pF:
70 pF:
IOL, IOH:
CK, RAS, CASx, RDWR, CS0 to CS3, AH, DACK0, DACK1
A21 to A0, D15 to D0, RD, WRx
Port output and peripheral module output pins other than the above.
See table 22.3, Permitted Output Current Values.
Figure 22.29 Output Test Circuit
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 588 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
22.4
A/D Converter Characteristics
Tables 22.15 and 22.16 show A/D converter characteristics for the HD6417014 and HD6417014R,
and table 22.17 shows A/D converter characteristics for the SH7016 and SH7017. The
HD6417014R has an absolute error of ±8 LSB or less.
Table 22.15 A/D Converter Characteristics (HD6417014)
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
28.7MHz
Item
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
10
10
10
Bits
⎯
⎯
2.9
μs
Analog input capacitance
⎯
⎯
20
pF
Permitted signal source impedance
⎯
⎯
1
kΩ
⎯
⎯
±8
LSB
⎯
⎯
±8
LSB
⎯
⎯
±8
LSB
⎯
⎯
±0.5
LSB
⎯
⎯
±15
LSB
Resolution
Conversion time*
1
2
Non-linear error*
Offset error*
2
2
Full-scale error*
Quantization error*
2
1
Absolute error*
Notes: 1. CKS = 1
2. Reference values
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 589 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
22. Electrical Characteristics (5 V 28.7 MHz)
Table 22.16 A/D Converter Characteristics (HD6417014R)
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC ±10%, VCC = AVCC = 0 V, Ta = −20 to +75°C
28.7MHz
Item
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
10
10
10
bit
⎯
⎯
2.9
μs
Analog input capacitance
⎯
⎯
20
pF
Permission signal source impedance
⎯
⎯
1
kΩ
Resolution
Conversion time*
1
2
Non-linear error*
Offset error*
2
⎯
⎯
±8
LSB
⎯
⎯
±8
LSB
⎯
⎯
±8
LSB
2
⎯
⎯
±0.5
LSB
1
⎯
⎯
±8
LSB
Full scale error*
Quantize error*
2
Absolute error*
Notes: 1. CKS = 1
2. Reference values
Table 22.17 A/D Converter Characteristics (SH7016, SH7017)
Conditions: VCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = 5.0 V ±10%, AVCC = VCC = 0 V, VSS = AVSS = 0 V,
Ta = −20 to +75°C
28.7MHz
20MHz
Item
min
typ
max
min
typ
max
Resolution
10
10
10
10
10
10
Conversion time (when CKS = 0)
⎯
⎯
9.3
⎯
⎯
13.4* μs
Analog input capacity
⎯
⎯
20
⎯
⎯
20
pF
Permission signal source impedance
⎯
⎯
1
⎯
⎯
1
kΩ
⎯
⎯
±3
⎯
⎯
±3
LSB
⎯
⎯
±3
⎯
⎯
±3
LSB
⎯
⎯
±3
⎯
⎯
±3
LSB
⎯
⎯
±0.5
⎯
⎯
±0.5
LSB
⎯
⎯
±4
⎯
⎯
±4
LSB
1
Non-linearity error*
Offset error*
1
Full scale error*
Quantize error*
1
1
Absolute error
Notes: 1. Reference value
2. 6.7 μs when CKS = 1.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 590 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Unit
bit
2
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
A.1
Addresses
Table A.1
Address
On-Chip I/O Register Addresses
Register
Abbr.
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module
C/A
CHR
PE
O/E
STOP
MP
CKS1
CKS0
SCI
TIE
RIE
TE
RE
MPIE
TEIE
CKE1
CKE0
TDRE
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
TEND
MPB
MPBT
H'FFFF81A6 ⎯
to
H'FFFF81AF
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF81B0 SMR1
C/A
CHR
PE
O/E
STOP
MP
CKS1
CKS0
TIE
RIE
TE
RE
MPIE
TEIE
CKE1
CKE0
TDRE
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
TEND
MPB
MPBT
H'FFFF81B6 ⎯
to
H'FFFF81FF
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8200 ⎯
to
H'FFFF823F
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8240 TSTR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
CST2
CST1
CST0
H'FFFF81A0 SMR0
H'FFFF81A1 BRR0
H'FFFF81A2 SCR0
H'FFFF81A3 TDR0
H'FFFF81A4 SSR0
H'FFFF81A5 RDR0
H'FFFF81B1 BRR1
H'FFFF81B2 SCR1
H'FFFF81B3 TDR1
H'FFFF81B4 SSR1
H'FFFF81B5 RDR1
H'FFFF8241 TSYR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
SYNC2
SYNC1
SYNC0
H'FFFF8242 ⎯
to
H'FFFF825F
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8260 TCR0
CCLR2
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1
CKEG0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
H'FFFF8261 TMDR0
⎯
⎯
BFB
BFA
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
H'FFFF8262 TIOR0H
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
H'FFFF8263 TIOR0L
IOD3
IOD2
IOD1
IOD0
IOC3
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
H'FFFF8264 TIER0
TTGE
⎯
⎯
TCIEV
TGIED
TGIEC
TGIEB
TGIEA
H'FFFF8265 TSR0
⎯
⎯
⎯
TCFV
TGFD
TGFC
TGFB
TGFA
MTU
H'FFFF8266 TCNT0
H'FFFF8267
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 591 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Address
Register
Abbr.
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
H'FFFF8268 TGR0A
MTU
H'FFFF8269
H'FFFF826A TGR0B
H'FFFF826B
H'FFFF826C TGR0C
H'FFFF826D
H'FFFF826E TGR0D
H'FFFF826F
H'FFFF8270 ⎯
to
H'FFFF827F
⎯
H'FFFF8280 TCR1
⎯
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1
CKEG0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
H'FFFF8281 TMDR1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
H'FFFF8282 TIOR1
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
H'FFFF8283 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8284 TIER1
TTGE
⎯
TCIEU
TCIEV
⎯
⎯
TGIEB
TGIEA
H'FFFF8285 TSR1
TCFD
⎯
TCFU
TCFV
⎯
⎯
TGFB
TGFA
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF828C ⎯
to
H'FFFF829F
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF82A0 TCR2
⎯
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1
CKEG0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
H'FFFF82A1 TMDR2
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
H'FFFF82A2 TIOR2
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
H'FFFF82A3 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF82A4 TIER2
TTGE
⎯
TCIEU
TCIEV
⎯
⎯
TGIEB
TGIEA
H'FFFF82A5 TSR2
TCFD
⎯
TCFU
TCFV
⎯
⎯
TGFB
TGFA
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8286 TCNT1
H'FFFF8287
H'FFFF8288 TGR1A
H'FFFF8289
H'FFFF828A TGR1B
H'FFFF828B
H'FFFF82A6 TCNT2
H'FFFF82A7
H'FFFF82A8 TGR2A
H'FFFF82A9
H'FFFF82AA TGR2B
H'FFFF82AB
H'FFFF82AC ⎯
to
H'FFFF8347
Module
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 592 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Address
Register
Abbr.
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
H'FFFF8348 IPRA
Module
INTC
H'FFFF8349
H'FFFF834A IPRB
H'FFFF834B
H'FFFF834C IPRC
H'FFFF834D
H'FFFF834E IPRD
H'FFFF834F
H'FFFF8350 IPRE
H'FFFF8351
H'FFFF8352 IPRF
H'FFFF8353
H'FFFF8354 IPRG
H'FFFF8355
H'FFFF8356 IPRH
H'FFFF8357
H'FFFF8358 ICR
NMIL
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8359
IRQ0S
IRQ1S
IRQ2S
IRQ3S
⎯
⎯
IRQ6S
IRQ7S
H'FFFF835A ISR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
NMIE
H'FFFF835B
IRQ0F
IRQ1F
IRQ2F
IRQ3F
⎯
⎯
IRQ6F
IRQ7F
H'FFFF835C ⎯
to
H'FFFF8381
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8382 PADRL
PA15DR
PA14DR*1 PA13DR*1 PA12DR*1 PA11DR*1 PA10DR*1 PA9DR
PA8DR
H'FFFF8383
PA7DR
PA6DR
PA5DR
PA4DR
PA3DR
PA2DR
PA1DR
PA0DR
H'FFFF8384 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8385 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8386 PAIORL
PA15IOR PA14IOR PA13IOR PA12IOR PA11IOR PA10IOR PA9IOR*1 PA8IOR*1
*1
*1
*1
*1
*1
H'FFFF8387
PA7IOR
PA6IOR
PA5IOR
PA4IOR
PA3IOR
PA2IOR
PA1IOR
PA0IOR
H'FFFF8388 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8389 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
I/O
PFC
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 593 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Address
Register
Abbr.
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module
H'FFFF838A ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
PFC
H'FFFF838B ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF838C PACRL1
⎯
PA15MD
⎯
PA14MD
*1
⎯
PA13MD
1
*
⎯
PA12MD
1
*
H'FFFF838D
⎯
PA11MD
*1
⎯
PA10MD
1
*
PA9MD1
PA9MD0
PA8MD1
PA8MD0
H'FFFF838E PACRL2
PA7MD1
PA7MD0
PA6MD1
PA6MD0
PA5MD1
PA5MD0
⎯
PA4MD
H'FFFF838F
⎯
PA3MD
PA2MD1
PA2MD0
⎯
PA1MD
⎯
PA0MD
H'FFFF8390 PBDR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
PB9DR
PB8DR
H'FFFF8391
H'FFFF8392 PCDR*
2
H'FFFF8393
1
I/O
1
PB7DR
PB6DR
PB5DR
PB4DR
PB3DR
PB2DR
PB1DR*
PB0DR*
PC15DR
PC14DR
PC13DR
PC12DR
PC11DR
PC10DR
PC9DR
PC8DR
PC7DR
PC6DR
PC5DR
PC4DR
PC3DR
PC2DR
PC1DR
PC0DR
PB8IOR
H'FFFF8394 PBIOR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
PB9IOR
H'FFFF8395
PB7IOR
PB6IOR
PB5IOR
PB4IOR
PB3IOR
PB2IOR
PB1IOR*1 PB0IOR*1
H'FFFF8396 PCIOR*2
PC15IOR PC14IOR PC13IOR PC12IOR PC11IOR PC10IOR PC9IOR
PC8IOR
H'FFFF8397
PC7IOR
PC6IOR
PC5IOR
PC4IOR
PC3IOR
PC2IOR
PC1IOR
PC0IOR
H'FFFF8398 PBCR1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8399
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
PB9MD1
PB9MD0
PB8MD1
PB8MD0
H'FFFF839A PBCR2
PB7MD1
PB7MD0
PB6MD1
PB6MD0
PB5MD1
PB5MD0
PB4MD1
H'FFFF839B
PB3MD1
PB3MD0
PB2MD1
PB2MD0
⎯
PB1MD*1 ⎯
PB0MD*1
PB4MD0
H'FFFF839C PCCR*2
PC15MD
PC14MD
PC13MD
PC12MD
PC11MD
PC10MD
PC9MD
PC8MD
H'FFFF839D
PC7MD
PC6MD
PC5MD
PC4MD
PC3MD
PC2MD
PC1MD
PC0MD
H'FFFF839E ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF839F ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83A0 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83A1 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83A2 PDDRL*2
PD15DR
PD14DR
PD13DR
PD12DR
PD11DR
PD10DR
PD9DR
PD8DR
H'FFFF83A3
PD7DR
PD6DR
PD5DR
PD4DR
PD3DR
PD2DR
PD1DR
PD0DR
H'FFFF83A4 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83A5 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83A6 PDIORL*2 PD15IOR PD14IOR PD13IOR PD12IOR PD11IOR PD10IOR PD9IOR
PD8IOR
H'FFFF83A7
PD7IOR
PD6IOR
PD5IOR
PD4IOR
PD3IOR
PD2IOR
PD1IOR
PD0IOR
H'FFFF83A8 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83A9 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83AA ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83AB ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 594 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
PFC
I/O
PFC
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Address
Register
Abbr.
2
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module
PFC
H'FFFF83AC PDCRL*
PD15MD
PD14MD
PD13MD
PD12MD
PD11MD
PD10MD
PD9MD
PD8MD
H'FFFF83AD
PD7MD
PD6MD
PD5MD
PD4MD
PD3MD
PD2MD
PD1MD
PD0MD
H'FFFF83AE ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83AF ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83B0 PEDR
PE15DR
PE14DR
PE13DR
PE12DR
PE11DR
PE10DR
PE9DR
PE8DR
H'FFFF83B1
PE7DR
PE6DR
PE5DR
PE4DR
PE3DR
PE2DR
PE1DR
PE0DR
H'FFFF83B2 PFDR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83B3
PF7DR
PF6DR
PF5DR
PF4DR
PF3DR
PF2DR
PF1DR
PF0DR
H'FFFF83B4 PEIOR
PE15IOR PE14IOR PE13IOR PE12IOR PE11IOR PE10IOR PE9IOR
PE8IOR
H'FFFF83B5
PE7IOR
PE6IOR
PE5IOR
PE4IOR
PE3IOR
PE2IOR
PE1IOR
PE0IOR
H'FFFF83B6 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83B7 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83B8 PECR1
PE15MD1 PE15MD0 PE14MD1 PE14MD0 ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83B9
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
I/O
PFC
H'FFFF83BA PECR2
⎯
PE7MD
⎯
PE6MD
⎯
PE5MD
⎯
PE4MD
H'FFFF83BB
PE3MD1
PE3MD0
PE2MD1
PE2MD0
PE1MD1
PE1MD0
PE0MD1
PE0MD0
H'FFFF83BC ⎯
to
H'FFFF83CF
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83D0 CMSTR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
CMT
H'FFFF83D1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
STR1
STR0
H'FFFF83D2 CMCSR0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83D3
CMF
CMIE
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
CKS1
CKS0
H'FFFF83D8 CMCSR1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83D9
CMF
CMIE
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
CKS1
CKS0
H'FFFF83DE ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83DF ⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83D4 CMCNT0
H'FFFF83D5
H'FFFF83D6 CMCOR0
H'FFFF83D7
H'FFFF83DA CMCNT1
H'FFFF83DB
H'FFFF83DC CMCOR1
H'FFFF83DD
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 595 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Address
Register
Abbr.
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
H'FFFF83E0 ADCSR
ADF
H'FFFF83E1 ADCR
⎯
H'FFFF83E2 ⎯
to
H'FFFF83EF
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module
ADIE
ADST
CKS
GRP
CH2
PWR
TRGS1
TRGS0
SCAN
DSMP
CH1
CH0
BUFE1
BUFE0
A/D
(High
speed)
(SH7014)
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF83F0 ADDRA
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD9
AD8
H'FFFF83F1
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
H'FFFF83F2 ADDRB
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD9
AD8
H'FFFF83F3
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
H'FFFF83F4 ADDRC
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD9
AD8
H'FFFF83F5
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
H'FFFF83F6 ADDRD
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD9
AD8
H'FFFF83F7
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
H'FFFF83F8 ADDRE
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD9
AD8
H'FFFF83F9
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
H'FFFF83FA ADDRF
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD9
AD8
H'FFFF83FB
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
H'FFFF83FC ADDRG
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD9
AD8
H'FFFF83FD
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
H'FFFF83FE ADDRH
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD9
AD8
H'FFFF83FF
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
AD1
AD0
H'FFFF8400 ⎯
to
H'FFFF841F
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8420 ADDRA
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
H'FFFF8421
AD1
AD0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8422 ADDRB
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
H'FFFF8423
AD1
AD0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AD2
H'FFFF8424 ADDRC
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
H'FFFF8425
AD1
AD0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8426 ADDRD
AD9
AD8
AD7
AD6
AD5
AD4
AD3
AD2
H'FFFF8427
AD1
AD0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8428 ADCSR
ADF
ADIE
ADST
SCAN
CKS
CH2
CH1
CH0
H'FFFF8429 ADCR
TRGE
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF842A ⎯
to
H'FFFF857F
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 596 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
A/D
(Midspeed)
(SH7016
/17)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Bit Names
Register
Abbr.
Bit 7
Bit 6
H'FFFF8580 FLMCR1
FWE
SWE
ESU1
PSU1
EV1
PV1
H'FFFF8581 FLMCR2
FLER
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8582 EBR1
EB7
EB6
EB5
EB4
EB3
EB2
EB1
EB0
H'FFFF8583 ⎯
to
H'FFFF860F
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8610 TCSR
OVF
WT/IT
TME
⎯
⎯
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
Address
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module
E1
P1
⎯
⎯
FLASH
(F-ZTAT
version
only)
WDT
H'FFFF8610 TCNT*3
H'FFFF8611 TCNT*
4
RSTE
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8613 RSTCSR* WOVF
RSTE
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8614 SBYCR
SBY
HIZ
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Powerdown
state
H'FFFF8615 ⎯
to
H'FFFF861F
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
BSC
H'FFFF8620 BCR1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
IOE
H'FFFF8621
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
A3SZ
A2SZ
A1SZ
A0SZ
H'FFFF8622 BCR2
IW31
IW30
IW21
IW20
IW11
IW10
IW01
IW00
H'FFFF8623
CW3
CW2
CW1
CW0
SW3
SW2
SW1
SW0
H'FFFF8624 WCR1
W33
W32
W31
W30
W23
W22
W21
W20
H'FFFF8625
W13
W12
W11
W10
W03
W02
W01
W00
H'FFFF8626 WCR2
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8627
⎯
⎯
DDW1
DDW0
DSW3
DSW2
DSW1
DSW0
H'FFFF8628 RAMER
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8629
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
RAMS
RAM1
RAM0
FLASH
(F-ZTAT
version
only)
H'FFFF862A DCR
TPC
RCD
TRAS1
TRAS0
DWW1
DWW0
DWR1
DWR0
BSC
H'FFFF862B
DIW
⎯
BE
RASD
⎯
SZ0
AMX1
AMX0
H'FFFF862C RTCSR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF862D
⎯
CMF
CMIE
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
RFSH
RMD
H'FFFF862E RTCNT
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8612 RSTCSR*3 WOVF
4
H'FFFF862F
H'FFFF8630 RTCOR
H'FFFF8631
H'FFFF8632 ⎯
to
H'FFFF86AF
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 597 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Address
Register
Abbr.
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module
H'FFFF86B0 DMAOR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF86B1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
AE
⎯
⎯
DMAC
NMIF
DME
H'FFFF86B2 ⎯
to
H'FFFF86BF
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF86CC CHCR0
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF86CD
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
RL
AM
AL
H'FFFF86CE
DM1
DM0
SM1
SM0
RS3
RS2
RS1
RS0
H'FFFF86CF
⎯
DS
TM
TS1
TS0
IE
TE
DE
H'FFFF86DC CHCR1
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF86DD
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
RL
AM
AL
H'FFFF86DE
DM1
DM0
SM1
SM0
RS3
RS2
RS1
RS0
H'FFFF86DF
⎯
DS
TM
TS1
TS0
IE
TE
DE
H'FFFF86C0 SAR0
H'FFFF86C1
H'FFFF86C2
H'FFFF86C3
H'FFFF86C4 DAR0
H'FFFF86C5
H'FFFF86C6
H'FFFF86C7
H'FFFF86C8 DMATCR0
H'FFFF86C9
H'FFFF86CA
H'FFFF86CB
H'FFFF86D0 SAR1
H'FFFF86D1
H'FFFF86D2
H'FFFF86D3
H'FFFF86D4 DAR1
H'FFFF86D5
H'FFFF86D6
H'FFFF86D7
H'FFFF86D8 DMATCR1
H'FFFF86D9
H'FFFF86DA
H'FFFF86DB
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 598 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Address
Register
Abbr.
Bit Names
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Module
H'FFFF87E0 ⎯
to
H'FFFF873F
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
H'FFFF8740 CCR
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
CAC
H'FFFF8741
⎯
⎯
⎯
CEDRAM CECS3
CECS2
CECS1
CECS0
H'FFFF8742 ⎯
to
H'FFFF87FF
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
⎯
Notes: 1.
2.
3.
4.
⎯
Reserved bit in the SH7014.
In the SH7014, this address is reserved and must not be accessed.
Write address.
Read address. For details, see section 13.2.4, Notes on Register Access, in section 13,
Watchdog Timer.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 599 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
A.2
Functions
Start address
Register acronym
Access size
Module
SCI
H'FFFF81A0 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF81B0 (Channel 1)
Serial Mode Register (SMR)
Bit
Item
Register outline
Bit Nmae
Initial value
R/W
Bit
Bit functions
7
C/A
0
R/W
6
CHR
0
R/W
5
PE
0
R/W
Value
0
1
0
6 Character Length (CHR)
1
0
5 Parity Enable (PE)
1
0
4 Parity Mode (O/E)
1
0
3 Stop Bit Length (STOP)
1
0
Multiprocessor
Mode
(MP)
2
1
0 0
1, 0 Clock Select 1 and 0
1
(CKS1 and CKS0)
1 0
1
7
8/16
Name
Communication Mode
(C/A)
Bit numbers
Bit acronym
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 600 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
4
O/E
0
R/W
3
STOP
0
R/W
2
MP
0
R/W
Description
Asynchronous mode
Clock synchronous mode
8-bit data
7-bit data
Parity bit not added or checked
Parity bit added and checked
Even parity
Odd parity
1 stop bit
2 stop bits
Multiprocessor function disabled
Multiprocessor format selected
φ/4
φ/16
φ/64
φ/256
1
CKS1
0
R/W
0
CKS0
0
R/W
(Initial value)
(Initial value)
(Initial value)
(Initial value)
(Initial value)
(Initial value)
(Initial value)
Initial bit values
Descriptions of bit settings
(When two or more bits are
described as a set, the higher bits
are on the left and the lower bits
on the right.)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
INTC
Interrupt Priority Register A (IPRA)
H'FFFF8348
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit Name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Bit
Name
Description
15 to 12
(IRQ0 priority level setting)
Sets the IRQ0 priority level
11 to 8
(IRQ1 priority level setting)
Sets the IRQ1 priority level
7 to 4
(IRQ2 priority level setting)
Sets the IRQ2 priority level
3 to 0
(IRQ3 priority level setting)
Sets the IRQ3 priority level
Interrupt Priority Register B (IPRB)
H'FFFF834A
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit Name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit
Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Description
7 to 4
(IRQ6 priority level setting)
Sets the IRQ6 priority level
3 to 0
(IRQ7 priority level setting)
Sets the IRQ7 priority level
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 601 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
INTC
Interrupt Priority Register C (IPRC)
H'FFFF834C
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Bit
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Name
Description
15 to 12
(DMAC0 priority level setting)
Sets the DMAC0 priority level
11 to 8
(DMAC1 priority level setting)
Sets the DMAC1 priority level
Interrupt Priority Register D (IPRD)
H'FFFF834E
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit Name
Initial value
R/W
Bit
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Name
Description
15 to 12
(MTU0 priority level setting)
Sets the MTU0 priority level
11 to 8
(MTU0 priority level setting)
Sets the MTU0 priority level
7 to 4
(MTU1 priority level setting)
Sets the MTU1 priority level
3 to 0
(MTU1 priority level setting)
Sets the MTU1 priority level
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 602 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
INTC
Interrupt Priority Register E (IPRE)
H'FFFF8350
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit Name
Initial value
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Name
Description
15 to 12
(MTU2 priority level setting)
Sets the MTU2 priority level
11 to 8
(MTU2 priority level setting)
Sets the MTU2 priority level
Interrupt Priority Register F (IPRF)
H'FFFF8352
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit Name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit
Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Description
7 to 4
(SCI0 priority level setting)
Sets the SCI0 priority level
3 to 0
(SCI1 priority level setting)
Sets the SCI1 priority level
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 603 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
INTC
Interrupt Priority Register G (IPRG)
H'FFFF8354
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
Bit Name
Initial value
R/W
0
0
0
10
9
8
―
―
―
―
0
R/W R/W R/W R/W
Bit
15 to 12
11
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Name
Description
(A/D priority level setting)
Sets the A/D priority level
7 to 4
(CMT0 priority level setting)
Sets the CMT0 priority level
3 to 0
(CMT1 priority level setting)
Sets the CMT1 priority level
Interrupt Priority Register H (IPRH)
H'FFFF8356
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
Bit Name
Initial value
R/W
Bit
15 to 12
0
0
0
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
0
R/W R/W R/W R/W
Name
(WDT and BSC priority level setting)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 604 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Description
Set the WDT and BSC priority level
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
INTC
Interrupt Control Register (ICR)
H'FFFF8358
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit Name
NMIL
―
―
―
―
―
―
NMIE
Initial value
*
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit Name
IRQ0S
IRQ1S
IRQ2S
IRQ3S
―
―
IRQ6S
IRQ7S
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
Note:
*
Bit
15
8
7 to 4,
1, 0
When NMI input is high: 1; when NMI input is low: 0
Name
NMI Input Level (NMIL)
Value
Description
0
NMI input level is low
1
NMI input level is high
NMI Edge Select (NMIE)
0
Interrupt request is detected on falling edge of NMI input
(initial value)
1
Interrupt request is detected on rising edge of NMI input
IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7
Sense Select (IRQ0S to IRQ3S,
IRQ6S, IRQ7S)
0
Interrupt request is detected on low level of IRQ input
(initial value)
1
Interrupt request is detected on falling edge of IRQ input
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 605 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
INTC
IRQ Status Register (ISR)
H'FFFF835A
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
IRQ0F
IRQ1F
IRQ2F
IRQ3F
―
―
IRQ6F
IRQ7F
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
Value
7 to 4,
1, 0
IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7
Flags (IRQ0F to IRQ3F, IRQ6F,
IRQ7F)
0
Detection
Setting
Description
Level
detection
No IRQn interrupt request exists.
Edge
detection
No IRQn interrupt request was detected.
(initial value)
Clear condition: When IRQn input is high
level
Clear conditions:
1. When a 0 is written after reading IRQnF
= 1 status
2. When IRQn interrupt exception
processing has been execute
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 606 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Level
detection
An IRQn interrupt request exists.
Edge
detection
An IRQn interrupt request was detected.
Set condition: When IRQn input is low level
Set condition: When a falling edge occurs at
an IRQn input
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
CAC
Cache Control Register (CCR)
H'FFFF8740
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
CEDRAM
CECS3
CECS2
CECS1
CECS0
Initial value
*
*
*
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note:
Bit
4
3
2
1
0
*
Undefined
Name
Value
Description
DRAM Space Cache Enable
(CEDRAM)
0
DRAM space cache disabled
1
DRAM space cache enabled
CS3 Space Cache Enable
(CECS3)
0
CS3 space cache disabled
1
CS3 space cache enabled
CS2 Space Cache Enable
(CECS2)
0
CS2 space cache disabled
1
CS2 space cache enabled
CS1 Space Cache Enable
(CECS1)
0
CS1 space cache disabled
1
CS1 space cache enabled
CS0 Space Cache Enable
(CECS0)
0
CS0 space cache disabled
1
CS0 space cache enabled
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 607 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
BSC
Bus Control Register 1 (BCR1)
H'FFFF8620
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
IOE
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
―
A3SZ
A2SZ
A1SZ
A0SZ
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
R/W
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
8
3
2
1
0
Note:
Name
Multiplex I/O Enable (IOE)
Value
Description
0
CS3 space is ordinary space
1
CS3 space is address/data multiplex I/O space
(initial value)
CS3 Space Size Specification
(A3SZ)
0
Byte (8-bit) size
1
Word (16-bit) size
CS2 Space Size Specification
(A2SZ)
0
Byte (8-bit) size
1
Word (16-bit) size
CS1 Space Size Specification
(A1SZ)
0
Byte (8-bit) size
1
Word (16-bit) size
CS0 Space Size Specification
(A0SZ)
0
Byte (8-bit) size
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
1
Word (16-bit) size
(initial value)
A0SZ is effective only in on-chip ROM effective mode. In on-chip ROM ineffective mode, the CS0
space bus size is specified by the mode pin.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 608 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
BSC
Bus Control Register 2 (BCR2)
H'FFFF8622
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
IW31
IW30
IW21
IW20
IW11
IW10
IW01
IW00
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
CW3
CW2
CW1
CW0
SW3
SW2
SW1
SW0
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
15 to 8
Name
Idles between
Cycles (IW31,
IW30, IW21, IW20,
IW11, IW10, IW01,
IW00)
Value
IW31,
IW30
0
1
IW21,
IW20
IW11,
IW10
No idle cycle after accessing CS3 space
1
Inserts one idle cycle
0
Inserts two idle cycles
1
Inserts three idle cycles
0
0
No idle cycle after accessing CS2 space
1
Inserts one idle cycle
1
0
Inserts two idle cycles
1
Inserts three idle cycles
0
No idle cycle after accessing CS1 space
1
Inserts one idle cycle
0
1
IW01,
IW00
Description
0
0
Inserts two idle cycles
1
Inserts three idle cycles
0
0
No idle cycle after accessing CS0 space
1
Inserts one idle cycle
1
0
Inserts two idle cycles
1
Inserts three idle cycles
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Idle Specification for
Continuous Access (CW3)
0
No CS3 space continuous access idle cycles
1
One CS3 space continuous access idle cycle (initial value)
Idle Specification for
Continuous Access (CW2)
0
No CS2 space continuous access idle cycles
1
One CS2 space continuous access idle cycle (initial value)
5
Idle Specification for
Continuous Access (CW1)
0
No CS1 space continuous access idle cycles
1
One CS1 space continuous access idle cycle (initial value)
4
Idle Specification for
Continuous Access (CW0)
0
No CS0 space continuous access idle cycles
1
One CS0 space continuous access idle cycle (initial value)
3
CS Assert Extension
Specification (SW3)
0
No CS3 space CS assert extension
1
CS3 space CS assert extension
7
6
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 609 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
BSC
Bit
2
1
0
Name
Value
Description
CS Assert Extension
Specification (SW2)
0
No CS2 space CS assert extension
1
CS2 space CS assert extension
CS Assert Extension
Specification (SW1)
0
No CS1 space CS assert extension
1
CS1 space CS assert extension
CS Assert Extension
Specification (SW0)
0
No CS0 space CS assert extension
1
CS0 space CS assert extension
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 610 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
BSC
Wait Control Register 1 (WCR1)
H'FFFF8624
8/16/32
Bit
Item
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
Bit
15 to 12
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
W33 W32 W31 W30 W23 W22 W21 W20 W13 W12 W11 W10 W03 W02 W01 W00
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Name
CS3 Space Wait
Specification (W33 to W30)
Value
Description
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait external wait input enabled
1
1
1
1
15 wait external wait input enabled (initial value)
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait external wait input enabled
…
11 to 8
CS2 Space Wait
Specification (W23 to W20)
…
7 to 4
CS1 Space Wait
Specification (W13 to W10)
1
1
1
1
15 wait external wait input enabled (initial value)
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait external wait input enabled
1
1
1
1
15 wait external wait input enabled (initial value)
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait external wait input enabled
1
1
15 wait external wait input enabled (initial value)
…
3 to 0
CS0 Space Wait
Specification (W03 to W00)
…
1
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 611 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
BSC
Wait Control Register 2 (WCR2)
H'FFFF8626
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
DDW1
DDW0
DSW3
DSW2
DSW1
DSW0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
5, 4
DRAM Space DMA Single
Address Mode Access Wait
Specification (DDW1, DDW0)
3 to 0
Value
CS Space DMA Single
Address Mode Access Wait
Specification (DSW3 to
DSW0)
Description
0
0
2-cycle (no wait) external wait disabled
(initial value)
0
1
3-cycle (1 wait) external wait disabled
1
0
4-cycle (2 wait) external wait enabled
1
1
5-cycle (3 wait) external wait enabled
0
0
0
0
No wait (external wait input disabled)
0
0
0
1
1 wait (external wait input enabled)
1
1
15 wait (external wait input enabled)
(initial value)
…
1
1
DRAM Area Control Register (DCR)
H'FFFF862A
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
TPC
RCD
TRAS1
TRAS0
DWW1
DWW0
DWR1
DWR0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
DIW
―
BE
RASD
―
SZ0
AMX1
AMX0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 612 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
BSC
Bit
15
14
13, 12
11, 10
9, 8
7
5
4
2
1, 0
Name
Value
Description
RAS Precharge Cycle Count
(TPC)
0
1.5 cycles
1
2.5 cycles
RAS—CAS Delay Cycle
Count (RCD)
0
1 cycle
1
2 cycles
CAS—Before-RAS Refresh
RAS Assert Cycle Count
(TRAS1 and TRAS0)
DRAM Write Cycle Wait Count
(DWW1 and DWW0)
DRAM Read Cycle Wait Count
(DWR1 and DWR0)
0
2.5 cycles
0
1
3.5 cycles
1
0
4.5 cycles
1
1
5.5 cycles
0
0
2-cycle (no wait) external wait disabled
0
1
3-cycle (1 wait) external wait disabled
1
0
4-cycle (2 wait) external wait enabled
1
1
5-cycle (3 wait) external wait enabled
0
0
2-cycle (no wait) external wait disabled
0
1
3-cycle (1 wait) external wait disabled
1
0
4-cycle (2 wait) external wait enabled
1
1
5-cycle (3 wait) external wait enabled
Burst Enable (BE)
RAS Down Mode (RASD)
DRAM Bus Width
Specification (SZ0)
DRAM Address Multiplex
(AMX1 and AMX0)
(initial value)
0
DRAM Idle Cycle Count (DIW)
0
No idle cycles
1
1 idle cycle
0
Burst disabled
1
DRAM high-speed page mode enabled
0
Access DRAM by RAS up mode
1
Access DRAM by RAS down mode
0
Byte (8-bit)
1
Word (16-bit)
0
0
9 bit
0
1
10 bit
1
0
11 bit
1
1
12 bit
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 613 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
BSC
Refresh Timer Control/Status Register (RTCSR)
H'FFFF862C
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
CMF
CMIE
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
RFSH
RMD
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
6
5
4 to 2
Name
Compare Match Flag (CMF)
Compare Match Interrupt
Enable (CMIE)
Clock Select (CKS2 to CKS0)
0
Value
Description
0
Clear condition: After RTCSR is read when CMF is
1, 0 is written in CMF
(initial value)
1
Set condition: RTCNT = RTCOR
Note: When both RTCNT and RTCOR are in an
initialized state (when values have not been
rewritten since initialization, and RTCNT has
not had its value changed due to a countup),
RTCNT and RTCOR match, as both are
H'0000, but in this case CMF is not set.
0
Disables an interrupt request caused by CMF
(initial value)
1
Enables an interrupt request caused by CMF
0
1
1
1
0
Refresh Control (RFSH)
Refresh Mode (RMD)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 614 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
0
Stops count-up
1
φ/2
0
φ/8
1
φ/32
0
0
φ/128
1
φ/512
1
0
φ/2048
1
φ/4096
0
Do not refresh DRAM
1
Refresh DRAM
0
CAS-before-RAS refresh
1
Self-refresh
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
BSC
Refresh Timer Counter (RTCNT)
H'FFFF862E
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Refresh Time Constant Register (RTCOR)
H'FFFF8630
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 615 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
DMAC
H'FFFF86C0 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF86D0 (Channel 1)
DMA Source Address Registers 0, 1 (SAR0, SAR1)
16/32
Bit
Item
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
...................................
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
0
...................................
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
DMA Destination Address Registers 0, 1
(DAR0, DAR1)
...................................
―
...................................
R/W
H'FFFF86C4 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF86D4 (Channel 1)
16/32
Bit
Item
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
...................................
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
0
...................................
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
DMA Transfer Count Registers 0, 1
(DMATCR0, DMATCR1)
...................................
―
...................................
R/W
H'FFFF86C8 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF86D8 (Channel 1)
16/32
Bit
Item
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 616 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
DMAC
DMA Channel Control Registers 0, 1
(CHCR0, CHCR1)
H'FFFF86CC (Channel 0)
H'FFFF86DC (Channel 1)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
RL
AM
AL
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
DM1
DM0
SM1
SM0
RS3
RS2
RS1
RS0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
DS
TM
TS1
TS0
IE
TE
DE
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/(W)
R/W
Bit
18
17
16
15, 14
Name
Value
Request Check Level (RL)
Acknowledge Mode (AM)
Acknowledge Level (AL)
Destination Address Mode 1, 0
(DM1 and DM0)
0
1
Description
0
Output DRAK with active high
1
Output DRAK with active low
0
Outputs DACK during read cycle
1
Outputs DACK during write cycle
0
Active high output
1
Active low output
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
0
Destination address fixed
1
Destination address incremented (+1 during 8-bit
transfer, +2 during 16-bit transfer, +4 during 32-bit
transfer)
(initial value)
0
Destination address decremented (–1 during 8-bit
transfer, –2 during 16-bit transfer, –4 during 32-bit
transfer)
1
(Setting prohibited)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 617 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
DMAC
Bit
13, 12
Name
Value
Source Address Mode 1, 0
(SM1 and SM0)
0
1
Description
0
Source address fixed
1
Source address incremented (+1 during 8-bit
transfer, +2 during 16-bit transfer, +4 during
32-bit transfer)
0
Source address decremented (–1 during 8-bit
transfer, –2 during 16-bit transfer, –4 during
32-bit transfer)
1
11 to 8
Resource Select 3 to 0
(RS3 to RS0)
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
6
5
4, 3
DREQ Select (DS)
Transfer Mode (TM)
Transfer Size 1, 0 (TS1, TS0)
Interrupt Enable (IE)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 618 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
External request, dual address mode
(initial value)
1
(Prohibited)
0
External request, single address mode.
External address space → external device.
1
External request, single address mode.
External device → external address space.
0
Auto-request
1
(Prohibited)
0
MTUTGI0A
1
MTUTGI1A
0
MTUTGI2A
1
(Prohibited)
0
(Prohibited)
1
A/D ADI
0
SCI0TXI0
1
RXI0
0
SCI1TXI1
1
RXI1
Low-level detection
1
Falling-edge detection
0
Cycle steal mode
1
Burst mode
1
2
(Setting prohibited)
0
0
0
(initial value)
0
Specifies byte size (8 bits)
1
Specifies word size (16 bits)
0
Specifies longword size (32 bits)
1
(Prohibited)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
0
Interrupt request not generated after
DMATCR—specified transfer count
(initial value)
1
Interrupt request enabled on completion of
DMATCR specified number of transfers
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
DMAC
Bit
Name
1
Value
Description
0
DMATCR—specified transfer count not ended
(initial value)
Clear condition: 0 write after TE = 1 read,
Power-on reset, standby mode
1
DMATCR specified number of transfers
completed
0
Operation of the corresponding channel
disabled
(initial value)
1
Operation of the corresponding channel
enabled
Transfer End Flag (TE)
0
DMAC Enable (DE)
DMAC Operation Register (DMAOR)
H'FFFF86B0
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
AE
NMIF
DME
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R/(W)
R/(W)*
R/W*
Note:
Bit
2
1
0
*
0 write only is valid after 1 is read.
Name
Address Error Flag (AE)
NMI Flag (NMIF)
DMAC Master Enable (DME)
Value
Description
0
No address error, DMA transfer enabled (initial value)
Clearing condition: Write AE = 0 after reading AE = 1
1
Address error, DMA transfer disabled
Setting condition: Address error due to DMAC
0
No NMI interrupt, DMA transfer enabled (initial value)
Clearing condition: Write NMIF = 0 after reading NMIF
=1
1
NMI has occurred, DMC transfer prohibited
Set condition: NMI interrupt occurrence
0
Disable operation on all channels
1
Enable operation on all channels
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 619 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Control Register 0 (TCR0)
H'FFFF8260
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
CCLR2
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1
CKEG0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
7 to 5
Name
Counter Clear 2 to 0
(CCLR2 to CCLR0)
Value
0
0
1
0
1
1
4, 3
Clock Edge 1, 0
(CKEG1 and CKEG0)*4
0
Timer Prescaler 2 to 0
(TPSC2 to TPSC0)
0
0
1
1
0
1
Notes:
TCNT clear disabled
1
TCNT is cleared by TGRA compare-match or input
captur
(initial value)
0
TCNT is cleared by TGRB compare-match or input
capture
1
Synchronizing clear: TCNT is cleared in synchronization
with clear of other channel counters operating in sync.*1
0
TCNT clear disabled
1
TCNT is cleared by TGRC compare-match or input
capture*2
0
TCNT is cleared by TGRD compare-match or input
capture*2
1
Synchronizing clear: TCNT is cleared in synchronization
with clear of other channel counters operating in sync*1
0
Count on rising edges
1
Count on falling edges
(initial value)
X*3 Count on both rising and falling edges
1
2 to 0
Description
0
0
Internal clock: count with φ/1
1
Internal clock: count with φ/4
0
Internal clock: count with φ/16
1
Internal clock: count with φ/64
0
External clock: count with the TCLKA pin input
(initial value)
1
External clock: count with the TCLKB pin input
0
External clock: count with the TCLKC pin input
1
External clock: count with the TCLKD pin input
1. Setting the SYNC bit of the TSYR to 1 sets the synchronization.
2. When TGRC or TGRD are functioning as buffer registers, TCNT is not cleared because the buffer
registers have priority and compare-match/input captures do not occur.
3. X: 0 or 1, don't care.
4. Internal clock edge selection is effective when the input clock is φ/4 or slower. These settings are
ignored when φ/1, or the overflow/underflow of another channel is selected for the input clock.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 620 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Mode Register 0 (TMDR0)
H'FFFF8261
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
BFB
BFA
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
5
4
3 to 0
Name
Value
Buffer Operation B (BFB)
Buffer Operation A (BFA)
Modes 3 to 0 (MD3 to MD0)
0
0
TGRB operates normally
1
TGRB and TGRD buffer operation
0
TGRA operates normally
1
TGRA and TGRC buffer operation
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
Description
0
0
1
0
Normal operation
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
PWM mode 1
1
PWM mode 2
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 621 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer I/O Control Register 0H (TIOR0H)
H'FFFF8262
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
7 to 4
I/O Control B3 to B0
(IOB3 to IOB0)
Value
0
0
0
Description
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on comparematch
0
1
1
TGR0B is Output disabled
(initial value)
an output Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
compare
Output 1 on compare-match
register
Toggle output on comparematch
0
TGR0B is Capture input
source is the
an input
TIOC0B pin
capture
register
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 622 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Capture input
source is
channel 1/
count clock
Input capture on TCNT1
count up/count down
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Bit
Name
3 to 0
I/O Control A3 to A0
(IOA3 to IOA0)
Value
0
0
0
Description
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on comparematch
0
1
1
TGR0A is Output disabled
(initial value)
an output Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
compare
Output 1 on compare-match
register
Toggle output on comparematch
0
TGR0A is Capture input
source is the
an input
TIOC0A pin
capture
register
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
Capture input
source is
channel 1/
count clock
Input capture on TCNT1
count up/count down
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 623 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer I/O Control Register 0L (TIOR0L)
H'FFFF8263
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
IOD3
IOD2
IOD1
IOD0
IOC3
IOC2
IOC1
IOC0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
7 to 4
I/O Control D3 to D0
(IOD3 to IOD0)
Value
0
0
0
Description
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on comparematch
0
1
1
TGR0D is Output disabled
(initial value)
an output Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
compare
Output 1 on compare-match
register
Toggle output on comparematch
0
TGR0D is Capture input
source is the
an input
TIOC0D pin
capture
register
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 624 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Capture input
source is
channel 1/
count clock
Input capture on TCNT1
count up/count down
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Bit
Name
3 to 0
I/O Control C3 to C0
(IOC3 to IOC0)
Value
0
0
0
Description
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on comparematch
0
1
1
TGR0C is Output disabled
(initial value)
an output Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
compare
Output 1 on compare-match
register
Toggle output on comparematch
0
TGR0C is Capture input
source is the
an input
TIOC0C pin
capture
register
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
Notes:
0
Capture input
source is
channel 1/
count clock
Input capture on TCNT1
count up/count down
1
1. When the BFB bit of TMDR0 is set to 1 and TGR0D is being used as a buffer register, these
settings become ineffective and input capture/output compares do not occur.
2. When the BFA bit of TMDR0 is set to 1 and TGR0C is being used as a buffer register, these
settings become ineffective and input capture/output compares do not occur.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 625 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Interrupt Enable Register 0 (TIER0)
H'FFFF8264
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
TTGE
―
―
TCIEV
TGIED
TGIEC
TGIEB
TGIEA
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
7
4
3
Name
Value
Description
A/D Conversion Start Request
Enable (TTGE)
0
Disable A/D conversion start requests
1
Enable A/D conversion start request generation
Overflow Interrupt Enable
(TCIEV)
0
Disable TCFV interrupt requests (TCIV)
1
Enable TCFV interrupt requests (TCIV)
TGR Interrupt Enable D (TGIED)
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGID) due to the TGFD bit
(initial value)
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGID) due to the TGFD bit
Disable interrupt requests (TGIC) due to the TGFC bit
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
2
TGR Interrupt Enable C (TGIEC)
0
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIC) due to the TGFC bit
1
TGR Interrupt Enable B (TGIEB)
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGIB) due to the TGFB bit
(initial value)
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIB) due to the TGFB bit
0
TGR Interrupt Enable A (TGIEA)
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGIA) due to the TGFA bit
(initial value)
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIA) due to the TGFA bit
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 626 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Status Register 0 (TSR0)
H'FFFF8265
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
TCFV
TGFD
TGFC
TGFB
TGFA
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Note:
Bit
4
3
2
1
*
Only 0 writes to clear the flags are possible.
Name
Overflow Flag (TCFV)
Input Capture/Output Compare
Flag D (TGFD)
Input Capture/Output Compare
Flag C (TGFC)
Input Capture/Output Compare
Flag B (TGFB)
Value
Description
0
Clear condition: With TCFV = 1, a 0 write to TCFV
after reading it
(initial value)
1
Set condition: When the TCNT value overflows
(H'FFFF → H'0000)
(initial value)
0
Clear condition: With TGFD = 1, a 0 write to TGFD
following a read
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
• When TGRD is functioning as an output compare
register (TCNT = TGRD)
• When TGRD is functioning as input capture (the
TCNT value is sent to TGRD by the input capture
signal)
0
Clear condition: With TGFC = 1, a 0 write to TGFC
following a read
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
• When TGRC is functioning as an output compare
register (TCNT = TGRC)
• When TGRC is functioning as input capture (the
TCNT value is sent to TGRC by the input capture
signal)
0
Clear condition: With TGFB = 1, a 0 write to TGFB
following a read
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
• When TGRB is functioning as an output compare
register (TCNT = TGRB)
• When TGRB is functioning as input capture (the
TCNT value is sent to TGRB by the input capture
signal)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 627 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Bit
Name
Input Capture/Output Compare
Flag A (TGFA)
0
Note:
*
Value
Description
0
Clear condition: With TGFA = 1, a 0 write to TGFA
following a read*
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
• When TGRA is functioning as an output compare
register (TCNT = TGRA)
• When TGRA is functioning as input capture (the
TCNT value is sent to TGRA by the input capture
signal)
Cleared by DMAC transfer due to TGFA.
Timer Counters 0 (TCNT0)
H'FFFF8266
16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
H'FFFF8268 (0A)
H'FFFF826A (0B)
H'FFFF826C (0C)
H'FFFF826E (0D)
Timer General Register 0 (TGR0)
16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 628 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Control Register 1 (TCR1)
H'FFFF8280
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1
CKEG0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
7 to 5
Counter Clear 2 to 0
(Reserved*2, CCLR1, CCLR0)
Value
0
0
1
Clock Edge 1, 0
(CKEG1, CKEG0)*5
4, 3
0
2 to 0*
Timer Prescaler 2 to 0
(TPSC2 to TPSC0)
0
1
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1
TCNT is cleared by TGRA compare-match or input
capture
0
TCNT is cleared by TGRB compare-match or input
capture
1
Synchronizing clear: TCNT is cleared in
synchronization with clear of other channel counters
operating in sync*1
0
Count on rising edges
1
Count on falling edges
(initial value)
(initial value)
Count on both rising and falling edges
0
Internal clock: count with φ/1
1
Internal clock: count with φ/4
1
0
Internal clock: count with φ/16
1
Internal clock: count with φ/64
0
0
External clock: count with the TCLKA pin input
1
External clock: count with the TCLKB pin input
0
Internal clock: count with φ/256
0
1
Notes:
TCNT clear disabled
X*3
1
4
Description
0
(initial value)
1 Count with the TCNT2 overflow/underflow
Setting the SYNC bit of the TSYR to 1 sets the synchronization.
The bit 7 of channels 1 is reserved. It always reads 0, and cannot be modified.
X: 0 or 1, don't care.
These settings are ineffective when channel 1 is in phase counting mode.
Internal clock edge selection is effective when the input clock is φ/4 or slower. These settings are
ignored when φ/1, or the overflow/underflow of another channel is selected for the input clock.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 629 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Mode Register 1 (TMDR1)
H'FFFF8281
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
―
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
3 to 0
Name
Modes 3 to 0 (MD3 to MD0)
Value
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 630 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Description
0
Normal operation
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
PWM mode 1
1
PWM mode 2
0
Phase counting mode 1
1
Phase counting mode 2
0
Phase counting mode 3
1
Phase counting mode 4
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
(Initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer I/O Control Register 1 (TIOR1)
H'FFFF8282
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
7 to 4
I/O Control B3 to B0
(IOB3 to IOB0)
Value
0
0
0
Description
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on comparematc
0
1
1
TGR1B is Output disabled
(initial value)
an output Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
compare
Output 1 on compare-match
register
Toggle output on comparematc
0
TGR1B is Capture input
an output source is the
compare TIOC1B pin
register
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
Capture input
source TGR0C
compare/match
input capture
Input capture on channel
0/TGR0C comparematch/input capture
generation
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 631 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Bit
Name
3 to 0
I/O Control A3 to A0
(IOA3 to IOA0)
Value
0
0
0
Description
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on comparematch
0
1
1
TGR1A is Output disabled
(initial value)
an output Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
compare
Output 1 on compare-match
register
Toggle output on comparematch
0
TGR1A is Capture input
source is the
an input
TIOC1A pin
capture
register
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 632 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Capture input
source TGR0A
compare/match
input capture
Input capture on channel
0/TGR0A comparematch/input capture
generation
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Interrupt Enable Register 1 (TIER1)
H'FFFF8284
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
TTGE
―
TCIEU
TCIEV
―
―
TGIEB
TGIEA
Initial value
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
Value
Description
A/D Conversion Start Request
Enable (TTGE)
0
Disable A/D conversion start requests
1
Enable A/D conversion start request generation
Underflow Interrupt Enable
(TCIEU)
0
Disable UDF interrupt requests (TCIU)
1
Enable UDF interrupt requests (TCIU)
Overflow Interrupt Enable
(TCIEV)
0
Disable TCFV interrupt requests (TCIV)
1
Enable TCFV interrupt requests (TCIV)
1
TGR Interrupt Enable B (TGIEB)
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGIB) due to the TGFB bit
(initial value)
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIB) due to the TGFB bit
0
TGR Interrupt Enable A (TGIEA)
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGIA) due to the TGFA bit
(initial value)
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIA) due to the TGFA bit
7
5
4
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 633 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Status Register 1 (TSR1)
H'FFFF8285
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
TCFD
―
TCFU
TCFV
―
―
TGFB
TGFA
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R
R
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Note:
*
Bit
Only 0 writes to clear the flags are possible.
Name
Value
Description
7
Count Direction Flag (TCFD)
0
1
TCNT counts up
5
Underflow Flag (TCFU)
0
Clear condition: With TCFU = 1, a 0 write to TCFU
after reading it
(initial value)
1
Set condition: When the TCNT value underflows
(H'0000 → H'FFFF)
0
Clear condition: With TCFV = 1, a 0 write to TCFV
after reading it
(initial value)
1
Set condition: When the TCNT value overflows
(H'FFFF → H'0000)
0
Clear condition: With TGFB = 1, a 0 write to TGFB
following a read
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
• When TGRB is functioning as an output compare
register (TCNT = TGRB)
• When TGRB is functioning as input capture (the
TCNT value is sent to TGRB by the input capture
signal)
0
Clear condition: With TGFA = 1, a 0 write to TGFA
following a read*
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
• When TGRA is functioning as an output compare
register (TCNT = TGRA)
• When TGRA is functioning as input capture (the
TCNT value is sent to TGRA by the input capture
signal)
4
Overflow Flag (TCFV)
Input Capture/Output Compare
Flag B (TGFB)
1
Input Capture/Output Compare
Flag A (TGFA)
0
Note:
*
Cleared by DMAC transfer due to TGFA.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 634 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
TCNT counts down
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Counters 1 (TCNT1)
H'FFFF8286
16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
H'FFFF8288 (1A)
H'FFFF828A (1B)
Timer General Register 1 (TGR1)
16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 635 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Control Register 2 (TCR2)
H'FFFF82A0
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
CCLR1
CCLR0
CKEG1
CKEG0
TPSC2
TPSC1
TPSC0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
7 to 5
Counter Clear 2 to 0
(Reserved*2, CCLR1, CCLR0)
Value
0
0
1
Clock Edge 1, 0
(CKEG1 and CKEG0)*5
4, 3
0
2 to 0*
Timer Prescaler 2 to 0
(TPSC2 to TPSC0)
0
1
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1
TCNT is cleared by TGRA compare-match or input
capture
0
TCNT is cleared by TGRB compare-match or input
capture
1
Synchronizing clear: TCNT is cleared in
synchronization with clear of other channel counters
operating in sync*1
0
Count on rising edges
1
Count on falling edges
(initial value)
(initial value)
Count on both rising and falling edges
0
Internal clock: count with φ/1
1
Internal clock: count with φ/4
1
0
Internal clock: count with φ/16
1
Internal clock: count with φ/64
0
0
External clock: count with the TCLKA pin input
1
External clock: count with the TCLKB pin input
0
External clock: count with the TCLKC pin input
0
1
Notes:
TCNT clear disabled
X*3
1
4
Description
0
(initial value)
1 Internal clock: count with φ/1024
Setting the SYNC bit of the TSYR to 1 sets the synchronization.
The bit 7 of channels 2 is reserved. It always reads 0, and cannot be modified.
X: 0 or 1, don't care.
These settings are ineffective when channel 2 is in phase counting mode.
Internal clock edge selection is effective when the input clock is φ/4 or slower. These settings are
ignored when φ/1 is selected for the input clock.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 636 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Mode Register 2 (TMDR2)
H'FFFF82A1
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
―
MD3
MD2
MD1
MD0
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
3 to 0
Name
Modes 3 to 0 (MD3 to MD0)
Value
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Description
0
Normal operation
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
PWM mode 1
1
PWM mode 2
0
Phase counting mode 1
1
Phase counting mode 2
0
Phase counting mode 3
1
Phase counting mode 4
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
0
Reserved (do not set)
1
Reserved (do not set)
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 637 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer I/O Control Register 2 (TIOR2)
H'FFFF82A2
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
IOB3
IOB2
IOB1
IOB0
IOA3
IOA2
IOA1
IOA0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
7 to 4
I/O Control B3 to B0
(IOB3 to IOB0)
Value
0
0
0
Description
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on comparematch
0
1
1
TGR2B is Output disabled
(initial value)
an output Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
compare
Output 1 on compare-match
register
Toggle output on comparematch
0
TGR2B is Capture input
an input
source is the
capture
TIOC2B pin
register
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
1
0
Input capture on rising edge
1
Input capture on falling edge
0
Input capture on both edges
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 638 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Bit
Name
3 to 0
I/O Control A3 to A0
(IOA3 to IOA0)
Value
0
0
0
Description
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
Output disabled
1
Initial output is 1 Output 0 on compare-match
0
Output 1 on compare-match
1
Toggle output on comparematch
0
1
1
TGR2A is Output disabled
(initial value)
an output Initial output is 0 Output 0 on compare-match
compare
Output 1 on compare-match
register
Toggle output on comparematch
0
TGR2A is Capture input
source is the
an input
TIOC2A pin
capture
register
Input capture on rising edge
Input capture on falling edge
Input capture on both edges
1
1
0
1
0
Input capture on rising edge
1
Input capture on falling edge
0
Input capture on both edges
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 639 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Interrupt Enable Register 2 (TIER2)
H'FFFF82A4
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
TTGE
―
TCIEU
TCIEV
―
―
TGIEB
TGIEA
Initial value
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
Value
Description
A/D Conversion Start Request
Enable (TTGE)
0
Disable A/D conversion start requests
1
Enable A/D conversion start request generation
Underflow Interrupt Enable
(TCIEU)
0
Disable UDF interrupt requests (TCIU)
1
Enable UDF interrupt requests (TCIU)
Overflow Interrupt Enable
(TCIEV)
0
Disable TCFV interrupt requests (TCIV)
1
Enable TCFV interrupt requests (TCIV)
1
TGR Interrupt Enable B (TGIEB)
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGIB) due to the TGFB bit
(initial value)
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIB) due to the TGFB bit
0
TGR Interrupt Enable A (TGIEA)
0
Disable interrupt requests (TGIA) due to the TGFA bit
(initial value)
1
Enable interrupt requests (TGIA) due to the TGFA bit
7
5
4
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 640 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Status Register 2 (TSR2)
H'FFFF82A5
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
TCFD
―
TCFU
TCFV
―
―
TGFB
TGFA
Initial value
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R
R
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
Note:
*
Bit
Only 0 writes to clear the flags are possible.
Name
Value
Description
7
Count Direction Flag (TCFD)
0
1
TCNT counts up
5
Underflow Flag (TCFU)
0
Clear condition: With TCFU = 1, a 0 write to TCFU
after reading it
(initial value)
1
Set condition: When the TCNT value underflows
(H'0000 → H'FFFF)
0
Clear condition: With TCFV = 1, a 0 write to TCFV
after reading it
(initial value)
1
Set condition: When the TCNT value overflows
(H'FFFF → H'0000)
0
Clear condition: With TGFB = 1, a 0 write to TGFB
following a read
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
• When TGRB is functioning as an output compare
register (TCNT = TGRB)
• When TGRB is functioning as input capture (the
TCNT value is sent to TGRB by the input capture
signal)
0
Clear condition: With TGFA = 1, a 0 write to TGFA
following a read*
(initial value)
1
Set conditions:
• When TGRA is functioning as an output compare
register (TCNT = TGRA)
• When TGRA is functioning as input capture (the
TCNT value is sent to TGRA by the input capture
signal)
4
Overflow Flag (TCFV)
Input Capture/Output Compare
Flag B (TGFB)
1
Input Capture/Output Compare
Flag A (TGFA)
0
Note:
*
TCNT counts down
(initial value)
Cleared by DMAC transfer due to TGFA.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 641 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Counters 2 (TCNT2)
H'FFFF82A6
16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
H'FFFF82A8 (2A)
H'FFFF82AA (2B)
Timer General Register 2 (TGR2)
16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Timer Start Register (TSTR)
H'FFFF8240
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
CST2
CST1
CST0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
2 to 0
Note:
Counter Start 2 to 0
(CST2 to CST0)
Value
Description
0
TCNTn count is halted
1
TCNTn count
(initial value)
n = 2 to 0
If 0 is written to the CST bit during operation with the TIOC pin in output status, the counter stops, but
the TIOC pin output compare output level is maintained. If a write is done to the TIOR register while the
CST bit is a 0, the pin output level is updated to the established initial output value.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 642 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
MTU
Timer Synchro Register (TSYR)
H'FFFF8241
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
SYNC2
SYNC1
SYNC0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
2 to 0
Notes:
Name
Timer Synchronization 2 to 0
(SYNC2 to SYNC0)
Value
Description
0
Timer counter (TCNTn) independent operation
(TCNTn preset/clear unrelated to other channels)
(initial value)
1
Timer counter synchronous operation*1
TCNTn synchronous preset/ synchronous clear*2
possible
n = 2 to 0
1. Minimum of two channel SYNC bits must be set to 1 for synchronous operation.
2. TCNT counter clear sources (CCLR2 to CCLR0 bits of the TCR register) must be set in addition to
the SYNC bit in order to have clear synchronization.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 643 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
WDT
H'FFFF8610 (Write)*1
H'FFFF8611 (Read)*2
Timer Counter (TCNT)
―
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
0
0
0
0
0
2
1
0
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Notes: 1. Write by word transfer. It cannot be written in byte or longword.
2. Read by byte transfer. It cannot be read in word or longword.
Timer Control/Status Register (TCSR)
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
―
H'FFFF8610
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
OVF
WT/IT
TME
―
―
CKS2
CKS1
CKS0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Initial value
R/W
Note:
*
Bit
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
The TCSR differs from other registers in that it is more difficult to write to. See section 11.2.4,
Register Access, for details.
Value
Description
7
Overflow Flag (OVF)
0
No overflow of TCNT in interval timer mode (initial value)
Cleared by reading OVF, then writing 0 in OVF
1
TCNT overflow in the interval timer mode
6
Timer Mode Select (WT/IT)
0
Interval timer mode: interval timer interrupt request to the
CPU when TCNT overflows
(initial value)
1
Watchdog timer mode: WDTOVF signal output externally
when TCNT overflows*1
0
Timer disabled: TCNT is initialized to H'00 and count-up
stops
(initial value)
1
Timer enabled: TCNT starts counting. A WDTOVF signal
or interrupt is generated when TCNT overflows.
5
Name
Timer Enable (TME)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 644 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
WDT
Description
Bit
Name
Value
Clock Select 2 to 0
(CKS2 to CKS0)
2 to 0
0
Notes:
0
φ/2
1
φ/64
573.4 μs
1
0
φ/128
1.1 ms
1
φ/256
2.3 ms
0
0
φ/512
4.6 ms
1
φ/1024
9.2 ms
1
0
φ/4096
36.7 ms
0
1
Clock Source
Overflow Interval*2
(φ = 28.7 MHz)
(Initial value) 17.9 μs
1 φ/8192
73.4 ms
1. Section 11.2.3, Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR), describes in detail what happens when
TCNT overflows in the watchdog timer mode.
2. The overflow interval listed is the time from when the TCNT begins counting at H'00 until an
overflow occurs.
―
H'FFFF8612 (Write)
H'FFFF8613 (Read)
Reset Control/Status Register (RSTCSR)
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
WOVF
RSTE
―
―
―
―
―
―
0
0
0
1
Initial value
R/W
Note:
*
R/(W)*
R/W
R
R
Only 0 can be written in bit 7 to clear the flag.
1
1
1
1
R
R
R
R
Bit
Name
Value
Description
7
Watchdog Timer Overflow Flag
(WOVF)
0
No TCNT overflow in watchdog timer mode
(initial value)
Cleared when software reads WOVF, then writes 0 in
WOVF
1
Set by TCNT overflow in watchdog timer mode
6
Reset Enable (RSTE)
0
Not reset when TCNT overflows
(initial value)
LSI not reset internally, but TCNT and TCSR reset
within WDT.
1
Reset when TCNT overflows
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 645 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
SCI
H'FFFF81A5 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF81B5 (Channel 1)
Receive Data Register (RDR)
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
H'FFFF81A3 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF81B3 (Channel 1)
Transmit Data Register (TDR)
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 646 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
SCI
H'FFFF81A0 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF81B0 (Channel 1)
Serial Mode Register (SMR)
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
C/A
CHR
PE
O/E
STOP
MP
CKS1
CKS0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
7
Value
Communication Mode (C/A)
6
Character Length (CHR)
5
Parity Enable (PE)
4
Parity Mode (O/E)
3
Stop Bit Length (STOP)
2
Multiprocessor Mode (MP)
Clock Select 1 and 0
(CKS1 and CKS0)
1, 0
0
1
Notes:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Description
0
Asynchronous mode
1
Clocked synchronous mode
0
Eight-bit data
1
Seven-bit data*1
0
Parity bit not added or checked
1
Parity bit added and checked*2
0
Even parity*3
1
Odd parity*4
0
One stop bit*5
1
Two stop bits*6
0
Multiprocessor function disabled
1
Multiprocessor format selected
0
φ
1
φ/4
0
φ/16
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
1 φ/64
When 7-bit data is selected, the MSB (bit 7) of the transmit data register is not transmitted.
When PE is set to 1, an even or odd parity bit is added to transmit data, depending on the parity
mode (O/E) setting. Receive data parity is checked according to the even/odd (O/E) mode setting.
If even parity is selected, the parity bit is added to transmit data to make an even number of 1s in
the transmitted character and parity bit combined. Receive data is checked to see if it has an even
number of 1s in the received character and parity bit combined.
If odd parity is selected, the parity bit is added to transmit data to make an odd number of 1s in the
transmitted character and parity bit combined. Receive data is checked to see if it has an odd
number of 1s in the received character and parity bit combined.
In transmitting, a single bit of 1 is added at the end of each transmitted character.
In transmitting, two bits of 1 are added at the end of each transmitted character.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 647 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
SCI
H'FFFF81A2 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF81B2 (Channel 1)
Serial Control Register (SCR)
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
TIE
RIE
TE
RE
MPIE
TEIE
CKE1
CKE0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
Value
7
Transmit Interrupt Enable
(TIE)
0
Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is disabled *1
(initial value)
1
Transmit-data-empty interrupt request (TXI) is enabled
0
Receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) and receive-error interrupt
(initial value)
(ERI) requests are disabled*2
1
Receive-data-full interrupt (RXI) and receive-error interrupt
(ERI) requests are enabled
0
Transmitter disabled*3
1
Transmitter enabled*4
0
Receiver disabled*5
1
Receiver enabled*6
0
Multiprocessor interrupts are disabled
(initial value)
(normal receive operation)
MPIE is cleared when the MPIE bit is cleared to 0, or the
multiprocessor bit (MPB) is set to 1 in receive data.
1
Multiprocessor interrupts are enabled*7
Receive-data-full interrupt requests (RXI), receive-error
interrupt requests (ERI), and setting of the RDRF, FER, and
ORER status flags in the serial status register (SSR) are
disabled until data with the multiprocessor bit set to 1 is
received.
0
Transmit-end interrupt (TEI) requests are disabled*8
(initial value)
1
Transmit-end interrupt (TEI) requests are enabled*8
6
5
4
3
2
Receive Interrupt Enable
(RIE)
Transmit Enable (TE)
Receive Enable (RE)
Multiprocessor Interrupt
Enable (MPIE)
Transmit-End Interrupt
Enable (TEIE)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 648 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Description
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
SCI
Description
Bit
Name
Clock Enable 1 and 0
(CKE1 and CKE0)*9
1, 0
Value
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
Clock synchronous mode
0
0
Internal clock, SCK pin used
for input pin (input signal is
ignored) or output pin (output
level is undefined)*10
Internal clock, SCK pin used
for synchronous clock
output*10
0
1
Internal clock, SCK pin used
for clock output*11
Internal clock, SCK pin used
for synchronous clock output
1
0
External clock, SCK pin used
for clock input*12
External clock, SCK pin used
for synchronous clock input
External clock, SCK pin used External clock, SCK pin used
for synchronous clock input
for clock input*12
The TXI interrupt request can be cleared by reading TDRE after it has been set to 1, then clearing
TDRE to 0, or by clearing TIE to 0.
RXI and ERI interrupt requests can be cleared by reading the RDRF flag or error flag (FER, PER,
or ORER) after it has been set to 1, then clearing the flag to 0, or by clearing RIE to 0.
The transmit data register empty bit (TDRE) in the serial status register (SSR) is locked at 1.
Serial transmission starts when the transmit data register empty (TDRE) bit in the serial status
register (SSR) is cleared to 0 after writing of transmit data into the TDR. Select the transmit format
in the SMR before setting TE to 1.
Clearing RE to 0 does not affect the receive flags (RDRF, FER, PER, ORER). These flags retain
their previous values.
Serial reception starts when a start bit is detected in the asynchronous mode, or synchronous
clock input is detected in the clock synchronous mode. Select the receive format in the SMR
before setting RE to 1.
The SCI does not transfer receive data from the RSR to the RDR, does not detect receive errors,
and does not set the RDRF, FER, and ORER flags in the serial status register (SSR). When it
receives data that includes MPB = 1, MPB is set to 1, and the SCI automatically clears MPIE to 0,
generates RXI and ERI interrupts (if the TIE and RIE bits in the SCR are set to 1), and allows the
FER and ORER bits to be set.
The TEI request can be cleared by reading the TDRE bit in the serial status register (SSR) after it
has been set to 1, then clearing TDRE to 0 and clearing the transmit end (TEND) bit to 0; or by
clearing the TEIE bit to 0.
The SCK pin is multiplexed with other functions. Use the pin function controller (PFC) to select the
SCK function for this pin, as well as the I/O direction.
Initial value.
The output clock frequency is the same as the bit rate.
The input clock frequency is 16 times the bit rate.
1
Notes:
Asynchronous mode
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 649 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
SCI
H'FFFF81A4 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF81B4 (Channel 1)
Serial Status Register (SSR)
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
TDRE
RDRF
ORER
FER
PER
TEND
MPB
MPBT
Initial value
1
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
R/W
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R/(W)*
R
R
R/W
Note:
*
The only value that can be written is a 0 to clear the flag.
Bit
Name
Value
7
Transmit Data Register Empty
(TDRE)
0
TDR contains valid transmit data
Clearing conditions:
• When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1
• When DMAC writes data in TDR
1
TDR does not contain valid transmit data
(initial value)
Setting conditions:
• Power-on reset or standby mode
• When the TE bit in SCR is 0
• When data is transferred from TDR to TSR and data
can be written to TDR
0
RDR does not contain valid received data
(initial value)
Clearing conditions:
• Power-on reset or standby mode
• When 0 is written to RDRF after reading RDRF = 1
• When DMAC reads data from RDR
1
RDR contains valid received data
Setting condition: When serial reception ends normally
and receive data is transferred from RSR to RDR
6
Receive Data Register Full
(RDRF)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 650 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Description
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
SCI
Bit
5
4
3
Name
Overrun Error (ORER)
Framing Error (FER)
Parity Error (PER)
Value
Description
0
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally*1
(initial value)
Clearing conditions:
• Power-on reset or standby mode
• When 0 is written to ORER after reading ORER =
1
1
A receive overrun error occurred
Setting condition: When the next serial reception is
completed while RDRF = 1*2
0
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally*3
(initial value)
Clearing conditions:
• Power-on reset or standby mode
• When 0 is written to FER after reading FER = 1
1
A receive framing error occurred*4
Setting condition: When at the end of an SCI receive
operation the final stop bit of the receive data is
checked and its value*4 is 0
0
Receiving is in progress or has ended normally*5
(initial value)
Clearing conditions:
• Power-on reset or standby mode
• When 0 is written to PER after reading PER = 1
1
A receive parity error occurred*6
Setting condition: PER is set to 1 if the number of 1s in
receive data, including the parity bit, does not match
the even or odd parity setting of the parity mode bit
(O/E) in the serial mode register (SMR)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 651 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
SCI
Bit
2
Name
Value
Transmit End (TEND)
Description
0
Transmission is in progress
Clearing conditions:
• When 0 is written to TDRE after reading TDRE = 1
• When DMAC writes data in TDR
1
End of transmission
(initial value)
Clearing conditions:
• Power-on reset or standby mode
• When the TE bit in SCR is 0
• When TDRE = at transmission of the last bit of a
1-byte serial transmit character
Multiprocessor bit value in receive data is 0*7 (initial value)
1
Multiprocessor Bit (MPB)
0
1
Multiprocessor bit value in receive data is 1
0
Multiprocessor Bit Transfer
(MPBT)
0
Multiprocessor bit value in transmit data is 0 (initial value)
Notes:
1
Multiprocessor bit value in transmit data is 1
1. The ORER flag is not affected and retains their previous values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared
to 0.
2. RDR continues to hold the data received before the overrun error, so subsequent receive data is
lost. Serial receiving cannot continue while ORER is set to 1. In the clock synchronous mode,
serial transmitting is disabled.
3. The FER flag is not affected and retains their previous values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to
0.
4. When the stop bit length is two bits, only the first bit is checked to see if it is a 1. The second stop
bit is not checked. When a framing error occurs, the SCI transfers the receive data into the RDR
but does not set RDRF. Serial receiving cannot continue while FER is set to 1. In the clock
synchronous mode, serial transmitting is also disabled. In addition, serial transmission cannot
continue in clock synchronous mode.
5. The PER flag is not affected and retains their previous values when the RE bit in SCR is cleared to
0.
6. When a parity error occurs, the SCI transfers the receive data into the RDR but does not set
RDRF. Serial receiving cannot continue while PER is set to 1. In the clock synchronous mode,
serial transmitting is also disabled. In addition, serial transmission cannot continue in clock
synchronous mode.
7. If RE is cleared to 0 when a multiprocessor format is selected, the MPB retains its previous value.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 652 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
SCI
H'FFFF81A1 (Write)
H'FFFF81B1 (Read)
Bit Rate Register (BRR)
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
Initial value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 653 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
A/D (SH7014)
H'FFFF83F0
H'FFFF83F2
H'FFFF83F4
H'FFFF83F6
H'FFFF83F8
H'FFFF83FA
H'FFFF83FC
H'FFFF83FE
A/D Data Registers A to H (ADDRA to ADDRH)
8/16
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 AD0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR)
H'FFFF83E0
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
ADF
ADIE
ADST
CKS
GRP
CH2
CH1
CH0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note:
Bit
7
6
*
Only 0 can be written to bit 7 to clear the flag.
Name
Value
Description
0
Clear conditions:
(initial value)
• With ADF = 1, by reading the ADF flag then writing 0
in ADF
• When the DMAC is activated by an ADI interrupt
1
Set conditions:
• Single mode: When A/D conversion ends after
conversion for all designated channels*
• Scan mode: After one round of A/D conversion for
all specified channels
0
Disables interrupt requests (ADI) after A/D conversion
ends
(initial value)
1
Enables interrupt requests (ADI) after A/D conversion
ends
A/D End Flag (ADF)
A/D Interrupt Enable (ADIE)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 654 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
A/D (SH7014)
Bit
Name
5
A/D Start (ADST)
Value
Description
0
A/D conversion halted
(initial value)
• Single mode: Start A/D conversion.
Automatically cleared to 0 after conversion
for the designated channel ends.
• Scan mode: Start A/D conversion.
Continuous conversion until 0 cleared by
software.
1
4
Clock Select (CKS)
3
Group Mode (GRP)
Channel Select 2 to 0
(CH2 to CH0)
2 to 0
*
Conversion time = 40 states (high speed A/D
converter standard clock = φ/2)
(initial value)
1
Conversion time = 80 states
(when φ/4 is selected)
0
Select mode
1
Group mode
(initial value)
Select mode (GRP = 0) Group mode (GRP = 1)
0
1
Note:
0
0
0
AN0
1
AN1
(Initial value) AN0
AN0, AN1
1
0
AN2
AN0 to AN2
1
AN3
AN0 to AN3
0
0
AN4
AN0 to AN4
1
AN5
AN0 to AN5
1
0
AN6
AN0 to AN6
1
AN7
AN0 to AN7
During buffer operation, this is not set until operation of the specified buffer has ended.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 655 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
A/D (SH7014)
A/D Control Register (ADCR)
H'FFFF83E1
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
PWR
TRGS1
TRGS0
SCAN
DSMP
BUFE1
BUFE0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
6
5, 4
Name
Value
Power (PWR)
Timer Trigger Select 1, 0
(TRGS1, TRGS0)
Description
0
Low power conversion mode
1
High speed start mode
0
1
(initial value)
0
Enable A/D conversion start by software
1
Enables A/D conversion start by MTU conversion start
trigger
(initial value)
0
Reserved
1
3
2
1, 0
Scan Mode (SCAN)
Simultaneous Sampling
(DSMP)
Buffer Enable 1, 0
(BUFE1, BUFE0)
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 656 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
0
Single mode
1
Scan mode
0
Normal sampling operation
1
Simultaneous sampling operation
(initial value)
(initial value)
0
Normal operation
1
ADDRA and ADDRB buffer operation:
conversion result → ADDRA → ADDRB
(initial value)
0
ADDRA and ADDRC, also ADDRB and ADDRD buffer
operation:
conversion result 1 → ADDRA → ADDRC, conversion
result 2 → ADDRB → ADDRD (ADDRC and ADDRD are
buffer registers)
1
ADDRA to ADDRD buffer operation:
conversion result → ADDRA → ADDRB → ADDRC →
ADDRD (ADDRB to ADDRD are buffer registers)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
A/D (SH7016, SH7017)
H'FFFF8420
H'FFFF8422
H'FFFF8424
H'FFFF8426
A/D Data Register A to D (ADDRA to ADDRD)
8/16
Bit
Item
15
Bit name
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
AD9 AD8 AD7 AD6 AD5 AD4 AD3 AD2 AD1 AD0
5
4
3
2
1
0
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
A/D Control/Status Register (ADCSR)
H'FFFF8428
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
ADF
ADIE
ADST
SCAN
CKS
CH2
CH1
CH0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/(W)*
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note:
Bit
7
6
*
Only 0 can be written to bit 7 to clear the flag.
Name
A/D End Flag (ADF)
A/D Interrupt Enable (ADIE)
Value
Description
0
Clear conditions:
(initial value)
1. Writing 0 to ADF after reading ADF with ADF
=1
2. When registers of the mid-speed converter
are accessed after the DMAC is activated by
ADI interrupt
1
Set conditions:
1. Single mode: When A/D conversion is
complete
2. Scan mode: When A/D conversion of all
designated channels are complete
0
Disables interrupt request (ADI) due to
completion of A/D conversion
(initial value)
1
Enables interrupt request (ADI) due to
completion of A/D conversion
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 657 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
A/D (SH7016, SH7017)
Bit
5
Name
Value
Description
0
A/D conversion halted
(initial value)
1. Single mode: Starts A/D conversion.
Automatically clears to 0 when conversion of
the designated channel is complete
2. Scan mode: Starts A/D conversion.
Continuous conversion until cleared to 0 by
the software
A/D Start (ADST)
1
4
3
2 to 0
Scan Mode (SCAN)
Clock Select (CKS)
Channel select 2 to 0
(CH2 to CH0)
0
0
Single mode
1
Scan mode
0
Conversion time = 266 states (max) (initial value)
1
Conversion time = 134 states (max)
Single Mode
Scan Mode
0
AN0
AN0
1
AN1
AN0, AN1
1
0
AN2
AN0 to AN2
1
AN3
AN0 to AN3
0
0
AN4
AN4
1
AN5
AN4, AN5
1
0
AN6
AN4 to AN6
1
AN7
AN4 to AN7
0
1
(initial value)
A/D Control Register (ADCR)
(Initial value)
H'FFFF8429
8/16
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
TRGE
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit
7
Name
Trigger Enable (TRGE)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 658 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Value
Description
0
Disables A/D conversion start of MTU trigger
(initial value)
1
Starts A/D conversion on MTU trigger
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
CMT
Compare Match Timer Start Register (CMSTR)
H'FFFF83D0
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
STR1
STR0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
1
Value
Count Start 1 (STR1)
0
Count Start 0 (STR0)
Description
0
CMCNT1 count operation halted
1
CMCNT1 count operation
0
CMCNT0 count operation halted
1
CMCNT0 count operation
Compare Match Timer Control/Status Register
(CMCSR)
(initial value)
(initial value)
H'FFFF83D2 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF83D8 (Channel 1)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
CMF
CMIE
―
―
―
―
CKS1
CKS0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/(W)*
R/W
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
Note:
Bit
7
6
*
The only value that can be written is a 0 to clear the flag.
Name
Compare Match Flag
(CMF)
Compare Match Interrupt
Enable (CMIE)
Value
Description
0
CMCNT and CMCOR values have not matched
Clear condition: Write a 0 to CMF after reading a 1 from it
(initial value)
1
CMCNT and CMCOR values have matched
0
Compare match interrupts (CMI) disabled
1
Compare match interrupts (CMI) enabled
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 659 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
CMT
Bit
1, 0
Name
Value
Clock Select 1, 0 (CKS1, CKS0)
Description
0
0
φ/8
0
1
φ/32
1
0
φ/128
1
1
φ/512
(initial value)
H'FFFF83D4 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF83DA (Channel 1)
Compare Match Timer Counter (CMCNT)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
H'FFFF83D6 (Channel 0)
H'FFFF83DC (Channel 1)
Compare Match Timer Constant Register (CMCOR)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Bit name
Initial value
R/W
R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 660 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
H'FFFF8386
H'FFFF8387
Port A I/O Register L (PAIORL)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
Bit name
PA15IOR
14
13
12
11
10
PA14IOR* PA13IOR* PA12IOR* PA11IOR* PA10IOR*
9
8
PA9IOR
PA8IOR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PA7IOR
PA6IOR
PA5IOR
PA4IOR
PA3IOR
PA2IOR
PA1IOR
PA0IOR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note:
*
Reserved bit on the SH7014.
H'FFFF838C
H'FFFF838D
Port A Control Register L1 (PACRL1)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
PA15MD
―
PA15MD*2
―
PA15MD*2
―
PA15MD*2
Initial value
0
0(1)*1
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
PA15MD*2
―
PA15MD*2
PA9MD1
PA9MD0
PA8MD1
PA8MD0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
Notes: 1. Bit 14 is initialized to 1 in extended mode.
2. Reserved bit on the SH7014.
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 661 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
Bit
Name
14
PA15 Mode (PA15MD)
12
PA14 Mode (PA14MD)
10
8
6
4
3, 2
Value
PA13 Mode (PA13MD)
PA12 Mode (PA12MD)
PA11 Mode (PA11MD)
PA10 Mode (PA10MD)
PA9 Mode 1, 0
(PA9MD1 and PA9MD0)
0
1
1, 0
PA8 Mode 1, 0
(PA8MD1 and PA8MD0)
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 662 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Description
0
General input/output (PA15)
(single chip mode initial value)
1
Clock output (CK) (extended mode initial value)
0
General input/output (PA14)
(RD in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Read output (RD) (PA14 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PA13)
(WRH in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Most significant side write output (WRH)
(PA13 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PA12)
(WRL in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Least significant side write output (WRL)
(PA12 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PA11)
(CS1 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Chip select output (CS1) (PA11 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PA10)
(CS0 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Chip select output (CS0) (PA10 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PA9)
1
MTU timer clock input (TCLKD)
0
Interrupt request input (IRQ3)
1
Reserved
0
General input/output (PA8)
1
MTU timer clock input (TCLKC)
0
Interrupt request input (IRQ2)
1
Reserved
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
H'FFFF838E
H'FFFF838F
Port A Control Register L2 (PACRL2)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PA7MD1
PA7MD0
PA6MD1
PA6MD0
PA5MD1
PA5MD0
―
PA4MD
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
PA3MD
PA2MD1
PA2MD0
―
PA1MD
―
PA0MD
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
Bit
15, 14
Name
PA7 Mode 1, 0
(PA7MD1 and PA7MD0)
Value
0
1
13, 12
PA6 Mode 1, 0
(PA6MD1 and PA6MD0)
0
1
11, 10
PA5 Mode 1, 0
(PA5MD1 and PA5MD0)
0
1
8
6
5, 4
PA4 Mode (PA4MD)
PA3 Mode (PA3MD)
PA2 Mode 1, 0
(PA2MD1 and PA2MD0)
0
1
Description
0
General input/output (PA7)
1
MTU timer clock input (TCLKB)
(initial value)
0
Chip select output (CS3) (PA7 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
0
General input/output (PA6)
1
MTU timer clock input (TCLKA)
(initial value)
0
Chip select output (CS2) (PA6 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
0
General input/output (PA5)
1
Serial clock input/output (SCK1)
0
DMA transfer request received input (DREQ1)
(PA5 in single-chip mode)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ1)
0
General input/output (PA4)
1
Transmit data output (TxD1)
0
General input/output (PA3)
1
Receive data input (RxD1)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
0
General input/output (PA2)
1
Serial clock input/output (SCK0)
(initial value)
0
DMA transfer request received input (DREQ0)
(PA2 in single-chip mode)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ0)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 663 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
Bit
Name
2
Value
PA1 Mode (PA1MD)
0
PA0 Mode (PA0MD)
Description
0
General input/output (PA1)
1
Transmit data output (TxD0)
0
General input/output (PA0)
1
Receive data input (RxD0)
(initial value)
(initial value)
H'FFFF8394
H'FFFF8395
Port B I/O Register (PBIOR)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
PB9IOR
PB8IOR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PB7IOR
PB6IOR
PB5IOR
PB4IOR
PB3IOR
PB2IOR
PB1IOR*
PB0IOR*
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note:
*
Reserved bit on the SH7014.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 664 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
H'FFFF8398
H'FFFF8399
Port B Control Register 1 (PBCR1)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
―
PB9MD1
PB9MD0
PB8MD1
PB8MD0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
3, 2
Name
PB9 Mode 1, 0
(PB9MD1 and PB9MD0)
Value
0
1
1, 0
PB8 Mode 1, 0
(PB8MD1 and PB8MD0)
0
1
Description
0
General input/output (PB9)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ7)
(initial value)
0
Address output (A21) (PB9 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
0
General input/output (PB8)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ6)
(initial value)
0
Address output (A20) (PB8 in single-chip mode)
1
Wait state request input (WAIT)
(PB8 in single-chip mode)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 665 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
H'FFFF839A
H'FFFF839B
Port B Control Register 2 (PBCR2)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PB7MD1
PB7MD0
PB6MD1
PB6MD0
PB5MD1
PB5MD0
PB4MD1
PB4MD0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PB3MD1
PB3MD0
PB2MD1
PB2MD0
―
PB1MD*
―
PB0MD*
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
Note:
*
Bit
15, 14
Reserved bit on the SH7014.
Name
PB7 Mode 1, 0
(PB7MD1 and PB7MD0)
Value
0
1
13, 12
PB6 Mode 1, 0
(PB6MD1 and PB6MD0)
0
1
11, 10
PB5 Mode 1, 0
(PB5MD1 and PB5MD0)
0
1
9, 8
PB4 Mode 1, 0
(PB4MD1 and PB4MD0)
0
1
7, 6
PB3 Mode 1, 0
(PB3MD1 and PB3MD0)
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 666 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Description
0
General input/output (PB7)
1
Reserved
(initial value)
0
Address output (A19) (PB7 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
0
General input/output (PB6)
1
Reserved
0
Address output (A18) (PB6 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
0
General input/output (PB5)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ3)
0
Reserved
1
Read/write output (RDWR)
0
General input/output (PB4)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ2)
0
Reserved
1
Column address strobe (CASH)
(PB4 in single-chip mode)
0
General input/output (PB3)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ1)
0
Reserved
1
Column address strobe (CASL)
(PB3 in single-chip mode)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
Bit
5, 4
Name
Value
PB2 Mode 1, 0
(PB2MD1 and PB2MD0)
0
1
2
0
PB1 Mode (PB1MD)
PB0 Mode (PB0MD)
Description
0
General input/output (PB2)
1
Interrupt request input (IRQ0)
(initial value)
0
Reserved
1
Row address strobe (RAS) (PB2 in single-chip mode)
0
General input/output (PB1)
(A17 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A17) (PB1 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PB0)
(A16 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A16) (PB0 in single chip mode)
(initial value)
(initial value)
H'FFFF8396
H'FFFF8397
Port C I/O Register (PCIOR) (SH7016, SH7017)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
Bit name
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
PC15IOR
PC14IOR
PC13IOR
PC12IOR
PC11IOR
PC10IOR
PC9IOR
PC8IOR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PC7IOR
PC6IOR
PC5IOR
PC4IOR
PC3IOR
PC2IOR
PC1IOR
PC0IOR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 667 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
H'FFFF839C
H'FFFF839D
Port C Control Register (PCCR) (SH7016, SH7017)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PC15MD
PC14MD
PC13MD
PC12MD
PC11MD
PC10MD
PC9MD
PC8MD
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PC7MD
PC6MD
PC5MD
PC4MD
PC3MD
PC2MD
PC1MD
PC0MD
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Name
PC15 Mode (PC15MD)
PC14 Mode (PC14MD)
PC13 Mode (PC13MD)
PC12 Mode (PC12MD)
PC11 Mode (PC11MD)
PC10 Mode (PC10MD)
PC9 Mode (PC9MD)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 668 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Value
Description
0
General input/output (PC15)
(A15 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A15) (PC15 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC14)
(A14 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A14) (PC14 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC13)
(A13 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A13) (PC13 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC12)
(A12 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A12) (PC12 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC11)
(A11 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A11) (PC11 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC10)
A10 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A10) (PC10 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC9)
(A9 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A9) (PC9 in single chip mode)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
Bit
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
Value
PC8 Mode (PC8MD)
PC7 Mode (PC7MD)
PC6 Mode (PC6MD)
PC5 Mode (PC5MD)
PC4 Mode (PC4MD)
PC3 Mode (PC3MD)
PC2 Mode (PC2MD)
PC1 Mode (PC1MD)
PC0 Mode (PC0MD)
Description
0
General input/output (PC8)
A8 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A8) (PC8 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC7)
(A7 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A7) (PC7 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC6)
(A6 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A6) (PC6 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (P5)
(A5 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A5) (PC5 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC4)
(A4 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A4) (PC4 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC3)
(A3 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A3) (PC3 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC2)
(A2 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A2) (PC2 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC1)
(A1 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A1) (PC1 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PC0)
(A0 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Address output (A0) (PC0 in single chip mode)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
H'FFFF83A6
H'FFFF83A7
Port D I/O Register L (PDIORL) (SH7016, SH7017)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PD15IOR
PD14IOR
PD13IOR
PD12IOR
PD11IOR
PD10IOR
PD9IOR
PD8IOR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PD7IOR
PD6IOR
PD5IOR
PD4IOR
PD3IOR
PD2IOR
PD1IOR
PD0IOR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 669 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
H'FFFF83AC
H'FFFF83AD
Port D Control Register L (PDCRL) (SH7016, SH7017)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PD15MD
PD14MD
PD13MD
PD12MD
PD11MD
PD10MD
PD9MD
PD8MD
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PD7MD
PD6MD
PD5MD
PD4MD
PD3MD
PD2MD
PD1MD
PD0MD
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
Name
PD15 Mode (PD15MD)
PD14 Mode (PD14MD)
PD13 Mode (PD13MD)
PD12 Mode (PD12MD)
PD11 Mode (PD11MD)
PD10 Mode (PD10MD)
PD9 Mode (PD9MD)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 670 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Value
Description
0
General input/output (PD15)
(D15 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D15) (PD15 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD14)
(D14 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D14) (PD14 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD13)
(D13 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D13) (PD13 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD12)
(D12 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D12) (PD12 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD11)
(D11 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D11) (PD11 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD10)
(D10 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D10) (PD10 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD9)
(D9 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D9) (PD9 in single chip mode)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
Bit
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Name
PD8 Mode (PD8MD)
PD7 Mode (PD7MD)
PD6 Mode (PD6MD)
PD5 Mode (PD5MD)
PD4 Mode (PD4MD)
PD3 Mode (PD3MD)
PD2 Mode (PD2MD)
PD1 Mode (PD1MD)
PD0 Mode (PD0MD)
Value
Description
0
General input/output (PD8)
(D8 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D8) (PD8 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD7)
(D7 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D7) (PD7 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD6)
(D6 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D6) (PD6 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD5)
(D5 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D5) (PD5 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD4)
(D4 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D4) (PD4 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD3)
(D3 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D3) (PD3 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD2)
(D2 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D2) (PD2 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD1)
(D1 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D1) (PD1 in single chip mode)
0
General input/output (PD0)
(D0 in on-chip ROM invalid mode)
1
Data input/output (D0) (PD0 in single chip mode)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 671 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
H'FFFF83B4
H'FFFF83B5
Port E I/O Register (PEIOR)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PE15IOR
PE14IOR
PE13IOR
PE12IOR
PE11IOR
PE10IOR
PE9IOR
PE8IOR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PE7IOR
PE6IOR
PE5IOR
PE4IOR
PE3IOR
PE2IOR
PE1IOR
PE0IOR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
H'FFFF83B8
H'FFFF83B9
Port E Control Register 1 (PECR1)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PE15MD1
PE15MD0
PE14MD1
PE14MD0
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit
15, 14
13, 12
Name
PE15 Mode 1, 0
(PE15MD1 and PE15MD0)
PE14 Mode 1, 0
(PE14MD1 and PE14MD0)
Value
0
Description
0
Input/output (PE15)
1
Reserved
1
0
DMA request received output (DACK1)
(PE15 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
0
0
Input/output (PE14)
1
Reserved
0
DMA request received output (DACK0)
(PE14 in single-chip mode)
1
Address hold output (AH)
(PE14 in single-chip mode)
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 672 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
H'FFFF83BA
H'FFFF83BB
Port E Control Register 2 (PECR2)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
PE7MD
―
PE6MD
―
PE5MD
―
PE4MD
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
R
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PE3MD1
PE3MD0
PE2MD1
PE2MD0
PE1MD1
PE1MD0
PE0MD1
PE0MD0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
14
12
10
8
7, 6
Name
Value
PE7 Mode (PE7MD)
PE6 Mode (PE6MD)
PE5 Mode (PE5MD)
PE4 Mode (PE4MD)
PE3 Mode 1, 0
(PE3MD1 and PE3MD0)
0
1
5, 4
PE2 Mode 1, 0
(PE2MD1 and PE2MD0)
0
1
Description
0
General input/output (PE7)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC2B)
(initial value)
0
General input/output (PE6)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC2A)
(initial value)
0
General input/output (PE5)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC1B)
(initial value)
0
General input/output (PE4)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC1A)
(initial value)
0
General input/output (PE3)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC0D)
(initial value)
0
DREQ1 request received output (DRAK1)
(PE3 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
0
General input/output (PE2)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC0C)
0
DREQ1 request received input
(PE2 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 673 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
PFC
Bit
3, 2
Name
PE1 Mode 1, 0
(PE1MD1 and PE1MD0)
Value
0
1
1, 0
PE0 Mode 1, 0
(PE0MD1 and PE0MD0)
0
1
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 674 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Description
0
General input/output (PE1)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC0B)
(initial value)
0
DREQ0 request received output (DRAK0)
(PE1 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
0
General input/output (PE0)
1
MTU input capture input/output compare output (TIOC0A)
0
DREQ0 request received output (DRAK0)
(PE0 in single-chip mode)
1
Reserved
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
I/O
H'FFFF8382
H'FFFF8383
Port A Data Register L (PADRL)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PA15DR
PA14DR*
PA13DR*
PA12DR*
PA11DR*
PA10DR*
PA9DR
PA8DR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PA7DR
PA6DR
PA5DR
PA4DR
PA3DR
PA2DR
PA1DR
PA0DR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note:
*
Reserved bit on the SH7014.
H'FFFF8390
H'FFFF8391
Port B Data Register (PBDR)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
―
―
―
―
―
―
PB9DR
PB8DR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PB7DR
PB6DR
PB5DR
PB4DR
PB3DR
DB2DR
PB1DR*
PB0DR*
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Note:
*
Reserved bit on the SH7014.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 675 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
I/O
H'FFFF8392
H'FFFF8393
Port C Data Register (PCDR) (SH7016, SH7017)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PC15DR
PC14DR
PC13DR
PC12DR
PC11DR
PC10DR
PC9DR
PC8DR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PC7DR
PC6DR
PC5DR
PC4DR
PC3DR
PC2DR
PC1DR
PC0DR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
H'FFFF83A2
H'FFFF83A3
Port D Data Register L (PDDRL) (SH7016, SH7017)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PD15DR
PD14DR
PD13DR
PD12DR
PD11DR
PD10DR
PD9DR
PD8DR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PD7DR
PD6DR
PD5DR
PD4DR
PD3DR
PD2DR
PD1DR
PD0DR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
H'FFFF83B0
H'FFFF83B1
Port E Data Register (PEDR)
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
PE15DR
PE14DR
PE13DR
PE12DR
PE11DR
PE10DR
PE9DR
PE8DR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PE7DR
PE6DR
PE5DR
PE4DR
PE3DR
PE2DR
PE1DR
PE0DR
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 676 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
I/O
Port F Data Register (PFDR)
H'FFFF83B3
8
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
PF7DR
PF6DR
PF5DR
PF4DR
PF3DR
PF2DR
PF1DR
PF0DR
Initial value
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Note:
*
Initial values are dependent on the status of the pins at the time of the reads.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 677 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
FLASH
Flash Memory Control Register 1 (FLMCR1)
H'FFFF8580
8
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
FWE
SWE
ESU
PSU
EV
PV
E
P
Initial value
1/0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
Name
Value
Description
When a low level is input to the FWP pin
(hardware-protected state)
7
Flash Write Enable Bit (FWE)
0
1
When a high level is input to the FWP pin
6
Software Write Enable Bit (SWE)
0
Writes disabled
1
Writes enabled
Setting condition: When FWE = 1
0
Erase setup cleared
1
Erase setup
Setting condition: When FWE = 1 and SWE = 1
0
Program setup cleared
1
Program setup
Setting condition: When FWE = 1 and SWE = 1
0
Erase-verify mode cleared
1
Transition to erase-verify mode
0
Program-verify mode cleared
1
Transition to program-verify mode
Setting condition: When FWE = 1 and SWE = 1
0
Erase mode cleared
1
Transition to erase mode
Setting condition: When FWE = 1, SWE = 1, and ESU
=1
0
Program mode cleared
1
Transition to program mode
Setting condition: When FWE = 1, SWE = 1, and PSU
=1
5
4
3
2
1
0
Erase Setup Bit (ESU)
Program Setup Bit (PSU)
Erase-Verify (EV)
Program-Verify (PV)
Erase (E)
Program (P)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 678 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
(initial value)
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
FLASH
Flash Memory Control Register 2 (FLMCR2)
H'FFFF8581
8
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
FLER
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit
7
Name
Flash Memory Error (FLER)
Value
Description
0
Flash memory is operating normally.
Flash memory program/erase protection (error
protection) is disabled.
Clearing condition: Power-on reset
(initial value)
1
An error has occurred during flash memory
programming/erasing.
Flash memory program/erase protection (error
protection) is enabled.
Setting condition: See section 18.8.3, Error Protection.
Erase Block Register 1 (EBR1)
H'FFFF8582
8
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
EB7
EB6
EB5
EB4
EB3
EB2
EB1
EB0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
7 to 0
Name
EB7 to EB0
Value
Description
0
Corresponding block is erase-protected
1
Corresponding block is not erase-protected
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 679 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
FLASH
RAM Emulation Register (RAMER)
H'FFFF8628
8/16/32
Bit
Item
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
Bit name
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
—
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
—
—
—
—
—
RAMS
RAM1
RAM0
Initial value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R/W
R/W
R/W
Bit
2
Name
RAM Select (RAMS)
Value
Description
0
Emulation not selected
Program/erase-protection of all flash memory blocks is
disabled
(initial value)
1
Emulation selected
Program/erase-protection of all flash memory blocks is
enabled
Bit2
RAMS
Bit1
RAM1
Bit0
RAM0
0
*
*
H'FFF800 to H'FFFBFF
RAM area 1 kB
1
0
0
H'01F000 to H'01F3FF
EB4 (1 kB)
1
0
1
H'01F400 to H'01F7FF
EB5 (1 kB)
1
1
0
H'01F800 to H'01FBFF
EB6 (1 kB)
1
1
1
H'01FC00 to H'01FFFF
EB7 (1 kB)
Address
Legend:
*: Don't care
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 680 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Block Name
Appendix A On-Chip Supporting Module Registers
Power-Down State
Standby Control Register (SBYCR)
H'FFFF8614
8/16/32
Bit
Item
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit name
SBY
HIZ
―
―
―
―
―
―
Initial value
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
R
R
R
R
R
Bit
7
6
Name
Standby (SBY)
Port High Impedance (HIZ)
Value
Description
0
Executing SLEEP instruction puts the LSI into sleep
mode
(initial value)
1
Executing SLEEP instruction puts the LSI into standby
mode
0
Holds pin status while in standby mode
1
Keeps pin at high impedance while in standby mode
(initial value)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 681 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PAR
PAn/RXDm
RES
R
Q PAnDR D
PFC
C
PAW
Q PAnMD
Q PAnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
SCI
RXDm
Legend:
PAR: Port A read signal
PAW: Port A write signal
RES: Reset signal
Notes: n = 0, 3
m = 0, 1
Figure B.1 PAn/RXm Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 682 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PAn/SCKm/DREQm/IRQm
PAR
RES
Q PAnDR D
C
PAW
SCKmOUT
PFC
Q PAnMD0
Q PAnMD1
Q PAnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
INTC
IRQm
DMAC
DREQm
SCI
SCKmIN
Legend:
PAR: Port A read signal
PAW: Port A write signal
RES: Reset signal
Notes: n = 2, 5
m = 0, 1
Figure B.2 PAn/SCKm/DREQm/IRQm Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 683 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PA6/TCLKA/CS2,
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PAR
RES
R
Q PAnDR D
C
PAW
CS2, CS3
PFC
Q PAnMD0
Q PAnMD1
Q PAnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
Legend:
PAR: Port A read signal
PAW: Port A write signal
RES: Reset signal
MTU
TCLKA,
TCLKB
Note: n = 6, 7
Figure B.3 PA6/TCLKA/CS2, PA7/TCLKB/CS3 (SH7014, Mask) Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 684 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
On-chip flash memory
WE
Programmer mode
Internal data bus
PA7/TCLKB/CS3
PAR
RES
Q PA7DR D
C
PAW
CS3
PFC
Q PA7MD0
Q PA7MD1
Q PA7IOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
MTU
TCLKB
Legend:
PAR: Port A read signal
PAW: Port A write signal
RES: Reset signal
Figure B.4 PA7/TCLKB/CS3 Block Diagram (F-ZTAT Version)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 685 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2,
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
PAR
RES
R
Q PAnDR D
C
PAW
PFC
Q PAnMD0
Q PAnMD1
Q PAnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
MTU
TCLKC,
TLCKD
Legend:
PAR: Port A read signal
PAW: Port A write signal
RES: Reset signal
INTC
IRQ2,
IRQ3
Note: n = 8, 9
Figure B.5 PAn/TCLKm/IRQx Block Diagram (SH7014, Mask)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 686 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
On-chip flash memory
OE, CE
Programmer mode
Internal data bus
PA8/TCLKC/IRQ2
PA9/TCLKD/IRQ3
PAR
RES
Q PAnDR D
C
PFC
PAW
Q PAnMD0
Q PAnMD1
Q PAnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
MTU
TCLKC,D
INTC
IRQ2,IRQ3
Legend:
PAR: Port A read signal
PAW: Port A write signal
RES: Reset signal
Note: n = 8, 9
Figure B.6 PAn/TCLKm/IRQx Block Diagram (F-ZTAT Version)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 687 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PAR
RES
PAn/TXDm
R
Q PAnDR D
C
TXDm
PAW
PFC
Q PAnMD
Q PAnIOR
Standby
Legend:
PAR: Port A read signal
PAW: Port A write signal
RES: Reset signal
Notes: n = 1, 4
m = 0, 1
Figure B.7 PAn/TXDm Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 688 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
SBYCR
Q HIZ
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PAR
RES
PA15/CK
R
Q PA15DR D
C
CK
PAW
Single-chip mode*
MCU mode 2
MCU mode 1
MCU mode 0
PFC
Q PA15MD
Q PA15IOR
Standby
Legend:
PAR: Port A read signal
PAW: Port A write signal
RES: Reset signal
Note:
SBYCR
Q HIZ
* SH7016, SH7017 only
Figure B.8 PA15/CK Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 689 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PAR
PAn/XXX
RES
R
Q PAnDR D
C
CS0, CS1, WRL,
WRH, RD
Single-chip mode
PAW
MCU mode 0
MCU mode 1
MCU mode 2
PFC
Bus right
release
Q PAnMD
Q PAnIOR
Standby
Legend:
PAR: Port A read signal
PAW: Port A write signal
RES: Reset signal
SBYCR
Q HIZ
Note: n = 10 to 14
Figure B.9 PAn/XXX Block Diagram (SH7016, SH7017)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 690 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
On-chip
flash memory*
A16
PB0/A16
Programmer mode
Internal data bus
PBR
RES
R
Q PB0DR D
C
A16
PBW
Single-chip mode
MCU mode 0
MCU mode 1
MCU mode 2
PFC
Bus right
release
Q PB0MDO
Q PB0IOR
Standby
Legend:
PBR: Port B read signal
PBW: Port B write signal
RES: Reset signal
SBYCR
Q HIZ
Note: * F-ZTAT version only
Figure B.10 PB0/A16 Block Diagram (SH7016, SH7017)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 691 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PBR
RES
PB1/A17
R
Q PB1DR D
C
A17
PBW
Single-chip mode
MCU mode 0
MCU mode 1
MCU mode 2
PFC
Q PB1MD
Q PB1IOR
Standby
Legend:
PBR: Port B read signal
PBW: Port B write signal
RES: Reset signal
SBYCR
Q HIZ
Figure B.11 PB1/A17 Block Diagram (SH7016, SH7017)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 692 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PBR
RES
PBn/Am
R
Q PBnDR D
C
PBW
Am
PFC
Q PBnMD0
Q PBnMD1
Q PBnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
Legend:
PBR: Port B read signal
PBW: Port B write signal
RES: Reset signal
Notes: n = 6, 7
m = 18, 19
Figure B.12 PBn/Am Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 693 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PBR
PBn/IRQm/CASx
RES
Q PBnDR D
C
PBW
CASL,CASH
PFC
Q PBnMD0
Q PBnMD1
Q PBnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
INTC
IRQm
Legend:
PBR: Port B read signal
PBW: Port B write signal
RES: Reset signal
Notes: n = 3, 4
m = 1, 2
Figure B.13 PBn/IRQm/CASx Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 694 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PBR
PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT
RES
Q PB8DR D
C
PBW
A20
PFC
Q PB8MD0
Q PB8MD1
Q PB8IOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
BSC
WAIT
INTC
IRQ6
Legend:
PBR: Port B read signal
PBW: Port B write signal
RES: Reset signal
Figure B.14 PB8/IRQ6/A20/WAIT Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 695 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PBR
PB9/IRQ7/A21
RES
Q PB9DR D
C
PBW
A21
PFC
Q PB9MD0
Q PB9MD1
Q PB9IOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
INTC
IRQ7
Legend:
PBR: Port B read signal
PBW: Port B write signal
RES: Reset signal
Figure B.15 PB9/IRQ7/A21 Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 696 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PBR
PBn/IRQm/XXXX
RES
Q PBnDR D
C
PBW
RAS,RDWR
PFC
Q PBnMD0
Q PBnMD1
Q PBnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
INTC
IRQm
Legend:
PBR: Port B read signal
PBW: Port B write signal
RES: Reset signal
Notes: n = 2, 5
m = 0, 3
Figure B.16 PBn/IRQm/XXXX Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 697 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
On-chip
flash memory*
An
PCn/An
Programmer mode
Internal data bus
PCR
RES
R
Q PCnDR D
C
An
PCW
Single-chip mode
MCU mode 0
MCU mode 1
MCU mode 2
PFC
Q PCnMD
Q PCnIOR
Standby
Legend:
PCR: Port C read signal
PCW: Port C write signal
RES: Reset signal
Notes: n = 0 to 15
* F-ZTAT version only
Figure B.17 PCn/An Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 698 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
SBYCR
Q HIZ
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
On-chip
flash memory*
Dn
Internal data bus
PDR
RES
Programmer mode
PDn/Dn
R
Q PDnDR D
C
Dn
Dout
PDW
Single-chip mode
MCU mode 0
MCU mode 1
MCU mode 2
PFC
SLEEP
Q PDnMD0
Q PDnIOR
Standby
Din
SBYCR
Q HIZ
Legend:
PDR: Port D read signal
PDW: Port D write signal
RES: Reset signal
Dout: Data bus output timing signal
Din: Data bus input timing signal
Notes: n = 0 to 15
* F-ZTAT version only
Figure B.18 PDn/Dn Block Diagram (SH7016, SH7017)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 699 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PER
PEn
RES
Q PEnDR D
C
PEW
PFC
Q PEnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Legend:
PER: Port E read signal
PEW: Port E write signal
RES: Reset signal
Note: n = 8 to 13
Figure B.19 PEn Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 700 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Q HIZ
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PER
PE14/DACK0/AH
RES
Q PE14DRD
C
PEW
DRAK0
AH
PFC
Q PE14MD0
Q PE14MD1
Q PE14IOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
Legend:
PER: Port E read signal
PEW: Port E write signal
RES: Reset signal
Figure B.20 PE14/DACK0/AH Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 701 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PER
PE15/DACK1
RES
Q PE15DRD
C
PEW
DRAK1
PFC
Q PE15MD0
Q PE15MD1
Q PE15IOR
SBYCR
Standby
Legend:
PER: Port E read signal
PEW: Port E write signal
RES: Reset signal
Figure B.21 PE15/DACK1 Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 702 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Q HIZ
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
Internal data bus
PER
PEn/TIOCXX
RES
Q PEnDR
C
D
PEW
TIOC1A, TIOC1B,
TIOC2A, TIOC2B
PFC
Q PEnMD
Q PEnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
MTU
TIOC1A, TIOC1B,
TIOC2A, TIOC2B
Legend:
PER: Port E read signal
PEW: Port E write signal
RES: Reset signal
Note: n = 4 to 7
Figure B.22 PEn/TIOCXX Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 703 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
PEn/TIOCXX/DRAKm
RES
Q PEnDR
C
Internal data bus
PER
D
PEW
TIOC0B
TIOC0D
DRAKm
PFC
Q PEnMD0
Q PEnMD1
Q PEnIOR
SBYCR
Standby
Q HIZ
MTU
Legend:
PER: Port E read signal
PEW: Port E write signal
RES: Reset signal
Notes: n = 1, 3
m = 0, 1
Figure B.23 PEn/TIOCXX/DRAKm Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 704 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
TIOC0B
TIOC0D
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
PEn/TIOCXX/DREQm
RES
Internal data bus
PER
Q PEnDR D
C
PEW
TIOC0A
TIOC0C
PFC
Q PEnMD0
Q PEnMD1
Q PEnIOR
Standby
SBYCR
Q HIZ
MTU
TIOC0A
TIOC0C
DMA
DREQm
Legend:
PER: Port E read signal
PEW: Port E write signal
RES: Reset signal
Notes: n = 0, 2
m = 0, 1
Figure B.24 PEn/TIOCXX/DREQm Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 705 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Internal data bus
Appendix B I/O Port Block Diagrams
PFn/ANn
PFR
Standby
SBYCR
Q HIZ
AD
ANn
Legend:
PFR: Port F read signal
Note: n = 0 to 7
Figure B.25 PFn/ANn Block Diagram
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 706 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix C Pin States
Appendix C Pin States
C.1
Pin States
Table C.1
Pin States in Reset, and Power-Down Modes
Pin modes
Pin Function
Class
Pin Name
Reset
Power-Down
Power-On
Standby
1
Sleep
Clock
CK
O
H*
System control
RES
I
I
I
WDTOVF
O
O
O
Interrupt
NMI
I
I
I
IRQ0 to IRQ3, IRQ6, IRQ7
Z
Z
I
Address bus
A0 to A21
O
Z
O
Data bus
D0 to D15
Z
Z
I/O
Bus control
WAIT
Z
Z
I
RDWR, RAS
Z
O
H
CASH, CASL
Z
O
H
RD
H
Z
H
CS0, CS1
H
Z
H
CS2, CS3
Z
Z
H
WRH, WRL
H
Z
H
AH
Z
Z
DMAC
MTU
SCI
A/D converter
DACK0, DACK1
Z
O
L
O*
1
O
1
O
DRAK0, DRAK1
Z
O*
DREQ0, DREQ1
Z
Z
TIOC0A to TIOC0D,
TIOC1A, TIOC1B,
TIOC2A, TIOC2B
Z
K*
TCLKA to TCLKD
Z
Z
SCK0, SCK1
Z
Z
I
1
I/O
I
I/O
1
TXD0, TXD1
Z
O*
O
RXD0, RXD1
Z
Z
I
AN0 to AN7
Z
Z
I
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 707 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix C Pin States
Pin modes
Pin Function
Class
I/O Port
Pin Name
PA0 to PA9, PA15
Reset
Power-Down
Power-On
Standby
Z
K*
Z
Z
1
Sleep
K
PB0 to PB9
PC0 to PC15
PD0 to PD15
PE0 to PE15*
2
PF0 to PF7
I
Legend:
I: Input
O: Output
H: High-level output
L: Low-level output
Z: High impedance
K: Input pin with high impedance, output pin mode maintained.
Notes: 1. If the standby control register port high-impedence bits are set to 1, output pins become
high impedence.
2. When an emulator is used, PE9 and PE11 to PE15 become high-impedance in standby
mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 708 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix C Pin States
C.2
Pin States of Bus Related Signals
Table C.2
Pin Settings for On-Chip Peripheral Modules
On-Chip Peripheral Module
16-Bit Space
Pin Name
On-Chip ROM
On-Chip
(SH7016/17 only) RAM
Lower
8-Bit Space Upper Byte Byte
Word/
Longword
CS0 to CS3
H
H
H
H
H
H
RAS*
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
RDWR
H
H
H
H
H
H
AH
L
L
L
L
L
L
R
H
H
H
H
H
H
W
⎯
H
H
H
H
H
R
H
H
H
H
H
H
W
⎯
H
H
H
H
H
R
H
H
H
H
H
H
W
⎯
H
H
H
H
H
A21 to A0
Address
Address
Address
Address
Address
Address
D15 to D8
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
D7 to D0
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
Hi-Z
1
CASH*
CASL*
2
2
RD
WRH
WRL
Legend:
R: Read
W: Write
Notes: 1. L asserted in RAS down state or refresh state.
2. L asserted in refresh state.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 709 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix C Pin States
Table C.3
Pin Settings for Normal External Space
Normal External Space
16-Bit Space
Pin Name
8-Bit Space
Upper Word
Lower Word
Word/Longword
CS0 to CS2
Valid
Valid
Valid
Valid
CS3
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
RAS*
1
CASH*
CASL*
2
2
RDWR
AH
L
L
L
L
R
L
L
L
L
W
H
H
H
H
R
H
H
H
H
W
H
L
H
L
R
H
H
H
H
W
L
H
L
L
A21 to A0
Address
Address
Address
Address
D15 to D8
Hi-Z
Data
Hi-Z
Data
D7 to D0
Data
Hi-Z
Data
Data
RD
WRH
WRL
Legend:
R:
Read
W:
Write
Valid: Chip select signal corresponding with accessed area is low; chip select signal in other
cases is high.
Notes: 1. L asserted in RAS down state or refresh state.
2. L asserted in refresh state.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 710 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix C Pin States
Table C.4
Pin Settings for Multiplex I/O Space
Multiplex I/O Space
16-Bit Space
Pin Name
8-Bit Space
Upper Byte
Lower Byte
Word/Longword
CS0 to CS2
H
H
H
H
CS3
L
L
L
L
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
H
RAS*
1
CASH*
CASL*
2
2
RDWR
AH
Valid
Valid
Valid
Valid
R
L
L
L
L
W
H
H
H
H
R
H
H
H
H
W
H
L
H
L
R
H
H
H
H
W
L
H
L
L
A21 to A0
Address
Address
Address
Address
D15 to D8
Hi-Z
Address/Data
D7 to D0
Address/Data Address
RD
WRH
WRL
Address
Address/Data
Address/Data
Address/Data
Legend:
R:
Read
W:
Write
Valid: High output in accordance with AH timing
Notes: 1. L asserted in RAS down mode or refresh mode.
2. L asserted in refresh mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 711 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix C Pin States
Table C.5
Pin Settings for DRAM Space
DRAM Space
16-Bit Space
Pin Name
8-Bit Space
Upper Word
Lower Word
Word/Longword
CS0 to CS3
H
H
H
H
RAS*
Valid
Valid
Valid
Valid
H
Valid
H
Valid
Valid
H
Valid
Valid
R
H
H
H
H
W
L
L
L
L
1
CASH*
CASL*
2
2
RDWR
AH
L
L
L
L
R
L
L
L
L
W
H
H
H
H
R
H
H
H
H
W
H
L
H
L
R
H
H
H
H
W
L
H
L
L
A21 to A0
Address
Address
Address
Address
D15 to D8
Hi-Z
Data
Hi-Z
Data
D7 to D0
Data
Hi-Z
Data
Data
RD
WRH
WRL
Legend:
R:
Read
W:
Write
Valid: Asserted (low) at a timing determined by the DRAM access strobe waveform
Notes: 1. L asserted in RAS down mode or refresh mode.
2. L asserted in refresh mode.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 712 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix D Notes when Converting the F-ZTAT Application Software to the Mask-ROM Versions
Appendix D Notes when Converting the F-ZTAT
Application Software to the Mask-ROM Versions
Please note the following when converting the F-ZTAT application software to the mask-ROM
versions.
The values read from the internal registers for the flash ROM of the mask-ROM version and FZTAT version differ as follows.
Status
Register
Bit
F-ZTAT Version
Mask-ROM Version
FLMCR1
FWE
0: Application software
running
0: Is not read out
1: Programming
1: Application software
running
Note: This difference applies to all the F-ZTAT versions and all the mask-ROM versions that have
different ROM size.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 713 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix E Product Code Lineup
Appendix E Product Code Lineup
Table E.1
SH7014, SH7016, and SH7017 Product Code Lineup
Product Type
Product Code
Mark Code
Package
(Package code)
SH7014
HD6417014F28
HD6417014F28
112-pin QFP (FP-112)
HD6417014RF28
HD6417014RF28
112-pin QFP (FP-112)
SH7016
Mask ROM
version
HD6437016F28
HD6437016(***)F28
112-pin QFP (FP-112)
SH7017
F-ZTAT
version
HD64F7017F28
HD64F7017
112-pin QFP (FP-112)
Note: (***) is the ROM code.
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 714 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix F Package Dimensions
Appendix F Package Dimensions
Package dimensions of the SH7014, SH7016, SH7017 (FP-112) are shown in figure F.1.
JEITA Package Code
P-QFP112-20x20-0.65
RENESAS Code
PRQP0112JA-A
Previous Code
FP-112/FP-112V
MASS[Typ.]
2.4g
HD
*1
D
84
NOTE)
1. DIMENSIONS"*1"AND"*2"
DO NOT INCLUDE MOLD FLASH
2. DIMENSION"*3"DOES NOT
INCLUDE TRIM OFFSET.
57
85
56
bp
c
c1
HE
*2
E
b1
Reference Dimension in Millimeters
Symbol
Min
ZE
Terminal cross section
29
112
28
F
c
A
ZD
A2
1
θ
A1
L
L1
Detail F
e
*3
y
bp
x
M
D
E
A2
HD
HE
A
AA
bp
b1
c
c1
θ
e
x
y
ZD
ZE
L
L1
Nom Max
20
20
2.70
22.9 23.2 23.5
22.9 23.2 23.5
3.05
0.00 0.10 0.25
0.24 0.32 0.40
0.30
0.12 0.17 0.22
0.15
8˚
0˚
0.65
0.13
0.10
1.23
1.23
0.5 0.8 1.1
1.6
Figure F.1 Package Dimensions (FP-112)
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 715 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Appendix F Package Dimensions
Rev.5.00 Sep. 27, 2007 Page 716 of 716
REJ09B0398-0500
Renesas 32-Bit RISC Microcomputer
Hardware Manual
SH7014, SH7016, SH7017F-ZTATTM
Publication Date: 1st Edition, September 1997
Rev.5.00, September 27, 2007
Published by:
Sales Strategic Planning Div.
Renesas Technology Corp.
Edited by:
Customer Support Department
Global Strategic Communication Div.
Renesas Solutions Corp.
© 2007. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan.
Sales Strategic Planning Div.
Nippon Bldg., 2-6-2, Ohte-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo 100-0004, Japan
RENESAS SALES OFFICES
http://www.renesas.com
Refer to "http://www.renesas.com/en/network" for the latest and detailed information.
Renesas Technology America, Inc.
450 Holger Way, San Jose, CA 95134-1368, U.S.A
Tel: <1> (408) 382-7500, Fax: <1> (408) 382-7501
Renesas Technology Europe Limited
Dukes Meadow, Millboard Road, Bourne End, Buckinghamshire, SL8 5FH, U.K.
Tel: <44> (1628) 585-100, Fax: <44> (1628) 585-900
Renesas Technology (Shanghai) Co., Ltd.
Unit 204, 205, AZIACenter, No.1233 Lujiazui Ring Rd, Pudong District, Shanghai, China 200120
Tel: <86> (21) 5877-1818, Fax: <86> (21) 6887-7898
Renesas Technology Hong Kong Ltd.
7th Floor, North Tower, World Finance Centre, Harbour City, 1 Canton Road, Tsimshatsui, Kowloon, Hong Kong
Tel: <852> 2265-6688, Fax: <852> 2730-6071
Renesas Technology Taiwan Co., Ltd.
10th Floor, No.99, Fushing North Road, Taipei, Taiwan
Tel: <886> (2) 2715-2888, Fax: <886> (2) 2713-2999
Renesas Technology Singapore Pte. Ltd.
1 Harbour Front Avenue, #06-10, Keppel Bay Tower, Singapore 098632
Tel: <65> 6213-0200, Fax: <65> 6278-8001
Renesas Technology Korea Co., Ltd.
Kukje Center Bldg. 18th Fl., 191, 2-ka, Hangang-ro, Yongsan-ku, Seoul 140-702, Korea
Tel: <82> (2) 796-3115, Fax: <82> (2) 796-2145
Renesas Technology Malaysia Sdn. Bhd
Unit 906, Block B, Menara Amcorp, Amcorp Trade Centre, No.18, Jalan Persiaran Barat, 46050 Petaling Jaya, Selangor Darul Ehsan, Malaysia
Tel: <603> 7955-9390, Fax: <603> 7955-9510
Colophon 6.0
TM
SH7014, SH7016, SH7017F-ZTAT
Hardware Manual
2-6-2, Ote-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo, 100-0004, Japan
Similar pages